Mazda Automobile 2007 CX 9 User Manual

CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page1  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (1,1)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page3  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (3,1)  
AWord to Mazda Owners  
Thank you for choosing a Mazda. We at Mazda design and build vehicles with complete  
customer satisfaction in mind.  
To help ensure enjoyable and trouble-free operation of your Mazda, read this manual  
carefully and follow its recommendations.  
An Authorized Mazda Dealer knows your vehicle best. So when maintenance or service is  
necessary, that's the place to go.  
Our nationwide network of Mazda professionals is dedicated to providing you with the best  
possible service.  
We assure you that all of us at Mazda have an ongoing interest in your motoring pleasure  
and in your full satisfaction with your Mazda product.  
Mazda Motor Corporation  
HIROSHIMA, JAPAN  
Important Notes About This Manual  
Keep this manual in the glove box as a handy reference for the safe and enjoyable use of your Mazda. Should you  
resell the vehicle, leave this manual with it for the next owner.  
All specifications and descriptions are accurate at the time of printing. Because improvement is a constant goal at  
Mazda, we reserve the right to make changes in specifications at any time without notice and without obligation.  
Event Data Recorder  
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder. In the event of a crash, this device records data related to  
vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of time. These data can help provide a better  
understanding of the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur and lead to the designing of safer  
vehicles.  
Air Conditioning and the Environment  
Your Mazda's genuine air conditioner is filled with HFC134a (R134a), a refrigerant that has been found not to  
damage the earth's ozone layer. If the air conditioner does not operate properly, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
Perchlorate  
Certain components of this vehicle such as [air bag modules, seat belt pretensioners, lithium batteries, ...] may  
contain Perchlorate MaterialSpecial handling may apply for service or vehicle end of life disposal. See  
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.  
Please be aware that this manual applies to all models, equipment and options. As a result, you may find  
some explanations for equipment not installed on your vehicle.  
©2006 Mazda Motor Corporation  
Printed in Japan Mar. 2007(Print3)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page4  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (4,1)  
How to Use This Manual  
We want to help you get the most driving  
pleasure from your vehicle. Your owner's  
manual, when read from cover to cover,  
can do that in many ways.  
NOTE  
A NOTE provides information and sometimes  
suggests how to make better use of your  
vehicle.  
The symbol below, located on some parts  
of the vehicle, indicates that this manual  
contains information related to the part.  
Please refer to the manual for a detailed  
explanation.  
Illustrations complement the words of the  
manual to best explain how to enjoy your  
Mazda. By reading your manual, you can  
find out about the features, important  
safety information, and driving under  
various road conditions.  
The symbol below in this manual means  
Do not do thisor Do not let this  
happen.  
Index: A good place to start is the Index,  
an alphabetical listing of all information  
in your manual.  
You'll find several WARNINGs,  
CAUTIONs, and NOTEs in the manual.  
WARNING  
A WARNING indicates a situation in  
which serious injury or death could  
result if the warning is ignored.  
CAUTION  
A CAUTION indicates a situation in  
which bodily injury or damage to  
your vehicle, or both, could result if  
the caution is ignored.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page5  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (5,1)  
Table of Contents  
Interior, exterior views and part identification of your Mazda.  
Use of safety equipment, including seats, seat belt system, child-restraint  
systems and SRS air bags.  
Explanation of basic operations and controls; opening/closing and adjustment  
of various parts.  
Important information about driving your Mazda.  
Explanation of instruments and controls.  
Use of various features for drive comfort, including air-conditioning and audio  
system.  
Helpful information on what to do in an emergency.  
How to keep your Mazda in top condition.  
Important consumer information including warranties and add-on equipment.  
Technical information about your Mazda.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page6  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (6,1)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page8  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (8,1)  
Your Vehicle at a Glance  
Interior Overview  
Interior Equipment (View A)  
1-2  
The equipment and installation position varies by vehicle  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page9  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (9,1)  
Your Vehicle at a Glance  
Interior Overview  
Interior Equipment (View B)  
Navigation System (if equipped) .......................................... Refer to the separate manual  
The equipment and installation position varies by vehicle  
1-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page10  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (10,1)  
Your Vehicle at a Glance  
Interior Overview  
Interior Equipment (View C)  
1-4  
The equipment and installation position varies by vehicle  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page13  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (13,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
2
Use of safety equipment, including seats, seat belt system, child-restraint  
systems and SRS air bags.  
2-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page14  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (14,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
Make sure the adjustable components  
of a seat are locked in place:  
Front Seats (Manually  
Operated Seats)  
Adjustable seats and seatbacks that  
are not securely locked are  
dangerous. In a sudden stop or  
collision, the seat or seatback could  
move, causing injury. Make sure the  
adjustable components of the seat  
are locked in place by attempting to  
slide the seat forward and backward  
and rocking the seatback.  
WARNING  
Do not modify or replace the front  
seats:  
Modifying or replacing the front seats  
such as replacing the upholstery or  
loosening any bolts is dangerous. The  
front seats contain air bag  
components essential to the  
supplemental restraint system. Such  
modifications could damage the  
supplemental restraint system and  
result in serious injury. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer if there is  
any need to remove or reinstall the  
front seats.  
qSeat Slide  
WARNING  
Adjust the driver seat only when the  
vehicle is stopped:  
Adjusting the driver's seat while the  
vehicle is moving is dangerous. The  
driver could lose control of the vehicle  
and have an accident.  
Do not drive with damaged front seats:  
Driving with damaged front seats is  
dangerous. A collision, even one not  
strong enough to inflate the air bags,  
could damage the front seats which  
contain essential air bag  
To move a seat forward or backward, raise  
the lever and slide the seat to the desired  
position and release the lever.  
components. If there was a  
subsequent collision, an air bag may  
not deploy which could lead to  
injuries. Always have an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer inspect the front seats,  
front seat belt pretensioners and air  
bags after a collision.  
Make sure the lever returns to its original  
position and the seat is locked in place by  
attempting to push it forward and  
backward.  
2-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page15  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (15,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
Do not drive with the seatback  
unlocked:  
qSeat Recline  
The seatback plays an important role  
in your protection in a vehicle.  
Leaving the seatback unlocked is  
dangerous as it can allow passengers  
to be ejected or thrown around and  
baggage to strike occupants in a  
sudden stop or collision, resulting in  
severe injury. After adjusting the  
seatback at any time, even when  
there are no other passengers, rock  
the seatback to make sure it is locked  
in place.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with the seats reclined:  
Sitting in a reclined position while the  
vehicle is moving is dangerous  
because you don't get the full  
protection from seat belts. During  
sudden braking or a collision, you  
can slide under the lap belt and  
suffer serious internal injuries. For  
maximum protection, sit well back  
and upright.  
Always sit in a passenger seat properly  
with the seatback upright and feet on  
the floor:  
To change the seatback angle, lean  
forward slightly while raising the lever.  
Then lean back to the desired position and  
release the lever.  
If your vehicle is equipped with front  
passenger seat weight sensors,  
sitting in the front passenger seat  
improperly out of position or with the  
seatback reclined too far while the  
vehicle is moving is dangerous as it  
can take off weight from the seat  
bottom and affect the weight  
determination of the front passenger  
sensing system. As a result the front  
passenger will not have the  
supplementary protection of the air  
bag and seat belt pretensioner, which  
could cause result in serious injury.  
Always sit upright against your  
seatback, with your feet on the floor.  
Make sure the lever returns to its original  
position and the seatback is locked in  
place by attempting to push it forward and  
backward.  
2-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page16  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (16,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
qHead Restraint  
CAUTION  
When returning a rear-reclined  
seatback to its upright position,  
make sure you hold onto the  
seatback with your other hand while  
operating the lever. If the seatback is  
not supported, it will flip forward  
suddenly and could cause injury.  
WARNING  
Always drive with the head restraints  
installed when seats are being used  
and make sure they are properly  
adjusted:  
Driving with the head restraints  
adjusted too low or removed is  
dangerous. With no support behind  
your head, your neck could be  
seriously injured in a collision.  
q
Height Adjustment (Driver's Seat)  
By moving the seat lever up or down, the  
seat bottom height can be adjusted.  
To raise a head restraint, pull it up to the  
desired position.  
To lower the head restraint, press the stop-  
catch release, then push the head restraint  
down.  
Up  
Down  
qLumbar Support Adjustment  
(Driver's Seat)  
To increase the seat firmness, pull the  
lever forward. Push the lever backward to  
decrease firmness.  
Adjust the head restraint so that the top is  
even with the top of the passenger's ears,  
never the passenger's neck to prevent  
injury.  
2-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page17  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (17,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
Front Seats (Electrically  
Operated Seats)  
CAUTION  
Ø The seat-bottom power  
adjustment is operated by motors.  
Avoid extended operation because  
excessive use can damage the  
motors.  
WARNING  
Do not modify or replace the front  
seats:  
Ø To prevent the battery from  
running down, avoid using the  
power adjustment when the  
engine is stopped. The adjuster  
uses a large amount of electrical  
power.  
Modifying or replacing the front seats  
such as replacing the upholstery or  
loosening any bolts is dangerous. The  
front seats contain air bag  
components essential to the  
supplemental restraint system. Such  
modifications could damage the  
supplemental restraint system and  
result in serious injury. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer if there is  
any need to remove or reinstall the  
front seats.  
Ø Don't use the switch to make more  
than one adjustment at a time.  
qSeat Slide  
To slide the seat, move the slide lifter  
switch on the outside of the seat to the  
front or back and hold it. Release the  
switch at the desired position.  
Do not drive with damaged front seats:  
Driving with damaged front seats is  
dangerous. A collision, even one not  
strong enough to inflate the air bags,  
could damage the front seats which  
contain essential air bag  
components. If there was a  
subsequent collision, an air bag may  
not deploy which could lead to  
injuries. Always have an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer inspect the front seats,  
front seat belt pretensioners and air  
bags after a collision.  
2-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page18  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (18,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
Change the seatback angle by pressing the  
front or rear side of the reclining switch.  
Release the switch at the desired position.  
qSeat Recline  
WARNING  
Do not drive with the seats reclined:  
Sitting in a reclined position while the  
vehicle is moving is dangerous  
because you don't get the full  
protection from seat belts. During  
sudden braking or a collision, you  
can slide under the lap belt and  
suffer serious internal injuries. For  
maximum protection, sit well back  
and upright.  
Always sit in a front passenger seat  
properly with the seatback upright and  
feet on the floor:  
q
Height Adjustment (Driver's Seat)  
If your vehicle is equipped with front  
passenger seat weight sensors,  
sitting in the front passenger seat  
improperly out of position or with the  
seatback reclined too far while the  
vehicle is moving is dangerous as it  
can take off weight from the seat  
bottom and affect the weight  
The seat height can be adjusted by  
moving the switch up or down.  
determination of the front passenger  
sensing system. As a result the front  
passenger will not have the  
supplementary protection of the air  
bag and seat belt pretensioner, which  
could cause result in serious injury.  
Always sit upright against your  
seatback, with your feet on the floor.  
2-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page19  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (19,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
l
Operation using the advanced key/  
retractable type key  
Programmed seat positions can also be  
called up using the following functions:  
l
Programming buttons  
Operation using the advanced key/  
retractable type key  
.
l
NOTE  
Individual seat positions can be programmed  
to the number of programming buttons 3  
available on the side of the driver's seat, plus  
one seat position for each advanced key/  
retractable type key used with the vehicle.  
qSeat Position Memory (Driver's  
Seat)í  
Operation using the seat-side buttons  
Programming  
One-touch seat position programming and  
call up is available on the driver's seat.  
Seat position programming is possible  
when the vehicle is parked.  
CAUTION  
1. Adjust the seat to the desired position.  
For each seat position adjustment  
method refer to the following pages:  
Seat Slide (page 2-5)  
When calling up the seat position, do  
not place your hands or fingers  
around the seat bottom. The seat  
moves to the desired position  
automatically, and if your hands or  
fingers are placed around the seat  
bottom, it could cause injury.  
Seat Recline (page 2-6)  
Height Adjustment (page 2-6)  
2. Press the desired programming button  
while pressing the set button  
until a beep sound is heard.  
Set button  
NOTE  
Vehicle maintenance or other reasons  
requiring the vehicle battery to be  
disconnected will result in the seat position  
memory being erased.  
In this case, re-program the seat positions.  
Seat position call up  
With the ignition switch in the LOCK  
position, and the driver's door open, press  
Programming of the driver's seat positions  
is possible using the following functions:  
the programming button  
that has  
been programmed to the desired seat  
position.  
l
Programming buttons  
set button.  
and the  
íSome models.  
2-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page20  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (20,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
NOTE  
Programming  
l
Seat positions can also be called up with  
One seat position can be programmed into  
each advanced key/retractable type key.  
After the following conditions have been  
met, operate the seat and the advanced  
key/retractable type key to program the  
seat positions.  
the ignition switch in the ON position and  
the door closed by pressing and holding the  
programming button  
that has  
been programmed to the desired seat  
position.  
If any of the following occurs, the seat  
position call up function cancels:  
l
l
The engine switch is in the LOCK  
position  
l
A seat adjustment switch is operated.  
The vehicle is moving or starts to move.  
The selected programming button  
(The auxiliary key/retractable type key  
is removed from the ignition switch)  
The driver's door is open  
l
l
l
or the set button is pressed  
again.  
1. Adjust the seat to the desired position.  
For each seat position adjustment  
method, refer to the following pages:  
Seat Slide (page 2-5)  
Operation using the advanced key/  
retractable type key  
With advanced key  
Seat Recline (page 2-6)  
Height Adjustment (page 2-6)  
Auxiliary key  
Lock button  
2. If the driver's door is closed, open it.  
3. Press and hold the unlock button of the  
advanced key/retractable type key  
while pressing the set button until a  
beep sound is heard.  
Seat position call up  
Unlock the doors using the unlock button  
on the advanced key/retractable type key,  
and open the driver's door.  
Unlock button  
With retractable type key  
Erasing memory  
After the following conditions have been  
met, press and hold the lock button of the  
advanced key/retractable type key while  
pressing the set button until a beep sound  
is heard.  
Lock button  
Unlock button  
l
The engine switch is in the LOCK  
position  
(The auxiliary key/retractable type key  
is removed from the ignition switch)  
The driver's door is open  
l
2-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page21  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (21,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
NOTE  
Electrically operated  
Memory will also be erased if any of the  
following operations are performed:  
The amount of lumbar support can be  
adjusted by pressing the switch.  
To increase the seat firmness, press and  
hold the front part of the switch to the  
desired position, then release it.  
Press the rear part of the switch to  
decrease firmness.  
l
The advanced key/retractable type key code  
has been changed.  
Refer to Immobilizer System (with  
Advanced Key) on page 3-50.  
Refer to Immobilizer System (without  
Advanced Key) on page 3-52.  
Refer to Immobilizer System on page 3-52.  
l
The vehicle battery is disconnected for  
vehicle maintenance or other reasons.  
qLumbar Support Adjustment  
(Driver's Seat)  
Manually operated  
To increase the seat firmness, pull the  
lever forward. Push the lever backward to  
decrease firmness.  
qHead Restraint  
WARNING  
Always drive with the head restraints  
installed when seats are being used  
and make sure they are properly  
adjusted:  
Driving with the head restraints  
adjusted too low or removed is  
dangerous. With no support behind  
your head, your neck could be  
seriously injured in a collision.  
2-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page22  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (22,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
To raise a head restraint, pull it up to the  
desired position.  
NOTE  
The seat temperature is regulated  
To lower the head restraint, press the stop-  
catch release, then push the head restraint  
down.  
automatically by a thermostat. Other than  
turning it on or off, it cannot be adjusted.  
Adjust the head restraint so that the top is  
even with the top of the passenger's ears,  
never the passenger's neck to prevent  
injury.  
qSeat Warmerí  
The front seats are electrically heated. The  
ignition switch must be in the ON  
position.  
Press the switch to turn the seat warmer  
on or off. When the switch is in the ON  
position, the indicator light will come on.  
2-10  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page23  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (23,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
Do not drive with the seatback  
unlocked:  
Second-Row Seats  
The seatback plays an important role  
in your protection in a vehicle.  
Leaving the seatback unlocked is  
dangerous as it can allow passengers  
to be ejected or thrown around and  
baggage to strike occupants in a  
sudden stop or collision, resulting in  
severe injury. After adjusting the  
seatback at any time, even when  
there are no other passengers, rock  
the seatback to make sure it is locked  
in place.  
WARNING  
Do not stack cargo higher than the  
seatback:  
Stacking luggage or other cargo  
higher than the seatback is  
dangerous. During a sudden stop or  
collision, objects can fly around and  
become projectiles that could hit and  
injure passengers.  
Make sure luggage and cargo is  
secured before driving:  
Not securing cargo while driving is  
dangerous as it could move or be  
crushed during sudden braking or a  
collision and cause injury.  
Never allow a passenger to sit or stand  
on the folded seatback while the  
vehicle is moving:  
Driving with a passenger on the  
folded seatback is dangerous.  
Allowing a child to sit up on the  
folded seatback while the vehicle is  
moving is particularly dangerous. In  
a sudden stop or even a minor  
collision, a child not in a proper seat  
or child-restraint system and seat  
belt could be thrown forward, back  
or even out of the vehicle resulting in  
serious injuries or death. The child in  
the baggage area could be thrown  
into other occupants and cause  
serious injury.  
Make sure the adjustable components  
of a seat are locked in place by  
attempting to slide the seat forward  
and backward and rocking the  
seatback:  
Adjustable seats that are not securely  
latched are dangerous. In a sudden  
stop or collision, the seat or seatback  
could move, causing injury.  
Adjust the seat only when the vehicle is  
stopped:  
Adjusting the seat while the vehicle is  
moving is dangerous. Sudden  
braking or a collision could cause  
serious injury.  
NOTE  
The second-row seats cannot be removed.  
2-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page24  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (24,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
qSeat Slide  
qSeat Recline  
To move the seat forward or backward,  
raise the bar and slide the seat to the  
desired position and release the bar.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with the seats reclined:  
Sitting in a reclined position while the  
vehicle is moving is dangerous  
because you don't get the full  
protection from the seat belts. During  
sudden braking or a collision, you  
can slide under the lap belt and  
suffer serious internal injuries. For  
maximum protection, sit well back  
and upright.  
Do not recline a second-row seatback  
when the third row seat is occupied:  
Reclining the second-row seatback  
when the third-row seat is occupied  
is dangerous.Because the clearance  
in the third-row seat is limited,  
occupants in the third-row seat could  
be hurt seriously on a reclined  
Make sure the bar returns to its original  
position and the seat is locked in place by  
attempting to push it forward and  
backward.  
second-row seatback.  
To change the seatback angle, lean  
forward slightly while pulling the lever.  
Then lean back to the desired position and  
release the lever.  
Make sure the lever returns to its original  
position and the seatback is locked in  
place by attempting to push it forward and  
backward.  
2-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page25  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (25,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
Adjust the head restraint so that the top is  
even with the top of the passenger's ears,  
never the passenger's neck to prevent  
injury.  
CAUTION  
When returning a rear-reclined  
seatback to its upright position,  
make sure you hold onto the  
seatback with your other hand while  
operating the lever. If the seatback is  
not supported, it will flip forward  
suddenly and could cause injury.  
Rear center seat  
WARNING  
Always drive with the head restraints  
installed when seats are being used  
and make sure they are properly  
adjusted:  
qHead Restraint  
Rear outboard seat  
Driving with the head restraints  
adjusted too low or removed is  
dangerous. With no support behind  
your head, your neck could be  
seriously injured in a collision.  
WARNING  
Always drive with the head restraints  
installed when seats are being used  
and make sure they are properly  
adjusted:  
To use a head restraint, pull it up to the  
locked position.  
To lower the head restraint, press the stop-  
catch release, then push the head restraint  
down.  
Driving with the head restraints  
adjusted too low or removed is  
dangerous. With no support behind  
your head, your neck could be  
seriously injured in a collision.  
Height adjustment  
To raise a head restraint, pull it up to the  
locked position.  
To lower the head restraint, press the stop-  
catch release, then push the head restraint  
down.  
2-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page26  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (26,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
After entering/exiting the third-row  
seat area  
qArmrest  
The armrest can be used (no occupant in  
the center seat) or placed upright.  
1. Return the second-row seatback to its  
upright position and lock it after sliding  
it backward. Make sure it is locked by  
attempting to lightly move it forward  
and backward.  
2. Make sure that the center-rear seat belt  
is routed properly (not under the head  
restraint) and the seat belt guide is  
snapped to the head restraint.  
CAUTION  
Ø When folding a seatback, always  
hold onto the seatback with your  
other hand while operating the  
lever. If the seatback is not  
supported, it will flip forward  
suddenly and could cause injury.  
Ø After entering/exiting the third-  
row seat area, return the seatback  
to its upright position. Otherwise,  
it could move unexpectedly and  
cause injury.  
qThird-Row Seat Access  
After folding the second-row seat  
seatback and sliding the seat forward, you  
can access the third-row seat easily.  
Entering/exiting the third-row seat area  
Raise the lever on the side of the second-  
row seat to fold the seatback forward and  
slide the seat forward.  
qFolding the Second-Row Seats  
To create a flat luggage compartment  
space, fold the seatbacks forward.  
Folding the seatbacks  
1. Unfasten the lap portion of the center-  
rear seat belt (page 2-29) and stow it  
into the ceiling recess (page 2-29).  
CAUTION  
Always unfasten the lap portion of  
the belt before folding the rear-left  
seatback. Leaving the lap portion of  
the belt fastened could cause  
damage to the seat belt, buckle and  
seatback.  
2-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page27  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (27,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
2. Slide the seat all the way back toward  
the rear of the vehicle.  
NOTE  
To create a flat luggage compartment space  
from the rear of the vehicle to the back of the  
front seats, fold the second-row and third-row  
seats (page 2-17).  
3. Lower the head restraints all the way  
down (page 2-13).  
4. Pull the lever and fold the seatback  
forward.  
Returning seatbacks to their original  
positions  
CAUTION  
1. Lift the seatback to its original  
position.  
When folding a seatback, always  
hold onto the seatback with your  
other hand while operating the lever.  
If the seatback is not supported, it  
will flip forward suddenly and could  
cause injury.  
Make sure the seatback is secured by  
attempting to lightly move it forward  
and back.  
2. Route the center-rear seat belt through  
the seat belt guide and fasten it. Check  
that all seat belts are routed properly  
for passenger use (page 2-27).  
2-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page28  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (28,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
Never allow a passenger to sit or stand  
on the folded seatback while the  
vehicle is moving:  
Third-Row Seat  
WARNING  
Do not stack cargo higher than the  
seatbacks:  
Driving with a passenger on the  
folded seatback is dangerous.  
Allowing a child to sit up on the  
folded seatback while the vehicle is  
moving is particularly dangerous. In  
a sudden stop or even a minor  
collision, a child not in a proper seat  
or child-restraint system and seat  
belt could be thrown forward, back  
or even out of the vehicle resulting in  
serious injuries or death. The child in  
the baggage area could be thrown  
into other occupants and cause  
serious injury.  
Stacking luggage or other cargo  
higher than the seatbacks is  
dangerous. During a sudden stop or  
collision, objects can fly around and  
become projectiles that could hit and  
injure passengers.  
Make sure luggage and cargo is  
secured before driving:  
Not securing cargo while driving is  
dangerous as it could move or be  
crushed during sudden braking or a  
collision and cause injury.  
qHead Restraint  
Make sure the adjustable components  
of a seat are locked in place by  
attempting to rock the seatback:  
Adjustable seats that are not securely  
latched are dangerous. In a sudden  
stop or collision, the seat or seatback  
could move, causing injury.  
WARNING  
Always drive with the head restraints  
set up when the rear center seat is  
being used and make sure they are  
properly set up:  
Driving with the head restraints not  
set up is dangerous. With no support  
behind your head, your neck could be  
seriously injured in a collision.  
Do not drive with the seatback  
unlocked:  
The seatback plays an important role  
in your protection in a vehicle.  
Leaving the seatback unlocked is  
dangerous as it can allow passengers  
to be ejected or thrown around and  
baggage to strike occupants in a  
sudden stop or collision, resulting in  
severe injury. After returning the  
seatback at any time, even when  
there are no other passengers, rock  
the seatback to make sure it is locked  
in place.  
2-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page29  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (29,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
To use a head restraint, pull it up to the  
locked position.  
To lower the head restraint, press the stop-  
catch release, then push the head restraint  
down.  
NOTE  
To create a flat luggage compartment space  
from the rear of the vehicle to the back of the  
front seats, fold the second-row and third-row  
seats (page 2-14).  
To return third-row seat to its original  
position  
qSplit-Folding the Third-Row Seat  
To create a flat luggage compartment  
space, fold the seatbacks forward.  
1. Return the seatback to its original  
position by pulling its strap.  
Make sure the seatback is secured by  
attempting to lightly move it forward  
and back.  
To fold third-row seat  
1. Lower the head restraints all the way  
down (page 2-16).  
2. Hold the board and fasten the strap to  
its original position.  
2. Pull the strap and fold the seatback  
forward.  
3. Fasten the strap to its original position.  
2-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page30  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (30,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
Seat Belt Precautions  
Seat belts help to decrease the possibility of severe injury during accidents and sudden  
stops. Mazda recommends that the driver and all passengers always wear seat belts.  
Your vehicle has the following types of seat belts.  
Seating Position  
Driver side  
Passenger side  
Second-row seat  
Third-row seat  
Types of seat belt  
3-point type seat belt with emergency locking mode retractor  
Front seat  
3-point type seat belt with emergency locking mode  
retractor/automatic locking mode retractor  
3-point type seat belt with emergency locking mode retractor  
This belt has retractors with an inertia lock that keep the belt retracted when not in use.  
The lock allows the belt to remain comfortable on the user, but it will lock in position  
during a collision.  
Refer to Emergency Locking Mode on page 2-20.  
3-point type seat belt with emergency locking mode retractor/automatic locking mode  
retractor  
In addition to the emergency locking mode function, this belt has retractors that operate in  
another mode, the automatic locking mode, for the child-restraint system.  
Refer to Automatic Locking Mode on page 2-21.  
Refer to Installing Child-Restraint Systems on page 2-38.  
We recommend you put all children in the rear seats, if you must use the front passenger  
seat for a child, slide the front passenger seat as far back as possible and make sure any  
child-restraint system is secured properly.  
2-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page31  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (31,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
WARNING  
Always wear your seat belt and make sure all occupants are properly restrained:  
Not wearing a seat belt is extremely dangerous. During a collision, occupants not  
wearing seat belts could hit someone or things inside the vehicle or even be thrown  
out of the vehicle. They could be seriously injured or even killed. In the same  
collision, occupants wearing seat belts would be much safer.  
Do not wear twisted seat belts:  
Twisted seat belts are dangerous. In a collision, the full width of the belt is not  
available to absorb the impact. This puts more force on the bones beneath the belt,  
which could cause serious injury or death.  
Never use one seat belt on more than one person at a time:  
Using one seat belt for more than one person at a time is dangerous. A seat belt  
used in this way cannot spread the impact forces properly and the two passengers  
could be crushed together and seriously injured or even killed. Never use one belt for  
more than one person at a time and always operate the vehicle with each occupant  
properly restrained.  
Do not operate a vehicle with a damaged seat belt:  
Using a damaged seat belt is dangerous. An accident could damage the belt  
webbing of the seat belt in use. A damaged seat belt cannot provide adequate  
protection in a collision. Have an Authorized Mazda Dealer inspect all seat belt  
systems in use during an accident before they are used again.  
Have your seat belts changed immediately if the pretensioner or load limiter has  
been expended:  
One or both front air bags may deploy, and the corresponding pretensioner(s) may  
also deploy at the same time. While it is safer to use a crash-used seat belt that was  
used in an accident than no seat belt at all, using a seat belt with an expended  
pretensioner or load limiter loaded reduces the safety available to you. Like the air  
bags, the seat belt pretensioners will only function once. After they are expended,  
they will not function again and must be replaced immediately. If the seat belt  
pretensioners are not replaced, the risk of injury in a collision will increase. Always  
have an Authorized Mazda Dealer inspect the seat belt pretensioners and air bags  
after any collision. Expended seat belt pretensioners and air bags must be replaced  
after any collision which caused them to deploy. Additionally, the load limiter will  
only limit loads on the chest once in a collision and this is another reason to have the  
front seat belts inspected.  
In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is significantly more likely to die than a  
person wearing a seat belt.  
2-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page32  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (32,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
CAUTION  
Belt retraction may become difficult if the belts and rings are soiled, so try to keep  
them clean. For more details about cleaning the seat belts, refer to Cleaning the  
Lap/Shoulder Belt Webbing(page 8-58).  
qPregnant Women and Persons with Serious Medical Conditions  
Pregnant women should always wear seat belts. Ask your doctor for specific  
recommendations.  
The lap belt should be worn SNUGLYAND AS LOWAS POSSIBLE OVER THE HIPS.  
The shoulder belt should be worn across your shoulder properly, but never across the  
stomach area.  
Persons with serious medical conditions also should wear seat belts. Check with your  
doctor for any special instructions regarding specific medical conditions.  
qEmergency Locking Mode  
In the emergency locking mode, the belt remains comfortable on the occupant and the  
retractor will lock in position during a collision. When the seat belt is fastened, it will  
always be in the emergency locking mode until it is switched to automatic locking mode by  
pulling it all the way out to its full length. If the belt feels tight and hinders comfortable  
movement while the vehicle is stopped or in motion, it may be in the automatic locking  
mode because the belt has been pulled too far out. To return to the belt to the more  
comfortable emergency locking mode, wait until the vehicle has stopped in a safe, level  
area, retract the belt fully to convert it back to emergency locking mode and then extend it  
around you again.  
2-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page33  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (33,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
qAutomatic Locking Mode  
Always use the automatic locking mode to keep the child-restraint system from shifting to  
an unsafe position in the event of an accident. To enable seat belt automatic locking mode,  
pull it all the way out and connect it as instructed on the child-restraint system. It will  
retract down to the child-restraint system and stay locked on it. See the section on child  
restraint (page 2-34).  
2-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page34  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (34,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
3-Point Type Seat Belt  
WARNING  
Positioning the Shoulder Portion of the  
Seat Belt:  
NOTE  
When using the center-rear seat belt, refer to  
Improper positioning of the shoulder  
portion of the seat belt is dangerous.  
Always make sure the shoulder  
portion of the seat belt is positioned  
across your shoulder and near your  
neck, but never under your arm, on  
your neck, or on your upper arm.  
Center-Rear Position Seat Belt(page 2-27).  
qFastening the Seat Belt  
1. Grasp the tongue.  
2. Slowly pull out the lap/shoulder belt.  
4. Position the lap belt as low as possible,  
not on the abdominal area, then adjust  
the shoulder belt so that it fits snugly  
against your body.  
Belt  
Tongue  
Take up slack  
Keep low on  
hip bone  
3. Insert the tongue into the buckle until  
you hear a click.  
Too high  
Tongue  
WARNING  
Positioning the Lap Portion of the Seat  
Belt:  
The lap portion of the seat belt worn  
too high is dangerous. In a collision,  
this would concentrate the impact  
force directly on the abdominal area,  
causing serious injury. Wear the lap  
portion of the belt snugly and as low  
as possible.  
Buckle  
2-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page35  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (35,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
qUnfastening the Seat Belt  
qShoulder Belt Adjusterí  
Depress the button on the buckle. If the  
belt does not fully retract, pull it out and  
check for kinks or twists. Then make sure  
it remains untwisted as it retracts.  
Adjust the height of the shoulder belt if  
the seat belt touches your neck, or if it  
crosses your arm instead of your shoulder.  
To raise the shoulder belt adjuster, push  
the adjuster up. To lower the shoulder belt  
adjuster, pull the adjuster and slide it  
down. Make sure the adjuster is locked.  
To raise  
To lower  
Button  
NOTE  
If a belt does not fully retract, inspect it for  
kinks and twists. If it is still not retracting  
properly, have it inspected at an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
WARNING  
Positioning the Shoulder Portion of the  
Seat Belt:  
To secure the outboard-third seat belts  
when not in use, insert the belts in their  
seat belt retainers.  
Improper positioning of the shoulder  
portion of the seat belt is dangerous.  
Always make sure the shoulder  
portion of the seat belt is positioned  
across your shoulder and near your  
neck, but never under your arm, on  
your neck, or on your upper arm.  
íSome models.  
2-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page36  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (36,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
Front Seat Belt Pretensioner  
and Load Limiting Systems  
WARNING  
Wear seat belts only as recommended  
in this owner's manual:  
For optimum protection, the driver and  
front passenger seat belts are equipped  
with pretensioner and load limiting  
systems. For both these systems to work  
properly you must wear the seat belt  
properly.  
Incorrect positioning of the driver and  
front passenger seat belts is  
dangerous. Without proper  
positioning, the pretensioner and  
load limiting systems cannot provide  
adequate protection in an accident  
and this could result in serious injury.  
For more details about wearing seat  
belts, refer to Fastening the seat  
belts(page 2-22).  
Pretensioners:  
The front seat belt retractors remove slack  
quickly as the air bags are expanding.  
For deployment details, refer to the SRS  
Air Bag Deployment Criteria (page 2-60).  
In addition, the pretensioner system for  
the front passenger, like the front  
passenger air bag, is designed to only  
deploy in accordance with the total seated  
weight on the front passenger seat. Any  
time the air bags and seat belt  
pretensioners have fired they must be  
replaced. For details, refer to the driver  
and front passenger occupant  
classification system (page 2-63).  
Load limiter:  
The load limiting system releases belt  
webbing in a controlled manner to reduce  
belt force on the occupant's chest. While  
the most severe load on a seat belt occurs  
in frontal collisions, the load limiter has  
an automatic mechanical function and can  
activate in any accident mode with  
sufficient occupant movement.  
Even if the pretensioners have not fired,  
the load limiting function must be  
checked by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
2-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page37  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (37,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
Have your seat belts changed  
immediately if the pretensioner or load  
limiter has been expended:  
Properly dispose of the pretensioner  
system:  
Improper disposal of the pretensioner  
system or a vehicle with non-  
deactivated pretensioners is  
One or both front air bags may  
deploy, and the corresponding  
pretensioner(s) may also deploy at  
the same time. While it is safer to use  
a crash-used seat belt that was used  
in an accident than no seat belt at  
all, using a seat belt with an  
expended pretensioner or load limiter  
loaded reduces the safety available to  
you. Like the air bags, the seat belt  
pretensioners will only function once.  
After they are expended, they will not  
function again and must be replaced  
immediately. If the seat belt  
pretensioners are not replaced, the  
risk of injury in a collision will  
increase. Always have an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer inspect the seat belt  
pretensioners and air bags after any  
collision. Expended seat belt  
dangerous. Unless all safety  
procedures are followed, injury could  
result. Ask an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer how to safely dispose of the  
pretensioner system or how to scrap  
a pretensioner-equipped vehicle.  
NOTE  
l
The pretensioner system will activate in a  
moderate or severe frontal, near-frontal  
collision or roll-over accident. The  
pretensioner system for the front passenger  
is designed to only deploy in accordance  
with the total seated weight on the front  
passenger seat. It will not activate in most  
side or rear impacts.  
l
Some smoke (non-toxic gas) will be  
released when the air bags and  
pretensioners deploy. This does not indicate  
a fire. This gas normally has no effect on  
occupants, however, those with sensitive  
skin may experience light skin irritation. If  
residue from the deployment of the air bags  
or the front pretensioner system gets on the  
skin or in the eyes, wash it off as soon as  
possible.  
pretensioners and air bags must be  
replaced after any collision which  
caused them to deploy. Additionally,  
the load limiter will only limit loads  
on the chest once in a collision and  
this is another reason to have the  
front seat belts inspected.  
Do not modify the components or  
wiring, or use electronic testing devices  
on the pretensioner system:  
Modifying the components or wiring  
of the pretensioner system, including  
the use of electronic testing devices is  
dangerous. You could accidentally  
activate it or make it inoperable  
which would prevent it from  
activating in an accident. The  
occupants or repairers could be  
seriously injured.  
2-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page38  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (38,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
q
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt  
Pretensioner System Warning Light  
q
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt  
Pretensioner System Warning Beep  
If a malfunction is detected in both the air  
bag/front seat belt pretensioner system  
and the warning light, a warning beep  
sound will be heard for about 1 minute.  
After that, the one-minute beep will be  
repeated every 30 minutes.  
If the air bag/front seat belt pretensioner  
system is working properly, the warning  
light illuminates when the ignition switch  
is turned to the ON position or after the  
engine is cranked. The warning light turns  
off after a specified period of time.  
Have your vehicle inspected at an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as  
possible.  
WARNING  
Do not drive the vehicle with the air  
bag/front seat belt pretensioner system  
warning beep sounding:  
A system malfunction is indicated if the  
warning light constantly flashes,  
Driving the vehicle with the air bag/  
front seat belt pretensioner system  
warning beep sounding is dangerous.  
In a collision, the air bags and the  
front seat belt pretensioner system  
will not deploy and this could result  
in death or serious injury.  
constantly illuminates or does not  
illuminate at all when the ignition switch  
is turned to the ON position. If any of  
these occur, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer as soon as possible. The system  
may not work in an accident.  
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer  
to have the vehicle inspected as soon  
as possible.  
WARNING  
Never tamper with the air bag/  
pretensioner systems and always have  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer perform  
all servicing and repairs:  
Self-servicing or tampering with the  
systems is dangerous. An air bag/  
pretensioner could accidentally  
activate or become disabled causing  
serious injury or death.  
2-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page39  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (39,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
Center-Rear Position Seat  
Belt (Second-Row Seats)  
WARNING  
Using the Seat Belt Guide:  
Not using the seat belt guide is  
dangerous. If the seat belt guide is  
not used, the shoulder portion of the  
center-rear seat belt could be  
mistakenly positioned under the  
head restraint; position that cannot  
provide adequate protection in a  
collision and could result in the  
center-rear passenger being seriously  
injured or killed. Always make sure  
the shoulder portion of the center-  
rear seat belt is on the right side of  
the left-rear head restraint and  
guided correctly through the seat belt  
guide.  
Before using the center-rear lap/shoulder  
belt make sure tongue (A) and anchor  
buckle (B) are fastened.  
(A)  
(B)  
Seat belt guide  
qFastening the Seat Belt  
1. Grasp the tongue (C).  
2. Slowly pull out the lap/shoulder belt.  
2-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page40  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (40,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
3. Insert the tongue (C) into the buckle  
(D) until you hear a click.  
4. Position the lap belt as low as possible,  
not on the abdominal area, then adjust  
the shoulder belt so that it fits snugly  
against your body.  
WARNING  
Positioning the Lap Portion of the Seat  
Belt:  
(C)  
(A)  
(B)  
The lap portion of the seat belt worn  
too high is dangerous. In a collision,  
this would concentrate the impact  
force directly on the abdominal area,  
causing serious injury. Wear the lap  
portion of the belt snugly and as low  
as possible.  
(D)  
WARNING  
Fastening the Center-Rear Seat Belt  
with Only One Buckle:  
qUnfastening the Seat Belt  
Depress the button on the buckle. If the  
belt does not fully retract, pull it out and  
check for kinks or twists. Then make sure  
it remains untwisted as it retracts.  
Fastening the center-rear seat belt  
with only one buckle is dangerous. If  
only one pair of seat belt tongue and  
buckle, either tongue (A) and anchor  
buckle (B) or tongue (C) and anchor  
buckle (D), is fastened, the seat belt  
cannot provide full protection. In a  
sudden stop or collision, the user  
could slide under the belt and suffer  
serious injuries. Always make sure  
that both pairs of seat belt tongues  
and buckles are fastened properly.  
Positioning the Shoulder Portion of the  
Seat Belt:  
Button  
Improper positioning of the shoulder  
portion of the seat belt is dangerous.  
Always make sure the shoulder  
portion of the seat belt is positioned  
across your shoulder and near your  
neck, but never under your arm, on  
your neck, or on your upper arm.  
NOTE  
If a belt does not fully retract, inspect it for  
kinks and twists. If it is still not retracting  
properly, have it inspected at an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
2-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page41  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (41,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
qUnfastening the Lap Portion of  
qStowing and pulling out the  
the Seat Belt  
Center-Rear Position Seat Belt  
Insert a small object such as a key in the  
anchor buckle (B) slot.  
The center-rear position seat belt can be  
stowed using the following procedure.  
CAUTION  
(A)  
(B)  
When stowing the seat belt, make  
sure the belt is locked securely into  
the recess. If the seat belt is not  
properly stowed, it might get caught  
in the seats and be damaged.  
To stow the seat belt, retract the belt, put  
tongues (A) and (C) together and insert  
each tongue into the respective ceiling  
recess. Insert the tongues until you hear a  
click.  
CAUTION  
Ceiling recess  
Always unfasten the lap portion of  
the belt before folding the left-rear  
seatback. Leaving the lap portion of  
the belt fastened could cause  
damage to the seat belt, buckle and  
seatback.  
(A)  
NOTE  
To encourage rear seat passengers to wear  
their seat belts, we suggest leaving the center-  
rear lap position of the belt fastened at all  
times except when folding the rear seat  
forward.  
(C)  
qFastening the Lap Portion of the  
Seat Belt  
Grasp tongue (A) and insert it into the  
anchor buckle (B) until you hear a click. It  
is now secure for passenger use.  
NOTE  
After returning the left-rear seatback to its  
upright position, guide the shoulder portion of  
the belt correctly through the seat belt guide  
and fasten the lap portion of the belt.  
2-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page42  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (42,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
To pull out the seat belt, press the area  
indicated in the figure upward with your  
finger and slide the belt forward. Then  
slowly pull out the seat belt from the  
ceiling recess.  
Seat Belt Extender  
If your seat belt is not long enough, even  
when fully extended, a seat belt extender  
may be available to you at no charge from  
your Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
This extender will be only for you and for  
the particular vehicle and seat. Even if it  
plugs into other seat belts, it may not hold  
in the critical moment of a crash.  
When ordering an extender, only order  
one that provides the necessary additional  
length to fasten the seat belt properly.  
Please contact your Authorized Mazda  
Dealer for more information.  
NOTE  
Pulling out the seat belt all the way out will  
switch it to automatic locking mode. If  
automatic locking mode is not needed, retract  
the seat belt fully to convert it back to  
emergency locking mode.  
2-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page43  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (43,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
NOTE  
WARNING  
Do not use a seat belt extender unless  
it is necessary:  
When not in use, remove the seat belt extender  
and store it in the vehicle. If the seat belt  
extender is left connected, the seat belt  
Using a seat belt extender when not  
necessary is dangerous. The seat belt  
will be too long and not fit properly.  
In an accident, the seat belt will not  
provide adequate protection and you  
could be seriously injured. Only use  
the extender when it is required to  
fasten the seat belt properly.  
extender might get damaged as it will not  
retract with the rest of the seat belt and can  
easily fall out of the door when not in use and  
be damaged. In addition, the seat belt warning  
light will not illuminate and function properly.  
Do not use an improper extender:  
Using a seat belt extender that is for  
another person or a different vehicle  
or seat is dangerous. The seat belt  
will not provide adequate protection  
and the user could be seriously  
injured in an accident. Only use the  
extender provided for you and for the  
particular vehicle and seat. NEVER  
use the extender in a different vehicle  
or seat.  
Do not use an extender that is too  
long:  
Using an extender that is too long is  
dangerous. The seat belt will not fit  
properly. In an accident, the seat belt  
will not provide adequate protection  
and you could be seriously injured.  
Do not use the extender or choose  
one shorter in length if the distance  
between the extender's buckle and  
the center of the user's body is less  
than 15cm (6 in).  
2-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page44  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (44,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
Driver seated/Front passenger not  
seated  
Seat Belt Warning Light/Beep  
The belt minder is a supplemental  
warning to the seat belt warning function.  
If the driver's seat belt is not fastened  
when the ignition switch is turned to the  
ON position, the warning light/beep  
operates to give you further reminders  
according to the chart below.  
The seat belt warning light illuminates  
and a beep sound will be heard if the  
driver's seat belt is not fastened when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position.  
Vehicle speed  
Between 0 20  
km/h  
(0 12 mph)  
20 km/h  
(12 mph) or  
more  
Condition  
Seat belt  
Conditions of operation  
Indicator  
Beep  
Condition  
Result  
The driver's seat belt is not The warning light  
fastened when the ignition flashes and a beep  
switch is turned to the ON sound will be heard  
: Fastened  
: Unfastened  
: Illuminated  
: Flashing  
: Beep  
position.  
for about 6 seconds.  
The driver's seat belt is  
fastened while the warning  
light and the beep sound are  
activated.  
The warning light  
turns off and the beep  
sound stops.  
Once the beep sound is heard, it continues  
sounding even if the vehicle speed lowers  
to 20 km/h (12 mph) or less until the  
seatbelt is fastened or the beep sound  
period has passed.  
The driver's seat belt is  
The warning light will  
fastened before the ignition not illuminate and the  
switch is turned to the ON beep sound will not be  
position.  
heard.  
qBelt Minder  
NOTE  
The belt minder can be deactivated. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer to deactivate and  
restore the seat belt minder.  
2-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page45  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (45,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
Driver seated/Front passenger seated  
The seat belt warning function reminds  
the front passenger to fasten the seat belt  
according to the chart below.  
Vehicle speed  
Between 0 20  
km/h  
(0 12 mph)  
20 km/h  
(12 mph) or  
more  
Condition  
Seat belt  
(Driver)  
Seat belt  
(Passenger)  
Indicator  
Beep  
: Fastened  
: Unfastened  
: Illuminated  
: Flashing  
: Beep  
Once the beep sound is heard, it continues  
sounding even if the vehicle speed lowers  
to 20 km/h (12 mph) or less until the  
seatbelt is fastened or the beep sound  
period has passed.  
NOTE  
l
To allow the front passenger seat weight  
sensor to function properly, do not place  
and sit on an additional seat cushion on the  
front passenger seat. The sensor may not  
function properly because the additional  
seat cushion could cause sensor  
interference.  
l
Placing packages, luggage, pets or other  
items on the front passenger seat may cause  
the front passenger seat belt warning  
function to operate depending on the  
weight of the item.  
2-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page46  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (46,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
Child Restraint Precautions  
Mazda strongly urges the use of child-restraint systems for children small enough to use  
them.  
You are required by law to use a child-restraint system for children in the U.S. and Canada.  
Check your local and state or provincial laws for specific requirements regarding the safety  
of children riding in your vehicle.  
Whatever child-restraint system you consider, please pick the appropriate one for the age  
and size of the child, obey the law and follow the instructions that come with the individual  
child-restraint system.  
A child who has outgrown child-restraint systems should sit in the rear and use seat belts,  
both lap and shoulder. If the shoulder belt crosses the neck or face, move the child closer to  
the center of the vehicle in the outboard seats, and towards the buckle on the right if the  
child is seated on the center seat.  
Statistics confirm that the rear seats are the best place for all children up to 12 years of age,  
and more so with a supplemental restraint system (air bags).  
A rear-facing child-restraint system should NEVER be used on the front seat with the air  
bag system activated. The front passenger's seat is also the least preferred seat for other  
child-restraint systems.  
To reduce the chance of injuries caused by deployment of the front passenger air bag, your  
vehicle is equipped with the front passenger seat weight sensors. These sensors deactivate  
the front passenger front and side air bags and also the front passenger seat belt  
pretensioner system when the total seated weight on the front passenger seat is less than  
approximately 30 kg (66 lb).  
When an infant or small child sits on the front passenger seat, the system shuts off the front  
passenger air bag, so make sure the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light  
illuminates.  
Even if the front passenger air bag is shut off, Mazda strongly recommends that children be  
properly restrained and child-restraint systems of all kinds are properly secured on the rear  
seats which are the best place for children.  
For more details, refer to Front passenger seat weight sensors(page 2-63).  
2-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page47  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (47,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
WARNING  
Use the correct size child-restraint system:  
For effective protection in vehicle accidents and sudden stops, a child must be  
properly restrained using a seat belt or child-restraint system depending on age and  
size. If not, the child could be seriously injured or even killed in an accident.  
Follow the manufacturer's instructions and always keep the child-restraint system  
buckled down:  
An unsecured child-restraint system is dangerous. In a sudden stop or a collision it  
could move causing serious injury or death to the child or other occupants. Make  
sure any child-restraint system is properly secured in place according to the child-  
restraint system manufacturer's instructions. When not in use, remove it from the  
vehicle or fasten it with a seat belt, or latch it down to BOTH LATCH lower anchors  
for LATCH child-restraint systems, and attach the corresponding tether anchor.  
Always secure a child in a proper child-restraint system:  
Holding a child in your arms while the vehicle is moving is extremely dangerous. No  
matter how strong the person may be, he or she cannot hold onto a child in a  
sudden stop or collision and it could result in serious injury or death to the child or  
other occupants. Even in a moderate accident, the child may be exposed to air bag  
forces that could result in serious injury or death to the child, or the child may be  
slammed into an adult, causing injury to both child and adult.  
Never use a rear-facing child-restraint system in the front seat with an air bag that  
could deploy:  
Rear-facing child-restraint systems on the front seat are particularly dangerous even  
though you may feel assured that a front passenger air bag will not deploy based on  
the fact that the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates.  
The child-restraint system can be hit by a deploying air bag and moved violently  
backward resulting in serious injury or death to the child.  
2-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page48  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (48,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
Do not install a front-facing child-restraint system on the front passenger seat unless  
it is unavoidable:  
In a collision, the force of a deploying air bag could cause serious injury or death to  
the child. If installing a front-facing child-restraint system on the front passenger  
seat is unavoidable, move the front passenger seat as back as possible.  
Seating a child in a child-restraint system on the front passenger seat is dangerous:  
Your vehicle is equipped with front passenger seat weight sensors. Even with front  
passenger seat weight sensors, if you must use the front passenger seat to seat a  
child, using a child-restraint system on the front passenger seat under the following  
conditions increases the danger of the front passenger air bag deploying and could  
result in serious injury or death to the child.  
Ø The total seated weight of the child with the child-restraint system on the front  
passenger seat is approximately 30 kg (66 lb) or more with a child in the child-  
restraint system.  
Ø Luggage or other items are placed on the seat with the child in the child-restraint  
system.  
Ø A rear passenger or luggage pushing or pulling down on the front passenger  
seatback.  
Ø A rear passenger puts their feet on the front seat rails.  
Ø Luggage or other items are placed on the seatback or hung on the head restraint.  
Ø The seat is washed.  
Ø Liquids are spilled on the seat.  
Ø The front passenger seat is moved backward, pushing into luggage or other items  
placed behind it.  
Ø The front passenger seatback contacts the second-row seat.  
Ø Luggage or other items are placed between the front passenger seat and driver  
seat.  
Ø Any accessories increasing the total seated weight on the front passenger seat are  
attached to the front passenger seat.  
The designated positions with seat belts on the rear seats are the safest places for  
children. Always use seat belts and child restraints.  
2-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page49  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (49,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
Do not allow a child to lean over or against the side window of a vehicle with side  
and curtain air bags:  
It is dangerous to allow anyone to lean over or against the side window, the area of  
the front passenger seat, the front and rear window pillars and the roof edge along  
both sides from which the side and curtain air bags deploy, even if a child-restraint  
system is used. If the vehicle is equipped with side and curtain air bags, the impact of  
inflation could cause serious injury or death to the child. Furthermore, leaning over  
or against the front door could block the side and curtain air bags and eliminate the  
advantages of supplemental protection. With the front air bag and the additional  
side air bag that comes out of the front seat, the rear seat is always a better location  
for children. Do not allow a child to lean over or against the side window, even if the  
child is seated in a child-restraint system.  
Never use one seat belt on more than one person at a time:  
Using one seat belt for more than one person at a time is dangerous. A seat belt  
used in this way cannot spread the impact forces properly and the two passengers  
could be crushed together and seriously injured or even killed. Never use one belt for  
more than one person at a time and always operate the vehicle with each occupant  
properly restrained.  
CAUTION  
A seat belt or child-restraint system can become very hot in a closed vehicle during  
warm weather. To avoid burning yourself or a child, check them before you or your  
child touches them.  
NOTE  
Your Mazda is equipped with LATCH lower anchors for attachment of specially designed LATCH  
child-restraint systems in the rear seats. When using these anchors to secure a child-restraint system,  
refer to LATCH Child-Restraint Systems(page 2-45).  
2-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page50  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (50,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
qSecond-Row Seats Child-  
Installing Child-Restraint  
Systems  
Restraint System Installation  
Follow these instructions when using a  
child-restraint system, unless you are  
attaching a LATCH-equipped child-  
restraint system to the rear LATCH lower  
anchors. Refer to LATCH Child-  
Restraint Systems(page 2-45).  
Accident statistics reveal that a child is  
safer in the rear seats. The front  
passenger's seat is clearly the worst choice  
for any child under 12, and with rear-  
facing child-restraint systems it is clearly  
unsafe due to air bags.  
NOTE  
Follow the child-restraint system  
Some child-restraint systems now come  
with tethers and therefore must be  
installed on the seats that take tethers to  
be effective. In your Mazda, tethered  
child-restraint systems can only be  
accommodated in the three positions on  
the second-row seats.  
manufacturer's instructions carefully. If you  
are not sure whether you have a LATCH  
system or tether, check in the child-restraint  
system manufacturer's instructions and follow  
them accordingly. Depending on the type of  
child-restraint system, it may not employ seat  
belts which are in automatic locking mode.  
Even if your vehicle is equipped with  
front passenger seat weight sensors (page  
2-63), which automatically deactivates the  
front passenger air bag, a rear seat is the  
safest place for a child of any age or size.  
1. When installing the child-restraint  
system on the second-row seat, make  
sure that the center-rear seat belt is  
routed through the seat belt guide.  
2. Make sure the seatback is securely  
latched by pushing it back until it is  
fully locked.  
Some child-restraint systems also employ  
specially designed LATCH attachments;  
refer to LATCH Child-Restraint  
Systems(page 2-45).  
3. Secure the child-restraint system with  
the lap portion of the lap/shoulder belt.  
See the manufacturer's instructions on  
the child-restraint system for belt  
routing instructions.  
WARNING  
Tethered Child-Restraint Systems Work  
Only on Tether-Equipped Rear Seats:  
Installation of a tether equipped  
child-restraint system in the front  
passenger's seat or the third-row  
seats defeats the safety design of the  
system and will result in an increased  
chance of serious injury if the child-  
restraint system goes forward  
without benefit of being tethered.  
Place tether equipped child-restraint  
systems where there are tether  
anchors.  
2-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page51  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (51,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
4. To get the retractor into the automatic  
locking mode, pull the shoulder belt  
portion of the seat belt until the entire  
length of the belt is out of the retractor.  
NOTE  
Inspect this function before each use of the  
child-restraint system. You should not be able  
to pull the shoulder belt out of the retractor  
while the system is in the automatic locking  
mode. When you remove the child-restraint  
system, be sure the belt fully retracts to return  
the system to emergency locking mode before  
occupants use the seat belts.  
6. If your child-restraint system requires  
the use of a tether strap, refer to the  
manufacturer's instructions to hook and  
tighten the tether strap after raising the  
head restraint.  
Anchor bracket location  
5. Push the child-restraint system firmly  
into the vehicle seat. Be sure the belt  
retracts as snugly as possible. Clicking  
from the retractor will be heard during  
retraction if the system is in the  
automatic locking mode. If the belt  
does not lock the seat down tight,  
repeat this step.  
Tether strap position  
Tether strap  
Forward  
2-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page52  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (52,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
qThird-Row Seats Child-Restraint  
WARNING  
Use the tether and tether anchor only  
for a child-restraint system:  
System Installation  
The third-row seats cannot accommodate  
LATCH-type child-restraint systems or  
tethers, therefore these systems must be  
installed on the other seat positions such  
as the second-row seat. If this not  
possible, LATCH-type child-restraint  
systems or tethers should be installed  
using seat belts depending on whether the  
child-restraint manufacturer allows their  
use without LATCH attachments and  
tether anchors.  
Using the tether or tether anchor to  
secure anything but a child-restraint  
system is dangerous. This could  
weaken or damage the tether or  
tether anchor and result in injury.  
Always route the tether strap between  
the head restraint and the seatback:  
Routing the tether strap on top of the  
head restraint is dangerous. In a  
collision the tether strap could slide  
off the head restraint and loosen the  
child-restraint system. The child-  
restraint system could move which  
may result in death or injury to the  
child.  
Follow these manufacturer's instructions  
when using a child-restraint system.  
NOTE  
Follow the child-restraint system  
manufacturer's instructions carefully.  
Depending on the type of child-restraint  
system, it may not employ seat belts which are  
in automatic locking mode.  
Always attach the tether strap to the  
correct tether anchor position:  
Attaching the tether strap to the  
incorrect tether anchor position is  
dangerous. In a collision, the tether  
strap could come off and loosen the  
child-restraint system. If the child-  
restraint system moves it could result  
in death or injury to the child.  
1. Secure the child-restraint system with  
the lap portion of the lap/shoulder belt.  
See the manufacturer's instructions on  
the child-restraint system for belt  
routing instructions.  
2-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page53  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (53,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
2. To get the retractor into the automatic  
locking mode, pull the shoulder belt  
portion of the seat belt until the entire  
length of the belt is out of the retractor.  
NOTE  
Inspect this function before each use of the  
child-restraint system. You should not be able  
to pull the shoulder belt out of the retractor  
while the system is in the automatic locking  
mode. When you remove the child-restraint  
system, be sure the belt fully retracts to return  
the system to emergency locking mode before  
occupants use the seat belts.  
qIf You Must Use the Front Seat  
for Children  
If you cannot put all children in the rear  
seats, at least put the smallest children in  
the rear and be sure the largest child up  
front uses the shoulder belt over the  
shoulder.  
NEVER put a rear-facing child-restraint  
system on the front passenger seat, even  
with a seat weight sensor equipped  
vehicle.  
This seat is also not set up for tethered  
child-restraint systems, put them in one of  
the rear seat positions set up with tether  
anchors.  
3. Push the child-restraint system firmly  
into the vehicle seat. Be sure the belt  
retracts as snugly as possible. Clicking  
from the retractor will be heard during  
retraction if the system is in the  
automatic locking mode. If the belt  
does not lock the seat down tight,  
repeat this step.  
Likewise the LATCH child-restraint  
system cannot be secured in the front  
passenger's seat and should be used in the  
second-row seats.  
Don't allow anyone to sleep against the  
side window if you have an optional side  
and curtain air bag, it could cause serious  
injuries to an out of position occupant. As  
children more often sleep in cars, it is  
better to put them in the rear seat. If  
installing the child-restraint system on the  
front seat is unavoidable, follow these  
instructions when using a front-facing  
child-restraint system in the front  
passenger's seat.  
2-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page54  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (54,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
NOTE  
Never use a rear-facing child-restraint  
system in the front seat with an air bag  
that could deploy:  
l
To check if your front seats have side air  
bags:  
Mazda vehicles equipped with side air bag  
will have a SRS AIRBAGtag on the  
outboard shoulder of the front seats.  
To check if your vehicle has curtain air  
bags:  
Mazda vehicles equipped with curtain air  
bag will have an SRS AIRBAGmarking  
on the window pillars along the roof edge.  
Rear-facing child-restraint systems  
on the front seat are particularly  
dangerous.  
l
Even in a moderate collision, the  
child-restraint system can be hit by a  
deploying air bag and moved  
violently backward resulting in  
serious injury or death to the child.  
Even though you may feel assured  
that the front passenger air bag will  
not deploy based on the fact that the  
front passenger air bag deactivation  
indicator light illuminates.  
WARNING  
Always move the front passenger seat  
as far back as possible if installing a  
front-facing child-restraint system on it  
is unavoidable:  
Do not allow a child to lean over or  
against the side window of a vehicle  
with side and curtain air bags:  
It is dangerous to allow anyone to  
lean over or against the side window,  
the area of the front passenger seat,  
the front and rear window pillars and  
the roof edge along both sides from  
which the side and curtain air bags  
deploy, even if a child-restraint  
As your vehicle has front air bags  
and doubly so if your vehicle has side  
air bags, a front-facing child-  
restraint system should be put on the  
front passenger seat only when it is  
unavoidable.  
Even if the front passenger air bag  
deactivation indicator light  
illuminates, always move the seat as  
far back as possible, because the  
force of a deploying air bag could  
cause serious injury or death to the  
child.  
system is used. If the vehicle is  
equipped with side and curtain air  
bags, the impact of inflation could  
cause serious injury or death to the  
child. Furthermore, leaning over or  
against the front door could block  
the side and curtain air bags and  
eliminate the advantages of  
supplemental protection. With the  
front air bag and the additional side  
air bag that comes out of the front  
seat, the rear seat is always a better  
location for children. Do not allow a  
child to lean over or against the side  
window, even if the child is seated in  
a child-restraint system.  
2-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page55  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (55,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
NOTE  
l
qFront Passenger's Seat Child-  
Inspect this function before each use of the  
child-restraint system. You should not be  
able to pull the shoulder belt out of the  
retractor while the system is in the  
automatic locking mode. When you remove  
the child-restraint system, be sure the belt  
fully retracts to return the system to  
emergency locking mode before occupants  
use the seat belts.  
Restraint System Installation  
1. Slide the seat as far back as possible.  
l
Follow the child-restraint system  
manufacturer's instructions carefully.  
Depending on the type of child-restraint  
system, it may not employ seat belts which  
are in automatic locking mode.  
5. Make sure the front passenger air bag  
deactivation indicator light illuminates  
after installing a child-restraint system  
on the front passenger seat.  
2. Secure the child-restraint system with  
the lap portion of the lap/shoulder belt.  
See the manufacturer's instructions on  
the child-restraint system for belt  
routing instructions.  
Refer to Front passenger air bag  
deactivation indicator light on page  
3. To get the retractor into the automatic  
locking mode, pull the shoulder belt  
portion of the seat belt until the entire  
length of the belt is out of the retractor.  
4. Push the child-restraint system firmly  
into the vehicle seat. Be sure the belt  
retracts as snugly as possible. Clicking  
from the retractor will be heard during  
retraction if the system is in automatic  
locking mode. If the belt does not lock  
the seat down tight, repeat the previous  
step and also this one.  
2-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page56  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (56,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
WARNING  
Do not seat a child in a child-restraint  
system on the front passenger seat if  
the front passenger air bag  
deactivation indicator light does not  
illuminated:  
While it is always better to install any  
child-restraint system on the rear  
seat, it is imperative that a child-  
restraint system ONLY be used on the  
front passenger seat if the  
deactivation indicator light  
illuminates when the child is seated  
in the child-restraint system (page  
2-63). Seating a child in a child-  
restraint system installed on the front  
passenger seat with the front  
passenger air bag deactivation  
indicator light not illuminated is  
dangerous. If this indicator light does  
not illuminate even when the total  
seated weight is less than  
approximately 30 kg (66 lb), this  
means that the front passenger front  
and side air bags, and seat belt  
pretensioner are ready for  
deployment. If an accident were to  
deploy an air bag, a child in a child-  
restraint system sitting in the front  
passenger seat could be seriously  
injured or killed. If the indicator light  
does not illuminate after seating a  
child in a child-restraint system on  
the front passenger seat, seat a child  
in a child-restraint system on the rear  
seat and consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
2-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page57  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (57,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
LATCH Child-Restraint Systems  
Your Mazda is equipped with LATCH lower anchors for attachment of specially designed  
LATCH child-restraint systems the second-row seats. Both anchors must be used,  
otherwise the seat will bounce around and put the child in danger. Most LATCH child-  
restraint systems must also be used in conjunction with a tether to be effective. If they have  
a tether you must use it to better assure your child's safety.  
WARNING  
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the use of the child-restraint system:  
An unsecured child-restraint system is dangerous. In a sudden stop or a collision it  
could move causing serious injury or death to the child or other occupants. Make  
sure the child-restraint system is properly secured in place according to the child-  
restraint system manufacturer's instructions.  
Never attach two child-restraint systems to the same LATCH lower anchor:  
Attaching two child-restraint systems to the same LATCH lower anchor is dangerous.  
In a collision, one anchor may not be strong enough to hold two child-restraint  
system attachments, and it may break, causing serious injury or death. If you use the  
seat position for another child-restraint system when an outboard LATCH position is  
occupied, use the center seat belts instead, and the tether if tether-equipped.  
Make sure the child-restraint system is properly secured:  
An unsecured child-restraint system is dangerous. In a sudden stop or a collision it  
could move causing serious injury or death to the child or other occupants. Follow  
the child-restraint system manufacturer's instructions on belt routing to secure the  
seat just as you would with a child in it so that nobody is tempted to put a child in  
an improperly secured seat later on. When not in use, remove it from the vehicle or  
fasten it with a seat belt, or latch it down to BOTH LATCH lower anchors for LATCH  
child-restraint systems.  
Make sure there are no seat belts or foreign objects near or around the LATCH child-  
restraint system:  
Not following the child-restraint system manufacturer's instructions when installing  
the child-restraint system is dangerous. If seat belts or a foreign object prevent the  
child-restraint system from being securely attached to the LATCH lower anchors and  
the child-restraint system is installed improperly, the child-restraint system could  
move in a sudden stop or collision causing serious injury or death to the child or  
other occupants. When installing the child-restraint system, make sure there are no  
seat belts or foreign objects near or around the LATCH lower anchors. Always follow  
the child-restraint system manufacturer's instructions.  
2-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page58  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (58,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
Anchor bracket location  
qLATCH Child-Restraint System  
Installation Procedure (Second-  
Row Outboard Seats)  
1. Slide the second-row seat as far back as  
possible.  
2. Make sure the seatback is securely  
latched by pushing it back until it is  
fully locked.  
3. Expand the area between the seat  
bottom and the seatback slightly to  
verify the locations of the LATCH  
lower anchors.  
Tether strap position  
Tether strap  
For rear  
left seat  
Forward  
For rear  
right seat  
NOTE  
The markings above the LATCH lower anchors  
indicate the locations of LATCH lower  
anchors for the attachment of a child-restraint  
system.  
4. Secure the child-restraint system using  
BOTH LATCH lower anchors,  
following the child-restraint system  
manufacturer's instruction.  
5. If your child-restraint system came  
equipped with a tether, that probably  
means it is very important to properly  
secure the tether for child safety. Please  
carefully follow the child-restraint  
system manufacturer's instructions  
when installing tethers.  
2-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page59  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (59,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
qLATCH Child-Restraint System  
Installation Procedure (Second-  
Row Center Seat)  
WARNING  
Use the tether and tether anchor only  
for a child-restraint system:  
The LATCH lower anchors at the center  
of the rear seat are much further apart than  
the sets of LATCH lower anchors for  
child-restraint system installation at other  
seating positions. Child-restraint systems  
with rigid LATCH attachments cannot be  
installed on the center seating position.  
Some LATCH equipped child-restraint  
systems can be placed in the center  
Using the tether or tether anchor to  
secure anything but a child-restraint  
system is dangerous. This could  
weaken or damage the tether or  
tether anchor and result in injury.  
Always route the tether strap between  
the head restraint and the seatback:  
Routing the tether strap on top of the  
head restraint is dangerous. In a  
collision the tether strap could slide  
off the head restraint and loosen the  
child-restraint system. The child-  
restraint system could move which  
may result in death or injury to the  
child.  
position and will reach the nearest  
LATCH lower anchors which are 500 mm  
(19.7 in) apart. LATCH compatible child-  
restraint systems (with attachments on belt  
webbing) can be used at this seating  
position only if the child-restraint system  
manufacturer's instructions state that the  
child-restraint system can be installed to  
LATCH lower anchors that are 500 mm  
(19.7 in) apart. Do not attach two child-  
restraint systems to the same LATCH  
lower anchor. If your child-restraint  
system has a tether, it must also be used  
for your child's optimum safety.  
Always attach the tether strap to the  
correct tether anchor position:  
Attaching the tether strap to the  
incorrect tether anchor position is  
dangerous. In a collision, the tether  
strap could come off and loosen the  
child-restraint system. If the child-  
restraint system moves it could result  
in death or injury to the child.  
1. Slide the second-row seat as far back as  
possible.  
2. Make sure the seatback is securely  
latched by pushing it back until it is  
fully locked.  
2-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page60  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (60,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
3. Expand the area between the seat  
bottom and the seatback slightly to  
verify the locations of the LATCH  
lower anchors.  
Anchor bracket position  
Tether strap position  
Tether strap  
NOTE  
The markings above the LATCH lower anchors  
indicate the locations of LATCH lower  
anchors for the attachment of a child-restraint  
system.  
Forward  
4. Secure the child-restraint system using  
BOTH LATCH lower anchors,  
following the child-restraint system  
manufacturer's instructions.  
5. If your child-restraint system came  
equipped with a tether, that probably  
means it is very important to properly  
secure the tether for child safety. Please  
carefully follow the child-restraint  
system manufacturer's instructions  
when installing tethers.  
2-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page61  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (61,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
WARNING  
Use the tether and tether anchor only  
for a child-restraint system:  
Using the tether or tether anchor to  
secure anything but a child-restraint  
system is dangerous. This could  
weaken or damage the tether or  
tether anchor and result in injury.  
Always route the tether strap between  
the head restraint and the seatback:  
Routing the tether strap on top of the  
head restraint is dangerous. In a  
collision the tether strap could slide  
off the head restraint and loosen the  
child-restraint system. The child-  
restraint system could move which  
may result in death or injury to the  
child.  
Always attach the tether strap to the  
correct tether anchor position:  
Attaching the tether strap to the  
incorrect tether anchor position is  
dangerous. In a collision, the tether  
strap could come off and loosen the  
child-restraint system. If the child-  
restraint system moves it could result  
in death or injury to the child.  
2-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page62  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (62,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Precautions  
The front and side supplemental restraint systems (SRS) include up to 6 air bags. Please  
verify which kinds of air bags are equipped on your vehicle by locating the SRS  
AIRBAGlocation indicators. These indicators are visible in the area where the air bags  
are installed.  
The air bags are installed in the following locations:  
l
The steering wheel hub (driver air bag)  
The front passenger dashboard (front passenger air bag)  
The outboard sides of the front seatbacks (side air bags)  
The front and rear window pillars, and the roof edge along both sides (curtain air bags)  
l
l
l
The air bag supplemental restraint systems are designed to provide supplemental protection  
in certain situations so seat belts are always important in the following ways:  
Without seat belt usage, the air bags cannot provide adequate protection during an accident.  
Seat belt usage is necessary to:  
l
Keep the occupant from being thrown into an inflating air bag.  
Reduce the possibility of injuries during an accident that is not designed for air bag  
l
inflation, such as rear impact.  
Reduce the possibility of injuries in frontal, near frontal, side collisions or roll-over  
l
accidents that are not severe enough to activate the air bags.  
Reduce the possibility of being thrown from your vehicle.  
Reduce the possibility of injuries to lower body and legs during an accident because the  
l
l
air bags provide no protection to these parts of the body.  
Hold the driver in a position which allows better control of the vehicle.  
l
Your vehicle is also equipped with a driver and front passenger occupant  
classification system. For details, refer to the driver and front passenger occupant  
classification system (page 2-63).  
Small children must be protected by a child-restraint system as stipulated by law in every  
state and province. In certain states and provinces, larger children must use a child-restraint  
system (page 2-34).  
Carefully consider which child-restraint system is necessary for your child and follow the  
installation directions in this Owner's Manual as well as the child-restraint system  
manufacturer's instructions.  
2-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page63  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (63,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
WARNING  
Seat belts must be worn in air bag equipped vehicles:  
Depending only on the air bags for protection during an accident is dangerous.  
Alone, air bags may not prevent serious injuries. The appropriate air bags can be  
expected to inflate only in the first accident, such as frontal, near frontal, side  
collisions or roll-over accident that are at least moderate. Vehicle occupants should  
always wear seat belts.  
Children should not ride in the front passenger seat:  
Placing a child, 12 years or under, in the front seat is dangerous. The child could be  
hit by a deploying air bag and be seriously injured or even killed. Even if the front  
passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates, always move the front  
passenger seat as far back as possible. A sleeping child is more likely to lean against  
the door and be hit by the side air bag in a moderate, right-side collision. Whenever  
possible, always secure a child 12 years and under on the rear seats with an  
appropriate child-restraint system for the child's age and size.  
Never use a rear-facing child-restraint system in the front seat with an air bag that  
could deploy:  
Rear-facing child-restraint systems on the front seat are particularly dangerous even  
though you may feel assured that a front passenger air bag will not deploy based on  
the fact that the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates.  
The child-restraint system can be hit by a deploying air bag and moved violently  
backward resulting in serious injury or death to the child.  
Do not sit too close to the driver and front passenger air bags:  
Sitting too close to the driver and front passenger air bag modules or placing hands  
or feet on them is extremely dangerous. The driver and front passenger air bags  
inflate with great force and speed. Serious injuries could occur if someone is too  
close. The driver should always hold onto only the rim of the steering wheel. The  
front seat passenger should keep both feet on the floor. Front seat occupants should  
adjust their seats as far back as possible and always sit upright against the  
seatbacks with seat belts worn properly.  
2-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page64  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (64,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Sit in the center of the seat and wear seat belts properly:  
Sitting too close to the side air bag modules or placing hands on them and sleeping  
up against the door or hanging out the windows is extremely dangerous. The side  
and curtain air bags inflate with great force and speed directly expand along the  
door on the side the car is hit. Serious injury could occur if someone is sitting too  
close to the door or leaning against a window, or if rear seat occupants grab the  
sides of the front seatbacks. Give the side and curtain air bags room to work by  
sitting in the center of the seat while the vehicle is moving with seat belts worn  
properly.  
Do not attach objects on or around the area where driver and front passenger air  
bags deploy:  
Attaching an object to the driver and front passenger air bag modules or placing  
something in front of them is dangerous. In an accident, an object could interfere  
with air bag inflation and injure the occupants.  
Do not attach objects on or around the area where a side air bag deploys:  
Attaching things to the front seat in such a way as to cover the outboard side of the  
seat in any way is dangerous. In an accident the object could interfere with the side  
air bag, which inflates from the outboard side of the front seats, impeding the added  
protection of the side air bag system or redirecting the air bag in a way that is  
dangerous. Furthermore, the bag could be cut open releasing the gas.  
Do not hang net bags, map pouches or backpacks with side straps on the front  
seats. Never use seat covers on the front seats. Always keep the side air bag modules  
in your front seats free to deploy in the event of a side collision.  
Do not attach objects on or around the area where a curtain air bag deploys:  
Attaching objects to the areas where the curtain air bag activates such as on the  
windshield glass, side door glass, front and rear window pillars and along the roof  
edge and assist grips is dangerous. In an accident the object could interfere with the  
curtain air bag, which inflates from the front and rear window pillars and along the  
roof edge, impeding the added protection of the curtain air bag system or redirecting  
the air bag in a way that is dangerous. Furthermore, the bag could be cut open  
releasing the gas.  
Do not place hangers or any other objects on the assist grips. When hanging clothes,  
hang them on the coat hook directly. Always keep the curtain air bag modules free  
to deploy in the event of a side collision or roll-over accident.  
Do not place luggage or other objects under the front seats:  
Placing luggage or other objects under the front seats is dangerous. The components  
essential to the supplemental restraint system could be damaged, and in the event of  
a side collision, the appropriate air bags may not deploy, which could result in death  
or serious injury. To prevent damage to the components essential to the  
supplemental restraint system, do not place luggage or other objects under the front  
seats.  
2-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page65  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (65,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Do not touch the components of the supplemental restraint system after the air bags  
have inflated:  
Touching the components of the supplemental restraint system after the air bags  
have inflated is dangerous. Immediately after inflation, they are very hot. You could  
get burned.  
Never install any front-end equipment to your vehicle:  
Installation of front-end equipment, such as frontal protection bar (kangaroo bar,  
bull bar, push bar, or other similar devices), snowplow, or winches, is dangerous. The  
air bag crash sensor system could be affected. This could cause air bags to inflate  
unexpectedly, or it could prevent the air bags from inflating during an accident.  
Front occupants could be seriously injured.  
Do not modify the suspension:  
Modifying the vehicle suspension is dangerous. If the vehicle's height or the  
suspension is modified, the vehicle will be unable to accurately detect a collision or  
roll-over accident resulting in incorrect or unexpected air bag deployment and the  
possibility of serious injuries.  
Do not use tires or wheels other than those specified for your Mazda:  
Use of any tire or wheel other than those specified for your Mazda (page 10-6) is  
dangerous. Use of such wheels will prevent the vehicle's accident detections system  
from accurately detecting a collision or roll-over accident resulting in incorrect or  
unexpected air bag deployment and the possibility of serious injuries.  
Do not overload your vehicle:  
Overloading your vehicle is dangerous as is could prevent the air bag crash sensor  
system from accurately detecting a collision or roll-over accident resulting in  
incorrect or unexpected air bag deployment and the possibility of serious injuries.  
The gross axle weight rating (GAWR) and the gross vehicle weight rating (GVWR) for  
your vehicle are on the Motor Vehicle Safety Standard Label on the driver's door  
frame. Do not exceed these ratings.  
Do not drive the vehicle off-road:  
Driving your Mazda off-road is dangerous because the vehicle has not been designed  
to do such. Driving the vehicle off-road could prevent the air bag crash sensor system  
from accurately detecting a collision or roll-over accident resulting in incorrect or  
unexpected air bag deployment and the possibility of serious injuries.  
2-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page66  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (66,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Do not modify the supplemental restraint system:  
Modifying the components or wiring of the supplemental restraint system is  
dangerous. You could accidentally activate it or make it inoperable. Do not make  
any modifications to the supplemental restraint system. This includes installing trim,  
badges, or anything else over the air bag modules. It also includes installing extra  
electrical equipment on or near system components or wiring. An Authorized Mazda  
Dealer can provide the special care needed in the removal and installation of front  
seats. It is important to protect the air bag wiring and connections to assure that the  
bags do not accidentally deploy, the driver seat slide position sensor and front  
passenger seat weight sensors are not damaged and that the seats retain an  
undamaged air bag connection.  
NOTE  
l
When an air bag deploys, a loud inflation noise can be heard and some smoke will be released.  
Neither is likely to cause injury, however, the texture of the air bags may cause light skin injuries  
on body parts not covered with clothing through friction.  
l
Should you sell your Mazda, we urge you to tell the new owner of its air bag systems and that  
familiarization with all instructions about them, from the Owner's Manual, is important.  
2-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page67  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (67,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Supplemental Restraint System Components  
(3)  
(4)  
(2)  
(5)  
(6)  
(1)  
(7)  
(8)  
(9)  
(11)  
(3)  
(10)  
(12)  
(8)  
(9)  
(8)  
(1) Driver seat slide position sensor (page 2-63)  
(2) Side and curtain inflators and air bags  
(3) Driver/Front passenger dual stage inflators and air bags  
(4) Air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system warning light (page 2-59)  
(5) Crash and roll-over sensors, and diagnostic module (SAS unit)  
(6) Front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light (page 2-63)  
(7) Front air bag sensor  
(8) Side crash sensor  
(9) Front seat belt pretensioner and load limiting systems (page 2-24)  
(10) Front passenger seat weight sensors (page 2-63)  
(11) Front passenger seat weight sensor control module  
(12) Driver and front passenger seat belt buckle switches (page 2-67)  
2-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page68  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (68,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
How the SRS Air Bags Work  
Your Mazda is equipped with the following types of SRS air bags. SRS air bags are  
designed to work together with the seat belts to help to reduce injuries during an accident.  
The SRS air bags are designed to provide further protection for passengers in addition to  
the seat belt functions. Be sure to wear seat belts properly.  
qFront Seat Belt Pretensioners  
The front seat belt pretensioners are designed to deploy in moderate or severe frontal, near  
frontal collisions or roll-over accidents.  
qDriver Air Bag  
The driver air bag is mounted in the steering wheels.  
When air bag crash sensors detect a frontal impact of greater than moderate force, the  
driver's air bag inflates quickly helping to reduce injury mainly to the driver's head or chest  
caused by directly hitting the steering wheel.  
The driver, dual stage air bag controls air bag inflation in two energy stages. During an  
impact of moderate severity the driver air bag deploys with lesser energy, whereas during  
more severe impacts, it deploys with more energy.  
2-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page69  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (69,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
qFront Passenger Air Bag  
The front passenger air bag is mounted in the front passenger dashboard.  
The inflation mechanism for the front passenger air bag is the same as the driver's air bag,  
as mentioned above. In addition, the front passenger air bag is designed to only deploy in  
accordance with the total seated weight on the front passenger seat. For details, refer to the  
driver and front passenger occupant classification system (page 2-63).  
qSide Air Bags  
The side bags are mounted in the outboard sides of the front seatbacks.  
When the air bag crash sensors detect a side impact of greater than moderate force, the  
system inflates the side air bag only on the side in which the vehicle was hit. The side air  
bag inflates quickly to reduce injury to the driver or front passenger's chest caused by  
directly hitting interior parts such as a door or window. In addition, the front passenger side  
air bag is designed to only deploy in accordance with the total seated weight on the front  
passenger seat. For details, refer to the driver and front passenger occupant classification  
system (page 2-63).  
2-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page70  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (70,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
qCurtain Air Bags  
The curtain air bags are mounted in the front and rear window pillars, and the roof edge  
along both sides.  
When the air bag crash sensors detect a side impact of greater than moderate force, the  
curtain air bag inflates quickly and helps to reduce injury mainly to the rear outboard  
passenger's head caused by directly hitting interior parts such as a door or window.  
In a side impact:  
Greater than moderate impact to one side of the vehicle will cause the curtain air bag on  
that side only to inflate.  
The only one side of curtain air bag will deploy  
only on the side the vehicle receives the force of  
the impact.  
In a roll-over:  
In response to a vehicle roll-over, both the curtain air bags inflate.  
Both curtain air bags will deploy after  
the roll-over accident is detected.  
2-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page71  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (71,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
qAir Bag/Front Seat Belt Pretensioner System Warning Light  
If the air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system is working properly, the warning light  
illuminates when the ignition switch is turned to the ON position or after the engine is  
cranked. The warning light turns off after a specified period of time.  
A system malfunction is indicated if the warning light constantly flashes, constantly  
illuminates or does not illuminate at all when the ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position. If any of these occur, consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
The system may not work in an accident.  
WARNING  
Never tamper with the air bag/pretensioner systems and always have an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer perform all servicing and repairs:  
Self-servicing or tampering with the systems is dangerous. An air bag/pretensioner  
could accidentally activate or become disabled causing serious injury or death.  
qAir Bag/Front Seat Belt Pretensioner System Warning Beep  
If a malfunction is detected in both the air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system and the  
warning light, a warning beep sound will be heard for about 1 minute. After that, the one-  
minute beep will be repeated every 30 minutes.  
Have your vehicle inspected at an Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING  
Do not drive the vehicle with the air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system warning  
beep sounding:  
Driving the vehicle with the air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system warning beep  
sounding is dangerous. In a collision, the air bags and the front seat belt  
pretensioner system will not deploy and this could result in death or serious injury.  
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer to have the vehicle inspected as soon as  
possible.  
2-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page72  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (72,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
SRS Air Bag Deployment Criteria  
This chart indicates the applicable SRS equipment that will deploy depending on the type of collision.  
(The illustrations are the representative case of collisions.)  
Types of collision  
A severe frontal/near frontal  
collision  
A severe side  
collision  
A roll-over/near  
roll-over  
A rear collision  
SRS  
equipment  
Front seat  
belt  
X*(both sides)  
X*(both sides)  
pretensioner  
Driver air  
bag  
No air bag and front  
seat belt  
X
Front  
passenger air  
bag  
pretensioner will be  
activated in a rear  
collision.  
X*  
Side air bag  
X*(impact side only)  
Curtain air  
bag  
X (impact side only)  
X (both sides)  
X: The SRS air bag equipment is designed to deploy in a collision.  
*: The front passenger front and side air bags and the seat belt pretensioner are designed to deploy depending on  
the condition of the total seated weight on the front passenger seat.  
2-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page73  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (73,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Limitations to SRS Air Bag  
In severe collisions or roll-overs such as those described previously in SRS Air Bag  
Deployment Criteria, the applicable SRS air bag equipment will deploy. However, in  
some accidents, the equipment may not deploy depending on the type of collision and its  
severity.  
Limitations to front/near front collision detection:  
The following illustrations are examples of front/near front collisions that may not be  
detected as severe enough to deploy the SRS air bag equipment.  
Frontal offset impact to the vehicle  
Impacts involving trees or poles  
Rear-ending or running under a truck's tail gate  
Limitations to side collision detection:  
The following illustrations are examples of side collisions that may not be detected as  
severe enough to deploy the SRS air bag equipment.  
Side impacts with two-wheeled vehicles  
Side impacts involving trees or poles  
2-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page74  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (74,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Limitations to roll-over detection:  
The following illustrations are examples of accidents that may not be detected as a roll-  
over accident. Therefore, the front seat belt pretensioners and curtain air bags may not  
deploy.  
Pitch end over end  
2-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page75  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (75,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Driver and Front Passenger Occupant Classification System  
First, please read Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Precautions(page 2-50)  
carefully.  
qDriver Seat Slide Position Sensor  
Your vehicle is equipped with a driver seat slide position sensor as a part of the  
supplemental restraint system. The sensor is located under the driver seat. The sensor  
determines whether the driver seat is fore or aft of a reference position and sends the seat  
position to the diagnostic module (SAS unit). The SAS unit is designed to control the  
deployment of the driver air bag depending on how close the driver seat is to the steering  
wheel.  
The air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system warning light flashes if the sensor has a  
possible malfunction (page 2-59)(Air Bag/Front Seat Belt Pretensioner System Warning  
Light).  
qFront Passenger Seat Weight Sensors  
Your vehicle is equipped with a front passenger seat weight sensors as a part of the  
supplemental restraint system. These sensors are located under both of the front passenger  
seat rails. These sensors determine the total seated weight on the front passenger seat. The  
SAS unit is designed to prevent the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt  
pretensioner system from deploying if the total seated weight is less than approximately 30  
kg (66 lb).  
To reduce the chance of injuries caused by deployment of the front passenger air bag, the  
system deactivates the front passenger front and side air bags and also the seat belt  
pretensioner system when:  
l
There is no passenger in the front passenger seat. (The front passenger air bag  
deactivation indicator light does not illuminate.)  
The total seated weight on the front passenger seat is less than approximately 30 kg (66  
l
lb). (The front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates.)  
This system shuts off the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner  
system, so make sure the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates  
according to the following table.  
The air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system warning light flashes and the front  
passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates if the sensors have a possible  
malfunction. If this happens, the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt  
pretensioner system will not deploy.  
2-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page76  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (76,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light  
This indicator light illuminates to remind you that the front passenger front and side air  
bags and seat belt pretensioner will not deploy during a collision.  
If the front passenger weight sensors are normal, the indicator light illuminates when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON position. For a specified of time it goes out.  
The front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates or is off under the following conditions:  
Front passenger seat  
Total seated weight on the Front passenger air bag Front passenger front and  
belt pretensioner  
front passenger seat  
deactivation indicator light  
side air bags  
Deactivated  
Deactivated  
system  
Empty (Not occupied)*  
OFF  
ON  
Deactivated  
Less than approx. 30 kg  
(66 lb)  
Deactivated  
Ready  
Approx. 42 kg (93 lb) or  
more  
OFF  
Ready  
* If the front passenger seat belt is buckled, the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates,  
however this does not indicate a malfunction.  
Curtain air bag is ready for inflating despite the chart above.  
If the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light does not illuminate when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON position and does not illuminate as indicated in the  
above chart, do not allow a child to sit in the front passenger seat and consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as possible. The system may not work properly in an  
accident.  
2-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page77  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (77,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
WARNING  
Do not decrease the total seated weight on the front passenger seat:  
When an adult or large child sits on the front passenger seat, decreasing the total  
seated weight on the front passenger seat from the total seated weight of  
approximately 42 kg (93 lb) required for air bag deployment is dangerous. The front  
passenger seat weight sensors will detect the reduced total seated weight condition  
and the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner system  
will not deploy during an accident. The front passenger will not have the  
supplementary protection of the air bag, which could result in serious injury.  
Decreasing the total seated weight on the front passenger seat from the total seated  
weight of approximately 42 kg (93 lb) could result in an air bag not deploying under  
the following conditions, for example:  
Ø A rear passenger pushes up on the front passenger seat with the feet.  
Ø Luggage or other items placed under the front passenger seat or between the  
front passenger seat and driver seat that push up the front passenger seat  
bottom.  
Ø The front passenger seat occupant sits in a manner that does not place the entire  
weight of the occupant on the seat such as by sitting too close to the door,  
grasping the assist grip or the rim of the moonroof and sitting with the seatback  
reclined too far.  
Ø Any accessories which might decrease the total seated weight on the front  
passenger seat are attached to the front passenger seat.  
The front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner systems will  
deactivate if the total seated weight on the front passenger seat is close to 30 kg (66  
lb) and they will reactivate before the weight exceeds 42 kg (93 lb).  
2-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page78  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (78,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Do not increase the total seated weight on the front passenger seat:  
When an infant or small child sits on the front passenger seat, increasing the total  
seated weight on the front passenger seat from the total seated weight of  
approximately 30 kg (66 lb) is dangerous. The front passenger seat weight sensors  
will detect the increased total seated weight, which could result in the unexpected  
deployment of the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner  
system in an accident and may cause serious injury. Increasing the total seated  
weight on the front passenger seat beyond the total seated weight of approximately  
30 kg (66 lb) could result in the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt  
pretensioner system deployment in an accident under the following conditions, for  
example:  
Ø Luggage or other items are placed on the seat with the child in the child-restraint  
system.  
Ø A rear passenger or luggage push or pull down on the front passenger seatback.  
Ø A rear passenger steps on the front passenger seat rails with the feet.  
Ø Luggage or other items are placed on the seatback or hung on the head restraint.  
Ø The seat is washed.  
Ø Liquids are spilled on the seat.  
Ø The front passenger seat is moved backward, pushing into luggage or other items  
placed behind it.  
Ø The front passenger seatback contacts the second-row seat.  
Ø Luggage or other items are placed between the front passenger seat and driver  
seat.  
Ø Any accessories which might increase the total seated weight on the front  
passenger seat are attached to the front passenger seat.  
The front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner systems will  
deactivate if the total seated weight on the front passenger seat is close to 30 kg (66  
lb) and they will reactivate before the weight exceeds 42 kg (93 lb).  
CAUTION  
Ø To assure proper deployment of the front air bag and to prevent damage to the  
sensors in the front seat bottoms:  
Ø
Do not place sharp objects on the front seat bottoms or leave heavy luggage on  
them.  
Ø
Do not spill any liquids on the front seats or under the front seats.  
Ø To allow the sensors to function properly, always perform the following:  
Ø
Adjust the front seats as far back as possible and always sit upright against the  
seatbacks with seat belts worn properly.  
If you place your child on the front passenger seat, secure the child-restraint  
system properly and slide the front passenger seat as far back as possible (page  
Ø
2-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page79  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (79,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
NOTE  
l
The system requires about 10 seconds to alternate between turning the front passenger front and  
side air bags and seat belt pretensioner system on or off.  
l
The front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light may illuminate repeatedly if luggage or  
other items are put on the front passenger seat, or if the temperature of the vehicle's interior  
changes suddenly.  
l
l
The front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light may illuminate for 10 seconds if the total  
seated weight on the front passenger seat changes.  
If the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light does not illuminate after installing a  
child-restraint system on the front passenger seat, install the child-restraint system on the rear  
seat and consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
qDriver and Front Passenger Buckle Switches  
The buckle switches on the front seat belts detect whether or not the front seat belts are  
securely fastened and further control the deployment of the air bags.  
2-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page80  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (80,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Monitoring and Maintenance  
qConstant Monitoring  
The following components of the air bag systems are monitored by a diagnostic system:  
l
SAS unit  
Front air bag sensor  
Air bag modules  
Side crash sensors  
Front seat belt pretensioners  
Related wiring  
Driver seat slide position sensor  
Front passenger seat weight sensors  
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
The diagnostic module continuously monitors the system's readiness. This begins when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON position and continues while the vehicle is being  
driven.  
qMaintenance  
The air bag systems do not require regular maintenance. But if any of the following occurs,  
take your vehicle to an Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as possible:  
l
The air bag system warning light flashes.  
The air bag system warning light remains illuminated.  
The air bag system warning light does not illuminate when the ignition switch is turned  
l
l
to the ON position.  
The air bag system warning beep sound will be heard.  
The air bags have deployed.  
Front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light does not illuminate when the ignition  
l
l
l
switch is turned to the ON position or does not illuminate as indicated in the chart. For  
more details about this indicator light and this chart, refer to Front passenger seat  
weight sensors(page 2-63).  
2-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page81  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (81,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
WARNING  
Do not operate a vehicle with damaged air bag/seat belt pretensioner system  
components:  
Expended or damaged air bag/seat belt pretensioner system components must be  
replaced after any collision which caused them to deploy or damage them. Only a  
trained Authorized Mazda Dealer can fully evaluate these systems to see that they  
will work in any subsequent accident. Driving with an expended or damaged air bag  
or pretensioner unit will not afford you the necessary protection in the event of any  
subsequent accident which could result in serious injury or death.  
Do not remove interior air bag parts:  
Removing any components such as the front seats, front dashboard, the steering  
wheel or parts on the front and rear window pillars and along the roof edge,  
containing air bag parts or sensors is dangerous. These parts contain essential air  
bag components. The air bag could accidentally activate and cause serious injuries.  
Always have an Authorized Mazda Dealer remove these parts.  
Dispose of the air bag properly:  
Improper disposal of an air bag or a vehicle with live air bags in it can be extremely  
dangerous. Unless all safety procedures are followed, injury can result. Ask an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer how to safely dispose of an air bag or how to scrap an air  
bag equipped vehicle.  
NOTE  
If it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the supplementary restraint  
system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical conditions in accordance with a  
certified physician, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer, refer to Customer Assistance (U.S.A.)”  
(page 9-2).  
2-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page82  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (82,1)  
2-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page83  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (83,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
3
Explanation of basic operations and controls; opening/closing and adjustment  
of various parts.  
Advanced Keysí ...................................................................... 3-2  
Keyless Entry Systemí .......................................................... 3-22  
Moonroofí ............................................................................. 3-44  
Theft-Deterrent Systemí ........................................................ 3-55  
íSome models.  
3-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page84  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (84,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
Advanced Keysí  
The advanced keyless functions (advanced keyless entry and start system) enables the  
following operations while the advanced key is being carried (page 3-7).  
l
Locking/unlocking the doors and the liftgate without operating the key.  
Starting the engine without operating the key.  
l
The advanced key enables additional functions other than those with the advanced keyless  
functions (page 3-13).  
l
The following operations are possible using the transmitter of the keyless entry system  
from a distance (Lock/Unlock/Panic/Liftgateí button):  
l
Locking/unlocking the doors and the liftgate.  
Opening/closing the power liftgateí.  
l
l
Opening the power windows and the moonroof.  
Operating the theft-deterrent systemí.  
l
l
Turning on the alarm.  
l
Locking/unlocking the doors or starting the engine using the auxiliary key.  
WARNING  
Do not leave the keys in your vehicle with children and keep them in a place where  
your children will not find or play with them:  
Leaving children in a vehicle with the key is dangerous. This could result in someone  
being badly injured or even killed. These new kinds of keys are fascinating to  
children. They could play with power windows or other controls, or even make the  
vehicle move.  
Radio waves from the advanced key may affect medical equipment such as  
pacemakers:  
Before using the advanced key near people who use medical equipment, ask the  
medical equipment manufacturer or your physician if radio waves from the  
advanced key will affect the equipment.  
NOTE  
l
The driver must carry the advanced key to ensure the system functions properly.  
l
Refer to Immobilizer System (page 3-50) for information regarding keys and engine starting.  
l
(With theft-deterrent system)  
Refer to Theft-Deterrent System (page 3-55) for information regarding keys and the prevention of  
vehicle and vehicle contents theft.  
3-2  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page85  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (85,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
With power liftgate button  
Power liftgate button  
Panic button  
Lock button  
Auxiliary key  
Unlock button  
Operation indicator light  
Key code number plate  
Without power liftgate button  
Panic button  
Lock button  
Auxiliary key  
Unlock button  
Operation indicator light  
Key code number plate  
A code number is stamped on the plate attached to the key set; detach this plate and store it  
in a safe place (not in the vehicle) for use if you need to make a replacement key.  
Also write down the code number and keep it in another safe and handy place, but not in  
the vehicle.  
If your key is lost, consult your Authorized Mazda Dealer with the code number ready.  
3-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page86  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (86,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
CAUTION  
Ø Because the advanced key uses low-intensity radio waves, it may not function  
correctly under the following conditions:  
Ø
The advanced key is carried with communication devices such as cellular  
phones.  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
The advanced key contacts or is covered by a metal object.  
The advanced key is near electronic devices such as personal computers.  
Non-Mazda genuine electronic equipment is installed in the vehicle.  
There is equipment which discharges radio waves near the vehicle.  
If the vehicle is near equipment such as wireless pay devices installed at certain  
gas stations.  
Ø The advanced key may consume battery power excessively if it receives high-  
intensity radio waves. Do not place the advanced key near electronic devices such  
as televisions or personal computers.  
Ø To avoid damage to the advanced key, DO NOT:  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Drop the advanced key.  
Get the advanced key wet.  
Disassemble the advanced key.  
Expose the advanced key to high temperatures on places such as the  
dashboard or hood, under direct sunlight.  
Place heavy objects on the advanced key.  
Put the advanced key in an ultrasonic cleaner.  
Put any magnetized objects close to the advanced key.  
Ø
Ø
Ø
NOTE  
l
Battery life is about one year. Replace the battery when the KEY indicator light (green) flashes in  
the instrument cluster.  
Refer to Advanced Key Battery Dead Warning on page 3-17.  
l
Additional advanced keys can be obtained at an Authorized Mazda Dealer. Up to 6 advanced keys  
can be used with the advanced keyless functions per vehicle.  
3-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page87  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (87,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
Replacing the battery at an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer is recommended to prevent  
damage to the advanced key. If replacing  
the battery by yourself, follow the  
instruction below.  
qAdvanced Key Maintenance  
CAUTION  
Ø Make sure the battery is installed  
with the correct pole facing  
upward. Battery leakage could  
occur if it is not installed correctly.  
Ø When replacing the battery, be  
careful not to bend the electrical  
terminals or get oil on them. Also  
be careful not to get dirt in the  
transmitter as it could be  
damaged.  
Replacing the advanced key battery  
1. Pull out the auxiliary key.  
Ø There is the danger of explosion if  
the battery is not correctly  
replaced.  
Ø Replace only with the same type  
battery (CR2025 or equivalent).  
Ø Dispose of used batteries  
according to the following  
instructions.  
2. Release the cap using a flathead  
screwdriver, then rotate and remove the  
cap.  
Ø
Insulate the plus and minus  
terminals of the battery using  
cellophane or equivalent tape.  
Never disassemble.  
Never throw the battery into  
fire or water.  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Never deform or crush.  
The following conditions indicate that the  
battery power is low:  
Cap  
l
The KEY indicator light (green) flashes  
in the instrument cluster when the  
engine is turned off.  
The system does not operate and the  
l
operation indicator light on the  
transmitter does not flash when the  
buttons are pressed.  
The system's operational range is  
reduced.  
CAUTION  
Do not turn the cap excessively. The  
cap may be damaged.  
l
3-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page88  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (88,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
3. Insert a flathead screwdriver into the  
crack and press the battery out.  
qService  
If you have a problem with the advanced  
keyless functions, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
If your advanced key is lost or stolen,  
bring all remaining advanced keys to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as  
possible for a replacement and to make  
the lost or stolen advanced key  
inoperative.  
CAUTION  
Radio equipment like this is governed  
by laws in the United States.  
Changes or modifications not  
expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could void  
the user's authority to operate the  
equipment.  
4. Insert the new battery (CR2025 or  
equivalent) with the positive pole (  
facing the ( ) mark on the cap.  
)
5. Rotate and close the cap.  
Cap  
6. Reinsert the auxiliary key.  
3-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page89  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (89,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
Starting the engine  
Operation Using Advanced  
Keyless Functions  
The operational range for starting the  
engine includes nearly the entire cabin  
area except for the luggage compartment.  
qOperational Range  
Interior transmitter  
The system operates only when the driver  
is in the vehicle or within operational  
range while the advanced key is being  
carried.  
NOTE  
When the battery power is low, or in places  
where there are high-intensity radio waves or  
noise, the operational range may become  
narrower or the system may not operate.  
Operational range  
Locking, unlocking the doors and the  
liftgate  
NOTE  
l
The luggage compartment is out of the  
operational range, however, starting the  
engine may be possible.  
The engine may not start if the advanced  
key is placed in the following areas:  
The operational range for locking/  
unlocking the doors is an area of up to 80  
cm (2.6 ft) from the center of the front  
door handles.  
The operational range for locking/  
unlocking the liftgate is an area of up to  
80 cm (2.6 ft) from the center of the  
liftgate.  
l
l
Around the dashboard  
In the storage compartments such as the  
l
glove box  
l
Starting the engine may be possible even if  
Exterior transmitter  
the advanced key is outside of the vehicle  
and extremely close to a door and window,  
however, always start the engine from the  
driver's seat.  
If the vehicle is started and the advanced  
key is not in the vehicle, the vehicle will not  
restart after it is shut off and the ignition  
switch is turned to the lock position.  
l
If the advanced key is detected within  
operational range, the operation indicator  
light located in the instrument cluster  
flashes momentarily.  
Operational range  
NOTE  
The system may not operate if you are too  
close to the windows, door handles, or liftgate.  
3-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page90  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (90,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
NOTE  
qLocking, Unlocking with Request  
(Without theft-deterrent system)  
The hazard warning lights will flash once to  
indicate that the doors and the liftgate are  
locked.  
Switch  
All doors and the liftgate can be locked/  
unlocked by pressing the request switch  
on the front doors or the liftgate while the  
advanced key is being carried.  
Front doors  
(With theft-deterrent system)  
l
The hazard warning lights will not flash.  
l
The hazard warning lights only flash when  
the theft deterrent system is armed or  
turned off, refer to the theft-deterrent  
system (page 3-55).  
To unlock  
Driver's door request switch  
Request switch  
To unlock the driver's door, press the  
request switch. A beep sound will be  
heard twice and the hazard warning lights  
will flash twice.  
To unlock all doors and the liftgate, press  
the request switch again within 3 seconds  
and two more beep sounds will be heard.  
Liftgate  
Request switch  
NOTE  
(Without theft-deterrent system)  
The hazard warning lights will flash twice to  
indicate that the doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked.  
(With theft-deterrent system)  
l
The hazard warning lights will not flash.  
l
The hazard warning lights only flash when  
the theft deterrent system is armed or  
turned off, refer to the theft-deterrent  
system (page 3-55).  
To lock  
Front passenger door/liftgate request  
switch  
To lock the doors and the liftgate, press  
the request switch. A beep sound will be  
heard once and the hazard warning lights  
will flash once.  
To unlock the doors and the liftgate, press  
the request switch. A beep sound will be  
heard twice and the hazard warning lights  
will flash twice.  
3-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page91  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (91,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
l
After unlocking doors and the liftgate by  
NOTE  
l
pressing the request switch, all doors and  
the liftgate will automatically lock if any of  
the following operations are not performed  
within about 30 seconds. If your vehicle has  
a theft-deterrent system, the hazard  
The request switch on the driver's door can  
be used to close the power windows and the  
moonroof.  
Refer to the following pages:  
Opening/Closing the Power Windows (page  
warning lights will flash for confirmation.  
l
A door or the liftgate is opened.  
The auxiliary key is inserted into the  
Opening/Closing the Moonroof (page 3-46)  
l
l
Confirm that all doors and the liftgate are  
ignition switch.  
The start knob is pushed.  
securely locked.  
All doors and the liftgate cannot be locked  
l
l
when any door or the liftgate is open.  
l
A beep sound is heard for confirmation  
qStarting the Engine  
when the doors and the liftgate are locked/  
unlocked using the request switch. If your  
prefer, the beep sound can be turned off  
(page 3-19).  
Ignition switch positions  
Without a traditional key, some of the  
ignition switch functions are different.  
l
The setting can be changed so that the  
doors and the liftgate are locked  
automatically without pressing the request  
switch (page 3-19).  
(Auto-lock function)  
A beep sound is heard when all doors and  
the liftgate are closed while the advanced  
key is being carried. All doors and the  
liftgate are locked automatically after about  
3 seconds when the advanced key is out of  
the operational range. Also, the hazard  
warning lights flash once. (Even if the  
driver is in the operational range, all doors  
and the liftgate are locked automatically  
after about 30 seconds.)  
If you are out of the operational range  
before the doors and the liftgate are  
completely closed or another advanced key  
is left in the vehicle, the auto-lock function  
will not work. Always make sure that all  
doors and the liftgate are closed and locked  
before leaving the vehicle.  
Start knob  
LOCK (Released)  
The steering wheel locks to help protect  
against theft.  
LOCK (Depressed)  
The ignition switch can be turned to the  
ACC position when the KEY indicator  
light (green) illuminates in the instrument  
cluster.  
3-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page92  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (92,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
NOTE  
WARNING  
When the ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position, the sound of the fuel pump motor  
operating near the fuel tank can be heard. This  
does not indicate an abnormality.  
Before leaving the driver's seat, always  
put the key or start knob to LOCK  
position, set the parking brake and  
make sure the shift lever is in P:  
Intentionally placing the key or start  
knob into LOCK position is much  
more important where you will not  
be removing the key to leave the  
vehicle and because leaving it in  
other positions will disable some of  
the vehicle security systems and run  
the battery down.  
START  
The engine is started in this position. It  
will crank until you release the start knob;  
then it returns to the ON position. The  
brake warning light can be checked after  
the engine is started (page 5-37).  
Starting the engine  
Leaving the driver's seat without  
putting the ignition switch in LOCK  
position, setting the parking brake  
and the shift lever is in P is  
dangerous. Unexpected vehicle  
movement could occur. This could  
cause an accident.  
NOTE  
l
Engine-starting is controlled by the spark  
ignition system.  
This system meets all Canadian  
Interference-Causing Equipment Standard  
requirements regulating the impulse  
electrical field strength of radio noise.  
l
The advanced key must be carried because  
NOTE  
the advanced key carries an immobilizer  
chip that must communicate with the engine  
controls at short range.  
l
If turning the ignition switch is difficult,  
jiggle the steering wheel from side to side.  
l
The ignition switch cannot be turned from  
l
When starting the engine, be sure the start  
the ACC position to the LOCK position  
when the shift lever is not in P.  
knob is securely attached before trying to  
operate it. If the knob becomes detached  
from the ignition switch, re-attach it by  
pushing it on to the ignition switch.  
ACC (Accessory)  
The steering wheel unlocks and some  
electrical accessories will operate.  
NOTE  
The Advanced Keyless Entry System does not  
function in the ACC position, and the doors  
will not lock/unlock using the transmitter or  
request switches even if the advanced key is  
carried away from the vehicle.  
ON  
This is the normal running position after  
the engine is started. The warning lights  
(except brakes) should be inspected  
before the engine is started (page 5-37).  
3-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page93  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (93,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
1. Make sure the advanced key is being  
carried.  
NOTE  
In the following cases, the KEY warning light  
(red) illuminates and the engine will not start.  
2. Occupants should fasten their seat  
belts.  
l
The advanced key battery is dead.  
l
The advanced key is out of operational  
range.  
3. Make sure the parking brake is on.  
4. Depress the brake pedal.  
l
The advanced key is placed in areas where  
it is difficult for the system to detect the  
signal (page 3-7).  
A key from another manufacturer similar to  
the advanced key is in the operational  
range.  
5. Put the vehicle in park (P). If you must  
restart the engine while the vehicle is  
moving, shift into neutral (N).  
l
NOTE  
The starter will not operate if the shift lever is  
not in P or N.  
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC  
position while pushing the start knob  
in.  
6. Push the start knob slowly all the way  
in.  
9. Turn the ignition switch from the ACC  
position to the START position and  
hold (up to 10 seconds at a time) until  
the engine starts.  
7. Verify that the KEY indicator light  
(green) illuminates in the instrument  
cluster. The KEY warning light (red)  
means you cannot continue to start the  
engine using the Advanced Keyless  
System. You may have to use the  
auxiliary key instead (page 3-20).  
CAUTION  
Don't try the starter for more than 10  
seconds at a time. If the engine stalls  
or fails to start, wait 10 seconds  
before trying again. Otherwise, you  
may damage the starter and drain  
the battery.  
10. After starting the engine, let it idle for  
about 10 seconds.  
3-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page94  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (94,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
NOTE  
NOTE  
_
l
l
In extremely cold weather, below 18° C  
(0° F), or after the vehicle has not been  
driven in several days, let the engine warm  
up without operating the accelerator.  
Whether the engine is cold or warm, it  
should be started without use of the  
accelerator.  
When turning the ignition switch to the  
LOCK position, the ignition switch has to  
be pushed in from the ACC position and  
turned. Without being pushed in, the  
ignition switch stops at the ACC position  
and the vehicle battery may be discharged  
if the ignition switch is left in the ACC  
position. When leaving the vehicle, make  
sure the ignition switch is turned to the  
LOCK position.  
l
Turning off the engine  
1. Move the shift lever to the P position.  
l
If the vehicle is left with the ignition switch  
not in the LOCK position, a beep sound is  
heard and the indicator light flashes to  
notify the driver.  
2. Turn the ignition switch from the ON  
position to the ACC position.  
NOTE  
Refer to Warning Beep (page 3-16).  
When the engine is turned off and the ignition  
switch it turned from the ACC position to the  
LOCK position, the KEY indicator light  
(green) flashes in the instrument cluster for  
about 30 seconds if the battery power of the  
advanced key is low. Replace the battery with a  
new one.  
Refer to Battery Replacement (page 3-6).  
3. Push in the start knob from the ACC  
position and turn it to the LOCK  
position.  
CAUTION  
When leaving the vehicle, make sure  
the ignition switch is turned to the  
LOCK position.  
3-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page95  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (95,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
Transmitter  
Operation Using Advanced  
Key Functions  
with power liftgate  
qKeyless Entry System  
Lock button  
Panic button  
This system uses the more traditional key  
buttons to remotely lock and unlock the  
doors and the liftgate, and opens the  
power windows and the moonroof.  
It can also help you signal for attention.  
Press the buttons slowly and carefully.  
Unlock button  
Power liftgate  
button  
NOTE  
l
The keyless entry system is designed to  
operate up to about 2.5 m (8 ft) from the  
center of the vehicle, but this may vary due  
to local conditions.  
without power liftgate  
l
The system does not operate when the  
Lock button  
ignition switch is not in the LOCK position  
or the start knob is pushed in.  
l
With the start knob installed in the LOCK  
Panic button  
position, the system is fully operational. If  
the ignition switch is not in the LOCK  
position or the start knob is pushed in, the  
system does not operate.  
Unlock button  
l
All doors and the liftgate cannot be locked  
by pressing the lock button while any door  
or the liftgate is open. The hazard warning  
lights will also not flash.  
l
If the transmitter does not operate when  
pressing a button or the operational range  
becomes too small, the battery may be  
dead. To install a new battery, refer to  
Maintenance (page 3-5).  
3-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page96  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (96,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
NOTE  
NOTE  
l
(U.S.A.)  
(Without theft-deterrent system)  
The hazard warning lights will flash once to  
indicate that all doors and the liftgate are  
locked.  
This device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause harmful interference, and (2)  
this device must accept any interference  
received, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation.  
(With theft-deterrent system)  
l
The hazard warning lights will not flash.  
l
The hazard warning lights only flash when  
the theft deterrent system is armed or  
turned off, refer to the theft-deterrent  
system (page 3-55).  
l
(CANADA)  
This device complies with RSS-210 of  
Industry CANADA. Operation is subject to  
the following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause interference, and (2) this  
device must accept any interference,  
including interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the device.  
NOTE  
l
All doors and the liftgate cannot be locked  
when any door or the liftgate is open.  
l
Confirm that all doors and the liftgate are  
locked visually or audibly by use of the  
double click.  
NOTE  
Unlock button  
The unlock button can be used to open the  
power windows and the moonroof, but the lock  
button cannot be used to close the power  
windows and the moonroof.  
Refer to the following pages:  
Opening/Closing the Power Windows (page  
To unlock the driver's door, press the  
unlock button. A beep will be heard twice  
and the hazard warning lights will flash  
twice.  
To unlock all doors and the liftgate, press  
the unlock button again within 3 seconds  
and two more beep sounds will be heard.  
Opening/Closing the Moonroof (page 3-46)  
The operation indicator light flashes when  
the buttons are pressed.  
NOTE  
(Without theft-deterrent system)  
The hazard warning lights will flash twice to  
indicate that all doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked.  
Lock button  
To lock the doors and the liftgate, press  
the lock button. A beep sound will be  
heard once and the hazard warning lights  
will flash once.  
(With theft-deterrent system)  
l
The hazard warning lights will not flash.  
l
The hazard warning lights only flash when  
the theft deterrent system is armed or  
turned off, refer to the theft-deterrent  
system (page 3-55).  
To confirm that all doors and the liftgate  
have been locked, press the lock button  
again within 5 seconds. If they are closed  
and locked, the horn will sound.  
3-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page97  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (97,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
NOTE  
qAuxiliary Key Function  
After unlocking with the transmitter, all doors  
and the liftgate will automatically lock if one  
of the doors or the liftgate is not opened within  
about 30 seconds.  
Use the auxiliary key stored in the  
advanced key in the event of a dead  
transmitter battery or malfunction.  
Removing the auxiliary key  
Power liftgate button  
Pull out the auxiliary key from the  
advanced key.  
If your Mazda has a power liftgate (page  
3-30), the transmitter can open/close the  
liftgate.  
Panic button  
If you witness from a distance someone  
attempting to break into or damage your  
vehicle, pressing the panic button will  
activate the vehicle's alarm.  
NOTE  
The panic button will work whether any door  
or the liftgate is open or closed.  
(Turning on the alarm)  
Locking, unlocking the doors  
Pressing the panic button for 1 second or  
more will trigger the alarm for about 2  
minutes and 30 seconds, and the  
following will occur:  
The doors can be locked/unlocked using  
the auxiliary key, refer to Locking,  
Unlocking with Key (page 3-26).  
l
The horn sounds intermittently.  
The hazard warning lights flash.  
Starting the engine  
l
The engine can be started with the  
auxiliary key, refer to Ignition Switch  
(page 5-2).  
(Turning off the alarm)  
The alarm stops by pressing any button on  
the transmitter.  
Locking, unlocking the glove box  
The glove box can be locked/unlocked  
using the auxiliary key, refer to Glove  
Box (page 6-128).  
3-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page98  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (98,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
Warning and Beep Sounds  
Advanced Key Suspend  
Function  
q
System Malfunction Warning Beep  
If one advanced key is left in the vehicle  
and a second advanced key is used to lock  
it, the functions of the advanced key left  
in the vehicle is temporarily suspended to  
prevent theft of the vehicle.  
If any malfunction occurs in the advanced  
keyless function, the KEY warning light  
(red) in the instrument cluster illuminates  
continuously and beep sounds will be  
heard.  
The following are inoperable:  
l
Starting the engine using the start  
CAUTION  
knob.  
If the KEY warning light (red) remains  
illuminated, do not continue to drive  
the vehicle with the advanced keyless  
function. Park the vehicle in a safe  
place and use the auxiliary key to  
continue driving the vehicle. Have the  
vehicle inspected at an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
Refer to Ignition Switch (page 5-2).  
l
Operating the request switches.  
To restore these functions, perform any  
one of the following:  
l
Press the lock or unlock button on the  
advanced key which has had its  
functions temporarily suspended.  
While carrying another advanced key,  
l
push in the start knob until the KEY  
indicator light (green) illuminates.  
Insert the auxiliary key and turn the  
l
qStart Knob Not in LOCK  
ignition switch to the ON position.  
Warning Beep  
If the start knob is in the ACC position  
and the driver's door is opened, a  
continuous beep sound will be heard to  
notify the driver that the start knob has not  
been returned to the LOCK position. In  
this case, the keyless entry system does  
not operate, the car cannot be locked, and  
the battery will run down.  
3-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page99  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (99,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
qAdvanced Key Removed from  
qRequest Switch Inoperable  
Vehicle Warning Beep  
Warning Beep  
Under the following conditions, a beep  
sound will be heard and the KEY warning  
light (red) will flash continuously when  
the start knob has not been returned to the  
LOCK position to notify the driver that  
the advanced key has been removed. The  
KEY warning light (red) will stop flashing  
when the advanced key is back inside the  
vehicle:  
Under the following conditions, if the  
request switch for a front door or the  
liftgate is pressed while the advanced key  
is being carried, a beep will be heard 6  
times to indicate that the front doors and  
the liftgate cannot be locked.  
l
A door or the liftgate is open (door ajar  
included).  
The start knob has not been returned to  
l
l
The start knob has not been returned to  
the LOCK position.  
The auxiliary key is inserted into the  
l
the LOCK position, the driver's door is  
open, and the advanced key is removed  
from the vehicle. (A beep sound will be  
heard 3 times.)  
ignition switch.  
qAdvanced Key Battery Dead  
However the beep sound will be heard  
continuously when the start knob is in  
the ACC position and the door is open  
due to the activation of the warning  
beep sound indicating that the start  
knob is not in the LOCK position.  
Warning  
When the start knob is returned to the  
ACC or LOCK position from the ON  
position, the KEY indicator light (green)  
flashes for approximately 30 seconds  
indicating that the remaining battery  
power is low. Replace with a new battery  
before the advanced key becomes  
unusable.  
l
The start knob has not been returned to  
the LOCK position and all the doors  
are closed after removing the advanced  
key from the vehicle. (A beep sound  
will be heard 6 times.)  
Refer to Advanced Key Maintenance  
(page 3-5).  
NOTE  
NOTE  
Because the advanced key utilizes low-intensity  
radio waves, the Advanced Key Removed From  
Vehicle Warning may activate if the advanced  
key is carried together with a metal object or it  
is placed in a poor signal reception area.  
The advanced key can be set so that the KEY  
indicator light (green) does not flash even if  
the battery power is low.  
Refer to Setting Change (page 3-19).  
q
Engine Start Not Permitted Warning  
Under the following conditions, the KEY  
warning light (red) flashes to inform the  
driver that the start knob will not rotate to  
the ACC position even if it is pushed in  
from the LOCK position.  
l
The advanced key battery is dead.  
3-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page100  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (100,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
l
The advanced key is not within  
operational range.  
The advanced key is placed in areas  
l
where it is difficult for the system to  
detect the signal (page 3-7).  
A key from another manufacturer  
l
similar to the advanced key is in the  
operational range.  
qAdvanced Key Left-in-vehicle  
Warning Beep  
If an advanced key is left in the vehicle  
cabin and all the doors and the liftgate are  
locked using a separate advanced key, a  
beep sound is heard for about 10 seconds  
to remind the driver that the advanced key  
has been left in the vehicle cabin. If this  
happens, the doors and the liftgate lock  
but the functions of the advanced key left  
in the vehicle cabin may be temporarily  
suspended. Perform the following  
procedure to restore the functions of the  
advanced key (page 3-16).  
3-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page101  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (101,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
Setting Change (Function Customization)  
The following function settings are possible. These settings can only be changed by an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
After Setting  
Change  
Setting  
Function  
At Initial Setting  
Advanced key battery KEY indicator light (green) flashes to indicate  
dead indicator that the advanced key battery power is low.  
Lock/unlock operation A beep sound is heard to confirm that all doors or  
Activated  
Deactivated  
confirmation beep  
the liftgate have been locked/unlocked.  
Activated  
Deactivated  
Activated  
sound*1  
When all doors and the liftgate are closed and the  
advanced key is being carried and out of  
operational range, all the doors and the liftgate  
automatically lock after 3 seconds.  
Autolock function*2  
Deactivated  
(Even if the driver is in the operational range, all  
doors and the liftgate are locked automatically  
after about 30 seconds.)  
*1: When the autolock function is operating, the warning sound will be heard regardless of the setting.  
*2: When Autolock function is enabled, windows will not automatically close. You must close before leaving  
vehicle.  
3-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page102  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (102,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
When Warning Indicator/Beep is Activated  
Under the following conditions, warning beeps are heard and a warning/indicator light in  
the instrument cluster illuminates to notify the driver of improper operation of the  
advanced key to prevent theft of the vehicle (page 3-16).  
Warning  
How to check  
When a door is open, a continuous beep sound will be Check whether the start knob has been returned to the  
heard.  
LOCK position.  
When a door is open, 3 beep sounds are heard, and the  
KEY warning light (red) in the instrument cluster  
flashes.  
Check whether the advanced key has been removed  
from the vehicle.  
When a door is closed, a beep sound is heard 6 times,  
and the KEY warning light (red) in the instrument  
cluster flashes.  
Check whether the advanced key has been removed  
from the vehicle.  
When locking the doors, the chime sounds for about 10 Check whether the advanced key has been left in the  
seconds.  
vehicle.  
Check whether the advanced key has been left in the  
vehicle.  
When attempting to lock the doors, a beep sound is  
heard 6 times.  
Check whether the start knob has been returned to the  
LOCK position.  
Check whether a door or the liftgate is open.  
The advanced key battery power is low. Replace the  
battery with a new one.  
Refer to Advanced Key Maintenance on page 3-5.  
When the KEY indicator light (green) flashes in the  
instrument cluster.  
The advanced key is malfunctioning. Park the vehicle in  
When the KEY warning light (red) remains illuminated a safe place, and use the auxiliary key to continue  
in the instrument cluster.  
driving the vehicle. Have the vehicle inspected at an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
3-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page103  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (103,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
A code number is stamped on the plate  
attached to the key set; detach this plate  
and store it in a safe place (not in the  
vehicle) for use if you need to make a  
replacement key.  
Keys  
WARNING  
Do not leave the keys in your vehicle  
with children and keep them in a place  
where your children will not find or  
play with them:  
NOTE  
Write down the code number and keep it in a  
separate safe and convenient place, but not in  
the vehicle.  
If your key is lost, consult your Authorized  
Mazda Dealer and have your code number  
ready.  
Leaving children in a vehicle with the  
key is dangerous. This could result in  
someone being badly injured or even  
killed. These new kinds of keys are  
fascinating to children. They could  
play with power windows or other  
controls, or even make the vehicle  
move.  
Key extend/retract method (Retractable  
type key)  
To extend the key, press the release  
button.  
NOTE  
l
Refer to Immobilizer System (page 3-52) for  
information regarding keys and engine  
starting.  
l
(With theft-deterrent system)  
Refer to Theft-Deterrent System (page 3-55)  
for information regarding keys and the  
prevention of vehicle and vehicle contents  
theft.  
The keys operate all locks.  
To retract the key, rotate it into the holder  
while pressing the release button.  
Retractable  
type key  
Key code number plate  
3-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page104  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (104,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
qTransmitter  
Keyless Entry Systemí  
This system remotely locks and unlocks  
the doors and the liftgate, and opens the  
power windows and the moonroof.  
Lock button  
Unlock button  
It can also help you signal for attention.  
Press the buttons slowly and carefully.  
CAUTION  
To avoid damage to the transmitter,  
do not:  
Ø Drop the transmitter.  
Ø Get the transmitter wet.  
Ø Expose the transmitter to any kind  
of magnetic field.  
Operation  
indicator light  
Panic button  
NOTE  
l
(U.S.A.)  
This device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause harmful interference, and (2)  
this device must accept any interference  
received, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation.  
Ø Expose the transmitter to high  
temperatures on places such as  
the dashboard or hood, under  
direct sunlight.  
NOTE  
l
The keyless entry system is designed to  
operate up to about 2.5 m (8 ft) from the  
center of the vehicle, but this may vary due  
to local conditions.  
The system doesn't operate when the key is  
in the ignition switch.  
l
(CANADA)  
This device complies with RSS-210 of  
Industry CANADA. Operation is subject to  
the following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause interference, and (2) this  
device must accept any interference,  
including interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the device.  
l
l
Doors and the liftgate cannot be locked by  
pressing the lock button while any other  
door or the liftgate is open. Also, the hazard  
warning lights will not flash.  
l
NOTE  
If the transmitter does not operate when  
The unlock button can be used to open the  
power windows and the moonroof, but the lock  
button cannot be used to close the power  
windows and the moonroof.  
pressing a button or the operation range  
becomes too small, the battery may be  
dead. To install a new battery, refer to  
Maintenance (page 3-24).  
l
Refer to the following pages:  
Additional transmitters can be obtained at  
Opening/Closing the Power Windows (page  
Opening/Closing the Moonroof (page 3-46)  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer. Up to 3  
transmitters can be used with the keyless  
entry system per vehicle. Bring all  
transmitters to an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer when additional transmitters are  
required.  
The operation indicator light flashes when  
the buttons are pressed.  
3-22  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page105  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (105,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Lock button  
NOTE  
(Without theft-deterrent system)  
The hazard warning lights will flash twice to  
indicate that all doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked.  
To lock the doors and the liftgate, press  
the lock button and the hazard warning  
lights will flash once.  
(With theft-deterrent system)  
To confirm that all doors and the liftgate  
have been locked, press the lock button  
again within 5 seconds. If they are closed  
and locked, the horn will sound.  
l
The hazard warning lights will not flash.  
l
The hazard warning lights only flash when  
the theft deterrent system is armed or  
turned off, refer to the theft-deterrent  
system (page 3-55).  
NOTE  
(Without theft-deterrent system)  
The hazard warning lights will flash once to  
indicate that all doors and the liftgate are  
locked.  
NOTE  
After unlocking with the transmitter, all doors  
and the liftgate will automatically lock if one  
of the doors or the liftgate is not opened within  
about 30 seconds.  
(With theft-deterrent system)  
l
The hazard warning lights will not flash.  
The hazard warning lights only flash when  
the theft deterrent system is armed or  
turned off, refer to the theft-deterrent  
system (page 3-55).  
l
Panic button  
If you witness from a distance someone  
attempting to break into or damage your  
vehicle, pressing the panic button will  
activate the vehicle's alarm.  
NOTE  
l
All doors and the liftgate cannot be locked  
NOTE  
when any door or the liftgate is open and  
the key is in the ignition switch.  
Confirm that all doors and the liftgate are  
locked visually or audibly by use of the  
double click.  
The panic button will work whether any door  
or the liftgate is open or closed.  
l
Turning on the alarm  
Pressing the panic button once will trigger  
the alarm for about 2 minutes and 30  
seconds, and the following will occur:  
Unlock button  
To unlock the driver's door, press the  
unlock button and the hazard warning  
lights will flash twice.  
l
The horn sounds intermittently.  
l
The hazard warning lights flash.  
Turning off the alarm  
To unlock all doors and the liftgate, press  
the unlock button again within 3 seconds.  
Press any button on the transmitter.  
3-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page106  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:17 PM  
Black plate (106,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
2. Insert a screwdriver into the slot and  
push the tab to remove the key from  
the transmitter.  
qTransmitter Maintenance  
If the buttons on the transmitter are  
inoperable and the operation indicator  
light does not flash, the battery may be  
dead.  
Tab  
Replace with a new battery before the  
transmitter becomes unusable.  
CAUTION  
Ø Install the battery with the positive  
pole ( ) facing down. Battery  
leakage could occur if it is not  
installed correctly.  
Ø When replacing the battery, be  
careful not to bend the electrical  
terminals or get oil on them. Also  
be careful not to get dirt in the  
transmitter as it could be  
damaged.  
3. Insert a screwdriver into the slot and  
gently pry open the transmitter.  
Ø There is the danger of explosion if  
the battery is not correctly  
replaced.  
Ø Replace only with the same type  
battery (CR1620 or equivalent).  
Ø Dispose of used batteries  
according to the following  
instructions.  
Ø
Insulate the plus and minus  
terminals of the battery using  
cellophane or equivalent tape.  
Never disassemble.  
Never throw the battery into  
fire and/or water.  
Never deform or crush.  
4. Remove the battery.  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Replacing the transmitter battery  
1. Unfold the key (page 3-21).  
A
3-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page107  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (107,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
5. Put in the new battery (CR1620 or  
equivalent) with the positive pole (  
facing down.  
Door Locks  
WARNING  
)
Always take all children and pets with  
you or leave a responsible person with  
them:  
Leaving a child or a pet unattended  
in a parked vehicle is dangerous. In  
hot weather, temperatures inside a  
vehicle can become high enough to  
cause brain damage or even death.  
Do not leave the keys in your vehicle  
with children and keep them in a place  
where your children will not find or  
play with them:  
6. Align the front and back covers and  
snap the transmitter shut.  
Leaving children in a vehicle with the  
key is dangerous. This could result in  
someone being badly injured or even  
killed. They could play with power  
windows or other controls, or even  
make the vehicle move.  
7. Install the key to the transmitter.  
qService  
If you have a problem with the keyless  
entry system, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
Keep all doors locked when driving:  
Unlocked doors in a moving vehicle  
are dangerous. Passengers can fall  
out if a door is accidentally opened  
and can more easily be thrown out in  
an accident.  
If your transmitter is lost or stolen, bring  
all remaining transmitters to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as  
possible for a replacement and to make  
the lost or stolen transmitter inoperative.  
Always close all the windows, lock the  
doors and take the key with you when  
leaving your vehicle unattended:  
CAUTION  
Radio equipment like this is governed  
by laws in the United States.  
Changes or modifications not  
expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could void  
the user's authority to operate the  
equipment.  
3-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page108  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (108,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
qLocking, Unlocking with Key  
qLocking, Unlocking with Door-  
Lock Knob  
The driver's door can be locked/unlocked  
with the key.  
Turn the key toward the front to unlock,  
toward the back to lock.  
To lock any door from the inside, push the  
door-lock knob.  
To unlock, pull it out.  
This does not operate the other door  
locks.  
Unlock  
Lock  
Lock  
Unlock  
qLocking, Unlocking with Request  
Switch (with Advanced Key)  
To lock any door with the door-lock knob  
from the outside, push the door-lock knob  
to the lock position and close the door.  
This does not operate the other door  
locks.  
The doors can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the request switch while  
carrying the advanced key outside the  
vehicle, refer to Operations Using  
Advanced Keyless Functions (page 3-7).  
qLocking, Unlocking with  
Transmitter (with Advanced Key)  
The doors can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the keyless entry system  
transmitter, refer to Keyless Entry System  
(page 3-13).  
Door-lock knob  
q
Locking, Unlocking with Transmitter  
(with Retractable Type Key)  
NOTE  
The doors can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the keyless entry system  
transmitter, refer to Keyless Entry System  
(page 3-22).  
l
(With advanced key)  
The driver's door cannot be locked using  
the door-lock knob from the outside.  
l
When locking the doors this way, be careful  
not to leave the key inside the vehicle.  
3-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page109  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (109,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
NOTE  
qPower Door Locks  
Holding the key in the unlocked position in the  
driver's door lock for about a second unlocks  
all doors and the liftgate. To unlock only the  
driver's door, insert the key into the driver's  
door lock and turn the key briefly to the unlock  
position and then immediately return it to the  
center position.  
Vehicle lock-out prevention  
(With advanced key)  
The vehicle lock-out prevention feature  
prevents you from locking yourself out of  
the vehicle. All doors and the liftgate will  
automatically unlock if they are locked  
using the power door locks with any door  
or the liftgate open.  
Locking, unlocking with door-lock  
switch  
(With retractable type key)  
The vehicle lock-out prevention feature  
prevents you from locking yourself out of  
the vehicle. With the key in the ignition  
switch, all doors and the liftgate will  
automatically unlock if they are locked  
using the power door locks with any door  
or the liftgate open.  
All doors and the liftgate lock  
automatically when lock side is pushed.  
They all unlock when unlock side is  
pushed.  
Unlock  
Lock  
Locking, unlocking with key  
All doors and the liftgate lock  
automatically when the driver's door is  
locked with the key. All doors and the  
liftgate unlock when the driver's door is  
unlocked and the key is held in the unlock  
position for one second or longer.  
Locking, unlocking with request switch  
(with advanced key)  
All doors and the liftgate can be locked/  
unlocked by operating the request switch  
on the front doors and the liftgate while  
carrying the advanced key outside the  
vehicle, refer to Operations Using  
Unlock  
Advanced Keyless Functions (page 3-7).  
Lock  
Locking, unlocking with transmitter  
(with advanced key)  
All doors and the liftgate can be locked/  
unlocked by operating the keyless entry  
system transmitter, refer to Keyless Entry  
System (page 3-13).  
3-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page110  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (110,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Locking, unlocking with transmitter  
(with retractable type key)  
Liftgate  
WARNING  
Never allow a person to ride in the  
luggage compartment:  
All doors and the liftgate can be locked/  
unlocked by operating the keyless entry  
system transmitter, refer to Keyless Entry  
System (page 3-22).  
Allowing a person to ride in the  
luggage compartment is dangerous.  
The person in the luggage  
qRear Door Child Safety Locks  
compartment could be seriously  
injured or killed during sudden  
braking or a collision.  
These locks are intended to help prevent  
children from accidentally opening the  
rear doors. Use them both whenever a  
child rides in the vehicle.  
Do not drive with the liftgate open:  
Exhaust gas in the cabin of a vehicle  
is dangerous. An open liftgate in a  
moving vehicle will cause exhaust  
gas to be drawn into the cabin. This  
gas contains CO (carbon monoxide),  
which is colorless, odorless, and  
highly poisonous, and it can cause  
loss of consciousness and death.  
Moreover, an open liftgate could  
cause occupants to fall out in an  
accident.  
If you slide the child safety lock to the  
lock position before closing that door, the  
door cannot be opened from the inside.  
The door can be opened only by pulling  
the outside handle.  
Lock  
Unlock  
qLocking, Unlocking with Request  
Switch (with Advanced Key)  
The liftgate can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the request switch while  
carrying the advanced key outside the  
vehicle, refer to Operations Using  
Advanced Keyless Functions (page 3-7).  
qLocking, Unlocking with  
Transmitter (with Advanced Key)  
The liftgate can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the keyless entry system  
transmitter, refer to Keyless Entry System  
(page 3-13).  
3-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page111  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (111,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
NOTE  
q
Locking, Unlocking with Transmitter  
(with Retractable Type Key)  
If the vehicle battery is dead or there is a  
malfunction in the electrical system and the  
liftgate cannot be unlocked, perform the  
following procedure as an emergency measure  
to unlock it:  
The liftgate can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the keyless entry system  
transmitter, refer to Keyless Entry System  
(page 3-22).  
1. Remove the cap on the interior surface of  
the liftgate with a flathead screwdriver.  
qLocking, Unlocking with Door-  
Lock Switch  
The liftgate can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the door-lock switch, refer to  
Power Door Locks (page 3-27).  
Cap  
qOpening and Closing the Liftgate  
Manually opening the liftgate  
WARNING  
Always fully open the liftgate when  
opening it:  
Raising the liftgate only partially is  
dangerous as it could drop  
unexpectedly resulting in injury.  
Pull up on the handle.  
3-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page112  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (112,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
2. (With power liftgate)  
Push the liftgate while pressing the lever  
down.  
WARNING  
Be sure to watch the power liftgate as  
it opens or closes, and make sure that  
it closes completely:  
(Without power liftgate)  
Turn the lever to the right to unlock the  
liftgate  
Opening or closing the power liftgate  
while not watching it move is  
dangerous. Because of unseen  
obstacles and the jam-safe feature, a  
liftgate may not close completely  
and, if left unnoticed, could result in  
serious injury or death if an occupant  
were to fall out of the vehicle.  
Always be sure that the area around  
the liftgate is clear before activating  
it.  
With power liftgate  
Lever  
Without power liftgate  
Always confirm the safety of the area  
around the power liftgate before  
operating it electrically.  
Lever  
Not checking the area around the  
liftgate for people before operating it  
using the power liftgate switch or the  
button on the keyless entry system is  
dangerous. A person could become  
caught between the liftgate and an  
obstruction while it is opening  
electrically or between the liftgate  
and vehicle while it is closing  
After performing this emergency measure,  
have the vehicle inspected at an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
Manually closing the liftgate  
Use both hands to push the liftgate down  
until the lock snaps shut. Do not slam it.  
Pull up on the liftgate to make sure it is  
securely latched.  
electrically, resulting in an accident  
and serious injury.  
qPower Liftgateí  
Always be sure the power liftgate  
completely closes before shifting into  
gear and driving the vehicle:  
The power liftgate opens/closes  
electrically by operating switches in the  
vehicle or the buttons on the keyless entry  
system transmitter.  
Refer to Keyless Entry System on page  
Shifting out of Park (P) while the  
liftgate is moving is dangerous. The  
liftgate will not close completely and  
this could result in serious injury or  
death if an occupant were to fall out  
of the vehicle. Occupants in the  
vehicle will also not have full  
protection in a collision.  
3-30  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page113  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (113,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Never allow children to operate the  
power liftgate system:  
NOTE  
l
Do not apply unnecessary force to the  
power liftgate when it is opening/closing  
electrically. Unnecessary force on the  
liftgate may cause it to reverse direction of  
movement automatically.  
Allowing children to operate the  
power liftgate switch and the keyless  
entry system is dangerous. Children  
are not aware of the dangers of  
people getting fingers and hands  
caught in a moving liftgate. If  
someone's neck, head or hands get  
caught in a closing door, it could  
result in death or serious injury.  
l
l
The power liftgate may not open/close  
electrically if the vehicle is parked on an  
incline, or there is strong wind, or the  
liftgate is laden with snow.  
The power liftgate will not operate unless it  
is unlocked. The power liftgate does not  
operate unless it is unlocked using the  
power door lock function.  
CAUTION  
Ø When closing the power liftgate,  
make sure there are no foreign  
objects around the striker. If  
foreign objects are obstructing the  
striker, the liftgate may not close  
properly.  
Refer to the Power Door Locks on page  
If a power liftgate system fuse has blown,  
the liftgate cannot be opened using the  
power liftgate switch or the outer handle  
(liftgate).  
l
l
l
Use the emergency lever to open the  
liftgate.  
Striker  
Fully close the power liftgate before  
disconnecting the vehicle battery. If the  
battery is disconnected with the liftgate  
open, it cannot be opened or closed  
automatically after the battery is  
reconnected.  
To restore the power liftgate functions,  
perform the following:  
1 Park on level ground.  
2 Fully close the liftgate manually.  
3 Unlock the liftgate and all the doors.  
4 Press the power liftgate switch or the  
power liftgate button on the keyless entry  
system transmitter to fully open the  
liftgate.  
5 Press the power liftgate switch or the  
power liftgate button on the keyless entry  
system transmitter again to fully close  
the liftgate.  
Ø Do not install accessories to the  
power liftgate other than specified  
accessories. Otherwise, it cannot  
be opened/closed automatically  
and could result in a malfunction.  
Ø Be careful when switching the  
power liftgate from electrical to  
manual operation. The power  
liftgate may open/close  
unexpectedly depending on its  
position which could result in  
injury.  
3-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page114  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (114,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Opening/Closing the power liftgate  
Operation from the driver's seat (To  
open/close)  
If the vehicle has satisfied all the  
following operation conditions, the power  
liftgate can be opened using the power  
function.  
Press the power liftgate switch for about  
one second or more while the liftgate is in  
the fully closed/open position. The hazard  
warning lights flash twice and the liftgate  
opens/closes fully after the beep sound is  
heard.  
Operation conditions  
(1) The power liftgate is unlocked.  
(2) The shift lever is in park (P) when the  
ignition switch is in the ON position.  
NOTE  
l
If condition (2) is not satisfied while the  
power liftgate is opening electrically, the  
beep sound will be heard and the liftgate  
will move in the reverse direction  
automatically.  
l
If condition (2) is not satisfied while the  
Power liftgate  
switch  
power liftgate is closing electrically, the  
beep sound will be heard and the liftgate  
continues closing.  
l
When condition (2) is satisfied, you can  
Operation from outside (To close only)  
resume power liftgate open/close operation  
with the switches.  
When the ignition switch is in the ON  
Press the power liftgate close switch for  
about one second or more while the  
liftgate is fully opened. The hazard  
warning lights flash twice and the liftgate  
closes automatically after the beep sound  
is heard.  
l
position, the transmitter does not operate.  
Operation using the transmitter  
Press the open/close button on the  
transmitter for one second or more with  
the power liftgate in the fully closed/open  
position. The hazard warning lights flash  
twice and the liftgate opens/closes after  
the beep sounds.  
Refer to Keyless Entry System on page  
Power liftgate  
close switch  
3-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page115  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (115,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
NOTE  
CAUTION  
If the power liftgate switch/power liftgate close  
switch/power liftgate button on the transmitter  
is pressed or the outside handle is operated  
while the liftgate is opening/closing  
electrically, the beep sound is heard and the  
liftgate moves in the reverse direction  
automatically. If this operation is repeated the  
system switches to manual operation.  
Sensors are installed on both ends of  
the power liftgate. Be careful not to  
allow the sensors to be scratched or  
damaged by sharp objects, otherwise  
the liftgate may no longer open/close  
automatically. In addition, if the  
sensor is damaged while the liftgate  
is closing automatically, the system  
changes to manual operation.  
Jam-safe equipment  
While the power liftgate is opening/  
closing electrically and the system detects  
a person or an object in the liftgate's path,  
the liftgate will move in the reverse  
direction automatically.  
Sensor  
WARNING  
Always check the area around the  
power liftgate before opening/closing  
it:  
Not checking for occupants and  
objects around the power liftgate  
before opening/closing it is  
NOTE  
dangerous. The jam-safe equipment  
is designed to prevent jamming in the  
event an obstruction is in the  
liftgate's path. The system may not  
detect certain objects obstructing the  
liftgate depending on the way they  
are positioned and their shape.  
However, if the jam-safe function  
detects an obstruction and moves the  
liftgate in the reverse direction, an  
occupant in the liftgate's path could  
be seriously injured.  
l
The liftgate has sensors on both sides. Be  
careful not to damage them. If the sensors  
are damaged, the power liftgate will not  
function properly.  
l
The jam-safe equipment does not activate  
during easy closure operation when the  
power liftgate is between the door-ajar  
position and fully closed position.  
When the power liftgate is moving in the  
open/close direction and an obstruction is  
detected, the beep sound will be heard and  
the liftgate moves in the opposite  
direction.  
3-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page116  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (116,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
NOTE  
NOTE  
l
If the system repeatedly detects an object  
obstructing the power liftgate in the open/close  
direction several times, the beep sound will be  
heard and the system changes to manual  
operation.  
If the liftgate handle is pulled while the  
easy closure function is operating, the  
liftgate can be opened.  
l
If the liftgate is opened/closed repeatedly in  
a short period of time, the easy closure  
function may not operate. Wait for a while  
and then try again.  
Power liftgate drop prevention  
mechanism  
The power liftgate drop prevention  
mechanism activates if the system detects  
weight such as that caused by a snow-  
laden liftgate when it is opened  
electrically. After the liftgate is fully  
opened, the beep sound will be heard and  
the liftgate closes automatically.  
NOTE  
l
If the power liftgate is snow-laden, remove  
the snow before operating the liftgate.  
l
Trying to force the power liftgate closed  
manually immediately after it has fully  
opened automatically may activate the  
liftgate drop prevention mechanism.  
However, this does not indicate a  
malfunction.  
Liftgate easy closure  
The Easy Closure system automatically  
closes the liftgate completely from the  
near-shut position.  
This system also operates when the  
liftgate is closed manually.  
WARNING  
When closing a liftgate, always keep  
hands and fingers away from the  
liftgate:  
Placing hands or fingers around a  
liftgate is dangerous because the  
liftgate closes automatically from the  
near-shut position, which could  
cause hands and fingers to be  
pinched and injured.  
3-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page117  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (117,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
q
Operating the Front Power Windows  
Power Windows  
NOTE  
l
The ignition switch must be in the ON  
position for the power windows to  
operate.  
Each passenger power window can be  
operated with each door switch when the  
power window lock switch on the driver's  
door is in the unlocked position (page  
WARNING  
Make sure the opening is clear before  
closing a window:  
l
Each passenger power window can also be  
operated by the power window master  
control switches on the driver's door.  
Closing power windows are  
dangerous. A person's hands, head,  
or even neck could be caught by the  
window and result in serious injury  
or even death.  
Owner master control switch  
Driver's window  
This warning applies especially to  
children.  
Left rear  
window  
Always lock all passenger power  
windows with the power window lock  
switch on the driver's side while  
children are in the vehicle, and never  
allow children to play with power  
window switches:  
Front passenger's  
window  
Right rear window  
l
Leaving the power window switches  
unlocked while children are in the  
vehicle is dangerous. Power window  
switches that are not locked with the  
power window lock switch would  
allow children to operate power  
windows unintentionally which could  
result in serious injury if a child's  
hands, head or neck becomes caught  
by the window.  
The following functions can be performed  
for the front power windows using the  
power window master control switches on  
the driver's door or front passenger's door  
switch.  
l
Manual opening/closing  
Auto-opening/closing  
Two-step down function  
l
l
3-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page118  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (118,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Manual opening/closing  
NOTE  
(POWER WINDOW INITIALIZATION  
PROCEDURE)  
To open a power window to the desired  
position, lightly hold down the switch.  
To close the power window to the desired  
position, lightly pull up the switch.  
If the battery was disconnected during vehicle  
maintenance, or for other reasons such as a  
switch continues to be operated after the  
window is fully open/close, the power windows  
will not fully open and close automatically. Re-  
initialization of the automatic function can be  
performed using the master control switches  
and the front passenger door switch. Carry out  
the following procedure to resume operation:  
Owner master control switch  
Open  
Close  
Driver's window  
Front passenger's  
window  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.  
2. Make sure that the power window lock  
switch located on the driver's door is not  
depressed.  
3. Press the switch and fully open the power  
window.  
Front passenger switch  
4. Pull up the switch to fully close the power  
window and continue holding the switch for  
about 2 seconds after the window fully  
closed.  
Close  
Open  
5. Repeat Steps 3-4 for each front power  
window.  
6. Make sure that the power windows operate  
correctly using the door switches.  
Auto-opening/closing  
Two-step down function  
To fully open a power window  
automatically, press the switch completely  
down.  
To fully close the power window  
automatically, pull the switch completely  
up.  
With the power window completely  
closed, press the switch lightly and it will  
open and stop about 3 cm (1 in) from the  
top.  
If you continue to press and hold the  
switch, the window will resume opening  
all the way.  
To stop the power window partway, pull  
or press the switch in the opposite  
direction and then release it.  
NOTE  
Pressing the power window switch once when  
the window is fully closed will only open it  
about 3 cm (1 in) to allow convenient  
ventilation of the cabin.  
3-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page119  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (119,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Canceling the two-step down function  
NOTE  
l
The two-step down function cannot be  
canceled if the procedure is not completed  
within the specified times, or the procedure  
is changed along the way. To redo the  
procedure, first turn the ignition switch to  
the LOCK position and proceed from the  
beginning.  
If you are unable to cancel the function  
despite carrying out the cancellation  
procedure, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
To cancel the two-step down function for  
the front power windows, carry out the  
following procedure using the master  
control switches.  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON  
position and complete the following  
procedure within 5 seconds:  
l
Press the power window switch 2 times  
firmly, then pull it 2 times firmly.  
Owner master control switch  
Restoring the two-step down function  
With the two-step down function in the  
canceled state, repeat the previous  
procedure for canceling the function on  
each door switch and it will be restored.  
NOTE  
Driver's window  
Front passenger's  
If you are unable to restore the function despite  
doing the restore procedure, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
window  
2. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK  
position.  
Jam-safe window  
If a person's hands, head or an object  
blocks the window during the manual  
closing operation or the auto-closing  
operation, the window will stop and open  
halfway.  
3. With the ignition switch in the LOCK  
position, and within 40 seconds, turn  
the ignition switch to the ON position  
and complete the following procedure  
within 5 seconds:  
WARNING  
Press the power window switch 2 times  
firmly, then pull 2 times firmly.  
Make sure nothing blocks the window  
just before it reaches the fully closed  
position or while fully holding up the  
power window switch:  
Blocking the power window just  
before it reaches the fully closed  
position or while fully holding up the  
power window switch is dangerous.  
In this case, the jam-safe function  
cannot prevent the window from  
stopping. If fingers are caught,  
serious injuries could occur.  
3-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page120  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (120,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
NOTE  
q
Operating the Rear Power Windows  
l
Depending on driving conditions, a closing  
The power windows may be operated  
when the power window lock switch on  
the driver's door is in the unlocked  
position.  
power window could stop and start opening  
when the window feels a shock that is  
similar to something blocking it.  
In the event the jam-safe function activates  
and the power window cannot be closed  
automatically, pull and hold the switch fully  
and the window will close.  
A rear power windows may be opened or  
closed using the power window master  
control switches on the driver's door.  
l
The jam-safe window function does not  
operate until the system is re-initialized.  
Engine-off power window operation  
The power window can be operated for  
about 40 seconds after the ignition switch  
is turned from the ON position to the  
ACC or LOCK position with all doors  
closed. If any door is opened, the power  
window will be inoperable.  
Left rear  
window  
Right rear window  
Power window lock  
switch  
NOTE  
l
For engine-off operation of the power  
window, the switch must be held up firmly  
throughout window closure because the  
auto-closing function will be inoperable.  
The two-step down function is inoperable  
during engine-off operation.  
To open the power window to the desired  
position, hold down the switch.  
To close the power window to the desired  
position, pull up the switch.  
l
Close  
Open  
3-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page121  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (121,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Engine-off power window operation  
NOTE  
When the power window lock switch is in the  
locked position, the light on each power  
window switch, except for the driver's power  
window switch, turns off. The light may be  
difficult to see depending on the surrounding  
brightness.  
The power windows can be operated for  
about 40 seconds after the ignition switch  
is turned from the ON position to the  
ACC or LOCK position with all doors  
closed. If any door is opened, the power  
windows will be inoperable.  
qOpening/Closing the Power  
qPower Window Lock Switch  
Windows from Outside  
With the lock switch in the unlocked  
position, all power windows on each door  
can be operated.  
The front power windows can be opened  
or closed from outside the vehicle after  
the doors and the liftgate are closed.  
The front power windows may be  
operated when the power window lock  
switch on the driver's door is in the lock  
or unlocked position.  
With the lock switch in the locked  
position, only the driver's side power  
window can be operated.  
Locked position  
WARNING  
Make sure the opening is clear before  
closing a window:  
Closing power windows are  
dangerous. A person's hands, head,  
or even neck could be caught by the  
window and result in serious injury  
or even death.  
Unlocked position  
This warning applies especially to  
children.  
NOTE  
WARNING  
The power windows cannot be opened or  
closed from outside the vehicle under the  
following condition:  
Unless a passenger needs to operate a  
power window, keep the power window  
lock switch in the locked position:  
Unintentional power window  
l
A door or the liftgate is opened.  
l
The key is inserted into the ignition switch.  
operation is dangerous. A person's  
hands, head, or neck could be caught  
by the window and result in serious  
injury.  
l
(With advanced key)  
The start knob is in any position except  
LOCK.  
3-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page122  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (122,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Opening  
Advanced key  
Because nobody likes getting into a very  
hot car, Mazda has introduced a way to  
open the two front windows and the  
moonroof as you approach the vehicle to  
get the air moving before you get in.  
Panic button  
Lock button  
Unlock button  
WARNING  
Use the auto-window function only  
when you can see the vehicle and it is  
in a secure area:  
Liftgate button  
Do not let children play with your  
keys. If they open the window  
without your knowing, the open  
windows are an even bigger  
invitation to a thief than leaving the  
doors unlocked.  
Retractable type key  
Lock button  
Unlock button  
The windows can be opened for  
ventilating the cabin before getting in the  
vehicle.  
With unlock button (Keyless entry  
system)  
Press once, then press again within 1.5  
seconds and hold.  
Panic button  
After the doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked, the two front windows and the  
moonroof open while the unlock button is  
pressed.  
To stop the windows and the moonroof  
while opening, release the button.  
If the operation is performed from the  
beginning again, the windows and the  
moonroof open.  
NOTE  
l
The unlock button does not operate unless  
it is pressed twice sequentially.  
The lock button cannot be used to close the  
power windows.  
l
With key  
1. Insert the key in the driver's door key  
cylinder.  
3-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page123  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (123,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
2. Turn the key toward the front and hold  
it. After the doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked, the windows fully open  
automatically.  
2. Turn the key toward the back and hold  
it. After the doors and the liftgate are  
locked, the windows close as long as  
the key is turned.  
Open  
Close  
To stop this operation, turn the key to the  
center position, then turn it toward the  
front again.  
With request switch on the driver's  
door (Advanced key)  
1. If the doors and the liftgate are locked,  
unlock them.  
NOTE  
The window opening operation also can be  
stopped by turning the key toward the back.  
However, the doors and the liftgate will lock.  
2. Press and hold the request switch on  
the driver's door. After the doors and  
the liftgate are locked, the windows  
close as long as the request switch is  
pressed.  
Closing  
The windows can be closed in case they  
are left open after getting out of the  
vehicle.  
NOTE  
(With advanced key)  
If the auto-lock function (page 3-8) has been  
activated, the doors and the liftgate  
automatically lock as you walk away from the  
vehicle, however, the power windows cannot  
be closed. When leaving the vehicle, close the  
windows using the power window switch  
inside the vehicle, the key, or a request switch.  
Request switch  
With key  
1. Insert the key in the driver's door key  
cylinder.  
3-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page124  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (124,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
qFuel-Filler Lid  
Fuel-Filler Lid and Cap  
To open, pull the remote fuel-filler lid  
release.  
WARNING  
When removing the fuel cap, loosen the  
cap slightly and wait for any hissing to  
stop. Then remove it:  
Fuel spray is dangerous. Fuel can  
burn skin and eyes and cause illness  
if ingested. Fuel spray is released  
when there is pressure in the fuel  
tank and the fuel cap is removed too  
quickly.  
Remote fuel-filler  
lid release  
Before refueling, stop the engine, and  
always keep sparks and flames away  
from the filler neck:  
Fuel vapor is dangerous. It could be  
ignited by sparks or flames causing  
serious burns and injuries.  
Additionally, use of the incorrect fuel  
filler cap or not using a fuel filler cap  
may result in fuel leak, which could  
result in serious burns or death in an  
accident.  
qFuel-Filler Cap  
To remove the filler cap, turn it  
counterclockwise.  
To close the filler cap, turn it clockwise  
until two or more clicks are heard.  
CAUTION  
Open  
Always use only a genuine Mazda  
fuel cap or an approved equivalent,  
available at an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer. The wrong cap can result in a  
serious malfunction of the fuel and  
emission control systems. It may also  
cause the check engine light in the  
instrument cluster to illuminate.  
Close  
3-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page125  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (125,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Hood  
CAUTION  
Make sure the fuel-filler cap is  
tightened securely. The check fuel cap  
warning light may illuminate if the  
cap is not tightened securely. If the  
light remains on even after you have  
tightened the cap securely, this may  
indicate a different problem. Contact  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon  
as possible.  
WARNING  
Always check that the hood is closed  
and securely locked:  
A hood that is not closed and  
securely locked is dangerous as it  
could fly open while the vehicle is  
moving and block the driver's vision  
which could result in a serious  
accident.  
qOpening the Hood  
1. With the vehicle parked, pull the  
release handle to unlock the hood.  
Release handle  
2. Slide the hood latch to the right and lift  
the hood.  
3-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page126  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (126,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
3. Grasp the support rod in the padded  
area and secure it in the stay hole  
indicated by the arrow to hold the hood  
open.  
Moonroofí  
The moonroof can be opened or closed  
electrically only when the ignition switch  
is in the ON position.  
Slide switch  
Tilt switch  
Pad  
Clip  
Support rod  
qClosing the Hood  
WARNING  
1. Check under the hood area to make  
certain all filler caps are in place and  
all loose items (e.g. tools, oil  
Do not let passengers stand up or  
extend part of the body through the  
open moonroof while the vehicle is  
moving:  
containers, etc.) have been removed.  
2. Insert the support rod in its clip while  
holding up the hood. Verify that the  
support rod is secured in the clip before  
closing the hood.  
Extending the head, arms, or other  
parts of the body through the  
moonroof is dangerous. The head or  
arms could hit something while the  
vehicle is moving. This could cause  
serious injury or death.  
3. Close the hood so that it locks securely.  
Make sure the opening is clear before  
closing the moonroof:  
A closing moonroof is dangerous. The  
hands, head, or even neck of a  
person especially a childcould  
be caught in it as it closes, causing  
serious injury or even death.  
NOTE  
After washing your Mazda or after it rains,  
wipe the water off the moonroof before  
operating it to avoid water penetration which  
could cause rust and water damage to your  
headliner.  
3-44  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page127  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (127,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
To stop sliding partway, push any part of  
the tilt or slide switch.  
qOperating the Moonroof  
Tilt Operation  
The rear of the moonroof can be tilted  
open to provide more ventilation.  
Open  
To fully tilt automatically, momentarily  
push the tilt switch.  
To fully close automatically, momentarily  
pull the tilt switch or push the front of the  
slide switch.  
Tilt down  
(Close)  
Close  
To stop tilting partway, push any part of  
the tilt or slide switch.  
Power moonroof initialization  
procedure  
If the battery had been disconnected  
during vehicle maintenance or for other  
reasons, the moonroof may not fully open  
or close. The moonroof's jam-safe  
function does not function while the  
moonroof is initializing. Carry out the  
following procedure to resume operation:  
Tilt down  
Close  
(Tilt down)  
Tilt up  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON  
position.  
Slide Operation  
2. Pull the tilt switch, to partially tilt open  
the rear of the moonroof.  
To fully open automatically, momentarily  
push the rear of the slide switch.  
To fully close automatically, momentarily  
push the front of the slide switch or pull  
the tilt switch.  
NOTE  
If the re-initialization procedure is performed  
while the moonroof is in the slide position  
(partially open) it closes before the rear tilts  
opens.  
3. Repeat the procedure in Step 2. The  
rear of the moonroof tilts open to the  
fully open position, then closes a little.  
3-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page128  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (128,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
qEngine-off Moonroof Operation  
WARNING  
Use the auto-moonroof function only  
when you can see the vehicle and it is  
in a secure area:  
The moonroof can be operated for about  
40 seconds after the ignition switch is  
turned from the ON position to the ACC  
or LOCK position with all doors closed. If  
any door is opened, the moonroof will be  
inoperable.  
Do not let children play with your  
keys. If they open the moonroof  
without your knowing, the open  
moonroof is an even bigger invitation  
to a thief than leaving the doors  
unlocked.  
qOpening/Closing the Moonroof  
from Outside  
The moonroof can be opened or closed  
from outside the vehicle after the doors  
and the liftgate are closed.  
The moonroof can be opened for  
ventilating the cabin before getting in the  
vehicle.  
With unlock button (Keyless entry  
system)  
WARNING  
Make sure the opening is clear before  
closing the moonroof:  
Press the unlock button twice within 1.5  
seconds and then hold the button pressed.  
After the doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked, the two front windows and the  
moonroof open as long as the unlock  
button is pressed.  
Closing the moonroof is dangerous. A  
person's hands, head, or even neck  
could be caught by the moonroof and  
result in serious injury or even death.  
This warning applies especially to  
children and pets.  
Advanced key  
NOTE  
Lock button  
Panic button  
The moonroof cannot be opened or closed  
from outside the vehicle under the following  
condition:  
l
A door or the liftgate is opened.  
Unlock button  
Power liftgate  
button  
l
The key is inserted into the ignition switch.  
(With advanced key)  
l
The start knob is pushed into the ignition  
switch.  
Opening  
Because nobody likes getting into a very  
hot car, Mazda has introduced a way to  
open the two front windows and the  
moonroof as you approach the vehicle to  
get the air moving before you get in.  
3-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page129  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (129,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Retractable type key  
2. Turn the key toward the front and hold  
it. After the doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked, the moonroof fully opens  
automatically.  
Lock button  
Unlock button  
Open  
Panic button  
To stop the windows and the moonroof  
from opening, release the button.  
If the operation is performed from the  
beginning again, the windows and the  
moonroof open.  
To stop this operation, turn the key to the  
center position, then turn it toward the  
front again.  
NOTE  
l
The unlock button does not operate unless  
NOTE  
it is pressed twice sequentially.  
The lock button cannot be used to close the  
moonroof.  
The moonroof opening operation also can be  
stopped by turning the key toward the back.  
However, the doors and the liftgate will lock.  
l
With key  
Closing  
The moonroof can be closed in case it is  
left open after getting out of the vehicle.  
1. Insert the key in the driver's door key  
cylinder.  
NOTE  
(With advanced key)  
If the auto-lock function (page 3-8) has been  
activated, the doors and the liftgate  
automatically lock as you walk away from the  
vehicle, however, for safety reasons, the  
moonroof cannot be closed. When leaving the  
vehicle, close the moonroof using the tilt or  
slide switch inside the vehicle, the key, or a  
request switch.  
With key  
1. Insert the key in the driver's door key  
cylinder.  
3-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page130  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (130,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
2. Turn the key toward the back and hold  
it. After the doors and the liftgate are  
locked, the moonroof closes as long as  
the key is turned.  
qJam-safe Moonroof  
If a person's hands, head or an object  
blocks the moonroof during closing  
operation, the moonroof will stop and  
open halfway.  
WARNING  
Make sure nothing blocks the  
moonroof just before it reaches the  
fully closed position:  
Blocking the moonroof just before it  
reaches the closed position is  
dangerous.  
Close  
In this case, the jam-safe function  
cannot prevent the moonroof from  
stopping. If fingers are caught,  
serious injuries could occur.  
With request switch on the driver's  
door (Advanced key)  
NOTE  
1. If the doors and the liftgate are locked,  
unlock them.  
l
Depending on driving conditions, a closing  
moonroof could stop and start opening  
when the moonroof feels a shock that is  
similar to something blocking it.  
2. Press the request switch on the driver's  
door and hold it. After the doors and  
the liftgate are locked, the moonroof  
closes as long as the request switch is  
pressed.  
l
The moonroof's jam-safe function does not  
function while the moonroof is initializing.  
Request switch  
3-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page131  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (131,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
qSunshade  
The sunshade can be opened and closed  
by hand.  
The sunshade opens automatically when  
the moonroof is opened, but must be  
closed by hand.  
Sunshade  
CAUTION  
Ø The sunshade does not tilt. To  
avoid damaging the sunshade, do  
not push up on it.  
Ø Do not close the sunshade while  
the moonroof is opening. Trying to  
force the sunshade closed could  
damage it.  
3-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page132  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (132,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
Immobilizer System (with  
Advanced Key)  
CAUTION  
Do not allow the following when  
starting the engine with the auxiliary  
key due to an advanced key dead  
battery or other malfunction.  
Otherwise the signal from the  
auxiliary key will not be received  
correctly and the engine may not  
start.  
The immobilizer system allows the engine  
to start only with an advanced key the  
system recognizes.  
If someone attempts to start the engine  
with an unrecognized key, the engine will  
not start, thereby helping to prevent the  
theft of your vehicle.  
Ø Metal parts of other keys or metal  
objects touch the key grip.  
Ø Spare auxiliary keys or keys for  
other vehicles equipped with an  
immobilizer system touch or come  
near the auxiliary key.  
Ø Equipment containing electronic  
components or cards with  
CAUTION  
Ø Radio equipment like this is  
governed by laws in the United  
States.  
Changes or modifications not  
expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could  
void the user's authority to  
operate the equipment.  
Ø To avoid damage to the key, do  
not:  
magnetic strips such as credit  
cards come near the auxiliary key.  
NOTE  
l
(U.S.A.)  
This device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause harmful interference, and (2)  
this device must accept any interference  
received, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation.  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Drop the key.  
Get the key wet.  
Expose the key to any kind of  
magnetic field.  
Expose the key to high  
temperatures on places such as  
the dashboard or hood, under  
direct sunlight.  
Ø
l
(CANADA)  
This device complies with RSS-210 of  
Industry CANADA. Operation is subject to  
the following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause interference, and (2) this  
device must accept any interference,  
including interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the device.  
3-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page133  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (133,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
NOTE  
l
qOperation  
The engine may not start and the security  
indicator light may illuminate or flash if the  
advanced key is placed in an area where it  
is difficult for the system to detect the  
signal, such as on the dashboard, or in the  
glove box. Move the advanced key to  
another place, turn the ignition switch to  
the LOCK position, and then restart the  
engine.  
Arming  
The system is armed when the ignition  
switch is turned from the ON position to  
the ACC or LOCK position. The security  
indicator light in the instrument cluster  
flashes every 2 seconds until the system is  
disarmed.  
l
Signals from a TVor radio station, or from  
a transceiver or a mobile telephone could  
interfere with your immobilizer system. If  
you are using the proper advanced key and  
the engine fails to start, check the security  
indicator light. If the indicator light is  
flashing, turn the ignition switch to the  
ACC or LOCK position and wait for a  
while, then restart the engine. If it doesn't  
start after 3 or more tries, contact an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Disarming  
The system is disarmed when the ignition  
switch is turned to the ON position with  
the registered advanced key.  
The security indicator light illuminates for  
about 3 seconds and goes out.  
l
If the security indicator light flashes  
continuously while you are driving, don't  
shut off the engine. Go to an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer and have it checked. If the  
engine is shut off while the indicator light is  
flashing, you won't be able to restart it.  
Since the electronic codes are reset when  
repairing the immobilizer system, the  
advanced key (including auxiliary key) are  
needed. Bring all the advanced keys  
(including auxiliary keys) to an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
If the engine doesn't start with the correct  
ignition key, and the security indicator  
light keeps illuminating or flashing, the  
system may have a malfunction. Consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
l
3-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page134  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (134,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
qMaintenance  
Immobilizer System  
If you have a problem with the  
immobilizer system or the key, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
(without Advanced Key)  
The immobilizer system allows the engine  
to start only with a key the system  
recognizes.  
NOTE  
l
The advanced keys (including auxiliary key)  
carry a unique electronic code. For this  
reason, and to assure your safety, obtaining  
a replacement advanced key (including  
auxiliary key) requires some waiting time.  
They are only available through an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
If someone attempts to start the engine  
with an unrecognized key, the engine will  
not start, thereby helping to prevent the  
theft of your vehicle.  
CAUTION  
l
Always keep a spare advanced key in case  
one is lost. If an advanced key is lost,  
consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer as  
soon as possible.  
Ø Radio equipment like this is  
governed by laws in the United  
States.  
Changes or modifications not  
expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could  
void the user's authority to  
operate the equipment.  
Ø To avoid damage to the key, do  
not:  
l
If you lose an advanced key (including  
auxiliary key), an Authorized Mazda Dealer  
will reset the electronic codes of your  
remaining advanced keys (including  
auxiliary keys) and immobilizer system.  
Bring all the remaining advanced keys  
(including auxiliary keys) to an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer to reset.  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Drop the key.  
Starting the vehicle with a key that has not  
been reset is not possible.  
Get the key wet.  
Expose the key to any kind of  
magnetic field.  
Expose the key to high  
temperatures on places such as  
the dashboard or hood, under  
direct sunlight.  
Ø
qModification and Add-On  
Equipment  
Mazda cannot guarantee the immobilizer  
system's operation if the system has been  
modified or if any add-on equipment has  
been installed to it.  
CAUTION  
To avoid damage to your vehicle, do  
not modify the system or install any  
add-on equipment to the immobilizer  
system or the vehicle.  
3-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page135  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (135,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
NOTE  
CAUTION  
l
(U.S.A.)  
This device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause harmful interference, and (2)  
this device must accept any interference  
received, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation.  
When starting the engine do not  
allow the following, as the engine  
may not start due to the electronic  
signal from the ignition key not being  
transmitted correctly.  
Ø A key ring rests on the key grip.  
l
(CANADA)  
This device complies with RSS-210 of  
Industry CANADA. Operation is subject to  
the following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause interference, and (2) this  
device must accept any interference,  
including interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the device.  
Ø Metal parts of other keys or metal  
objects touch the key grip.  
qOperation  
Arming  
The system is armed when the ignition  
switch is turned from the ON to the ACC  
position.  
The security indicator light in the  
instrument panel flashes every 2 seconds  
until the system is disarmed.  
Ø Spare keys or keys for other  
vehicles equipped with an  
immobilizer system touch or come  
near the key grip.  
Disarming  
The system is disarmed when the ignition  
switch is turned to the ON position with  
the correct ignition key.  
The security indicator light illuminates for  
about 3 seconds and goes out.  
Ø Devices for electronic purchases, or  
security passage touch or come  
near the key.  
3-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page136  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (136,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
If the engine doesn't start with the correct  
ignition key, and the security indicator  
light keeps illuminating or flashing, the  
system may have a malfunction. Consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
qMaintenance  
If you have a problem with the  
immobilizer system or the key, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
NOTE  
NOTE  
l
The keys carry a unique electronic code.  
l
If the security indicator light comes on and  
stays on when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position, the engine will not start.  
For this reason, and to assure your safety,  
obtaining replacement key requires some  
waiting time. They are only available  
through an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
l
Signals from a TVor radio station, or from  
a transceiver or a mobile telephone, could  
interfere with your immobilizer system. If  
you are using the proper key and your  
engine fails to start, check the security  
indicator light. If it is flashing, remove the  
ignition key and wait 2 seconds or more,  
then reinsert it and try starting the engine  
again. If it doesn't start after 3 or more  
tries, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
l
Always keep a spare key, in case one is lost.  
If a key is lost, contact an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
l
If you lose a key, an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer will reset the electronic codes of  
your remaining keys and immobilizer  
system. Bring all the remaining keys to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer to reset.  
Starting the vehicle with a key that has not  
been reset is not possible.  
l
If the security indicator light flashes  
continuously while you are driving, don't  
shut off the engine. Go to an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer and have it checked. If you  
shut off the engine while the light is  
qModification and Add-On  
Equipment  
flashing you won't be able to restart it.  
Since the electronic codes are reset when  
repairing the immobilizer system, the keys  
are needed. Bring all the existing keys to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Mazda cannot guarantee the immobilizer  
system's operation if the system has been  
modified or if any add-on equipment has  
been installed to it.  
l
CAUTION  
To avoid damage to your vehicle, do  
not modify the system or install any  
add-on equipment to the immobilizer  
system or the vehicle.  
3-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page137  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (137,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
qHow to Arm the System  
Theft-Deterrent Systemí  
1. Remove the key from the ignition  
switch.  
The theft-deterrent system is designed to  
prevent your vehicle or its contents from  
being stolen when all doors, hood, and  
liftgate are locked.  
If forcible entry is attempted, the system  
sounds the horn and flashes the hazard  
warning lights.  
(With advanced key)  
Turn the start knob to the LOCK  
position.  
2. Make sure the hood is closed. Close  
and lock all doors and the liftgate from  
the outside using the key. If you have  
the keyless entry system, press the lock  
button on the transmitter.  
NOTE  
l
The theft-deterrent system operates with the  
advanced keyless function, keyless entry  
system or the auxiliary key.  
The system operates only when the driver is  
in the vehicle or within operational range  
while the advanced key is being carried.  
(With advanced key)  
Press a request switch or the lock  
button on the transmitter.  
The hazard warning lights will flash  
once to indicate that the system is  
armed.  
l
The system will not function unless it is  
properly armed. To properly secure the  
vehicle, always make sure all windows are  
completely closed and all doors and the  
liftgate are locked before leaving the  
vehicle. Remember to take your advanced  
key.  
(Without advanced key)  
The following method will also arm the  
theft-deterrent system:  
Close the hood and the liftgate . Press  
the area on the door-lock switch  
marked “ ” once. Close all doors.  
qOperation  
qTo Turn off an Armed System  
What turns it on:  
l
Forcing open a door, the hood or the  
liftgate.  
Opening a door or the hood by  
operating an inside door-lock knob or  
the hood release handle.  
An armed system can be turned off by any  
one of the following methods:  
l
l
Unlock a door with the key.  
Press the unlock button on the keyless  
l
entry system transmitter.  
Insert the key into the ignition switch  
l
What it does:  
and turn it to the ON position.  
l
The horn sounds intermittently and the  
hazard warning lights flash.  
The alarm continues for about 30  
seconds, then stops.  
l
(With advanced key)  
l
Press a request switch or the unlock  
l
button on the transmitter.  
Turn the start knob to the ON  
l
If the system is triggered again, the lights  
and horn will activate until a door or the  
liftgate is unlocked with the key or with  
the transmitter.  
position.  
The hazard warning lights will flash twice  
to indicate that the system is turned off.  
íSome models.  
3-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page138  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (138,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
qTo Stop an Alarm  
A triggered alarm can be turned off by  
any one of the following methods:  
l
Unlock a door or the liftgate with the  
key.  
l
Press the unlock button on the keyless  
entry system transmitter.  
l
(With advanced key)  
l
Press a request switch.  
Press the unlock button on the  
l
transmitter.  
NOTE  
If you have any problem with the theft-  
deterrent system, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
qTheft-Deterrent Labels  
A label indicating that your vehicle is  
equipped with a Theft-Deterrent System is  
in the glove box.  
Mazda recommends that you affix it to the  
lower rear corner of a front door window.  
3-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page139  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (139,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Steering Wheel and Mirrors  
Steering Wheel  
Mirrors  
qOutside Mirrors  
WARNING  
Never adjust the steering wheel while  
the vehicle is moving:  
Check the mirror angles before driving.  
Mirror type  
Adjusting the steering wheel while  
the vehicle is moving is dangerous.  
Moving it can very easily cause the  
driver to abruptly turn to the left or  
right. This can lead to loss of control  
or an accident.  
Flat type (driver's side)  
Flat surface mirror.  
Convex type (front passenger side)  
The mirror has single curvature on its  
surface.  
WARNING  
qSteering Wheel Adjustment  
Be sure to look over your shoulder  
before changing lanes:  
To change the angle or length of the  
steering wheel:  
Changing lanes without taking into  
account the actual distance of the  
vehicle in the convex mirror is  
dangerous. You could have a serious  
accident. What you see in the convex  
mirror is closer than it appears.  
1. Stop the vehicle, pull down the lock  
release lever under the steering  
column.  
Tilt wheel release  
lever  
Power mirror  
The ignition switch must be in the ACC  
or ON position.  
To adjust:  
1. Press the left or right side of the  
selector switch to choose the left or  
right side mirror.  
2. Tilt the steering wheel and/or adjust the  
steering column length to the desired  
positions, push the lever up to lock the  
column.  
3. Push the wheel up and down to be  
certain it's locked before driving.  
3-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page140  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (140,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Steering Wheel and Mirrors  
2. Depress the mirror switch in the  
appropriate direction.  
Mirror defrosterí  
To turn on the mirror defrosters, turn the  
ignition switch to the ON position and  
push the rear window defroster switch  
(page 5-61).  
Selector switch  
Mirror switch  
Outside mirror  
qRearview Mirror  
Rearview mirror adjustment  
Before driving, adjust the rearview mirror  
to center on the scene through the rear  
window.  
After adjusting the mirror, lock the control  
by placing the selector switch in the  
middle position.  
Folding the mirror  
Fold the outside mirror rearward until it is  
flush with the vehicle.  
Reducing glare from headlights  
Adjust the mirror with the day/night lever  
in the day position.  
Push the lever forward for day driving.  
Pull it back to reduce glare from  
headlights.  
Day/Night lever  
WARNING  
Always return the outside mirrors to  
the driving position before you start  
driving:  
Driving with the outside mirrors  
folded in is dangerous. Your rear view  
will be restricted, and you could have  
an accident.  
Day  
Night  
3-58  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page141  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (141,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Steering Wheel and Mirrors  
WARNING  
Do not stack cargo or objects higher  
than the seatbacks:  
Cargo stacked higher than the  
seatbacks is dangerous. It can block  
your view in the rearview mirror,  
which might cause you to hit another  
car when changing lanes.  
3-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page142  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (142,1)  
3-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page143  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (143,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
4
Important information about driving your Mazda.  
4-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page144  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (144,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Fuel and Engine Exhaust Precautions  
Fuel Requirements  
Vehicles with catalytic converters or oxygen sensors must use ONLY UNLEADED FUEL,  
which will reduce exhaust emissions and keep spark plug fouling to a minimum.  
Fuel with a lower rating could cause the emission control system to lose effectiveness. It  
could also cause engine knocking and serious engine damage.  
Your Mazda will perform best with fuel listed in the table.  
Fuel  
Octane Rating*(Anti-knock index)  
Regular unleaded fuel  
87 [ (R+M)/2 method] or above (91 RON or above)  
* U.S. federal law requires that octane ratings be posted on gasoline station pumps.  
Fuel with a rating lower than 87 octane (91 RON) could cause the emission control system  
to lose effectiveness. It could also cause engine knocking and serious engine damage.  
CAUTION  
Ø USE ONLY UNLEADED FUEL.  
Leaded fuel is harmful to the catalytic converter and oxygen sensors and will lead  
to deterioration of the emission control system and or failures.  
Ø Your vehicle can only use oxygenated fuels containing no more than 10% ethanol  
by volume. Damage to your vehicle may occur when ethanol exceeds this  
recommendation, or if the gasoline contains any methanol. Stop using gasohol of  
any kind if your vehicle engine is performing poorly.  
Ø Never add fuel system additives. Never add cleaning agents other than those  
specified by Mazda. Other cleaning agents and additives may damage the system.  
Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Gasoline blended with oxygenates such as alcohol or ether compounds are generally  
referred to as oxygenated fuels. The common gasoline blend that can be used with your  
vehicle is ethanol blended at no more than 10%. Gasoline containing alcohol, such as  
ethanol or methanol, may be marketed under the name Gasohol.  
Vehicle damage and drivability problems resulting from the use of the following may not  
be covered by the Mazda warranty.  
l
Gasohol containing more than 10% ethanol.  
Gasoline or gasohol containing methanol.  
Leaded fuel or leaded gasohol.  
l
l
4-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page145  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (145,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Fuel and Engine Exhaust Precautions  
Emission Control System  
Your vehicle is equipped with an emission control system (the catalytic converter is part of  
this system) that enables your vehicle to comply with existing exhaust emissions  
requirements.  
WARNING  
Never park over or near anything flammable:  
Parking over or near anything flammable, such as dry grass, is dangerous. Even with  
the engine turned off, the exhaust system remains very hot after normal use and  
could ignite anything flammable. A resulting fire could cause serious injury or death.  
CAUTION  
Ignoring the following precautions could cause lead to accumulate on the catalyst  
inside the converter or cause the converter to get very hot. Either condition will  
damage the converter and cause poor performance.  
Ø USE ONLY UNLEADED FUEL.  
Ø Don't drive your Mazda with any sign of engine malfunction.  
Ø Don't coast with the ignition switch turned off.  
Ø Don't descend steep grades in gear with the ignition switch turned off.  
Ø Don't operate the engine at high idle for more than 5 minutes.  
Ø Don't tamper with the emission control system. All inspections and adjustments  
must be made by a qualified technician.  
Ø Don't push-start or pull-start your vehicle.  
NOTE  
Under U.S. federal law, any modification to the original-equipment emission control system before  
the first sale and registration of a vehicle is subject to penalties. In some states, such modification  
made on a used vehicle is also subject to penalties.  
4-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page146  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (146,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Fuel and Engine Exhaust Precautions  
Engine Exhaust (Carbon Monoxide)  
WARNING  
Do not drive your vehicle if you smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle:  
Engine exhaust gas is dangerous. This gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), which is  
colorless, odorless, and poisonous. When inhaled, it can cause loss of consciousness  
and death. If you smell exhaust gas inside your vehicle, keep all windows fully open  
and contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer immediately.  
Do not run the engine when inside an enclosed area:  
Running the engine inside an enclosed area, such as a garage, is dangerous. Exhaust  
gas, which contains poisonous carbon monoxide, could easily enter the cabin. Loss  
of consciousness or even death could occur.  
Open the windows or adjust the heating or cooling system to draw fresh air when  
idling the engine:  
Exhaust gas is dangerous. When your vehicle is stopped with the windows closed  
and the engine running for a long time even in an open area, exhaust gas, which  
contains poisonous carbon monoxide, could enter the cabin. Loss of consciousness or  
even death could occur.  
Clear snow from underneath and around your vehicle, particularly the tail pipe,  
before starting the engine:  
Running the engine when a vehicle is stopped in deep snow is dangerous. The  
exhaust pipe could be blocked by the snow, allowing exhaust gas to enter the cabin.  
Because exhaust gas contains poisonous carbon monoxide, it could cause loss of  
consciousness or even death to occupants in the cabin.  
4-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page147  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (147,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Before Starting the Engine  
Before Getting In  
After Getting In  
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Be sure the windows, outside mirrors,  
and outside lights are clean.  
Inspect inflation pressures and  
condition of tires.  
Look under the vehicle for any sign of  
fluid leaks.  
Are all doors closed and locked?  
Is the seat adjusted properly?  
Are the inside and outside mirrors  
adjusted?  
Is everyone's seat belt fastened?  
Check all gauges.  
Check all warning lights when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position.  
Release the parking brake and make  
sure the brake warning light goes off.  
l
l
l
If you plan to back up, make sure  
nothing is in your way.  
NOTE  
l
Engine oil, engine coolant, brake fluid, washer  
fluid, and other fluid levels should be  
inspected. See Maintenance, Section 8.  
Always be thoroughly familiar with your  
Mazda.  
4-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page148  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (148,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Driving Tips  
Break-In Period  
Money-Saving Suggestions  
No special break-in is necessary, but a few  
precautions in the first 1,000 km (600  
miles) may add to the performance,  
economy, and life of your Mazda.  
How you operate your Mazda determines  
how far it will travel on a tank of fuel. Use  
these suggestions to help save money on  
fuel and repairs.  
l
l
Don't race the engine.  
Don't maintain one constant speed,  
Avoid long warm-ups. Once the engine  
l
runs smoothly, begin driving.  
Avoid fast starts.  
Keep the engine tuned. Follow the  
l
either slow or fast, for a long period of  
time.  
Don't drive constantly at full-throttle or  
l
l
maintenance schedule (page 8-3) and  
have an Authorized Mazda Dealer  
perform inspections and servicing.  
high engine rpm for extended periods  
of time.  
Avoid unnecessary hard stops.  
Avoid full-throttle starts.  
Don't tow a trailer.  
l
l
Use the air conditioner only when  
l
necessary.  
Slow down on rough roads.  
Keep the tires properly inflated.  
Don't carry unnecessary weight.  
l
l
l
l
l
Don't rest your foot on the brake pedal  
while driving.  
Keep the wheels in correct alignment.  
Keep windows closed at high speeds.  
Slow down when driving in crosswinds  
l
l
l
and headwinds.  
WARNING  
Never stop the engine when going  
down a hill:  
Stopping the engine when going  
down a hill is dangerous. This causes  
the loss of power steering and power  
brake control, and may cause  
damage to the drivetrain. Any loss of  
steering or braking control could  
cause an accident.  
4-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page149  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (149,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Driving Tips  
l
For more traction in starting on  
Hazardous Driving  
slippery surfaces such as ice or packed  
snow, use sand, rock salt, chains,  
carpeting, or other nonslip material  
under the front wheels.  
qDriving on Slippery Surface  
WARNING  
NOTE  
Be extremely careful if it is necessary to  
downshift on slippery surfaces:  
Downshifting into lower gear while  
driving on slippery surfaces is  
Use snow chains only on the front wheels.  
dangerous. The sudden change in tire  
speed could cause the tires to skid.  
This could lead to loss of vehicle  
control and an accident.  
Do not rely on ABS or RSC as a  
substitute for safe driving:  
The ABS and RSC cannot compensate  
for unsafe and reckless driving,  
excessive speed, tailgating (following  
another vehicle too closely), driving  
on ice and snow, and hydroplaning  
(reduced tire friction and road  
contact because of water on the road  
surface). You can still have an  
accident.  
When driving on ice or in water, snow,  
mud, sand, or similar hazards:  
l
Be cautious and allow extra distance  
for braking.  
Avoid sudden braking and sudden  
l
maneuvering.  
Do not pump the brakes. Continue to  
l
press down on the brake pedal.  
If you get stuck, select a lower gear and  
l
accelerate slowly. Do not spin the front  
wheels.  
Do not perform abrupt maneuvers  
l
when the road surface changes (such as  
from a paved road to gravel) because  
the reaction of the vehicle against the  
driving operation changes.  
4-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page150  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (150,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Driving Tips  
qRoll-over  
qEmergency Maneuvering  
WARNING  
Avoid sharp turns, excessive speed and  
abrupt maneuvers when driving this  
vehicle:  
WARNING  
Do not perform abrupt maneuvers  
when driving the vehicle in an  
emergency situation:  
Sharp turns, excessive speed and  
abrupt maneuvering of this vehicle is  
dangerous as it could result in the  
increased risk of loss of vehicle  
control, vehicle roll-over, personal  
injury or death.  
This vehicle has a higher center of  
gravity. Vehicles with a higher center  
of gravity such as utility and AWD  
vehicles handle differently than  
vehicles with a lower center of  
gravity.  
Performing abrupt maneuvers even  
when driving in an emergency  
situation is dangerous as it could  
reduce vehicle stability and  
operability resulting in an accident.  
Operate the accelerator pedal, brake  
pedal, and the steering wheel  
smoothly.  
Utility and AWD vehicles are not  
designed for cornering at speeds as  
any more than low profile sports cars  
are designed to perform satisfactorily  
under off-road conditions. In  
addition, utility vehicles have a  
significantly higher rollover rate than  
other types of vehicles.  
RSC might help if you get into  
trouble, but then it might not be able  
to allow you to fully recover, always  
drive carefully with the vehicle's  
height in mind.  
Drive carefully when the vehicle is  
loaded by lowering vehicle speed and  
applying the brakes earlier:  
Abrupt maneuvering and sudden  
braking when driving a loaded  
vehicle is dangerous as the driving  
behavior of a vehicle with a high  
center of gravity is different when it is  
loaded compared to when it is not,  
and could result in the loss of vehicle  
control and an accident.  
4-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page151  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (151,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Driving Tips  
Rocking the Vehicle  
Winter Driving  
l
Carry emergency gear, including tire  
chains, window scraper, flares, a small  
shovel, jumper cables, and a small bag  
of sand or salt.  
WARNING  
Do not spin the wheels at more than 56  
km/h (35 mph), and do not allow  
anyone to stand behind a wheel when  
pushing the vehicle:  
Ask an Authorized Mazda Dealer to  
perform the following precautions:  
When the vehicle is stuck, spinning  
the wheels at high speed is  
dangerous. The spinning tire could  
overheat and explode. This could  
cause serious injuries.  
l
Have the proper ratio of antifreeze in  
the radiator.  
Refer to Engine Coolant on page 8-21.  
Inspect the battery and its cables. Cold  
l
reduces battery capacity.  
Inspect the ignition system for damage  
l
and loose connections.  
Use washer fluid made with  
antifreezebut don't use engine  
coolant antifreeze for washer fluid  
(page 8-26).  
CAUTION  
Too much rocking may cause engine  
overheating, transaxle failure, and  
tire damage.  
l
l
Don't use the parking brake in freezing  
If you must rock the vehicle to free it from  
snow, sand or mud, depress the  
accelerator slightly and slowly move the  
shift lever from D to R.  
weather as the parking brake may  
freeze. Instead, shift to P and block the  
rear wheels.  
qSnow Tires  
Use snow tires on all four wheels  
Don't go faster than 120 km/h (75 mph)  
while driving with snow tires. Inflate  
snow tires 30 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm2, 4.3 psi)  
more than recommended on the tire  
pressure label (driver's door frame), but  
never more than the maximum cold-tire  
pressure shown on the tires.  
WARNING  
Use only the same size and type tires  
(snow, radial, or non-radial) on all four  
wheels:  
Using tires different in size or type is  
dangerous. Your vehicle's handling  
could be greatly affected and result  
in an accident.  
4-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page152  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (152,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Driving Tips  
NOTE  
CAUTION  
Check local regulations before using  
studded tires.  
If your vehicle is equipped with the tire  
pressure monitoring system, the system may  
not function correctly when using tire chains.  
Install the chains on the front tires.  
Do not use chains on the rear tires.  
Use only genuine Mazda tire chains.  
Please consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
NOTE  
If your vehicle is equipped with the tire  
pressure monitoring system, the system may  
not function correctly when using tires with  
steel wire reinforcement in the sidewalls (page  
Installing the chains  
1. Secure the chains on the front tires as  
tightly as possible. Always follow the  
chain manufacturer's instructions.  
qTire Chains  
Check local regulations before using tire  
chains.  
2. Retighten the chains after driving 1/2  
1 km (1/41/2 mile).  
CAUTION  
Ø Chains may affect handling.  
Ø Do not go faster than 50 km/h (30  
mph) or the chain manufacturer's  
recommended limit, whichever is  
lower.  
Ø Drive carefully and avoid bumps,  
holes, and sharp turns.  
Ø Avoid locked-wheel braking.  
Ø Do not use chains on a temporary  
spare tire; it may result in damage  
to the vehicle and to the tire.  
Ø Do not use chains on roads that  
are free of snow or ice. The tires  
and chains could be damaged.  
Ø Chains may scratch or chip  
aluminum wheels.  
NOTE  
Use of tire chains on a vehicle equipped with P  
245/50R20 specification tires could cause  
interference with the vehicle body and  
scratching. If tire chains are to be used,  
replace both front and rear tires with P245/60  
R18 tires. Please consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
4-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page153  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (153,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Driving Tips  
Driving In Flooded Area  
Overloading  
WARNING  
WARNING  
Dry wet brakes by driving very slowly  
and applying the brakes lightly until  
brake performance returns to normal:  
Driving with wet brakes is  
Be careful not to overload your vehicle:  
The gross axle weight rating (GAWR)  
and the gross vehicle weight rating  
(GVWR) of your vehicle are on the  
Motor Vehicle Safety Standard Label  
on the driver's door frame. Exceeding  
these ratings can cause an accident  
or vehicle damage. You can estimate  
the weight of your load by weighing  
the items (or people) before putting  
them in the vehicle.  
dangerous. Increased stopping  
distance or the vehicle pulling to one  
side when braking could result in a  
serious accident. Light braking will  
indicate whether the brakes have  
been affected.  
CAUTION  
Do not drive the vehicle on flooded  
roads as it could cause short  
circuiting of electrical/electronic  
parts, or engine damage or stalling  
from water absorption. If the vehicle  
has been immersed in water, consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
4-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page154  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (154,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
Trailer Towing (Except Mexico)  
Your Mazda was designed and built primarily to carry passengers and cargo.  
If you tow a trailer, follow these instructions because driver and passenger safety depends  
on proper equipment and safe driving habits. Towing a trailer will affect handling, braking,  
durability, performance, and economy.  
Never overload vehicle or trailer. Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer if you need further  
details.  
CAUTION  
Don't tow a trailer during the first 1,000 km (600 miles) of your new Mazda. If you  
do, you may damage the engine, transaxle, differential, wheel bearings, and other  
power train components.  
qWeight Limits  
TTW and GCWR  
The total trailer weight (TTW), gross combination weight rating (GCWR), gross axle  
weight rating (GAWR), trailer load, and trailer tongue load must be within the  
prescribed limits.  
l
The total trailer weight (TTW) is the sum of the weights of the trailer load (trailer  
weight plus cargo), trailer hitch, vehicle passengers, and vehicle load. Never allow  
the total trailer weight (TTW) to exceed specifications in the Trailer Towing-Load  
Table.  
l
The maximum GCWR is the combination weight of the trailer and load plus the  
towing vehicle (including trailer hitch, vehicle passengers, and load). It must not  
exceed specifications in the load table.  
GAWR and GVWR  
Don't exceed front and rear GAWR (gross axle weight rating) and GVWR (gross vehicle  
weight rating). If you do, vehicle handling, braking, and performance will be affected.  
These values are also on the Motor Vehicle Safety Certification Label posted on the driver's  
door frame.  
High-altitude operation  
In a high-altitude operating environment, a gasoline engine loses power at a rate of 3% to  
4% per 304 m (1,000 ft) of elevation. In these conditions, a reduction in gross vehicle  
weight and gross combination weight is recommended.  
4-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page155  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (155,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
TRAILER TOWING-LOAD TABLE  
Because vehicle weights vary, adjustments must be made to meet the requirements in this  
table.  
Model  
Item  
Without Towing  
Package  
With Towing  
Package  
MAX. FRONTAL  
AREA  
2.97 m2 (32 ft2)  
4.65 m2 (50 ft2)  
Add trailer's weight, load and hitch; vehicle  
passengers and vehicle load*  
* i.e. baggage, food, camp gear  
MAX. TTW  
907 kg (2,000 lb)  
1,588 kg (3,500 lb)  
3,096 kg*1 (6,826 lb) 3,777 kg*1 (8,327 lb)  
3,201 kg*2 (7,057 lb) 3,882 kg*2 (8,558 lb)  
MAX. GCWR  
MAX. GAWR  
1,271 kg*1 (2,802 lb)  
1,307 kg*2 (2,881 lb)  
1,390 kg*1 (3,064 lb)  
1,456 kg*2 (3,210 lb)  
2,633 kg*1 (5,805 lb)  
Front  
Rear  
MAX. GVWR  
2,733 kg*2 (6,025 lb)  
Tongue load  
Trailer load  
Tongue load/Trailer load × 100 = 10% to  
15%  
TRAILER-TON-  
GUE LOAD  
Front  
Rear  
60%  
40%  
DISTRIBUTION  
OF TRAILER  
LOAD  
GCWR: Gross Combination Weight Rating (sum of TTW, vehicle weights and 2 passengers)  
GAWR: Gross Axle Weight Rating  
GVWR: Gross Vehicle Weight Rating  
*1 2WD  
*2 AWD  
4-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page156  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (156,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
WARNING  
Always keep tow loads within specified limits as indicated in the Trailer Towing-Load  
Table:  
Attempting to tow loads greater than those specified is dangerous as it may cause  
serious handling and performance problems that could result in personal injury or  
vehicle damage, or both.  
Load your trailer with the weight about 60% toward the front and 40% toward the  
rear:  
Loading the trailer with more weight in the rear than in the front is dangerous.  
Doing so could cause you to lose control. The trailer tongue load must be 10%15%  
of the total trailer load (sum of the weights of the trailer and cargo).  
Always have the total trailer weight and tongue load determined prior to departure:  
Attempting to tow loads without determining the total trailer weight and tongue  
load is dangerous. Trailer sway from crosswinds, rough roads or other causes could  
result in loss of control and a serious accident.  
CAUTION  
The total trailer weight and tongue load can be determined by weighing the trailer  
on platform scales at a highway weight station or a trucking company.  
qTrailer Hitch  
Use only a hitch ball recommended by the trailer manufacturer that conforms to the gross  
trailer weight requirement.  
When not towing a trailer, remove the trailer hitch (if detachable) to reduce the possibility  
of damage as a result of the vehicle being rear-ended.  
4-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page157  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (157,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
WARNING  
Always make sure the trailer hitch is securely attached before departure:  
An unsecured trailer hitch is dangerous as it causes greater trailer sway from  
crosswinds, rough roads or other causes, resulting in loss of control and a serious  
accident.  
Examine all trailer-hitch mounting bolts regularly and tighten any that are loose. If  
the hitch is removed, seal any open mounting holes to prevent exhaust, dust, water,  
dirt and other foreign elements from filtering in, possibly endangering personal  
safety and damaging your vehicle.  
Do not install a hitch that stiffens the bumper as it will reduce the bumper's  
performance.  
Make sure there are no exhaust gas leaks into the passenger compartment if any  
mounting bolts are connected to the body:  
Modifying your vehicle exhaust system is dangerous. Exhaust gas entering the  
vehicle could cause loss of consciousness or even death.  
When mounting the trailer hitch, make no modifications to the vehicle exhaust  
system.  
CAUTION  
Ø Make all hitch adjustments with actual loads. Don't load and unload vehicle while  
adjusting hitch. This action will change the vehicle height.  
Ø Don't use an axle-mounted hitch. This may damage the axle and related parts.  
qTires  
When towing a trailer, make sure all tires are inflated to the recommended cold-tire  
pressure, as indicated on the tire pressure chart on the driver's door frame. Trailer tire size,  
load rating, and inflation pressures should conform to tire manufacturer specifications.  
WARNING  
Never use the temporary spare tire when towing:  
Using the temporary spare tire on your vehicle when towing a trailer is dangerous as  
it could result in tire failure, loss of control, and injury to vehicle occupants.  
4-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page158  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (158,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
qSafety Chains  
Safety chains must be used as a precautionary measure should the trailer become  
unintentionally unhitched. They should cross under the trailer tongue and attach to the  
hitch. Leave enough slack to allow full turns. Consult literature published by your trailer or  
hitch manufacturer for more details.  
WARNING  
Make sure the safety chain is securely attached to both the trailer and the vehicle  
prior to departure:  
Towing a trailer without using a safety chain securely attached to both the trailer  
and the vehicle is dangerous. If damage occurs to the coupling unit or hitch ball, the  
trailer could wander into another lane and cause a collision.  
qTrailer Lights  
Trailer lights must comply with all federal, state, and local regulations. Equip your trailer  
as required before towing it day or night.  
CAUTION  
Don't connect a trailer lighting system directly to the lighting system of your Mazda.  
This may damage your vehicle's electrical system and lighting systems. Have a  
recreational vehicle dealer or trailer rental agency connect the system, and inspect  
the brake lights and turn signals yourself before each trip.  
qTrailer Brakes  
If the total trailer weight exceeds 450 kg (1,000 lb), trailer brakes are required. If your  
trailer has brakes, make sure they comply with all federal, state, and local regulations.  
WARNING  
Do not connect a hydraulic trailer-brake system to your vehicle's brake system:  
Connecting a hydraulic trailer-brake system directly to the vehicle brake system is  
dangerous and will result in inadequate braking and possible injury.  
qTrailer Towing Tips  
l
Verify that your Mazda maintains a near-normal attitude when a loaded or unloaded  
trailer is connected. Don't drive if it has an abnormal front-up or front-down position.  
Inspect for incorrect tongue load, worn suspension parts, and trailer overloading.  
Make sure the trailer is properly loaded and the cargo is secure to prevent it from  
l
shifting.  
l
Make sure the mirrors conform to all government regulations. If they do not, install  
required rear view mirrors appropriate for towing purposes.  
4-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page159  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (159,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
The three main causes of vehicle-trailer accidents are driver error, excessive speed, and  
improper trailer loading.  
Before driving  
l
Have your cooling and braking system checked by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Before starting out, inspect the operation of all vehicle and trailer lights and all vehicle-  
l
to-trailer connections. Stop and re-inspect all lights and connections after driving a short  
distance.  
Driving  
l
Your Mazda will handle differently with a trailer in tow, so practice turning, backing,  
and stopping in a traffic-free area.  
Take time to get accustomed to the extra weight and length.  
Allow more room between your vehicle and the one in front because braking distance  
l
l
increases with a trailer. For each 16 km/h (10 mph) of speed, allow at least one vehicle  
and trailer length between your Mazda and the vehicle ahead.  
Avoid jerky starts or sudden acceleration.  
l
l
Avoid sudden braking. It may cause loss of control and result in jackknifing, especially  
so on wet or slippery roads.  
Shift the shift lever to the D position when towing a trailer in hilly terrain or when  
l
heavily loaded.  
These positions will allow operating the vehicle without frequent shifting.  
Lane changes and turning  
Avoid quick lane changes, sudden turns, and tight turns. Slow down before turning to  
avoid the need of sudden braking.  
A turning trailer will make a tighter arc than the tow vehicle. Compensate with turns that  
are larger than normal.  
Passing  
Plan well ahead to pass other vehicles, and provide plenty of room before changing lanes.  
Crosswinds from passing vehicles, especially larger ones, and the effects of rough roads  
will affect handling.  
If swaying occurs, firmly grip the steering wheel and reduce speed immediately, but  
gradually.  
Steer straight ahead. If no extreme correction of steering or braking is made, the  
combination of less speed and firm steering will result in stability.  
Backing up  
Backing a vehicle with a trailer requires practice and patience. Back slowly, and have a  
helper outside at the rear of the trailer to reduce the risk of an accident.  
To turn the trailer, place your hand at the bottom of the steering wheel and turn it in the  
direction you want the trailer to go. Make only slight movements to prevent sharp or  
prolonged turning.  
4-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page160  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (160,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
Ascending a hill  
Shift into a lower gear to reduce the possibility of overloading or overheating the engine, or  
both.  
Descending a hill  
Shift into a lower gear and use engine compression as a braking effect.  
WARNING  
Always use lower gears to reduce speed:  
Holding the brake pedal down too long or too frequently is dangerous as it could  
cause the brakes to overheat and lose power, resulting in loss of control and a  
serious accident. Use lower gears to help reduce speed. Pull off the road and allow  
brakes to cool down whenever braking performance feels reduced.  
Overheated engine  
The extra weight of the trailer may strain the engine on hot days and on long or steep  
upgrades.  
If the temperature gauge indicates overheating, turn off the air conditioner, drive safely to  
the side of the road, park off the right-of-way and wait for engine to cool. Refer to  
Overheating (page 7-14).  
Parking  
Always make sure the tires of the trailer and the tow vehicle are blocked while parked.  
Apply the parking brake firmly and put the transaxle in P.  
Avoid parking on an incline, but if you must, follow these instructions:  
1. Depress and hold down the brake pedal.  
2. Have a helper put wheel blocks against the downhill side of all vehicle and trailer tires.  
3. Then release the brake pedal slowly until the blocks bear the load.  
l
If the grade is downhill, turn the steering wheel so that the front of the front tires face  
the curb.  
l
If it is uphill, face the rear of the front tires against the curb.  
4. Firmly apply the parking brake.  
5. Shift the transaxle into P, and stop the engine.  
To restart after parking on an incline:  
1. With the transaxle in P, start the engine. (Be sure to depress and hold the brake pedal.)  
2. Shift into gear.  
4-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page161  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (161,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
3. Release the parking brake (also the foot brake) and pull away from the wheel blocks.  
Stop; apply the parking brake and shift into P.  
4. Have a helper retrieve the wheel blocks.  
Fuel consumption  
Trailer towing causes higher fuel consumption.  
Maintenance  
If you tow a trailer frequently, have your vehicle serviced as shown in Scheduled  
Maintenance (page 8-3).  
4-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page162  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (162,1)  
4-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page163  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (163,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
5
Explanation of instruments and controls.  
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) Operationí ..................................... 5-16  
Tire Pressure Monitoring Systemí ......................................... 5-27  
Fog Lightsí ............................................................................ 5-57  
íSome models.  
5-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page164  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (164,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
qIgnition Switch Positions  
Ignition Switch  
With advanced  
key  
Auxiliary key (with advanced key)  
NOTE  
When starting the engine using the advanced  
key, refer to Starting the Engine (page 3-9).  
Without advanced  
key  
When starting the engine with the  
auxiliary key, perform the following  
procedure.  
1. Remove the auxiliary key from the  
advanced key (page 3-15).  
LOCK  
2. Make sure the start knob is in LOCK  
position.  
The steering wheel locks to protect  
against theft. Only in this position can the  
key be removed.  
3. Remove the start knob by pulling it  
outward while pressing the buttons on  
both the left and right sides.  
4. Insert the auxiliary key in the ignition  
switch.  
5-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page165  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (165,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
ON  
WARNING  
This is the normal running position after  
the engine is started. The warning lights  
(except brakes) should be inspected  
before the engine is started (page 5-37).  
Remove the key only when the vehicle  
is parked:  
Removing the key from the ignition  
switch while the vehicle is moving is  
dangerous. Removing the key allows  
the steering wheel to lock. You will  
lose steering control and a serious  
accident could occur. (For vehicles  
equipped with the advanced key, the  
steering wheel locks when the starter  
knob is turned to the LOCK position.)  
NOTE  
When the ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position, the sound of the fuel pump motor  
operating near the fuel tank can be heard. This  
does not indicate an abnormality.  
NOTE  
Vibration of the brake pedal may be felt when  
the ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position, however, this is a normal operation of  
the DSC/RSC and does not indicate an  
abnormality.  
Before leaving the driver's seat, always  
put the key or start knob to LOCK  
position, set the parking brake and  
make sure the shift lever is in P:  
Intentionally placing the start knob  
into LOCK position is much more  
important where you will not be  
removing the key to leave the vehicle  
and because leaving it in other  
positions will disable some of the  
vehicle security systems and run the  
battery down.  
START  
The engine is started in this position. It  
will crank until you release the key; then  
it returns to the ON position. The brake  
warning light can be checked after the  
engine is started (page 5-37).  
Leaving the driver's seat without  
putting the ignition switch in LOCK  
position, setting the parking brake  
and the shift lever is in P is  
dangerous. Unexpected vehicle  
movement could occur. This could  
cause an accident.  
qIgnition Key Reminder  
If the ignition switch is in the LOCK or  
ACC position with the key inserted, a  
continuous beep sound will be heard  
when the driver's door is opened.  
NOTE  
If turning the key is difficult, jiggle the steering  
wheel from side to side.  
Leaving the key or start knob in any position  
but LOCK position also disables some of the  
security features and may run the battery  
down.  
ACC (Accessory)  
The steering wheel unlocks and some  
electrical accessories will operate.  
5-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page166  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (166,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
Starting the Engine  
_
l
In extremely cold weather, below 18 °C  
(0 °F), or after the vehicle has not been  
driven in several days, let the engine warm  
up without operating the accelerator.  
Whether the engine is cold or warm, it  
should be started without use of the  
accelerator.  
NOTE  
Engine-starting is controlled by the spark  
ignition system.  
This system meets all Canadian Interference-  
Causing Equipment Standard requirements  
regulating the impulse electrical field strength  
of radio noise.  
l
1. Occupants should fasten their seat  
belts.  
2. Make sure the parking brake is on.  
3. Depress the brake pedal.  
4. Put the vehicle in park (P). If you must  
restart the engine while the vehicle is  
moving, shift into neutral (N).  
NOTE  
The starter will not operate if the shift lever is  
not in P or N.  
5. Turn the ignition switch to the START  
position and hold (up to 10 seconds at  
a time) until the engine starts.  
CAUTION  
Don't try the starter for more than 10  
seconds at a time. If the engine stalls  
or fails to start, wait 10 seconds  
before trying again. Otherwise, you  
may damage the starter and drain  
the battery.  
6. After starting the engine, let it idle for  
about 10 seconds.  
5-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page167  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (167,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Brake System  
WARNING  
Dry brakes that have become wet by  
driving very slowly and applying the  
brakes lightly until brake performance  
is normal:  
qFoot Brake  
Your Mazda has power-assisted brakes  
that adjust automatically through normal  
use.  
Driving with wet brakes is  
dangerous. Increased stopping  
distance or the vehicle pulling to one  
side when braking could result in a  
serious accident. Light braking will  
indicate whether the brakes have  
been affected.  
Should power-assist fail, you can stop by  
applying greater force than normal to the  
brake pedal. But the distance required to  
stop will be greater than usual.  
WARNING  
qParking Brake  
Do not coast with the engine stalled or  
turned off, find a safe place to stop:  
Coasting with the engine stalled or  
turned off is dangerous. Braking will  
require more effort, and the brake's  
power-assist could be depleted if you  
pump the brake. This will cause  
longer stopping distances or even an  
accident.  
WARNING  
Before leaving the driver's seat, always  
put the key or start knob to LOCK  
position, set the parking brake and  
make sure the shift lever is in P:  
Intentionally placing the start knob  
into LOCK position is much more  
important where you will not be  
removing the key to leave the vehicle  
and because leaving it in other  
positions will disable some of the  
vehicle security systems and run the  
battery down.  
Shift to a lower gear when going down  
steep hills:  
Driving with your foot continuously  
on the brake pedal or steadily  
applying the brakes for long  
distances is dangerous. This causes  
overheated brakes, resulting in  
longer stopping distances or even  
total brake failure. This could cause  
loss of vehicle control and a serious  
accident. Avoid continuous  
Leaving the driver's seat without  
putting the ignition switch in LOCK  
position, setting the parking brake  
and the shift lever is in P is  
dangerous. Unexpected vehicle  
movement could occur. This could  
cause an accident.  
application of the brakes.  
CAUTION  
Driving with the parking brake on  
will cause excessive wear of the brake  
linings or pads.  
5-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page168  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (168,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
qBrake System Warning Light  
For parking in snow, refer to Winter Driving  
(page 4-9) regarding parking brake use.  
Setting the parking brake  
Depress the brake pedal, then depress the  
parking brake pedal fully.  
This warning has the following functions:  
Parking brake warning  
The light comes on when the parking  
brake is applied with the ignition switch  
in the START or ON position. It goes off  
when the parking brake is fully released.  
Low brake fluid level warning  
If the light stays on after the parking brake  
is fully released, you may have a brake  
problem.  
Releasing the parking brake  
Depress the brake pedal, then depress the  
parking brake pedal until it releases.  
Gradually let up on the parking brake  
pedal.  
Drive to the side of the road and park off  
the right-of-way.  
You may notice that the pedal is harder to  
push or that it may go closer to the floor.  
In either case, it will take longer to stop  
the vehicle.  
1. With the engine stopped, check the  
brake fluid level immediately and add  
fluid as required (page 8-23).  
2. After adding fluid, check the light  
again.  
If the warning light remains on, or if the  
brakes do not operate properly, do not  
drive the vehicle. Have it towed to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
NOTE  
Release the parking brake pedal once before  
trying to reapply it.  
Even if the light goes out have your brake  
system inspected as soon as possible by  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
5-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page169  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (169,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
WARNING  
Do not rely on ABS or RSC as a  
substitute for safe driving:  
Having to add brake fluid is sometimes an  
indicator of leakage. Consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible even if the  
brake light is no longer illuminated.  
The ABS and RSC cannot compensate  
for unsafe and reckless driving,  
excessive speed, tailgating (following  
another vehicle too closely), driving  
on ice and snow, and hydroplaning  
(reduced tire friction and road  
contact because of water on the road  
surface). You can still have an  
accident.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with the brake system  
warning light illuminated. Contact an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer to have the  
brakes inspected as soon as possible:  
Driving with the brake system  
warning light illuminated is  
dangerous. It indicates that your  
brakes may not work at all or that  
they could completely fail at any  
time. If this light remains  
illuminated, after checking that the  
parking brake is fully released, have  
the brakes inspected immediately.  
NOTE  
l
Braking distances may be longer on loose  
surfaces (snow or gravel, for example)  
which usually have a hard foundation. A  
vehicle with a normal braking system may  
require less distance to stop under these  
conditions because the tires will build up a  
wedge of surface layer when the wheels  
skid.  
qParking Brake Reminder  
l
The sound of the ABS operating may be  
If the parking brake has not been  
completely released and the vehicle is  
driven at about 5 km/h (3 mph) or faster, a  
continuous beep sound will be heard to  
notify the driver that the parking brake  
has not been released.  
heard when starting the engine or  
immediately after starting the vehicle.  
However, it does not indicate a malfunction.  
qABS Warning Light  
qAnti-Lock Brake System (ABS)  
The ABS control unit continuously  
monitors the speed of each wheel. If one  
is about to lock up, the ABS responds by  
automatically releasing and reapplying  
that wheel's brake.  
The warning light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
The driver will feel a slight vibration in  
the brake pedal and may hear a chattering  
noise from the brake system. This is  
normal when the ABS operates. Don't  
pump the brakes, continue to press down  
on the brake pedal.  
5-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page170  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (170,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
If the ABS warning light stays on while  
you're driving, the ABS control unit has  
detected a system malfunction. If this  
occurs, your brakes will function normally  
as if the vehicle had no ABS.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with both the ABS warning  
light and brake warning light  
illuminated. Have the vehicle towed to  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer to have  
the brakes inspected as soon as  
possible:  
Should this happen, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
NOTE  
Driving when the brake system  
warning light and ABS warning light  
are illuminated at the same time is  
dangerous.  
When both lights are illuminated, the  
rear wheels could lock more quickly  
in an emergency stop than under  
normal circumstances.  
When the engine is jump-started to charge the  
battery, uneven rpm occurs and the ABS  
warning light comes on. This is due to a weak  
battery, not a malfunction.  
Recharge the battery.  
qElectronic Brake Force  
Distribution System Warning  
qBrake Assist  
During emergency braking situations  
when it is necessary to depress the brake  
pedal with greater force, the brake assist  
system provides braking assistance, thus  
enhancing braking performance.  
If the electronic brake force distribution  
control unit determines that some  
components are operating incorrectly, the  
control unit may turn the brake system  
warning light and the ABS warning light  
on at the same time. The problem is likely  
to be an electronic brake force distribution  
system.  
When the brake pedal is depressed hard or  
depressed more quickly, the brakes apply  
more firmly.  
NOTE  
l
When the brake pedal is depressed hard or  
depressed more quickly, the pedal will feel  
softer but the brakes will apply more firmly.  
This is a normal effect of the brake assist  
operation and does not indicate an  
abnormality.  
l
The brake assist equipment does not  
supersede the functionality of the vehicle's  
main braking system.  
5-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page171  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (171,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
qBrake Pad Wear Indicator  
When the disc brake pads become worn,  
the built-in wear indicators contact the  
disc plates. This causes a screeching noise  
to warn that the pads should be replaced.  
When you hear this noise, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as  
possible.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with worn disc pads:  
Driving with worn disc pads is  
dangerous. The brakes could fail and  
cause a serious accident. As soon as  
you hear a screeching noise consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
5-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page172  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (172,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Automatic Transaxle Controls  
Various Lockouts:  
Indicates that you must depress the brake pedal to shift (The ignition  
switch must be in the ACC or ON position).  
Indicates the shift lever can be shifted freely into any position.  
NOTE  
This Sport AT has an option that is not included in traditional automatic transaxle - giving the driver  
the option of selecting each gear instead of leaving it to the transaxle to shift gears. Even if you  
intend to use the automatic transaxle functions as a traditional automatic, you should also be aware  
that you can inadvertently shift into manual shift mode and an inappropriate gear may be retained as  
you change speeds. If you notice the engine speed going higher or hear the engine racing, confirm  
you have not accidentally slipped into manual shift mode (page 5-12).  
5-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page173  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (173,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
qTransaxle Ranges  
WARNING  
If the engine is running faster than idle,  
do not shift from N or P into a driving  
gear:  
The shift lever must be in P or N to  
operate the starter.  
P (Park)  
It's dangerous to shift from N or P  
into a driving gear when the engine  
is running faster than idle. If this is  
done, the vehicle could move  
suddenly, causing an accident or  
serious injury.  
P locks the transaxle and prevents the  
front wheels from rotating.  
WARNING  
Always set the shift lever to P AND set  
the parking brake:  
Do not shift into N when driving the  
vehicle:  
Only setting the shift lever to the P  
position without using the parking  
brake to hold the vehicle is  
dangerous. If P fails to hold, the  
vehicle could move and cause an  
accident.  
Shifting into N while driving is  
dangerous. Engine braking cannot be  
applied when decelerating which  
could lead to an accident or serious  
injury.  
CAUTION  
Ø Shifting into P, N or R while the  
vehicle is moving can damage  
your transaxle.  
Ø Shifting into a driving gear or  
reverse when the engine is running  
faster than idle can damage the  
transaxle.  
CAUTION  
Do not shift into N when driving the  
vehicle. Doing so can cause transaxle  
damage.  
NOTE  
Apply the parking brake or depress the brake  
pedal before moving the shift lever from N to  
prevent the vehicle from moving unexpectedly.  
R (Reverse)  
In position R, the vehicle moves only  
backward. You must be at a complete stop  
before shifting to or from R, except under  
rare circumstances as explained in  
Rocking the Vehicle (page 4-9).  
D (Drive)  
D is the normal driving position. From a  
stop, the transaxle will automatically shift  
through a 6-gear sequence.  
M (Manual)  
N (Neutral)  
M is the manual shift mode position.  
Gears can be shifted up or down by  
operating the shift lever.  
In N, the wheels and transaxle are not  
locked. The vehicle will roll freely even  
on the slightest incline unless the parking  
brake or brakes are on.  
Refer to Manual Shift Mode (page 5-12).  
5-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page174  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (174,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
l
qActive Adaptive Shift (AAS)  
When the ignition switch is in the LOCK  
position, the shift lever cannot be shifted  
from P.  
To be sure the vehicle is in park, the  
ignition key cannot be removed unless the  
shift lever is in P.  
Active Adaptive Shift (AAS)  
automatically controls the transaxle shift  
points to best suit the road conditions and  
driver input. This optimizes engine  
performance and improves driving  
comfort. When cornering the vehicle,  
AAS mode will hold the transaxle in the  
gear the vehicle was in before entering the  
curve, allowing the vehicle to be  
accelerated from the same gear after  
exiting the curve.  
If the driver accelerates rapidly, or  
accelerates and decelerates rapidly by  
operating the accelerator and brake pedal  
for a certain period of time while the  
selector lever is in the D position, AAS  
mode could activate. When this occurs,  
AAS mode will maintain the transaxle in  
the optimum gear and the driver may  
sense that the transaxle is not shifting,  
however this does not indicate an  
abnormality.  
l
l
(With Advanced Key)  
The ignition switch cannot be turned from  
the ACC position to the LOCK position  
when the shift lever is not in P.  
qManual Shift Mode  
This mode gives you the feel of driving a  
manual transaxle vehicle by operating the  
shift lever and allows you to control  
engine rpm and torque to the drive wheels  
much like a manual transaxle when more  
control is desired.  
To change to manual shift mode, shift the  
lever from D to M.  
qShift-Lock System  
The shift-lock system prevents shifting  
out of P unless the brake pedal is  
depressed.  
To shift from P:  
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal.  
2. Start the engine.  
3. Move the shift lever.  
To return to automatic shift mode, shift  
the lever from M to D.  
NOTE  
If you change to manual shift mode when the  
vehicle is stopped, the gear will shift to M1.  
5-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page175  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (175,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Indicators  
Shifting  
Shift position indicator  
Manually Shifting up  
In manual shift mode, the Mof the shift  
position indicator in the instrument panel  
illuminates.  
(M1M2M3M4M5M6)  
To shift up to a higher gear, tap the shift  
lever back ( ) once.  
Gear position indicator  
The numeral for the selected gear  
illuminates.  
Shift position indicator  
NOTE  
l
When driving slowly, the gears may not  
shift up depending on vehicle speed.  
Gear position indicator  
l
In manual shift mode, gears do not shift up  
automatically. Don't run the engine with the  
tachometer needle in the RED ZONE. If the  
tachometer needle enters the RED ZONE,  
you may feel engine-braking because the  
fuel delivery will be stopped to protect the  
engine. However, this does not indicate an  
abnormality.  
When depressing the accelerator fully, the  
transaxle will shift to a lower gear,  
depending on vehicle speed.  
NOTE  
l
If the gears cannot be shifted down when  
driving at higher speeds, the gear position  
indicator will flash twice to signal that the  
gears cannot be shifted down.  
l
If the automatic transaxle fluid (ATF)  
temperature becomes too high, there is the  
possibility that the transaxle will switch to  
automatic shift mode, canceling manual  
shift mode and turning off the gear position  
indicator illumination. This is a normal  
function to protect the AT. After the ATF  
temperature has decreased, the gear  
position indicator illumination turns back  
on and driving in manual shift mode is  
restored.  
l
5-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page176  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (176,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Manually Shifting down  
Second gear fixed mode  
When the shift lever is tapped back (  
(M6M5M4M3M2M1)  
To shift down to a lower gear, tap the shift  
lever forward ( ) once.  
)
while the vehicle is stopped, the transaxle  
is set in the second gear fixed mode. The  
gear is fixed in second while in this mode  
for easier starting and driving on slippery  
roads. If the shift lever is tapped back (  
or forward ( ) while in the second gear  
fixed mode, the mode will be canceled.  
)
Shifting specification  
Shifting up  
If the vehicle speed is lower than the  
speed specified for each gear, the gear  
cannot be shifted up to a higher gear.  
Gear  
Vehicle speed  
You can shift up to M2 whether the  
vehicle is stopped or moving.  
WARNING  
M1M2  
Do not use engine braking on slippery  
road surfaces or at high speeds:  
Shifting down while driving on wet,  
snowy, or frozen roads, or while  
driving at high speeds causes sudden  
engine braking, which is dangerous.  
The sudden change in tire speed  
could cause the tires to skid. This  
could lead to loss of vehicle control  
and an accident.  
M2M3  
M3M4  
M4M5  
M5M6  
15 km/h (10 mph)  
29 km/h (19 mph)  
40 km/h (25 mph)  
50 km/h (32 mph)  
Shifting down  
If the vehicle speed is higher than the  
speed specified for each gear, the gear  
cannot be shifted down to a lower gear.  
Gear  
M6M5  
Vehicle speed  
230 km/h (142 mph)  
201 km/h (124 mph)  
150 km/h (93 mph)  
96 km/h (59 mph)  
NOTE  
l
When driving at high speeds, the gear may  
not shift down depending on vehicle speed.  
M5M4  
M4M3  
M3M2  
M2M1  
l
During deceleration, the gear may  
automatically shift down depending on  
vehicle speed.  
49 km/h (30 mph)  
l
During deceleration, the gears shift down  
automatically when speed is reduced to  
the following:  
When depressing the accelerator fully, the  
transaxle will shift to a lower gear,  
depending on vehicle speed.  
Gear  
M6M5  
Vehicle speed  
47 km/h (29 mph)  
M5M4  
37 km/h (22 mph)  
26 km/h (16 mph)  
9 km/h (5 mph)  
M4M3  
M3 or M2M1  
5-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page177  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (177,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
qDriving Tips  
The gear does not shift down to M1  
automatically while in the second gear fixed  
mode.  
Passing  
For extra power when passing another  
vehicle or climbing steep grades, depress  
the accelerator fully. The transaxle will  
shift to a lower gear, depending on vehicle  
speed.  
If the vehicle is kicked down at the  
following speeds or lower, the gears shift  
down automatically:  
Gear  
M6M5  
Vehicle speed  
230 km/h (142 mph)  
90 km/h (55 mph)  
65 km/h (40 mph)  
40 km/h (24 mph)  
Climbing steep grades from a stop  
To climb a steep grade from a stopped  
position:  
M5M4  
M4M3  
M3M2  
1. Depress the brake pedal.  
Recommendations for shifting  
Upshifting  
2. Shift to D or M1, depending on the  
load weight and grade steepness.  
3. Release the brake pedal while  
gradually accelerating.  
For normal acceleration and cruising, we  
recommend these shift points.  
Descending steep grades  
Gear  
M1 to M2  
Vehicle speed  
24 km/h (15 mph)  
When descending a steep grade, shift to  
lower gears, depending on load weight  
and grade steepness. Descend slowly,  
using the brakes only occasionally to  
prevent them from overheating.  
M2 to M3  
M3 to M4  
M4 to M5  
M5 to M6  
40 km/h (25 mph)  
65 km/h (40 mph)  
73 km/h (45 mph)  
80 km/h (50 mph)  
Downshifting  
When you must slow down in heavy  
traffic or on a steep upgrade, downshift  
before the engine starts to overwork. This  
gives better acceleration when you need  
more speed.  
On a steep downgrade, downshifting  
helps maintain safe speed and prolongs  
brake life.  
5-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page178  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (178,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Power Steering  
All-Wheel Drive (AWD)  
Operationí  
Power steering is only operable when the  
engine is running. If the engine is off or if  
the power steering system is inoperable,  
you can still steer, but it requires more  
physical effort.  
AWD provides excellent driveability on  
snow-covered and ice-packed roads, sand  
and mud, as well as on steep slopes and  
other slippery surfaces.  
If the steering feels stiffer than usual  
during normal driving, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
CAUTION  
Never hold the steering wheel to the  
extreme left or right for more than 5  
seconds with the engine running.  
This could damage the power  
steering system.  
5-16  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page179  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (179,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
qAWD Driving  
qAWD Warning Light  
WARNING  
Avoid sharp turns, excessive speed and  
abrupt maneuvers when driving this  
vehicle:  
Sharp turns, excessive speed and  
abrupt maneuvering of this vehicle is  
dangerous as it could result in the  
increased risk of loss of vehicle  
control, vehicle roll-over, personal  
injury or death.  
This vehicle has a higher center of  
gravity. Vehicles with a higher center  
of gravity such as utility and AWD  
vehicles handle differently than  
vehicles with a lower center of  
gravity.  
Utility and AWD vehicles are not  
designed for cornering at speeds as  
any more than low profile sports cars  
are designed to perform satisfactorily  
under off-road conditions. In  
addition, utility vehicles have a  
significantly higher rollover rate than  
other types of vehicles.  
This warning light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
Thereafter, the warning light will  
illuminate or flash under the following  
conditions:  
l
Illuminates when there is an  
abnormality with the AWD system.  
Flashes when the differential oil  
l
temperature is abnormally high.  
Flashes when there are continually  
l
large differences between front and rear  
wheel rotation, such as when trying to  
pull away from an icy surface.  
If the AWD warning light illuminates:  
If the AWD warning light illuminates,  
contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
RSC might help if you get into  
trouble, but then it might not be able  
to allow you to fully recover, always  
drive carefully with the vehicle's  
height in mind.  
If the AWD warning light flashes:  
Park the vehicle in a safe place. After a  
few moments; if the warning light stops  
flashing, you can resume driving. If the  
light does not stop flashing, contact an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Drive carefully when the vehicle is  
loaded by lowering vehicle speed and  
applying the brakes earlier:  
Abrupt maneuvering and sudden  
braking when driving a loaded  
vehicle is dangerous as the driving  
behavior of a vehicle with a high  
center of gravity is different when it is  
loaded compared to when it is not,  
and could result in the loss of vehicle  
control and an accident.  
5-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page180  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (180,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Tire chains  
WARNING  
l
Install tire chains to the front tires.  
Do not drive the vehicle faster than 30  
km/h (19 mph) with the tire chains  
installed.  
Do not drive the vehicle with tire  
chains on road conditions other than  
snow or ice.  
Never spin a wheel that is off the  
ground:  
l
Spinning a wheel that is off the  
ground as a result of the vehicle  
being stuck or in a ditch is  
dangerous. The drive assembly could  
be seriously damaged which could  
lead to an accident or could even  
lead to overheating, oil leakage, and  
a fire.  
l
qTowing  
If the vehicle requires towing, have it  
towed with all four wheels completely off  
the ground(page 7-20).  
qTires and Tire Chains  
The condition of the tires plays a large  
role in the performance of the vehicle.  
Moreover, to prevent adverse effects to  
the drive assembly, please note the  
following:  
Tires  
l
When replacing tires, always replace  
all front and rear tires at the same time.  
All tires must be of the same size,  
l
manufacture, brand and tread pattern.  
Pay particular attention when  
equipping snow or other types of  
winter tires.  
l
Do not mix tread-worn tires with  
normal tires.  
Inspect tire inflation pressures at the  
l
specified periods and adjust to the  
specified pressures.  
NOTE  
Check the tire inflation pressure label attached  
to driver's door frame for the correct tire  
inflation pressure.  
l
Make sure to equip the vehicle with  
genuine wheels of the specified size,  
on all wheels. With AWD, the system  
is calibrated for all four wheels being  
of the same dimensions.  
5-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page181  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (181,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
qActivation/Deactivation  
Cruise Control  
To activate the system, press up on the  
ON/OFF switch.  
The cruise main indicator light  
illuminates.  
With cruise control, you can set and  
automatically maintain any speed of more  
than about 30 km/h (19 mph).  
WARNING  
Do not use the cruise control under the  
following conditions:  
To deactivate the system, press down on  
the ON/OFF switch.  
The cruise main indicator light turns off.  
Using the cruise control under the  
following conditions is dangerous  
and could result in loss of vehicle  
control.  
Ø Hilly terrain  
Ø Steep inclines  
Ø Heavy or unsteady traffic  
Ø Slippery or winding roads  
Ø Similar restrictions that require  
inconsistent speed  
qCruise Main Indicator Light  
(Amber)/Cruise Set Indicator  
Light (Green)  
WARNING  
Keep the ON/OFF switch off when  
cruise control is not in use:  
Leaving the ON/OFF switch on when  
not using the cruise control is  
dangerous as you may hit one of the  
other buttons and put the vehicle in  
cruise control unexpectedly. This  
could result in loss of vehicle control.  
The indicator light has two colors.  
Cruise Main Indicator Light (Amber)  
qTo Set Speed  
The indicator light illuminates amber  
when the ON/OFF switch is pressed up  
and the cruise control system is activated.  
1. Activate the cruise control system by  
momentarily pressing up the ON/OFF  
switch.  
Cruise Set Indicator Light (Green)  
2. Accelerate to the desired speed, which  
must be more than 30 km/h (19 mph).  
The indicator light illuminates green when  
a cruising speed has been set.  
5-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page182  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (182,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
3. Press down or press up on the cruise  
control SET +/SET - switch and release  
it at the speed you want. Release the  
accelerator at the same time.  
qTo Increase Cruising Speed  
Follow either of these procedures.  
To increase speed using cruise control  
switch  
Press up on the cruise control SET +  
switch and hold it. Your vehicle will  
accelerate.  
Release the switch at the speed you want.  
Cruise control switch  
Cruise control switch  
NOTE  
l
Release the cruise control switch at the  
desired speed, otherwise the speed will  
continue increasing while the switch is  
pulled up, and continue decreasing while it  
is pulled down (except when the accelerator  
pedal is depressed).  
The SET function can't be activated until  
about 2 seconds after the ON/OFF switch  
has been engaged.  
Your vehicle has a tap-up feature that  
allows you to increase your current speed  
in increments of 1.6 km/h (1 mph) by a  
momentary tap of the cruise control  
switch. Multiple taps will increase your  
vehicle speed 1.6 km/h (1 mph) for each  
tap.  
l
l
On a steep grade, the vehicle may  
momentarily slow down going up or speed  
up while going down.  
l
Cruise control will turn off if vehicle speed  
drops below 30 km/h (19 mph) when cruise  
is activated, such as when climbing a steep  
grade.  
5-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page183  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (183,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
To increase speed using accelerator  
pedal  
Your vehicle has a tap-down feature that  
allows you to decrease your current speed  
in decrements of 1.6 km/h (1 mph) by a  
momentary tap of the cruise control  
switch. Multiple taps will decrease your  
vehicle speed 1.6 km/h (1 mph) for each  
tap.  
Depress the accelerator pedal to accelerate  
to the desired speed.  
Press down or press up on the cruise  
control SET +/SET - switch and release it  
immediately.  
qTo Resume Cruising Speed at  
More Than 30 km/h (19 mph)  
If some other method besides the ON/  
OFF switch was used to cancel cruising  
speed (such as applying the brake pedal)  
and the system is still activated, the most  
recent set speed will automatically resume  
when the RESUME button is pressed.  
If vehicle speed is below 30 km/h (19  
mph), increase the vehicle speed up to 30  
km/h (19 mph) and press the RESUME  
button.  
Cruise control switch  
NOTE  
Accelerate if you want to speed up temporarily  
when the cruise control is on. Greater speed  
will not interfere with or change the set speed.  
Take your foot off the accelerator to return to  
the set speed.  
qTo Decrease Cruising Speed  
Press down the cruise control SET -  
switch and hold it. The vehicle will  
gradually slow.  
Release the switch at the speed you want.  
qTo Cancel  
To cancel the system, use one of these  
methods:  
l
Pull down the ON/OFF switch.  
Slightly depress the brake pedal.  
l
Cruise control switch  
5-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page184  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (184,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
l
Press the CANCEL button.  
Traction Control System  
(TCS)  
The Traction Control System (TCS)  
enhances traction and safety by  
controlling engine torque and braking.  
When the TCS detects driving wheel  
slippage, it lowers engine torque and  
operates the brakes to prevent loss of  
traction.  
This means that on a slick surface, the  
engine adjusts automatically to provide  
optimum power to the drive wheels  
without causing them to spin and lose  
traction.  
The system is off when the ignition is off.  
NOTE  
Cruise control will cancel at about 15 km/h (9  
mph) below the preset speed (such as may  
happen when climbing a long, steep grade) or  
below 30 km/h (19 mph).  
WARNING  
Do not rely on the traction control  
system as a substitute for safe driving:  
The traction control system (TCS)  
cannot compensate for unsafe and  
reckless driving, excessive speed,  
tailgating (following another vehicle  
too closely), and hydroplaning  
(reduced tire friction and road  
contact because of water on the road  
surface). You can still have an  
accident.  
Use snow tires or tire chains and drive  
at reduced speeds when roads are  
covered with ice and/or snow:  
Driving without proper traction  
devices on snow and/or ice-covered  
roads is dangerous. The traction  
control system (TCS) alone cannot  
provide adequate traction and you  
could still have an accident.  
5-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page185  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (185,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
qTCS OFF Indicator Light  
If, because of hard driving, TSC intervenes  
frequently, TSC may then have to shut down to  
protect the brakes from overheating, then after  
the brakes have cooled down the control  
returns to normal operations. So don't drive  
the car to its handling limits thinking TSC will  
save you from yourself.  
This indicator light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
qTCS/DSC Indicator Light  
It also illuminates when the TCS OFF  
switch is pressed and TCS is switched off.  
Refer to TCS OFF Switch on page 5-24.  
If the light remains illuminated and the  
TCS is not switched off, take your vehicle  
to an Authorized Mazda Dealer. The  
dynamic stability control may have a  
malfunction.  
This indicator light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position. If the TCS or DSC is  
operating, the indicator light flashes.  
NOTE  
If the TCS/DSC indicator light and the TCS  
OFF indicator light remain illuminated even  
after turning the ignition switch to the ON  
position, attempt the procedure again. If this  
still does not work, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
If the light stays on, the TCS, DSC or the  
brake assist system may have a  
malfunction and they may not operate  
correctly. Take your vehicle to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
NOTE  
l
In addition to the indicator light flashing, a  
slight lugging sound will come from the  
engine. This indicates that the TCS is  
operating properly.  
l
On slippery surfaces, such as fresh snow, it  
will be impossible to achieve high rpm  
when the TCS is on.  
5-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page186  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (186,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
l
qTCS OFF Switch  
When TCS is on and you attempt to free the  
vehicle when it is stuck, or drive it out of  
freshly fallen snow, the TCS will activate.  
Depressing the accelerator will not  
increase engine power and freeing the  
vehicle may be difficult. When this happens,  
turn off the TCS.  
If the vehicle speed is less than 15 km/h  
(9 mph), press the TCS OFF switch to  
turn off the TCS. The TCS OFF indicator  
light will illuminate.  
l
If the TCS is off when the engine is turned  
off, it automatically activates when the  
ignition switch is turned on.  
l
l
Leaving the TCS on will provide the best  
traction.  
If the TCS is OFF when the vehicle speed is  
more than 15 km/h (9 mph), it  
automatically activates and the TCS OFF  
indicator light will turn off.  
l
If the TCS OFF switch is pressed and held  
for 10 seconds or more, the TCS OFF  
switch malfunction detection function  
operates and the TCS and DSC/RSC system  
activates automatically. The TCS OFF  
indicator light turns off while the TCS  
system is operative.  
Press the switch again to turn the TCS  
back on. The TCS OFF indicator light  
will go out. If the vehicle speed is more  
than 15 km/h (9 mph), the TCS OFF  
indicator light will not illuminate even if  
the switch is pressed.  
5-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page187  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (187,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Dynamic Stability Control  
(DSC)/Roll Stability  
Control (RSC)  
WARNING  
Do not rely on the dynamic stability  
control as a substitute for safe driving:  
The dynamic stability control (DSC)/  
Roll Stability Control (RSC) cannot  
compensate for unsafe and reckless  
driving, excessive speed, tailgating  
(following another vehicle too  
The Dynamic Stability Control (DSC)  
automatically controls braking and engine  
torque in conjunction with systems such  
as ABS and TCS to help control side slip  
when driving on slippery surfaces or  
during sudden or evasive maneuvering,  
enhancing vehicle safety.  
closely), and hydroplaning (reduced  
tire friction and road contact because  
of water on the road surface). You  
can still have an accident.  
The Roll Stability Control (RSC)  
automatically controls braking and engine  
torque in conjunction with systems such  
as ABS and TCS to help control rolling  
when cornering at a higher speed or  
during sudden or evasive maneuvering,  
enhancing vehicle safety.  
When driving under bad road  
conditions, lower the vehicle speed and  
drive carefully:  
Reckless driving and excessive speed  
under any road conditions is  
dangerous as it reduces vehicle  
stability and operability which could  
result in an accident.  
Refer to ABS (page 5-7) and TCS (page  
DSC/RSC operation is possible at speeds  
greater than 15 km/h (9 mph).  
5-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page188  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (188,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
CAUTION  
Ø The DSC/RSC may not operate  
correctly unless the following are  
observed:  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Use tires of the correct size  
specified for your Mazda on all  
four wheels.  
Use tires of the same  
manufacturer, brand and tread  
pattern on all four wheels.  
Do not mix worn tires.  
Ø The DSC/RSC may not operate  
correctly when tire chains are used  
or a temporary spare tire is  
installed because the tire diameter  
changes.  
Ø Do not modify the suspension,  
steering wheel, and tires. It may  
affect the DSC/RSC.  
Ø Do not install non-genuine  
speakers since their vibration may  
affect the DSC/RSC sensors.  
qTCS/DSC/RSC Indicator Light  
This indicator light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position. If the TCS or DSC/  
RSC is operating, the indicator light  
flashes.  
If the light stays on, the TCS or DSC/RSC  
may have a malfunction and they may not  
operate correctly. Take your vehicle to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
5-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page189  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (189,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Tire Pressure Monitoring Systemí  
The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) monitors the pressure for each tire.  
If tire pressure is too low in one or more tires, the system will inform the driver via the  
warning light in the instrument panel and by the warning beep sound.  
The tire pressure sensors installed on each wheel send tire pressure data by radio signal to  
the receiver unit in the vehicle.  
Tire pressure sensors  
NOTE  
When the ambient temperature is low due to seasonal changes, tire temperatures are also lower.  
When the tire temperature decreases, the air pressure decreases as well. The TPMS warning light  
may illuminate more frequently. Visually inspect the tires daily before driving, and check tire  
pressures monthly with a tire pressure gauge. When checking tire pressures, use of a digital tire  
pressure gauge is recommended.  
TPMS does not alleviate your need to check the pressure and condition of all four tires  
regularly.  
íSome models.  
5-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page190  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (190,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
CAUTION  
Ø Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold  
and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer  
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a  
different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation  
pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those  
tires.)  
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure  
monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one  
or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire  
pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as  
possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-  
inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation  
also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's  
handling and stopping ability.  
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it  
is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-  
inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire  
pressure telltale.  
Ø Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to  
indicate when the system is not operating properly.  
The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale.  
When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately  
one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will  
continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.  
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to  
detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a  
variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or  
wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always  
check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on  
your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow  
the TPMS to continue to function properly.  
Ø To avoid false readings, the system samples for a little while before indicating a  
problem. As a result it will not instantaneously register a rapid tire deflation or  
blow out.  
NOTE  
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two  
conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any  
interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
5-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page191  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (191,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
qTire Pressure Monitoring System  
WARNING  
Warning Light  
If the tire pressure monitoring system  
warning light illuminates or flashes, or  
the tire pressure warning beep sound is  
heard, decrease vehicle speed  
immediately and avoid sudden  
maneuvering and braking:  
If the tire pressure monitoring system  
warning light illuminates or flashes,  
or the tire pressure warning beep  
sound is heard, it is dangerous to  
drive the vehicle at high speeds, or  
perform sudden maneuvering or  
braking. Vehicle drivability could  
worsen and result in an accident.  
To determine if you have a slow leak  
or a flat, pull over to a safe position  
where you can check the visual  
condition of the tire and determine if  
you have enough air to proceed to a  
place where air may be added and  
the system monitored again, an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer or a tire  
repair station.  
This warning light illuminates for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
Thereafter, the warning light illuminates  
and a beep is heard when tire pressure is  
too low in one or more tires, and flashes  
when there is a system malfunction.  
Do not ignore the TPMS Warning Light:  
Ignoring the TPMS warning light is  
dangerous, even if you know why it is  
illuminated. Have the problem taken  
care of as soon as possible before it  
develops into a more serious  
situation that could lead to tire  
failure and a dangerous accident.  
Warning light illuminates/Warning  
beep sounds  
When the warning light illuminates, and  
the warning beep sound is heard (about 3  
seconds), tire pressure is too low in one or  
more tires.  
5-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page192  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (192,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Adjust the tire pressure to the correct tire  
pressure. Refer to the specification charts  
(page 10-6).  
NOTE  
l
Perform tire pressure adjustment when the  
tires are cold. Tire pressure will vary  
according to the tire temperature, therefore  
let the vehicle stand for 1 hour or only drive  
it 1.6 km (1 mile) or less before adjusting  
the tire pressures. When pressure is  
adjusted on hot tires to the cold inflation  
pressure, the TPMS warning light/beep may  
turn on after the tires cool and pressure  
drops below specification.  
CAUTION  
When replacing/repairing the tires or  
wheels or both, have the work done  
by an Authorized Mazda Dealer, or  
the tire pressure sensors may be  
damaged.  
Also, an illuminated TPMS warning light,  
resulting from the tire air pressure dropping  
due to cold ambient temperature, may go  
out if the ambient temperature rises. In this  
case, it will also be necessary to adjust the  
tire air pressures. If the TPMS warning  
light illuminates due to a drop in tire air  
pressure, make sure to check and adjust the  
tire air pressures.  
l
After adjusting the tire air pressures, it may  
require some time for the TPMS warning  
light to go out. If the TPMS warning light  
remains illuminated, drive the vehicle at a  
speed of at least 25 km/h (16 mph) for 10  
minutes, and then verify that it goes out.  
Tires can loose a little air quite naturally  
over time and the TPMS cannot tell if the  
tires are getting too soft over time or you  
have a flat. However, when you find one  
low tire in a set of four - that is an  
l
indication of trouble; you should have  
someone drive the vehicle slowly forward  
so you can inspect any low tire for cuts and  
any metal sticking through tread or  
sidewall. Put a few drops of water in the  
valve stem to see if it bubbles indicating a  
bad valve. Leaks need to be addressed by  
more than simply refilling the trouble tire as  
leaks are dangerous - take it to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer which has all the  
equipment to fix tires, TPMS systems and  
order the best replacement tire for your  
vehicle.  
5-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page193  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (193,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
If the warning light illuminates again even  
after the tire pressures are adjusted, there  
may be a tire puncture. Replace the  
punctured tire with the temporary spare  
tire (page 7-8).  
qTires and Wheels  
CAUTION  
When inspecting or adjusting the tire  
air pressures, do not apply excessive  
force to the stem part of the wheel  
unit. The stem part could be  
damaged.  
NOTE  
A tire pressure sensor is not installed to the  
temporary spare tire. The warning light will  
flash continuously while the temporary spare  
tire is being used.  
Changing tires and wheels  
The following procedure allows the  
TPMS to recognize a tire pressure sensor's  
unique ID signal code whenever tires or  
wheels are changed, such as changing to  
and from winter tires.  
Warning light flashes  
When the warning light flashes, there may  
be a system malfunction. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
NOTE  
qSystem Error Activation  
Each tire pressure sensor has a unique ID  
signal code. The signal code must be  
registered with the TPMS before it can work.  
The easiest way to do it is to have an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer change your tire and  
complete ID signal code registration.  
When the TPMS warning light flashes,  
there may be a system malfunction.  
Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
A system error activation may occur in  
the following cases:  
l
When there is equipment or a device  
When having tires changed at an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer  
near the vehicle using the same radio  
frequency as that of the tire pressure  
sensors.  
Tire pressure sensor ID signal code  
registration is completed when an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer changes your  
vehicle's tires.  
l
When using the following devices in  
the vehicle that may cause radio  
interference with the receiver unit.  
l
A digital device such as a personal  
When changing tires yourself  
computer.  
A current converter device such as a  
l
If you or someone else changes tires, you  
or someone else can also undertake the  
steps for the TPMS to complete the ID  
signal code registration.  
DC-AC converter.  
When excess snow or ice adheres to  
l
the vehicle, especially around the  
wheels.  
When the tire pressure sensor batteries  
1. After tires have been changed, turn the  
ignition switch to the ON position, then  
turn it back to the ACC or LOCK  
position.  
l
are exhausted.  
When using a wheel with no tire  
l
pressure sensor installed.  
When using tires with steel wire  
l
2. Wait for about 15 minutes.  
reinforcement in the side walls.  
When using tire chains.  
l
5-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page194  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (194,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
l
3. After about 15 minutes, drive the  
vehicle at a speed of at least 25 km/h  
(16 mph) for 10 minutes and the tire  
pressure sensor ID signal code will be  
registered automatically.  
A new tire pressure sensor is installed  
to a new wheel.  
NOTE  
l
The tire pressure sensor ID signal code  
must be registered when a new tire pressure  
sensor is purchased. For purchase of a tire  
pressure sensor and registration of the tire  
pressure sensor ID signal code, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
When reinstalling a previously removed tire  
pressure sensor to a wheel, replace the  
grommet (seal between valve body/sensor  
and wheel) for the tire pressure sensor.  
NOTE  
If the vehicle is driven within about 15 minutes  
of changing tires, the tire pressure monitoring  
system warning light will flash because the  
sensor ID signal code would not have been  
registered. If this happens, park the vehicle for  
about 15 minutes, after which the sensor ID  
signal code will register upon driving the  
vehicle for 10 minutes.  
l
Replacing tires and wheels  
CAUTION  
Ø When replacing/repairing the tires  
or wheels or both, have the work  
done by an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer, or the tire pressure sensors  
may be damaged.  
Ø The wheels equipped on your  
Mazda are specially designed for  
installation of the tire pressure  
sensors. Do not use non-genuine  
wheels, otherwise it may not be  
possible to install the tire pressure  
sensors.  
Be sure to have the tire pressure sensors  
installed whenever tires or wheels are  
replaced.  
When having a tire or wheel or both  
replaced, the following types of tire  
pressure sensor installations are possible.  
l
The tire pressure sensor is removed  
from the old wheel and installed to the  
new one.  
The same tire pressure sensor is used  
l
with the same wheel. Only the tire is  
replaced.  
5-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page196  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (196,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Instrument Cluster and Indicators  
qSpeedometer  
The speedometer indicates the speed of  
the vehicle.  
qOdometer, Trip Meter and Trip  
Odometer  
Meter Selector  
The display mode can be changed  
between trip meter A and trip meter B by  
pressing the selector while one of them is  
displayed. The selected mode will be  
displayed.  
Trip meter A  
Odometer  
Press the selector  
Selector  
Trip meter B  
Press the selector  
Odometer  
Odometer  
Trip meter  
The odometer records the total distance  
the vehicle has been driven.  
Trip meter  
The trip meter can record the total  
distance of two trips. One is recorded in  
trip meter A, and the other is recorded in  
trip meter B.  
For instance, trip meter A can record the  
distance from the point of origin, and trip  
meter B can record the distance from  
where the fuel tank is filled.  
When trip meter A is selected, pressing  
the selector again within one second will  
change to trip meter B mode.  
When trip meter A is selected, TRIP A  
will be displayed. When trip meter B is  
selected, TRIP B will be displayed.  
5-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page197  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (197,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Instrument Cluster and Indicators  
The trip meter records the total distance  
the vehicle is driven until the meter is  
again reset. Return it to 0.0by holding  
the selector depressed for more than 1  
second. Use this meter to measure trip  
distances and to compute fuel  
q
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge  
The engine coolant temperature gauge  
shows the temperature of the engine  
coolant.  
consumption.  
NOTE  
l
Only the trip meters record tenths of  
kilometers (miles).  
l
The trip record will be erased when:  
l
The power supply is interrupted (blown  
fuse or the battery is disconnected).  
The vehicle is driven over 999.9 km  
l
(mile).  
qTachometer  
If the needle is near H, it indicates  
overheating.  
The tachometer shows engine speed in  
thousands of revolutions per minute  
(rpm).  
CAUTION  
Driving with an overheated engine  
can cause serious engine damage  
(page 7-14).  
Red zone  
CAUTION  
Don't run the engine with the  
tachometer needle in the RED ZONE.  
This may cause severe engine  
damage.  
5-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page198  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (198,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Instrument Cluster and Indicators  
qFuel Gauge  
Dim  
The fuel gauge shows approximately how  
much fuel is in the tank. We recommend  
keeping the tank over 1/4 full. When the  
low fuel warning light illuminates or  
when the needle is near E, refuel as soon  
as possible.  
Bright  
Canceling the illumination dimmer  
(Black-out meter and dashboard  
illuminations)  
Low fuel  
warning light  
When the headlight switch is in the or  
position, the illumination of the  
instrument cluster and the information  
display dims.  
NOTE  
The direction of the arrow (  
the low fuel warning light indicates that the  
fuel-filler lid is on the left side of the vehicle.  
When driving on snowy or foggy roads,  
or in other situations when the instrument  
cluster or information display's visibility  
is reduced due to glare from surrounding  
brightness, cancel the illumination  
dimmer and increase the illumination  
intensity.  
) shown next to  
qDashboard Illumination  
Rotate the knob to adjust the brightness of  
the instrument cluster and other  
illuminations in the dashboard.  
To cancel the illumination dimmer, press  
the dashboard illumination knob.  
NOTE  
l
The brightness of dashboard illuminations  
NOTE  
can be adjusted when the headlight switch  
If the dashboard illumination knob is kept at  
the illumination dimmer cancel position, the  
instrument cluster and the information display  
will not dim when the headlight switch is  
is in the  
or  
position.  
l
l
When the dashboard illumination  
brightness cannot be adjusted any more, a  
beep sound will be heard.  
turned to the  
or  
position again.  
(Black-out meter)  
The brightness of the instrument cluster  
illumination can be adjusted when the  
headlight switch is in any position.  
5-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page199  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (199,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
Warning/Indicator Lights  
Warning/Indicator lights will appear in any of the highlighted areas  
Signal  
Warning/Indicator Lights  
Brake System Warning Light  
Page  
Charging System Warning Light  
Engine Oil Pressure Warning Light  
Check Engine Light  
Powertrain Malfunction/Reduced Power Warning Light  
ABS Warning Light  
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt Pretensioner System Warning Light  
5-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page200  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (200,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
Signal  
Warning/Indicator Lights  
Page  
Low Fuel Warning Light  
Check Fuel Cap Warning Light  
Seat Belt Warning Light/Beep  
Door-Ajar Warning Light  
Low Washer Fluid Level Warning Light  
Automatic Transaxle Warning Light  
AWD Warning Light  
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Warning Light  
KEY Warning Light (Red)/KEY Indicator Light (Green)  
Security Indicator Light  
Headlight High-Beam Indicator Light  
Shift Position Indicator Light  
TCS/DSC Indicator Light  
TCS OFF Indicator Light  
Cruise Main Indicator Light (Amber)/Cruise Set Indicator Light (Green)  
Light-On Indicator Light  
5-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page201  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (201,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
Signal  
Warning/Indicator Lights  
Turn Signal/Hazard Warning Indicator Lights  
Page  
Even if the light goes out have your brake  
system inspected as soon as possible by  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
qBrake System Warning Light  
NOTE  
Having to add brake fluid is sometimes an  
indicator of leakage. Consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible even if the  
brake light is no longer illuminated.  
This warning has the following functions:  
WARNING  
Parking brake warning  
Do not drive with the brake system  
warning light illuminated. Contact an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer to have the  
brakes inspected as soon as possible:  
Driving with the brake system  
The light comes on when the parking  
brake is applied with the ignition switch  
in the START or ON position. It goes off  
when the parking brake is fully released.  
warning light illuminated is  
Low brake fluid level warning  
dangerous. It indicates that your  
brakes may not work at all or that  
they could completely fail at any  
time. If this light remains  
If the light stays on after the parking brake  
is fully released, you may have a brake  
problem.  
illuminated, after checking that the  
parking brake is fully released, have  
the brakes inspected immediately.  
Drive to the side of the road and park off  
the right-of-way.  
You may notice that the pedal is harder to  
push or that it may go closer to the floor.  
In either case, it will take longer to stop  
the vehicle.  
qABS Warning Light  
1. With the engine stopped, check the  
brake fluid level immediately and add  
fluid as required (page 8-23).  
2. After adding fluid, check the light  
again.  
The warning light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
If the warning light remains on, or if the  
brakes do not operate properly, do not  
drive the vehicle. Have it towed to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
5-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page202  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (202,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
If the ABS warning light stays on while  
WARNING  
you're driving, the ABS control unit has  
detected a system malfunction. If this  
occurs, your brakes will function normally  
as if the vehicle had no ABS.  
Should this happen, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
Do not drive with both the ABS warning  
light and brake warning light  
illuminated. Have the vehicle towed to  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer to have  
the brakes inspected as soon as  
possible:  
NOTE  
Driving when the brake system  
warning light and ABS warning light  
are illuminated at the same time is  
dangerous.  
When both lights are illuminated, the  
rear wheels could lock more quickly  
in an emergency stop than under  
normal circumstances.  
When the engine is jump-started to charge the  
battery, uneven rpm occurs and the ABS  
warning light comes on. This is due to a weak  
battery, not a malfunction.  
Recharge the battery.  
qElectronic Brake Force  
Distribution System Warning  
qCharging System Warning Light  
If the electronic brake force distribution  
control unit determines that some  
components are operating incorrectly, the  
control unit may turn the brake system  
warning light and the ABS warning light  
on at the same time. The problem is likely  
to be an electronic brake force distribution  
system.  
This warning light illuminates when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position and turns off when the engine is  
started.  
If the warning light illuminates while  
driving, it indicates a malfunction of the  
alternator or of the charging system.  
Drive to the side of the road and park off  
the right-of-way. Consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
CAUTION  
Don't continue driving when the  
charging system warning light is  
illuminated because the engine could  
stop unexpectedly.  
5-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page203  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (203,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
q
Engine Oil Pressure Warning Light  
qCheck Engine Light  
This warning light illuminates when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position and turns off when the engine is  
started.  
This indicator light illuminates when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position and goes off when the engine is  
started.  
This warning light indicates low engine  
oil pressure.  
If this light comes on while driving, the  
vehicle may have a problem. It is  
important to note the driving conditions  
when the light came on and consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
If the light illuminates while driving:  
1. Drive to the side of the road and park  
off the right-of-way on level ground.  
The check engine light may come on in  
the following cases:  
2. Turn off the engine and wait 5 minutes  
for the oil to drain back into the oil  
pan.  
l
The fuel tank level being very low or  
approaching empty.  
The engine's electrical system has a  
l
3. Inspect the engine oil level (page 8-20).  
If it's low, add oil.  
problem.  
The emission control system has a  
l
problem.  
The fuel-filler cap is missing or not  
tightened securely.  
4. Start the engine and check the warning  
light.  
l
If the light remains illuminated even after  
you add oil, stop the engine immediately  
and have your vehicle towed to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
If the check engine light remains on or  
flashes continuously, do not drive at high  
speeds and consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer as soon as possible.  
CAUTION  
Don't run the engine if oil pressure is  
low. It could result in extensive  
engine damage.  
5-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page204  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (204,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
qPowertrain Malfunction/Reduced  
q
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt  
Pretensioner System Warning Light  
Power Warning Light  
This warning light illuminates for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
If the air bag/front seat belt pretensioner  
system is working properly, the warning  
light illuminates when the ignition switch  
is turned to the ON position or after the  
engine is cranked. The warning light turns  
off after a specified period of time.  
If this light comes on while driving, the  
vehicle may have a problem. It is  
important to note the driving conditions  
when the light came on and consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
A system malfunction is indicated if the  
warning light constantly flashes,  
constantly illuminates or does not  
illuminate at all when the ignition switch  
is turned to the ON position. If any of  
these occur, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer as soon as possible. The system  
may not work in an accident.  
The powertrain malfunction/reduced  
power warning light may come on in the  
following cases:  
l
The engine's electrical system has a  
problem.  
The emission control system has a  
l
WARNING  
problem.  
Never tamper with the air bag/  
pretensioner systems and always have  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer perform  
all servicing and repairs:  
If the powertrain malfunction/reduced  
power warning light remains on, do not  
drive at high speeds and consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as  
possible.  
Self-servicing or tampering with the  
systems is dangerous. An air bag/  
pretensioner could accidentally  
activate or become disabled causing  
serious injury or death.  
5-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page205  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (205,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
qLow Fuel Warning Light  
qSeat Belt Warning Light/Beep  
Low fuel  
warning light  
This warning light in the fuel gauge  
signals that the fuel tank will soon be  
empty.  
The seat belt warning light illuminates  
and a beep sound will be heard if the  
driver's seat belt is not fastened when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position.  
Refuel as soon as possible.  
qCheck Fuel Cap Warning Light  
Conditions of operation  
Condition  
Result  
The driver's seat belt is not The warning light  
fastened when the ignition flashes and a beep  
switch is turned to the ON sound will be heard  
position.  
for about 6 seconds.  
The driver's seat belt is  
fastened while the warning  
light and the beep sound are  
activated.  
The warning light  
turns off and the beep  
sound stops.  
This warning light illuminates for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
The driver's seat belt is  
fastened before the ignition not illuminate and the  
switch is turned to the ON beep sound will not be  
The warning light will  
If the check fuel cap warning light  
position.  
heard.  
illuminates while driving, the fuel-filler  
cap may not be installed properly. Stop  
the engine and reinstall the fuel-filler cap.  
Refer to the fuel-filler cap on page 3-42.  
Belt minder  
NOTE  
The belt minder can be deactivated. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer to deactivate and  
restore the seat belt minder.  
5-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page206  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (206,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
Driver seated/Front passenger not  
seated  
Driver seated/Front passenger seated  
The seat belt warning function reminds  
the front passenger to fasten the seat belt  
according to the chart below.  
The belt minder is a supplemental  
warning to the seat belt warning function.  
If the driver's seat belt is not fastened  
when the ignition switch is turned to the  
ON position, the warning light/beep  
operates to give you further reminders  
according to the chart below.  
Vehicle speed  
Between 0 20  
km/h  
(0 12 mph)  
20 km/h  
(12 mph) or  
more  
Condition  
Seat belt  
(Driver)  
Vehicle speed  
Seat belt  
(Passenger)  
Between 0 20  
km/h  
(0 12 mph)  
20 km/h  
(12 mph) or  
more  
Condition  
Indicator  
Beep  
Seat belt  
Indicator  
Beep  
: Fastened  
: Unfastened  
: Illuminated  
: Flashing  
: Beep  
: Fastened  
: Unfastened  
: Illuminated  
: Flashing  
: Beep  
Once the beep sound is heard, it continues  
sounding even if the vehicle speed lowers  
to 20 km/h (12 mph) or less until the  
seatbelt is fastened or the beep sound  
period has passed.  
Once the beep sound is heard, it continues  
sounding even if the vehicle speed lowers  
to 20 km/h (12 mph) or less until the  
seatbelt is fastened or the beep sound  
period has passed.  
NOTE  
l
To allow the front passenger seat weight  
sensor to function properly, do not place  
and sit on an additional seat cushion on the  
front passenger seat. The sensor may not  
function properly because the additional  
seat cushion could cause sensor  
interference.  
l
Placing packages, luggage, pets or other  
items on the front passenger seat may cause  
the front passenger seat belt warning  
function to operate depending on the  
weight of the item.  
5-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page207  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (207,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
qDoor-Ajar Warning Light  
CAUTION  
If the automatic transaxle warning  
light illuminates, the transaxle has  
an electrical problem. Continuing to  
drive your Mazda in this condition  
could cause damage to your  
transaxle. Consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
This warning light comes on when any  
door isn't securely closed.  
qAWD Warning Light (AWD)  
qLow Washer Fluid Level  
Warning Lightí  
This warning light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
This warning light indicates that little  
washer fluid remains. Add fluid (page  
Thereafter, the warning light will  
illuminate or flash under the following  
conditions:  
l
Illuminates when there is an  
q
Automatic Transaxle Warning Light  
abnormality with the AWD system.  
Flashes when the differential oil  
l
temperature is abnormally high.  
Flashes when there are continually  
l
large differences between front and rear  
wheel rotation, such as when trying to  
pull away from an icy surface.  
If the AWD warning light illuminates:  
This warning light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
If the AWD warning light illuminates,  
contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
The light illuminates when the transaxle  
has a problem.  
If the AWD warning light flashes:  
Park the vehicle in a safe place. After a  
few moments; if the warning light stops  
flashing, you can resume driving. If the  
light does not stop flashing, contact an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
íSome models.  
5-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page208  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (208,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
WARNING  
Never spin a wheel that is off the  
ground:  
WARNING  
If the tire pressure monitoring system  
warning light illuminates or flashes, or  
the tire pressure warning beep sound is  
heard, decrease vehicle speed  
immediately and avoid sudden  
maneuvering and braking:  
Spinning a wheel that is off the  
ground as a result of the vehicle  
being stuck or in a ditch is  
dangerous. The drive assembly could  
be seriously damaged which could  
lead to an accident or could even  
lead to overheating, oil leakage, and  
a fire.  
If the tire pressure monitoring system  
warning light illuminates or flashes,  
or the tire pressure warning beep  
sound is heard, it is dangerous to  
drive the vehicle at high speeds, or  
perform sudden maneuvering or  
braking. Vehicle drivability could  
worsen and result in an accident.  
To determine if you have a slow leak  
or a flat, pull over to a safe position  
where you can check the visual  
condition of the tire and determine if  
you have enough air to proceed to a  
place where air may be added and  
the system monitored again, an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer or a tire  
repair station.  
qTire Pressure Monitoring System  
(TPMS) Warning Lightí  
This warning light illuminates for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
Do not ignore the TPMS Warning Light:  
Ignoring the TPMS warning light is  
dangerous, even if you know why it is  
illuminated. Have the problem taken  
care of as soon as possible before it  
develops into a more serious  
Thereafter, the warning light illuminates  
when tire pressure is too low in one or  
more tires, and flashes when there is a  
system malfunction.  
situation that could lead to tire  
failure and a dangerous accident.  
Warning light illuminates/Warning  
beep sounds  
When the warning light illuminates, and  
the warning beep sound is heard (about 3  
seconds), tire pressure is too low in one or  
more tires.  
5-46  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page209  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (209,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
Adjust the tire pressure to the correct tire  
pressure. Refer to the specification charts  
(page 10-6).  
NOTE  
l
Perform tire pressure adjustment when the  
tires are cold. Tire pressure will vary  
according to the tire temperature, therefore  
let the vehicle stand for 1 hour or only drive  
it 1.6 km (1 mile) or less before adjusting  
the tire pressures. When pressure is  
adjusted on hot tires to the cold inflation  
pressure, the TPMS warning light/beep may  
turn on after the tires cool and pressure  
drops below specification.  
CAUTION  
When replacing/repairing the tires or  
wheels or both, have the work done  
by an Authorized Mazda Dealer, or  
the tire pressure sensors may be  
damaged.  
Also, an illuminated TPMS warning light,  
resulting from the tire air pressure dropping  
due to cold ambient temperature, may go  
out if the ambient temperature rises. In this  
case, it will also be necessary to adjust the  
tire air pressures. If the TPMS warning  
light illuminates due to a drop in tire air  
pressure, make sure to check and adjust the  
tire air pressures.  
l
After adjusting the tire air pressures, it may  
require some time for the TPMS warning  
light to go out. If the TPMS warning light  
remains illuminated, drive the vehicle at a  
speed of at least 25 km/h (16 mph) for 10  
minutes, and then verify that it goes out.  
Tires can loose a little air quite naturally  
over time and the TPMS cannot tell if the  
tires are getting too soft over time or you  
have a flat. However, when you find one  
low tire in a set of four - that is an  
l
indication of trouble; you should have  
someone drive the vehicle slowly forward  
so you can inspect any low tire for cuts and  
any metal sticking through tread or  
sidewall. Put a few drops of water in the  
valve stem to see if it bubbles indicating a  
bad valve. Leaks need to be addressed by  
more than simply refilling the trouble tire as  
leaks are dangerous - take it to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer which has all the  
equipment to fix tires, TPMS systems and  
order the best replacement tire for your  
vehicle.  
5-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page210  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (210,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
If the warning light illuminates again even  
WARNING  
Do not drive the vehicle with the KEY  
warning light illuminated:  
after the tire pressures are adjusted, there  
may be a tire puncture. Replace the  
punctured tire with the temporary spare  
tire (page 7-8).  
If the KEY warning light remains  
illuminated, do not continue to drive  
using the advanced key system. Park  
the vehicle in a safe place and use  
the auxiliary key to continue driving  
the vehicle. Have the vehicle  
NOTE  
A tire pressure sensor is not installed to the  
temporary spare tire. The warning light will  
flash continuously while the temporary spare  
tire is being used.  
inspected at an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer as soon as possible.  
Warning light flashes  
When the warning light flashes, there may  
be a system malfunction. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
When flashing  
l
Under the following conditions, the  
KEY warning light (red) flashes to  
inform the driver that the start knob  
will not rotate to the ACC position  
even if it is pushed in from the LOCK  
position.  
qKEY Warning Light (Red)/KEY  
Indicator Light (Green) (with  
Advanced Key)  
l
The advanced key battery is dead.  
The advanced key is not within  
l
operational range.  
The advanced key is placed in areas  
l
where it is difficult for the system to  
detect the signal (page 3-7).  
A key from another manufacturer  
l
similar to the advanced key is in the  
operational range.  
This indicator has two colors.  
KEY Warning Light (Red)  
When illuminated  
l
When the ignition switch is turned to  
the ON position, it illuminates  
momentarily and then goes out.  
If any malfunction occurs in the  
l
advanced keyless system, it illuminates  
continuously.  
5-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page211  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (211,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
l
Under the following conditions, the  
KEY warning light (red) will flash  
continuously when the start knob has  
not been returned to the LOCK  
position to notify the driver that the  
advanced key has been removed from  
the vehicle. It will stop flashing when  
the advanced key is back inside the  
vehicle.  
NOTE  
The advanced key can be set so that the KEY  
indicator light (green) does not flash even if  
the battery power is low.  
Refer to Setting Change (Function  
Customization)(page 3-19).  
qSecurity Indicator Light  
l
The start knob has not been returned  
to the LOCK position, the driver's  
door is open, and the advanced key  
is removed from the vehicle.  
l
The start knob has not been returned  
to the LOCK position and all the  
doors are closed after removing the  
advanced key from the vehicle.  
This indicator light starts flashing every 2  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
from the ON to the ACC position and the  
immobilizer system is armed.  
NOTE  
The flashing KEY warning light (red) and the  
beep sound operate simultaneously (page  
The light stops flashing when the ignition  
switch is turned to the ON position with  
the correct ignition key.  
At this time, the immobilizer system is  
disarmed and the light illuminates for  
about 3 seconds and then goes out.  
KEY Indicator Light (Green)  
When illuminated  
When the start knob is pushed in from the  
LOCK position, the system confirms that  
the correct advanced key is inside the  
vehicle, the KEY indicator light (green)  
illuminates, and the start knob can be  
turned to the ACC position (page 3-9).  
If the engine doesn't start with the correct  
ignition key, and the security indicator  
light keeps illuminating or flashing, the  
system may have a malfunction. Consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
When flashing  
When the advanced key battery power is  
low, the KEY indicator light flashes for 30  
seconds after the start knob is turned from  
the ON position to the ACC or LOCK  
position. Replace with a new battery  
before the advanced key becomes  
unusable (page 3-6).  
5-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page212  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (212,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
Gear position indicator  
qHeadlight High-Beam Indicator  
Light  
When the shift lever is in the D or M  
position, the numeral for the selected gear  
displays.  
qTCS/DSC Indicator Light  
This light indicates one of two things:  
l
The high-beam headlights are on.  
The turn signal lever is in the flash-to-  
l
pass position.  
This indicator light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position. If the TCS or DSC/  
RSC is operating, the indicator light  
flashes.  
qShift Position Indicator Light  
This indicates the selected shift position  
when the ignition switch is in the ON  
position.  
If the light stays on, the TCS, DSC or the  
brake assist system may have a  
malfunction and they may not operate  
correctly. Take your vehicle to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Gear position indicator  
5-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page213  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (213,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
Cruise Main Indicator Light (Amber)  
qTCS OFF Indicator Light  
The indicator light illuminates amber  
when the ON/OFF switch pulled up and  
the cruise control system is activated.  
Cruise Set Indicator Light (Green)  
The indicator light illuminates green when  
a cruising speed has been set.  
This indicator light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
qLight-On Indicator Light  
It also illuminates when the TCS OFF  
switch is pressed and TCS is switched off.  
Refer to TCS OFF Switch on page 5-24.  
If the light remains illuminated and the  
TCS is not switched off, take your vehicle  
to an Authorized Mazda Dealer. The  
dynamic stability control may have a  
malfunction.  
This indicator light comes on when the  
exterior lights and dashboard illumination  
are on.  
NOTE  
If the TCS/DSC indicator light and the TCS  
OFF indicator light remain illuminated even  
after turning the ignition switch to the ON  
position, attempt the procedure again. If this  
still does not work, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
qTurn-Signal/Hazard Warning  
Indicator Lights  
qCruise Main Indicator Light  
(Amber)/Cruise Set Indicator  
Light (Green)  
When operating the turn signal lights, the  
left or right turn signal indicator light  
flashes to indicate which turn signal light  
is operating (page 5-56).  
When operating the hazard warning  
lights, both turn signal indicator lights  
flash (page 5-63).  
The indicator light has two colors.  
NOTE  
If an indicator light remains illuminated (does  
not flash) or if it flashes abnormally, one of the  
turn signal bulbs may be burned out.  
5-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page214  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:18 PM  
Black plate (214,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
qIgnition Key Reminder  
Beep Sounds  
If the ignition switch is in the LOCK or  
ACC position with the key inserted, a  
continuous beep sound will be heard  
when the driver's door is opened.  
q
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt  
Pretensioner System Warning Beep  
If a malfunction is detected in both the air  
bag/front seat belt pretensioner system  
and the warning light, a warning beep  
sound will be heard for about 1 minute.  
After that, the one-minute beep will be  
repeated every 30 minutes.  
qLights-On Reminder  
If lights are on and the key is removed  
from the ignition switch, a continuous  
beep sound will be heard when the  
driver's door is opened.  
Have your vehicle inspected at an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as  
possible.  
NOTE  
When the advanced keyless function is used  
and the start knob is in the ACC position, the  
Start Knob Not in LOCK Warning Beep”  
(page 3-16) overrides the lights-on reminder.  
WARNING  
Do not drive the vehicle with the air  
bag/front seat belt pretensioner system  
warning beep sounding:  
qParking Brake Reminder  
Driving the vehicle with the air bag/  
front seat belt pretensioner system  
warning beep sounding is dangerous.  
In a collision, the air bags and the  
front seat belt pretensioner system  
will not deploy and this could result  
in death or serious injury.  
If the parking brake has not been  
completely released and the vehicle is  
driven at about 5 km/h (3 mph) or faster, a  
continuous beep sound will be heard to  
notify the driver that the parking brake  
has not been released.  
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer  
to have the vehicle inspected as soon  
as possible.  
qTire Inflation Pressure Warning  
Beepí  
The warning beep sound will be heard for  
about 3 seconds when there is any  
abnormality in tire inflation pressures  
(page 5-27).  
qSeat Belt Warning Beep  
If the driver's seat belt is not fastened  
when the ignition switch is turned to the  
ON position, a beep sound will be heard  
for about 6 seconds.  
qAdvanced Keyless Warning  
If the driver's seat belt is not fastened and  
the vehicle is driven at a speed faster than  
about 20 km/h (12 mph), a beep sound  
will be heard again for a specified period  
of time.  
Warning indicators for the advanced key,  
such as the advanced key removed from  
vehicle warning, use a beep sound and  
warning/indicator lights in the instrument  
cluster.  
Refer to Seat Belt Warning Light/Beep on  
Refer to Warning and Beep Sounds on  
5-52  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page215  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (215,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
Type B (With AUTO position)  
Lighting Control  
qHeadlights  
Type A (Without AUTO position)  
Turn the headlight switch to turn the  
headlights, other exterior lights and  
dashboard illumination on or off.  
Switch Position  
Turn the headlight switch to turn the  
headlights, other exterior lights and  
dashboard illumination on or off.  
Headlights  
Off  
Off  
Off  
On  
On  
On  
Taillights  
Parking lights  
License lights  
Side-marker  
lights  
Dashboard  
illumination  
Switch Position  
Auto  
Headlights  
Off  
Off  
Off  
On  
On  
On  
Taillights  
Parking lights  
License lights  
Side-marker lights  
Dashboard illumination  
NOTE  
l
If the light switch is left on, the lights will  
automatically switch off approximately 30  
seconds after turning the ignition switch to  
the ACC or LOCK position.  
To prevent discharging the battery, don't  
leave the lights on while the engine is off  
unless safety requires them.  
NOTE  
l
If the light switch is left on, the lights will  
automatically switch off approximately 30  
seconds after turning the ignition switch to  
the ACC or LOCK position.  
l
l
To prevent discharging the battery, don't  
leave the lights on while the engine is off  
unless safety requires them.  
AUTO(Auto-light control)  
When the headlight switch is in the  
AUTO position and the ignition switch is  
in the ON position, the light sensor senses  
the surrounding lightness or darkness and  
automatically turns on or off the  
headlights, other exterior lights and  
dashboard illumination (see chart above).  
5-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page216  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (216,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
NOTE  
l
CAUTION  
The light may not turn off immediately even  
if the surrounding area becomes well-lit  
because the light sensor determines that it  
is nighttime if the surrounding area is  
continuously dark for several minutes such  
as inside long tunnels, traffic jams inside  
tunnels, or in indoor parking lots.  
Ø Do not shade the light sensor by  
adhering a sticker or a label on  
the windshield. Otherwise the light  
sensor will not operate correctly.  
In this case, the light turns off if the light  
switch is turned to the OFF position. (If the  
light switch is turned to the AUTO position  
again after turning it to the OFF position,  
the light turns on/off depending on the  
surrounding brightness.)  
Light sensor  
l
When the headlight switch is in the AUTO  
position and the ignition switch is turned to  
the ACC or LOCK position, the headlights,  
other exterior lights and dashboard  
illumination will turn off.  
Ø The light sensor also works as a  
rain sensor for the auto-wiper  
control. Keep hands and scrapers  
clear of the windshield when the  
ignition switch is in the ON  
l
The timing for turning on the headlights,  
other exterior lights and dashboard  
illumination can be delayed by adjusting  
the sensitivity of the light sensor. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer regarding sensor  
adjustment.  
position as fingers pinched or the  
wipers and wiper blades damaged  
when they activate automatically.  
If you are going to clean the  
windshield, be sure the wipers are  
turned off completely - this is  
particularly important when  
clearing ice and snow - when it is  
particularly tempting to leave the  
engine running.  
Xenon fusion headlight bulbsí  
The low-beam bulbs of the headlights  
have xenon fusion bulbs that produce a  
bright white beam over a wide area.  
WARNING  
Do not replace the xenon fusion bulbs  
yourself:  
Replacing the xenon fusion bulbs  
yourself is dangerous. Because the  
xenon fusion bulbs require high  
voltage, you could receive an electric  
shock if the bulbs are handled  
incorrectly. Consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer when the replacement  
is necessary.  
5-54  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page217  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (217,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
NOTE  
qFlashing the Headlights  
If the headlights flicker, or the brightness  
weakens, the bulb-life may be depleted and a  
replacement is necessary. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
To flash the headlights, pull the lever fully  
toward you. The headlight switch does  
not need to be on, and the lever will return  
to the normal position when released.  
qLights-On Reminder  
If lights are on and the key is removed  
from the ignition switch, a continuous  
beep sound will be heard when the  
driver's door is opened.  
NOTE  
When the advanced keyless function is used  
and the start knob is in the ACC position, the  
Start Knob Not in LOCK Warning Beep”  
(page 3-16) overrides the lights-on reminder.  
qHeadlight Levelingí  
qHeadlight High-Low Beam  
Push the lever forward for high beam.  
Pull back to original position for low  
beam.  
The number of passengers and weight of  
cargo in the luggage compartment change  
the angle of the headlights.  
The headlight leveling switch adjusts this  
angle.  
High beam  
Low beam  
íSome models.  
5-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page218  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (218,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
Select the proper setting from the following chart.  
Turn and Lane-Change  
Signals  
Front seat  
Rear  
seat  
Switch  
Load  
Position  
Driver Passenger  
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
0
0
1
2
3
qTurn Signal  
×
Move the signal lever down (for a left  
turn) or up (for a right turn) to the stop  
position. The signal will self-cancel after  
the turn is completed.  
×
×
×
×: Yes  
: No  
If the indicator light continues to flash  
after a turn, manually return the lever to  
its original position.  
q
Daytime Running Lights (Canada)  
In Canada, vehicles must be driven with  
the headlights on during daytime  
operation.  
Right turn  
Right lane  
change  
For that reason, the daytime running lights  
automatically turn on when the ignition  
switch is turned to the ON position.  
OFF  
Left lane  
change  
NOTE  
The Daytime Running Lights turn off when the  
parking brake is applied.  
Left turn  
Green indicators on the dashboard show  
which signal is working.  
Lane-change signals  
Move the lever slightly toward the  
direction of the change until the  
indicator flashesand hold it there. It  
will return to the off position when  
released.  
NOTE  
If an indicator light stays on without flashing  
or if it flashes abnormally, one of the turn  
signal bulbs may be burned out.  
5-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page219  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (219,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
Fog Lightsí  
Windshield Wipers and  
Washer  
Use this switch to turn on the fog lights.  
They help you to see as well as to be seen.  
The ignition switch must be in the ON  
position.  
To turn the front fog lights on, rotate the  
fog light switch to the  
The headlight switch must be in the  
position to turn on the front fog lights.  
position.  
WARNING  
Use only windshield washer fluid or  
plain water in the reservoir:  
Using radiator antifreeze as washer  
fluid is dangerous. If sprayed on the  
windshield, it will dirty the  
windshield, affect your visibility, and  
could result in an accident.  
Do not use the washer without first  
warming the windshield and never use  
plain tap water:  
Fog light switch  
Using windshield washer fluid  
without anti-freeze protection in  
freezing temperatures is dangerous.  
The washer fluid could freeze on the  
windshield and block your vision. You  
could have an accident.  
To turn them off, rotate the fog light  
switch to the OFF position or turn the  
headlight switch to the or OFF  
position.  
NOTE  
NOTE  
Because heavy ice and snow can jam the wiper  
blades, the wiper motor is protected from  
motor breakdown, overheating and possible  
fire by a circuit breaker. This mechanism will  
automatically stop operation of the blades, but  
only for about 5 minutes.  
If this happens, turn off the wiper switch and  
park off the right-of-way, and remove the snow  
and ice.  
After 5 minutes, turn on the switch and the  
blades should operate normally. If they don't  
resume functioning, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible. Drive to  
the side of the road and park off the right-of-  
way. Wait until the weather clears before trying  
to drive with the wipers inoperative.  
l
The fog lights will turn off when the  
headlights are set at high beam.  
(With auto-light control)  
If the fog light switch is in the ON position  
and the headlight switch is in the AUTO  
position, the front fog lights will be turned  
on when the headlights, the exterior lights  
and dashboard illumination are  
l
automatically turned on.  
íSome models.  
5-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page220  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (220,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
Type B (With AUTO position)  
qWindshield Wipers  
Type A (With INT position)  
Turn the wipers on by pulling the lever  
down.  
MIST Mist  
AUTO Auto control  
1 Low speed  
2 High speed  
Turn the wipers on by pulling the lever  
down.  
MIST Mist  
INT Intermittent  
1 Low speed  
2 High speed  
For a single wiping cycle, push the lever  
up to MIST.forward and release it.  
For a single wiping cycle, push the lever  
up to MIST.forward and release it.  
AUTO (Auto-wiper control)  
When the wiper lever is in the AUTO  
position, the rain sensor senses the  
amount of rainfall on the windshield and  
turns the wiper on or off automatically  
(offintermittentlow speedhigh  
speed).  
Variable-speed intermittent wipers  
Set the lever to INT and choose the  
interval timing by rotating the ring.  
INT ring  
5-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page221  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (221,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
The sensitivity of the rain sensor can be  
adjusted by turning the switch on the  
wiper lever.  
Ø When the wiper lever is in the  
AUTO position and the ignition  
switch is in the ON position, the  
wipers may move automatically in  
the following cases:  
From the center position (normal), turn  
the switch towards (+) for higher  
sensitivity (faster response) or turn the  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
If the windshield above the rain  
sensor is touched.  
If the windshield above the rain  
sensor is wiped with a cloth.  
If the windshield is struck with  
a hand or other object.  
If the rain sensor is struck with  
a hand or other object from  
inside the vehicle.  
_
switch towards ( ) for less sensitivity  
(slower response).  
Less sensitivity  
Switch  
Center  
position  
Keep hands and scrapers clear of  
the windshield when the ignition  
switch is in the ON position as  
fingers pinched or the wipers and  
wiper blades damaged when they  
activate automatically. If you are  
going to clean the windshield, be  
sure the wipers are turned off  
completely - this is particularly  
important when clearing ice and  
snow - when it is particularly  
tempting to leave the engine  
running.  
Higher sensitivity  
CAUTION  
Ø Do not shade the rain sensor by  
adhering a sticker or a label on  
the windshield. Otherwise the rain  
sensor will not operate correctly.  
Light sensor  
5-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page222  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (222,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
NOTE  
If the washer doesn't work, inspect the  
fluid level (page 8-26). If it's OK, consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
l
The auto-wiper control may not operate  
when the rain sensor temperature is about  
_
10 °C(14 °F) or lower, or about 85 °C  
(185 °F) or higher.  
l
If the windshield is coated with water  
repellent, the rain sensor may not be able to  
sense the amount of rainfall correctly and  
auto-wiper control may not operate  
properly.  
l
If dirt or foreign matter (e.g. ice or matter  
containing salt water) adheres to the  
windshield above the rain sensor or if the  
windshield is iced, it could cause the wipers  
to move automatically. However, if the  
wipers cannot remove this ice, dirt or  
foreign matter, the auto-wiper control will  
stop operation. In this case, pull the wiper  
lever to the 1 or 2 position for manual  
operation, or remove the ice, dirt or foreign  
matter by hand to restore the auto-wiper  
operation.  
qWindshield Washer  
Pull the lever toward you and hold it to  
spray washer fluid.  
OFF  
Washer  
NOTE  
With the wiper lever in the OFF or INT  
position, the wipers will operate continuously  
until the lever is released.  
5-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page223  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (223,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
Rear Window Defroster  
Rear Window Wiper and  
Washer  
The rear window defroster clears frost,  
fog, and thin ice from the rear window.  
The ignition switch must be in the ON  
position.  
The ignition switch must be in the ON  
position.  
qRear Window Wiper  
Press the switch to turn on the rear  
window defroster. The rear window  
defroster operates for about 15 minutes  
and turns off automatically.  
The indicator light illuminates during  
operation.  
The defroster operation can be confirmed  
by the indicator in the display.  
To turn off the rear window defroster  
before the 15 minutes has elapsed, press  
the switch again.  
Turn the wiper on by turning the rear  
wiper/washer switch.  
ON Normal  
INT Intermittent  
qRear Window Washer  
Indicator light  
To spray washer fluid, turn the rear wiper/  
washer switch to the  
position. After  
the switch is released, the washer will  
stop.  
If the washer doesn't work, inspect the  
fluid level (page 8-26). If it's OK and the  
washer still doesn't work, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
CAUTION  
Don't use sharp instruments or  
window cleaners with abrasives to  
clean the inside of the rear window  
surface. They may damage the  
defroster grid inside the window.  
5-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page224  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (224,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
NOTE  
Horn  
This defroster is not designed for melting snow.  
If there is an accumulation of snow on the rear  
window, remove it before using the defroster.  
To sound the horn, press the  
the steering wheel.  
mark on  
5-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page225  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (225,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
Hazard Warning Flasher  
The hazard warning lights should always  
be used when you stop on or near a  
roadway in an emergency.  
The hazard warning lights warn other  
drivers that your vehicle is a traffic hazard  
and that they must take extreme caution  
when near it.  
Depress the hazard warning flasher and all  
the turn signals will flash.  
NOTE  
l
The turn signals do not work when the  
hazard warning lights are on.  
l
Check local regulations about the use of  
hazard warning lights while the vehicle is  
being towed to verify that it is not in  
violation of the law.  
5-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page226  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (226,1)  
5-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page227  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (227,1)  
Interior Comfort  
6
Use of various features for drive comfort, including air-conditioning and audio  
system.  
Bluetooth Hands-Freeí .................. 6-103  
Power Outletí ................................ 6-132  
Rear Entertainment Systemí ............ 6-51  
íSome models.  
6-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page228  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (228,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
qParking in Direct Sunlight  
Operating Tips  
If the vehicle has been parked in direct  
sunlight during hot weather, open the  
windows to let warm air escape, then run  
the climate control system.  
qOperating the Climate Control  
System  
Operate the climate control system with  
the engine running.  
qNot Using for a Long Period  
NOTE  
Run the air conditioner about 10 minutes  
at least once a month to keep internal  
parts lubricated.  
To prevent the battery from being discharged,  
do not leave the fan control dial on for a long  
period of time with the ignition switch in the  
ACC position when the engine is not running.  
qCheck the Refrigerant before the  
Weather Gets Hot  
qClearing the Air Inlet  
Have the air conditioner checked before  
the weather gets hot. Lack of refrigerant  
may make the air conditioner less  
efficient. Consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer for refrigerant inspection.  
Clear all obstructions like leaves, snow  
and ice from the hood and the air inlet in  
the cowl grille to improve the system  
efficiency.  
qFoggy Windows  
The air conditioner is filled with  
HFC134a (R134a), a refrigerant that will  
not damage the ozone layer.  
If the air conditioner is low on refrigerant  
or has a malfunction, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
The windows may fog up easily in humid  
weather. Use the climate control system to  
defog the windows.  
To help defog the windows, operate the  
air conditioner to dehumidify the air.  
q
Replacement of the Cabin Air Filter  
NOTE  
The air conditioner may be used along with the  
heater to dehumidify the air.  
If your vehicle is equipped with an air  
filter for the air conditioner, it is necessary  
to change the filter periodically as  
indicated in scheduled maintenance (page  
8-3). Consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer for replacement of the cabin air  
filter.  
qOutside/Recirculated Air Position  
Use the outside air position in normal  
conditions. The recirculated air position  
should be used only when driving on  
dusty roads or for quick cooling of the  
interior.  
6-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page229  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (229,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
qSunlight/Temperature Sensor  
The fully automatic air conditioner  
function measures inside and outside  
temperatures, and the temperature of  
direct sunlight. It then sets temperatures  
inside the passenger compartment  
accordingly.  
CAUTION  
Do not obstruct either sensor,  
otherwise the automatic air  
conditioner will not operate properly.  
Sunlight sensor  
Interior temperature sensor  
6-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page230  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (230,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Vent Operation (Front)  
Open  
Close  
qAdjusting the Vents  
Directing airflow  
You can direct air flow by moving the adjustment knob.  
Opening/closing vents  
The two outside vents can be opened and closed with wheel.  
NOTE  
When using the air conditioner, mist may come out from the vents. This is not a sign of trouble but a  
result of humid air being suddenly cooled.  
6-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page231  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (231,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
qSelecting the Airflow Mode  
Dashboard Vents  
Defroster and Floor Vents  
Defroster Vents  
Dashboard and Floor Vents  
Floor Vents  
6-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page232  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (232,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Fully Automatic Type  
Climate control information is displayed on the information display.  
Information display  
Air intake display  
A/C  
AUTO  
DUAL  
Airflow display  
Mode selector display  
Temperature setting display(driver)  
Ambient temperature /Temperature  
setting display(front passenger)  
Driver temperature control dial  
Fan control dial  
Front passenger temperature control dial  
DUAL switch  
A/C switch  
AUTO switch  
Mode selector  
switch  
OUTSIDE (Ambient  
temperature) switch  
OFF switch  
Air intake selector  
Windshield defroster switch  
6-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page233  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (233,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Temperature control dial  
qControl Switches  
AUTO switch  
Cold  
Hot  
This dial controls temperature. Turn it  
clockwise for hot and counterclockwise  
for cold.  
By pressing the AUTO switch the  
following functions will be automatically  
controlled in accordance with the set  
temperature:  
l
When the DUAL switch is off:  
Turn the driver temperature control dial  
to control the temperature.  
When the DUAL switch is on:  
l
Airflow temperature  
Amount of airflow  
Selection of airflow mode  
Outside/Recirculated air selection  
l
l
Turn the driver or front passenger  
temperature control dial to control the  
temperature.  
l
l
l
Air conditioner operation  
NOTE  
NOTE  
AUTO switch indicator light  
The system changes to the individual operation  
mode (DUAL switch indicator light  
illuminated) by turning the front passenger  
temperature control dial even when the DUAL  
switch is off, which allows individual control  
of the set temperature for the driver and front  
passenger.  
l
When on, it indicates AUTO operation, and  
the system will function automatically.  
l
When off, it indicates the operation of other  
switches such as the mode selector switch,  
fan control dial, A/C switch and windshield  
defroster switch. Other functions will  
continue to operate automatically.  
Fan control dial  
OFF switch  
Fast  
Slow  
The fan has seven speeds. The selected  
speed will be displayed.  
Pressing the OFF switch shuts off the  
climate control system.  
6-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page234  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (234,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Mode selector switch  
Air intake selector  
The desired airflow mode can be selected  
(page 6-5).  
Outside or recirculated air positions can  
be selected. Press the switch to select  
outside/recirculated air positions.  
NOTE  
l
With the airflow mode set to the  
Recirculated air position  
position and the temperature control dial  
set at a medium temperature, heated air is  
directed to the feet and a comparably lower  
air temperature will flow through the  
(indicator light illuminated)  
Use this position when going through  
tunnels, driving in congested traffic (high  
engine exhaust areas) or when quick  
cooling is desired.  
central, left and right vents.  
l
To set the air vent to  
, press the  
Outside air position  
light turned off)  
(indicator  
windshield defroster switch.  
A/C switch  
Use this position for normal conditions  
and defogging.  
WARNING  
Do not use the  
rainy weather:  
Using the  
position in cold or  
position in cold or  
rainy weather is dangerous as it will  
cause the windows to fog up. Your  
vision will be hampered, which could  
lead to a serious accident.  
With the AUTO or fan control dial ON,  
press the A/C switch to turn the air  
conditioning (cooling/dehumidifying  
functions) on or off.  
NOTE  
The air conditioner may not function when the  
outside temperature approaches 0 °C (32 °F).  
(Indicator light remains on even when system  
is off.)  
6-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page235  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (235,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
OUTSIDE (Ambient Temperature)  
switch  
Interconnection mode (indicator light  
turned off)  
The set temperature for the driver and  
front passenger is controlled  
simultaneously.  
NOTE  
l
The set temperature for the front passenger  
changes to that of the driver while in the  
interconnected mode.  
l
is displayed on the information  
Press the OUTSIDE switch to display the  
ambient temperature.  
display while in the individual operation  
mode.  
The system changes to the interconnection  
mode automatically if the windshield  
defroster switch is pressed. The system will  
not change to the individual operation  
mode by pressing the DUAL switch or  
turning the front passenger temperature  
control dial.  
l
NOTE  
l
The displayed ambient temperature may  
vary from the actual ambient temperature  
depending on the surrounding area and  
vehicle conditions.  
l
Press the OUTSIDE switch 3 seconds or  
more to switch the display from Fahrenheit  
to Centigrade or vice versa.  
Windshield defroster switch  
l
Press the OUTSIDE switch again to switch  
the display from ambient temperature to the  
temperature set for the air conditioner.  
DUAL switch  
Press the switch to defrost the windshield  
and front door windows.  
Use the DUAL switch to change the mode  
between the individual operation and  
interconnection modes.  
Individual operation mode (indicator  
light illuminated)  
The set temperature can be controlled  
individually for the driver and front  
passenger.  
6-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page236  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (236,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
qOperation of Automatic Air  
q
Windshield Defrosting and Defogging  
Conditioning  
1. Press the AUTO switch. Selection of  
the airflow mode, air intake selector  
and amount of airflow will be  
automatically controlled.  
Press the windshield defroster switch.  
In this position, the position is  
automatically selected, and the air  
conditioner automatically turns on. The  
air conditioner will directly dehumidify  
the air to the front windshield and side  
windows (page 6-5). Airflow amount will  
be increased.  
2. Use the temperature control dial to  
select a desired temperature.  
Press the DUAL switch or turn the  
front passenger temperature control  
dial to control the set temperature  
individually for the driver and front  
passenger.  
WARNING  
Set the temperature control to the hot  
or warm position when defogging (  
position):  
Using the  
position with the  
Cold  
Hot  
temperature control set to the cold  
position is dangerous as it will cause  
the outside of the windshield to fog  
up. Your vision will be hampered,  
which could lead to a serious  
accident.  
To turn off the system, press the OFF  
switch.  
NOTE  
l
Setting the temperature to the maximum  
high or low will not provide the desired  
temperature at a faster rate.  
l
When selecting heat, the system will restrict  
airflow until it has warmed to prevent cold  
air from blowing out of the vents.  
6-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page237  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (237,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
NOTE  
l
Press the windshield defroster switch to  
change the mode to the interconnection  
mode automatically. The system does not  
change to the individual operation mode by  
pressing the DUAL switch or turning the  
front passenger temperature control dial.  
l
Use the temperature control dial to increase  
the air flow temperature and defog the  
windshield more quickly.  
6-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page238  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (238,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Vent Operation (Rear)  
qAdjusting the Vents  
Directing airflow  
You can direct air flow by moving the adjustment knob.  
NOTE  
When using the air conditioner, mist may come out from the vents. This is not a sign of trouble but a  
result of humid air being suddenly cooled.  
6-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page239  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (239,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
qSelecting the Airflow Mode  
For vehicles with rear full-auto air conditioning, the airflow mode can be selected  
according to the purpose of use.  
Instrument panel Vents  
Floor Vents  
Instrument panel and Floor Vents  
6-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page240  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (240,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Control Panel (Rear)  
Front  
AUTO switch  
REAR CONTROL switch  
Rear  
Fan control dial  
Temperature control dial  
6-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page241  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (241,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
This dial controls temperature. Turn it  
clockwise for hot and counterclockwise  
for cold.  
qControl Switches  
Rear air conditioning on switch  
Fan control dial  
Slow  
Fast  
Press the REAR CONTROL switch to  
operate the rear air conditioning from the  
rear seats.  
The fan has 15 speeds.  
Fan and temperature adjustment from the  
rear control panel is possible only when  
CONTROL ONin the rear control  
panel is illuminated.  
qOperation of Automatic Air  
Conditioning  
Operation from front seats  
NOTE  
1. Turn the front air conditioning on.  
l
When the rear control switch is off,  
operation of the rear airflow amount and  
vent temperature from the rear seats is not  
possible.  
2. Turn the REAR CONTROL switch off.  
(indicator light turned off.)  
NOTE  
l
When the rear control switch is off, the  
l
Setting the temperature to the maximum  
airflow amount and the vent temperature  
for the rear are changed by operating the  
temperature control dial of the front control  
panel.  
high or low will not provide the desired  
temperature at a faster rate.  
l
When selecting heat, the system will restrict  
airflow until it has warmed to prevent cold  
air from blowing out of the vents.  
While in individual operation mode, the  
temperature setting is controlled at the  
driver's temperature.  
When operating the air conditioning from  
l
When the rear control switch is off, the  
mode for the rear is changed according to  
the mode selector switch and the  
temperature control dial of the front control  
panel.  
l
l
Temperature control dial  
the front seats (REAR CONTROL switch is  
off), operation from the rear seats is not  
possible.  
l
Airflow amount and the mode for the rear  
cannot be changed by operating the mode  
selector switch and fan control dial of the  
front control panel. Airflow amount and the  
mode are automatically changed according  
to the temperature control dial.  
Cold  
Hot  
6-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page242  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (242,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Operation from rear seats  
1. Turn the front air conditioning on.  
2. Turn the REAR CONTROL switch on  
in the front control panel. (indicator  
light illuminated.)  
NOTE  
CONTROL ONilluminates in the REAR  
CONTROL panel.  
3. Set the temperature control dial to the  
desired position.  
Cold  
Hot  
NOTE  
The airflow mode may change depending on  
the set temperature.  
4. Set the fan control dial to the desired  
position.  
Slow  
Fast  
6-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page243  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (243,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Antenna  
Operating Tips for Audio  
System  
qRear Window Antenna  
The rear window antenna receives both  
AM and FM signals.  
WARNING  
Do not adjust the audio control  
switches while driving the vehicle:  
Adjusting the audio while driving the  
vehicle is dangerous as it could  
Rear window antenna  
distract your attention from the  
vehicle operation which could lead to  
a serious accident. Always adjust the  
audio while the vehicle is stopped.  
Even if the audio control switches are  
equipped on the steering wheel, learn  
to use the switches without looking  
down at them so that you can keep  
your maximum attention on the road  
while driving the vehicle.  
CAUTION  
When washing the inside rear  
window, use a soft cloth dampened  
in lukewarm water, gently wiping the  
antenna lines.  
Use of glass cleaning products could  
damage the antenna.  
CAUTION  
Ø For the purposes of safe driving,  
adjust the audio volume to a level  
that allows you to hear sounds  
outside of the vehicle.  
Ø Do not install non-genuine  
speakers since their vibration may  
affect the DSC/RSC sensors.  
NOTE  
l
Do not use the audio for long periods of  
time while the engine is off. Otherwise the  
battery could go dead.  
l
If a cellular phone or CB radio is used in  
or near the vehicle, it could cause noise to  
occur from the audio system, however, this  
does not indicate that the system has been  
damaged.  
6-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page244  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (244,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Signals from an FM transmitter are similar  
to beams of light because they do not  
bend around corners, but they do reflect.  
Unlike AM signals, FM signals cannot  
travel beyond the horizon. Therefore, FM  
stations cannot be received at the great  
distances possible with AM reception.  
qRadio Reception  
AM characteristics  
AM signals bend around such things as  
buildings or mountains and bounce off the  
ionosphere. Therefore, they can reach  
longer distances than FM signals. Because  
of this, two stations may sometimes be  
picked up on the same frequency at the  
same time.  
Ionosphere  
FM wave  
AM wave  
Ionosphere  
FM wave  
100—200 km (60—120 miles)  
Atmospheric conditions can also affect  
FM reception. High humidity will cause  
poor reception. However, cloudy days  
may provide better reception than clear  
days.  
Station 1  
Station 2  
FM characteristics  
An FM broadcast range is usually about  
4050 km (2530 miles) from the  
source. Because of extra coding needed to  
break the sound into two channels, stereo  
FM has even less range than monaural  
(non-stereo) FM.  
Multipath noise  
Since FM signals can be reflected by  
obstructions, it is possible to receive both  
the direct signal and the reflected signal at  
the same time. This causes a slight delay  
in reception and may be heard as a broken  
sound or a distortion. This problem may  
also be encountered when in close  
FM Station  
proximity to the transmitter.  
40—50km  
(25—30 miles)  
Reflected wave  
Direct  
6-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page245  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (245,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Flutter/Skip noise  
Strong signal noise  
Signals from an FM transmitter move in  
straight lines and become weak in valleys  
between tall buildings, mountains, and  
other obstacles. When a vehicle passes  
through such an area, the reception  
conditions may change suddenly, resulting  
in annoying noise.  
This occurs very close to a transmitter  
tower. The broadcast signals are  
extremely strong, so the result is noise and  
sound breakup at the radio receiver.  
Station drift noise  
When a vehicle reaches the area of two  
strong stations broadcasting at similar  
frequencies, the original station may be  
temporarily lost and the second station  
picked up. At this time there will be some  
noise from this disturbance.  
Weak signal noise  
In suburban areas, broadcast signals  
become weak because of distance from  
the transmitter. Reception in such fringe  
areas is characterized by sound breakup.  
Station 2  
Station 1  
88.1 MHz  
88.3 MHz  
6-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page246  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (246,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
l
The CD revolves at high speed within  
the unit. Defective (cracked or badly  
bent) CDs should never be used.  
qOperating Tips for CD Player/In-  
Dash CD Changer  
Condensation phenomenon  
Immediately after turning on the heater  
when the vehicle is cold, the CD or  
optical components (prism and lens) in the  
CD player/In-dash CD changer may  
become clouded with condensation. At  
this time, the CD will eject immediately  
when placed in the unit. A clouded CD  
can be corrected simply by wiping it with  
a soft cloth. Clouded optical components  
will clear naturally in about an hour. Wait  
for normal operation to return before  
attempting to use the unit.  
l
Do not use non-conventional discs  
such as heart-shaped, octagonal discs,  
etc. The disc may not eject resulting in  
a malfunction.  
Handling the CD player/In-dash CD  
changer  
The following precautions should be  
observed.  
l
Do not spill any liquid on the audio  
system.  
l
If the memory portion of the CD is  
transparent or translucent, do not use  
the disc.  
l
Do not insert any objects, other than  
CDs, into the slot.  
Transparent  
6-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page247  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (247,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
l
A new CD may have rough edges on  
CD Player  
its inner and outer perimeters. If a disc  
with rough edges is used, proper  
setting will not be possible and the CD  
player/In-dash CD changer will not  
play the CD. In addition, the disc may  
not eject resulting in a malfunction.  
Remove the rough edges in advance by  
using a ball-point pen or pencil as  
shown below. To remove the rough  
edges, rub the side of the pen or pencil  
against the inner and outer perimeter of  
the CD.  
In-dash CD changer  
l
Be sure never to touch the signal  
surface when handling the CDs. Pick  
up a CD by grasping the outer edge or  
the edge of the hole and the outer edge.  
l
When driving over uneven surfaces,  
the sound may jump.  
l
l
Do not stick paper or tape on the CD.  
Avoid scratching the reverse side (the  
side without a label). The disc may not  
eject resulting in a malfunction.  
Dust, finger smudges, and dirt can  
decrease the amount of light reflected  
from the signal surface, thus affecting  
sound quality. If the CD should  
become soiled, gently wipe it with a  
soft cloth from the center of the CD to  
the edge.  
l
The CD player/In-dash CD changer has  
been designed to play CDs bearing the  
identification logo as shown. No other  
discs can be played.  
l
Use discs that have been legitimately  
produced. If illegally-copied discs such  
as pirated discs are used, the system  
may not operate properly.  
6-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page248  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (248,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
l
Do not use record sprays, antistatic  
Handling the In-dash CD changer  
agents, or household spray cleaners.  
Volatile chemicals such as benzine and  
thinner can also damage the surface of  
the CD and must not be used. Anything  
that can damage, warp, or fog plastic  
should never be used to clean CDs.  
Insert discs one by one. If two discs are  
inserted at the same time, the system  
may not operate properly.  
l
This unit may not be able to play  
certain CD-R/CD-RWs made using a  
computer or music CD recorder due to  
disc characteristics, scratches,  
smudges, dirt, etc., or due to dust or  
condensation on the lens inside the  
unit.  
l
l
Storing CDs in the vehicle exposed to  
direct sunlight or high temperature may  
damage the CD-R/CD-RWs, and make  
them unplayable.  
CD-R/CD-RW exceeding 700 MB  
cannot be played.  
l
CD TEXT textual information cannot  
be displayed by audio units other than  
the In-dash CD changer (MP3 file  
support type only). (Only playback is  
possible.)  
The following player can play MP3  
files recorded in CD-ROM, CD-R, and  
CD-RW.  
· In-dash CD changer (MP3 file  
support type only)  
The CD player/In-dash CD changer  
ejects the CD if the CD is inserted  
upside down. Also dirty and/or  
defective CDs may be ejected.  
l
l
This unit may not be able to play  
l
certain discs made using a computer  
due to the application (writing  
software) setting used. (For details,  
consult the store where the application  
was purchased.)  
l
l
It is possible that certain text data, such  
as titles, recorded on a CD-R/CD-RW  
may not be displayed when musical  
data (CD-DA) is playing.  
The period from when a CD-RW is  
inserted to when it begins playing is  
longer than a normal CD or CD-R.  
Completely read the instruction manual  
and cautions for CD-R/CD-RWs.  
Do not use discs with cellophane tape  
adhering, partially peeled off labels, or  
adhesive material exuding from the  
edges of the CD label. Also, do not use  
discs with a commercially-available  
CD-R label affixed. The disc may not  
eject resulting in a malfunction.  
l
An 8 cm (3 in) CD can be played in the  
CD player.  
l
The In-dash CD changer is specially  
made for 12 cm (5 in) CDs.  
An 8 cm (3 in) CD can be played in the  
In-dash CD changer (MP3 file support  
type only) if an 8 cm (3 in) CD adapter  
is used.  
If an 8 cm (3 in) CD adapter is not  
used, the In-dash CD changer (MP3  
file support type only) may be  
damaged. Always use a CD adapter.  
An 8 cm (3 in) CD cannot be played in  
the In-dash CD changer (MP3 file non-  
support type only) even if an 8 cm (3  
in) CD adapter is used.  
l
l
l
Do not insert cleaning discs in the CD  
player/In-dash CD changer.  
Do not insert any disc with a peel-off  
l
seal affixed to it.  
6-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page249  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (249,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
l
If a disc has both music data (CD-DA)  
and MP3 files, playback of the two file  
types differs depending on how the  
disc was recorded.  
Packet written discs cannot be played  
on this unit.  
This unit does not play CDs recorded  
using MP3i (MP3 interactive), MP3  
PRO and RIFF MP3 formats.  
qOperating tips for MP3  
NOTE  
Supply of this product only conveys a license  
for private, non-commercial use and does not  
convey a license nor imply any right to use this  
product in any commercial (i.e. revenue-  
generating) real time broadcasting (terrestrial,  
satellite, cable and/or any other media),  
broadcasting/streaming via the Internet,  
intranets and/or other networks or in other  
electronic content distribution systems, such as  
pay-audio or audio-on-demand applications.  
An independent license for such use is  
required. For details, please visit http://  
www.mp3licensing.com.  
l
l
l
This audio system handles MP3 files  
that have been recorded on CD-R/CD-  
RW/CD-ROMs. Discs that have been  
recorded using the following formats  
can be played:  
l
ISO 9660 level 1  
ISO 9660 level 2  
Joliet extended format  
Romeo extended format  
l
l
l
l
This unit handles MP3 files  
conforming to the MP3 format  
containing both header frames and data  
frames.  
l
This unit can play multi-session  
recorded discs that have up to 99  
sessions.  
This unit can play MP3s with sampling  
l
frequencies of 16/22.05/24/32/44.1/48  
kHz.  
This unit can play MP3 files that have  
l
been recorded in bit rates of 8 kbps to  
320 kbps. Nonetheless, to insure  
enjoyment of music with consistent  
sound quality, it is recommended to use  
discs that have been recorded at a bit  
rate of 128 kbps or more.  
6-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page250  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (250,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
l
l
About folders and files  
MP3 files not conforming to the MP3  
format containing both header frames  
and data frames will be skipped and  
not played.  
This unit will play MP3 files that have  
up to eight levels. However, the more  
levels a disc has, the longer it will take  
to initially start playing. It is  
recommended to record discs with two  
levels or less.  
A single disc with up to 999 files can  
be played and a single folder with up to  
255 files can be played.  
When naming an MP3 file, be sure to  
add an MP3 file extension (.mp3) after  
the file name.  
The maximum number of characters  
that can be used for file names is as  
follows. However, this unit will only  
display up to 30 characters, including  
the file extension (.mp3).  
l
The order of hierarchy for MP3 files  
and folders during playback or other  
functions is from shallow to deep. The  
arrangement and playing order of a  
recorded disc containing MP3 files is  
as follows:  
l
File number  
A numerical file number is assigned  
to each file in a folder in the order of  
hierarchy from shallow to deep.  
l
l
l
l
Folder number  
A numerical folder number is  
assigned to each folder in the order  
of hierarchy from shallow to deep.  
Folder  
No.  
01  
02  
04  
3
Maximum number of  
characters in a file name  
(including a separator .”  
and the three letters of the  
file extension)  
03  
2
ISO9660 level 1  
12*  
31*  
05  
ISO9660 level 2  
4
Joliet extended  
format  
64  
06  
Romeo extended  
format  
128  
5
1
* English one-byte characters (capitalized only) and  
underbar _are available.  
CAUTION  
Level1 Level2 Level3 Level4  
This unit can only play MP3 files that  
have an MP3 file extension (.mp3)  
attached. Do not attach an MP3 file  
extension to any other type file as it  
could cause noise to be emitted or a  
malfunction in the unit.  
l
The folder order is automatically  
assigned and this order cannot be  
optionally set.  
Any folder without an MP3 file will be  
ignored. (It will be skipped and the  
folder number will not be displayed.)  
l
6-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page251  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (251,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
About ID3 Tag display  
Sampling  
l
This unit can only display ID3 Tag  
Refers to the process of encoding analog  
audio data at regular intervals and  
converting it to digital data. The sampling  
rate refers to the number of times a  
sample is taken in one second and is  
expressed in Hz units. Increasing the  
sampling rate improves the sound quality  
but also increases the data size.  
album, track and artist names that have  
been input using Ver1.0/1.1/2.2/2.3  
formats. Any other data that may have  
been input cannot be displayed.  
l
This unit can only display English  
(including numerals) one-byte  
characters. Use only English (including  
numerals) one-byte characters when  
inputting ID3 tags. Two-byte characters  
and some special symbols cannot be  
displayed.  
Bit rate  
Refers to the volume of data per second,  
expressed in bps (bits per second).  
Generally, the larger the number of the  
transfer bit rate when compressing an  
MP3 file, the more information regarding  
musical reproduction it carries, and  
therefore the better the sound quality.  
Specialized glossary  
MP3  
Abbreviation for MPEG Audio Layer 3.  
A technical standard for audio  
compression as decided by an ISO  
(International Organization for  
Standardization) MPEG working group.  
Use of MP3 allows for audio data to be  
compressed to approximately a tenth of  
the source data size.  
Packet writing  
A general term for the method, similar to  
that used for floppy discs or hard drives,  
of recording the required file in a single  
increment on a CD-R and similar.  
ID3 Tag  
ISO 9660  
ID3 tag is a method for storing  
An international standard for logical  
formatting of CD-ROM files and folders.  
It is divided into three separate levels  
based on differences in file naming  
procedures, data configuration and other  
characteristics.  
information related to the music in an  
MP3 file. Information such as track, artist  
and album name can be stored. This  
content can be freely edited using ID3  
editing function software.  
VBR  
Multi-session  
Abbreviation for Variable Bit Rate. While  
CBR (Constant Bit Rate) is generally  
used, VBR varies the bit rate for audio  
compression according to compression  
conditions and this allows for  
A session is the complete amount of data  
recorded from the beginning to the end of  
a single period of CD-ROM, CD-R/CD-  
RW data recording. Multi-session refers to  
the existence of data from two or more  
sessions on a single disc.  
compression with preference given to  
sound quality.  
6-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page252  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (252,1)  
MEMO  
6-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page254  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (254,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
qPower/Volume/Sound Controls  
Power/Volume dial  
Audio control dial  
Power ON/OFF  
Audio sound adjustment  
Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or  
ON position.  
1. Press the audio control dial to select the  
function. The selected function will be  
indicated.  
Press the power/volume dial to turn the  
audio system on.  
Press the power/volume dial again to turn  
the audio system off.  
Standard audio-  
equipped model  
NOTE  
To prevent the battery from being discharged,  
do not leave the audio system on for a long  
period of time when the engine is not running.  
Volume adjustment  
Depending on the mode selected, the  
indication changes.  
To adjust the volume, turn the power/  
volume dial.  
Turn the power/volume dial to the right to  
increase volume, to the left to decrease it.  
6-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page255  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (255,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Bose® Sound System-equipped model  
(Stereo mode)  
Bose Sound  
System-  
equipped model  
Indication  
Turn Left Turn Right  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
Decrease  
bass  
Increase  
bass  
Decrease  
treble  
Increase  
treble  
Depending on the mode selected, the  
indication changes.  
Shift the  
Shift the  
sound to the sound to the  
2. Turn the audio control dial to adjust the  
selected functions as follows:  
front  
rear  
Shift the  
Shift the  
sound to the sound to the  
Standard audio-equipped model  
left  
right  
Indication  
Turn Left Turn Right  
OFF  
ON  
Select mode  
OFF  
ON  
Decrease  
bass  
Increase  
bass  
(5.1-channel sound mode)  
Decrease  
treble  
Increase  
treble  
Indication  
Turn Left Turn Right  
Shift the  
Shift the  
sound to the sound to the  
OFF  
ON  
front  
rear  
Shift the  
Shift the  
sound to the sound to the  
left  
right  
Select mode  
OFF  
ON  
Decrease  
bass  
Increase  
bass  
OFF  
ON  
Decrease  
treble  
Increase  
treble  
Shift the  
Shift the  
sound to the sound to the  
front  
rear  
Shift the  
Shift the  
sound to the sound to the  
left  
right  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
6-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page256  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (256,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
NOTE  
The following four modes are available.  
Select the desired mode.  
l
DVDor Surroundis displayed in  
areas depending on the model.  
MUSICor ALLis displayed in  
Mode  
Volume change  
l
No change  
areas depending on the model.  
l
MOVIEor Rris displayed in  
Minimum  
Medium  
areas depending on the model.  
The display switches to the 5.1-channel  
sound mode when the following  
conditions are met:  
Maximum  
l
The vehicle is Rear Entertainment  
System equipped.  
The mode is switched to RSES(page  
Turn the audio control dial to select ALC  
OFF or ALC LEVEL13 modes. The  
selected mode will be indicated.  
l
l
A CD or a DVD is inserted in the Rear  
Entertainment System or the sound of  
the disc is 5.1 Dolby Digital/DTS  
audio.  
NOTE  
About 5 seconds after selecting any mode, the  
volume function will be automatically selected.  
To reset bass, treble, fade, and balance, press  
the audio control dial for 2 seconds. The unit  
will beep and CLEARwill be displayed.  
Automatic Level Control (ALC)  
(Standard audio-equipped model)  
*AudioPilotTM(Bose® Sound System-  
equipped model)  
The automatic level control is a feature  
that automatically adjusts audio volume  
and sound quality according to the vehicle  
speed.  
The volume increases in accordance with  
the increase in vehicle speed, and  
decreases as vehicle speed decreases.  
AudioPilot automatically adjusts audio  
volume and sound quality in accordance  
with the level of noise entering the vehicle  
interior while driving. When AudioPilot is  
turned ON, the system automatically  
calculates the conditions for optimum  
hearing of sound which may be difficult  
to hear depending on exterior noise.  
* AudioPilotTM is a registered trademark  
of Bose Corporation.  
6-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page257  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (257,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
*Centerpoint®(Bose® Sound System-  
equipped model)  
NOTE  
Centerpoint® operates only with a 2-  
l
channel stereo CD.  
Centerpoint offers you the experience of  
5.1-channel surround sound in your  
vehicle even with your conventional 2-  
channel stereo DVDs inserted in the Rear  
Entertainment System main unit or 2-  
channel stereo CDs.  
Centerpoint® does not work with AM/FM/  
SIRIUS/AUX.  
l
* Centerpoint® is a registered trademark  
of Bose Corporation.  
Rear seat-optimized  
Turn up the volume to enhance the  
surround sound effect, or down to lessen  
it.  
The rear seat-optimized function allows  
passengers to optimize the audio output to  
the rear for a more pleasurable acoustic  
field when selecting the 5.1-channel  
sound mode.  
Indication  
Volume change  
Minimum  
Select DVD MOVIE*1 to increase the  
surround effect to the rear seat. Select  
DVD MUSIC*2 to apply the surround  
effect to all seats.  
Low  
Medium  
High  
*1 Surroundand Rrwill be displayed  
instead of DVDand MOVIE”  
depending on the model.  
Maximum  
*2 Surroundand ALLwill be  
displayed instead of DVDand  
MUSICdepending on the model.  
1. Turn the audio control dial and select  
CENTERPT ON.  
NOTE  
2. Press the audio control dial and select  
the surround effect mode.  
Rear seat-optimized is only effective if a CD or  
a DVD inserted in the Rear Entertainment  
System main unit is 5.1 Dolby Digital/DTS  
audio.  
3. Turn the audio control dial to select  
CENTERPT MINMAX mode. The  
selected mode will be indicated.  
6-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page258  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (258,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Surround  
When the rear seat-optimized function is  
operating, the surround effect can be  
enjoyed at five separate levels.  
Indication  
Volume change  
Minimum  
Low  
Medium  
High  
Maximum  
Turn the audio control dial to select  
MIN-MAX mode. The selected mode will  
be indicated.  
NOTE  
DVDor Surroundis displayed in  
areas depending on the model.  
BEEP setting  
The beep-sound when operating the audio  
system can be set on or off.  
ILLM EFT setting (Illumination setting  
during operation)  
The audio system illumination during  
operation can be set on or off.  
6-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page259  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (259,1)  
MEMO  
6-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page260  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (260,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
qOperating the Radio  
Band selector button  
Satellite button  
Scan button  
Manual tuning dial/Auto memory  
button/Electric serial number  
Channel preset buttons  
Seek tuning  
buttons  
Radio ON  
Tuning  
Press a band selector button (  
turn the radio on.  
) to  
The radio has the following tuning  
methods: Manual, Seek, Scan, Preset  
channel, and Auto memory tuning. The  
easiest way to tune stations is to set them  
on preset channels.  
Band selection  
Successively pressing the band selector  
button ( ) switches the bands as  
follows: FM1FM2AM.  
NOTE  
If the power supply is interrupted (fuse blows  
or the battery is disconnected), the preset  
channels will be canceled.  
The selected mode will be indicated. If  
FM stereo is being received, STwill be  
displayed.  
Manual tuning  
NOTE  
Turning the manual tuning dial will  
change the frequency higher or lower.  
If the FM broadcast signal becomes weak,  
reception automatically changes from  
STEREO to MONO for reduced noise, and the  
STindicator will go out.  
Seek tuning  
Pressing the seek tuning button (  
,
)
will cause the tuner to seek a higher or  
lower frequency automatically.  
6-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page261  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (261,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
NOTE  
Press and hold the auto memory button  
If you continue to press and hold the button,  
the frequency will continue changing without  
stopping.  
(
) for about 2 seconds until a beep  
sound is heard; the system will  
automatically scan and temporarily store  
up to 6 stations with the strongest  
frequencies in each selected band in that  
area.  
Scan tuning  
Press the scan button (  
) to  
automatically sample strong stations.  
Scanning stops at each station for about 5  
seconds. To hold a station, press the scan  
After scanning is completed, the station  
with the strongest frequency will be tuned  
and its frequency displayed.  
button (  
) again during this interval.  
Press and release the auto memory button  
Preset channel tuning  
(
) to recall stations from the auto-  
stored stations. One stored station will be  
selected each time; its frequency and  
channel number will be displayed.  
The 6 preset channels can be used to store  
6 AM and 12 FM stations.  
1. To set a channel first select AM, FM1,  
or FM2. Tune to the desired station.  
NOTE  
If no stations can be tuned after scanning  
operations, Awill be displayed.  
2. Depress a channel preset button for  
about 2 seconds until a beep sound is  
heard. The preset channel number and  
station frequency will be displayed.  
The station is now held in the memory.  
SATELLITE RADIO (SAT)  
Vehicles equipped with the separately  
purchased SIRIUS digital satellite radio  
unit have the ability to receive up to 100  
channels of digital quality programming  
coast to coast via satellite. For information  
on use, read the Satellite Radio Kit  
manual accompanying the SIRIUS digital  
satellite radio unit. A subscription to  
SIRIUS digital satellite radio service is  
required (available in the U.S. - Except  
Alaska and Hawaii) to enable this feature  
once the separately purchased SIRIUS  
digital satellite radio unit has been  
3. Repeat this operation for the other  
stations and bands you want to store.  
To tune one in the memory, select AM,  
FM1, or FM2 and then press its  
channel preset button. The station  
frequency and the channel number will  
be displayed.  
NOTE  
If the power supply is interrupted (fuse blows  
or the battery is disconnected), the preset  
channels will be canceled.  
installed. For subscription information or  
digital satellite radio technical issues  
contact SIRIUS directly at:  
Auto memory tuning  
This is especially useful when driving in  
an area where the local stations are not  
known. Additional AM/FM stations can  
be stored without disturbing the  
- Web: www.siriusradio.com  
- Phone (24 hrs/day, 7 days/week): 888-  
539-SIRI (7474)  
- E-mail: [email protected]  
- Mailing Address: Sirius Satellite Radio  
previously set channels.  
6-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page262  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (262,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
1221 Avenue Of The Americas  
New York, NY 10020  
Attention: Customer Care  
Include your Sirius Radio ESN  
(Electronic Serial Number) when  
subscribing or requesting technical  
assistance. See the Satellite Radio Kit  
manual accompanying the SIRIUS unit  
for complete satellite radio activation  
procedures and information on how to  
display the ESN#.  
6-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page263  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (263,1)  
MEMO  
6-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page264  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (264,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
qOperating the Compact Disc (CD) Playerí  
CD eject button  
Random button  
Repeat button  
Load button  
Track up button  
Scan button  
CD slot  
Track down button  
Reverse button Fast-forward button  
Power/Volume dial  
CD play button  
Type  
Playable data  
· Music data (CD-DA)  
NOTE  
When the load button (  
) is pressed, the  
Music CD player  
CD will load and play even if the CD eject  
button ( ) had been previously pressed.  
Inserting the CD  
Insert the CD into the slot, label-side up.  
The auto-loading mechanism will set the  
CD and begin play. There will be a short  
lapse before play begins while the player  
reads the digital signals on the CD.  
Fast-forward/Reverse  
Press and hold the fast-forward button  
(
) to advance through a track at high  
speed.  
Press and hold the reverse button (  
to reverse through a track at high speed.  
)
Ejecting the CD  
Press the CD eject button ( ) to eject the  
CD.  
Track search  
Press the track up button ( ) once to skip  
forward to the beginning of the next track.  
Press the track down button ( ) once to  
skip back to the beginning of the current  
track.  
Playing  
Press the CD play button ( ) to start  
play when a CD is in the unit.  
If there isn't a CD in the unit when the CD  
play button ( ) is pressed, NO DISC”  
will flash on and off.  
6-38  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page265  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (265,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Music scan  
This feature helps to find a program by  
playing about the first 10 seconds of each  
track.  
Press the scan button (  
) during play  
to start scan play operation (the track  
number will flash).  
Press the scan button (  
to cancel scan play.  
) once again  
NOTE  
If the unit is left in scan, normal play will  
resume where scan was selected.  
Repeat play  
This feature makes it possible to listen to  
a selection repeatedly.  
Press the repeat button (  
) during play.  
The current selection will be repeated  
(RPTwill be displayed).  
Press the repeat button (  
to cancel repeat play.  
) once again  
Random play  
This feature allows the CD player to  
randomly select the order of the songs.  
Press the random button (  
) during  
play. The next selection will be randomly  
selected (RDMwill be displayed).  
Press the random button (  
) once  
again to cancel random play.  
Message display  
If CHECK CDis displayed, it means  
that there is some CD malfunction. Check  
for damage, dirt, or smudges on the CD,  
and then properly reinsert. If the message  
appears again, take the unit to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer for service.  
6-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page266  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (266,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
qOperating the In-Dash CD Changerí  
CD eject button  
(Music CD player)  
Fast-forward button  
Random button  
Disc up/Folder up  
button  
(Music CD/MP3 CD player)  
CD slot  
Load button Scan button  
Track up  
button  
Track down  
button  
Display  
button  
Reverse button  
CD play button  
Display feed  
Disc down/Folder  
down button  
Channel preset  
dial  
Repeat button  
Power/Volume dial  
buttons  
There are two types of In-dash CD  
changers. Check which In-dash CD  
changer type you own.  
Inserting the CD  
The CD must be label-side up when  
inserting. The auto-loading mechanism  
will set the CD and begin play. There will  
be a short lapse before play begins while  
the player reads the digital signals on the  
CD.  
Type  
Playable data  
Music CD player  
· Music data (CD-DA)  
Music CD/MP3 CD  
player  
· Music data (CD-DA)  
· MP3 file  
The disc number and the track number  
will be displayed.  
NOTE  
If a disc has both music data (CD-DA) and  
MP3 files, playback of the two file types differs  
depending on how the disc was recorded.  
NOTE  
The CD will begin playback automatically  
after insertion.  
A CD cannot be inserted while the display  
reads WAIT. A beeping sound can be heard  
during this waiting time. Simultaneously  
pressing the power/volume dial and the load  
button (  
) for about 2 seconds will turn  
this beeping sound ON or OFF.  
6-40  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page267  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (267,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Normal insertion  
Ejecting the CD  
Normal ejection  
1. Press the load button (  
).  
2. When INis displayed, insert the CD.  
1. Press the CD eject button ( ). The  
disc number and DISC OUTwill be  
displayed.  
Inserting CDs into desired tray number  
1. Press and hold the load button (  
)
2. Pull out the CD.  
for about 2 seconds until a beep sound  
is heard.  
NOTE  
l
When the CD is ejected during play, the  
2. Press the channel preset button for the  
desired tray number while WAITis  
displayed.  
next CD will be played automatically.  
l
(Music CD player)  
If the CD is not removed from the slot  
within approximately 10 seconds after  
ejection, it will be re- inserted  
automatically.  
3. When INis displayed, insert the CD.  
NOTE  
The CD cannot be inserted to the desired tray  
number if the number is already occupied.  
Ejecting CDs from desired tray number  
1. Press and hold the CD eject button (  
for about 2 seconds until a beep sound  
is heard.  
)
Multiple insertion  
1. Press and hold the load button (  
)
for about 2 seconds until a beep sound  
is heard.  
The DISC OUTdisplay flashes.  
2. Press the channel preset button for the  
desired CD number for less than 5  
seconds after the beep sound is heard.  
2. When INis displayed, insert the CD.  
3. When INis displayed again, insert  
the next CD.  
3. Pull out the CD.  
NOTE  
NOTE  
(Music CD player)  
If the CD is not removed from the slot within  
approximately 10 seconds after ejection, it will  
be re- inserted automatically.  
The first-inserted CD will be played  
automatically when:  
l
No other CD is inserted within 15 seconds  
after INis displayed.  
l
The CD trays are full.  
Multiple ejection  
Displaying the CD-inserted tray  
number  
1. Press and hold the CD eject button (  
for about 2 seconds until a beep sound  
is heard.  
)
When you want to know the number for a  
CD-inserted tray, press the display button  
The DISC OUTdisplay flashes.  
(
). The tray number will be displayed  
for 5 seconds.  
2. Press the CD eject button ( ) again  
for less than 5 seconds after the beep  
sound is heard.  
6-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page268  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (268,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
NOTE  
Disc search  
If the button is not pressed and about 5  
seconds have elapsed while DISC OUTis  
flashing, CDs are automatically ejected.  
During music CD playback  
To change the disc, press the DISC button  
(
or  
) during playback.  
3. Pull out the CD, then the next CD will  
be ejected.  
During MP3 CD playback  
To change the disc, press the DISC button  
NOTE  
(
or  
) for 1.5 seconds or  
l
CDs will be ejected starting with the one  
with the lowest number.  
more during playback.  
l
All CDs in the tray will be ejected  
continuously.  
CDs can be ejected when the ignition  
switch is off. Press and hold the CD eject  
button ( ) for about 2 seconds and all  
CDs will eject.  
Folder search (during MP3 CD  
playback)  
l
To change to the previous folder, press the  
folder down button (  
1.5 seconds, or press the folder up button  
) for less than 1.5 seconds to  
) for less than  
(
l
(Music CD player)  
advance to the next folder.  
If the CD is not removed from the slot  
within approximately 10 seconds after  
ejection, it will be re- inserted  
automatically.  
Music scan  
This feature helps to find a program by  
playing about the first 10 seconds of each  
track.  
Playing  
Press the CD play button ( ) to start  
play when a CD is in the unit.  
If there isn't a CD in the unit when the CD  
play button ( ) is pressed, NO DISC”  
will flash on and off.  
Press the scan button (  
to start scan play operation (the track  
number will flash).  
Press the scan button (  
to cancel scan play.  
) during play  
) once again  
Fast-forward/Reverse  
NOTE  
If the unit is left in scan, normal play will  
resume where scan was selected.  
Press and hold the fast-forward button  
(
) to advance through a track at high  
speed.  
Repeat play  
Press and hold the reverse button (  
)
to reverse through a track at high speed.  
During music CD playback  
Track search  
1. Press the repeat button (  
) during  
playback to play the current track  
repeatedly. RPTis displayed.  
Press the track up button ( ) once to skip  
forward to the beginning of the next track.  
Press the track down button ( ) once to  
skip back to the beginning of the current  
track.  
2. Press the button again to cancel the  
repeat play.  
6-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page269  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (269,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
During MP3 CD playback  
(Track repeat)  
(CD random)  
1. Press the random button (  
) during  
playback, and then press the button  
again within 3 seconds to play the  
tracks in the CD randomly. RDMis  
displayed.  
1. Press the repeat button (  
) during  
playback to play the current track  
repeatedly. RPTis displayed.  
2. To cancel the repeat play, press the  
button again after 3 seconds.  
2. Press the button again to cancel the  
random play.  
(Folder repeat)  
Switching the display (Music CD/MP3  
CD player)  
1. Press the repeat button (  
) during  
playback, and then press the button  
again within 3 seconds to play the  
tracks in the current folder repeatedly.  
RPTis displayed.  
Each time the display button (  
) is  
pressed during playback, the display will  
switch in the following order.  
Music CD  
2. Press the button again to cancel the  
repeat play.  
Track number/Elapsed  
time  
Random play  
Disc tray number  
File name  
Tracks are randomly selected and played.  
During music CD playback  
1. Press the random button (  
) during  
Album name  
Artist name  
playback to play the tracks in the CD  
randomly. RDMis displayed.  
2. Press the button again to cancel the  
random play.  
During MP3 CD playback  
(Folder random)  
1. Press the random button (  
) during  
playback to play the tracks in the folder  
randomly. RDMis displayed.  
2. To cancel the random play, press the  
button again after 3 seconds.  
6-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page270  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (270,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
MP3 CD  
Message display  
If CHECK CDis displayed, it means  
that there is some CD malfunction. Check  
for damage, dirt, or smudges on the CD,  
and then properly reinsert. If the message  
appears again, take the unit to an  
Disc number/File  
number/Elapsed time  
Disc tray number  
Authorized Mazda Dealer for service.  
Folder number/Track  
number  
qOperating the Auxiliary jack  
You can connect portable audio units or  
similar products on the market to the  
auxiliary jack to listen to music or audio  
over the vehicle's speakers, refer to  
Auxiliary Input (page 6-48).  
File name  
Folder name  
Album name (ID3 Tag)  
Song name (ID3 Tag)  
Artist name (ID3 Tag)  
NOTE  
(MP3 CD)  
This unit can only read English (including  
numerals) one-byte characters. Depending on  
the CD writing software used, proper display  
may not be possible.  
Display scroll (Music CD/MP3 CD  
player)  
Only 12 characters can be displayed at  
one time. To display the rest of the  
characters of a long title, turn the display  
feed dial (  
) to the right. Hidden  
titles can be scrolled into the display one  
character at a time.  
NOTE  
The displayable number of characters is  
limited. If the number of characters, including  
the file extension (.mp3), exceeds 32  
characters, it may not be fully displayed.  
6-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page271  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (271,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
qError Indications  
If you see an error indication on the display, find the cause in the chart. If you cannot clear  
the error indication, take the vehicle to an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Indication  
Cause  
Solution  
Insert the CD properly. If the error indication  
does not disappear, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer  
CD is inserted upside down  
CHECK CD  
Insert another CD properly. If the error indication  
does not disappear, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer  
CD is defective  
6-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page272  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (272,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
With navigation system  
Use the VOICE switch for navigation  
system sound operation.  
For details, refer to the separate manual  
NAVIGATION SYSTEM.  
Audio Control Switch  
Operation (Steering Wheel)  
When the audio unit is turned on,  
operation of the audio unit from the  
steering wheel is possible.  
VOICE switch  
Mode switch  
NOTE  
Because the audio unit will be turned off under  
the following conditions, the switches will be  
inoperable.  
l
When the ignition switch is turned to the  
LOCK position.  
l
When the power button on the audio unit is  
pressed and the audio unit is turned off.  
l
Volume switch  
Seek switch  
When CD being played is ejected. (For the  
In-dash CD changer, when all CDs are  
ejected.)  
NOTE  
l
The VOICE switch is operable with the  
Without navigation system  
audio unit turned off.  
l
Mazda has installed this system to prevent  
Mute switch  
Mode switch  
distraction while driving the vehicle and  
using audio controls on the dashboard.  
Always make safe driving your first priority.  
qAdjusting the Volume  
To increase the volume, pull up the  
volume switch.  
To decrease the volume, press down the  
volume switch.  
Volume switch  
Seek switch  
6-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page273  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (273,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
qChanging the Source  
qSeek Switch  
Press the mode switch (  
) to change  
the audio source (FM1 radio> FM2 radio>  
AM radio> CD player or CD changer>  
SIRIUS1> SIRIUS2> SIRIUS3> RSES or  
AUX> cyclical).  
When listening to the radio  
Pull up or press down the seek switch, the  
radio switches to the next/previous stored  
station in the order that it was stored  
(16).  
NOTE  
Pull up or press down the seek switch for  
about 2 seconds until a beep sound is  
heard to seek all usable stations at a  
higher or lower frequency whether  
programmed or not.  
CD, CD changer, RSES, and SIRIUS digital  
satellite radio modes cannot be selected in the  
following cases:  
l
CD, CD changer, RSES, or SIRIUS digital  
satellite radio unit is not equipped on the  
audio system.  
When playing a CD  
l
CD has not been inserted.  
Pull up the seek switch to skip to the next  
track.  
Press down the seek switch to repeat the  
current track.  
Connect a portable audio unit or similar  
product on the market to the auxiliary jack to  
listen to music or audio over the vehicle's  
speakers. Change the audio source to AUX  
mode (page 6-48).  
qMute Switch  
The audio source is changed to the AUX mode  
only when a commercially available portable  
audio unit is connected to the auxiliary jack.  
Press the mute switch ( ) once to mute  
audio, press it again to resume audio  
output.  
NOTE  
If the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK  
position with the audio muted, the mute will be  
canceled.  
Therefore, when the engine is restarted, the  
audio is not muted. To mute the audio again,  
press the mute switch ( ).  
6-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page274  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (274,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Auxiliary Input (AUX mode)  
You can connect portable audio units or  
similar products on the market to the  
auxiliary jack to listen to music or audio  
over the vehicle's speakers.  
Auxiliary jack  
WARNING  
Do not adjust the portable audio unit  
or a similar product while driving the  
vehicle:  
Adjusting the portable audio unit or  
a similar product while driving the  
vehicle is dangerous as it could  
distract your attention from the  
vehicle operation which could lead to  
a serious accident. Always adjust the  
portable audio unit or a similar  
product while the vehicle is stopped.  
6-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page275  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (275,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
NOTE  
NOTE  
l
l
Before using the auxiliary jack, read the  
Insert the plug to the auxiliary jack  
manufacturer's instructions for the product  
being connected.  
Use a commercially-available, non-  
impedance (3.5 ) stereo mini plug for  
connecting the portable audio unit to the  
auxiliary jack. Before using the auxiliary  
jack, read the manufacture's instructions  
for connecting a portable audio unit to the  
auxiliary jack.  
securely.  
l
l
Insert or remove the plug with the plug  
perpendicular to the auxiliary jack hole.  
Insert or remove the plug by holding its  
base.  
l
To operate the portable audio unit  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or  
ON position.  
l
To prevent discharging of the battery, do  
2. Press the power/volume dial to turn the  
audio system on.  
not use the auxiliary input for long periods  
with the engine off or idling.  
l
Noise may occur depending on the product  
3. Press the MEDIA button (  
the audio unit or the mode switch  
) of the audio control switch to  
change to the AUX mode.  
) of  
connected to the auxiliary jack.  
If a power supply from the portable audio  
unit is needed, use the unit's batteries.  
Using the power socket equipped on the  
vehicle may cause noise depending on the  
unit connected to the power supply socket.  
l
(
WARNING  
Do not allow the connection plug cord  
to get tangled with the parking brake  
or the shift lever:  
Allowing the plug cord to become  
tangled with the parking brake or  
the shift lever is dangerous as it  
could interfere with driving, resulting  
in an accident.  
NOTE  
l
Set the volume of the portable audio unit to  
the maximum within the range that the  
sound does not become distorted, then  
adjust the volume using the power/volume  
dial of the audio unit or the volume button  
CAUTION  
Do not place objects or apply force to  
the auxiliary jack with the plug  
connected.  
(
,
) of the audio control switch.  
l
If the connection plug is pulled out from the  
auxiliary jack while in AUX mode, noise  
may occur.  
6-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page276  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (276,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Safety Certification  
This CD player is made and tested to meet exacting safety standards. It meets FCC  
requirements and complies with safety performance standards of the U.S. Department of  
Health and Human Services.  
CAUTION  
Ø This CD player should not be adjusted or repaired by anyone except qualified  
service personnel.  
If servicing is required, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Ø Use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other than those  
specified herein may result in hazardous laser exposure. Never operate the CD  
player with the top case of the unit removed.  
Ø Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for  
compliance could void the user's authority to operate this equipment.  
NOTE  
For CD player section:  
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two  
conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any  
interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
NOTE  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device,  
pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection  
against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can  
radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions,  
may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that  
interference will not occur in a particular installation.  
6-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page277  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (277,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Rear Entertainment Systemí  
qRear Entertainment System Outline  
The Rear Entertainment System has a 9.0-inch wide LCD, as well as DVD video, DVD  
audio, video CD, audio CD, and MP3/WMA CD playback functions. Moreover, the system  
is equipped with input terminals for video picture and audio sound, and AVequipment such  
as a video game player or a video camera can be connected and displayed on the monitor  
screen.  
qProper Operation of Rear Entertainment System  
For safe driving, read the following warnings and cautions before starting operation, and  
use the system properly.  
WARNING  
Ø Do not disassemble or modify this unit.  
It may cause an accident, fire, or electrical shock.  
Ø Do not use if there is a malfunction condition such as no screen image or sound.  
It may cause an accident, fire, or electrical shock. Follow the procedures in  
Symptoms and Actions(page 6-100) and if the problem is not resolved, consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Ø Do not use if some problem has occurred.  
If any problem occurs, such as a foreign material penetration, spilled liquid,  
smoking from internal burning, or other abnormal smells, stop operation  
immediately and consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer. If operation is continued, it  
may cause an accident, fire, or electrical shock.  
Ø Lower the volume to minimum before turning off the power.  
If the volume is set high, loud sound will be produced when turning on the power,  
causing auditory problems or an accident.  
Ø Adjust the volume while driving so that ambient sound can be heard.  
If the volume is too high and ambient sound cannot be heard while driving,  
driving operation could be obstructed causing an accident.  
Ø Do not leave the remote controller and the headphones unstowed.  
If the remote controller and the headphone are not stowed, they could fall under  
the brake pedal during a sudden stop or while turning, which could obstruct  
driving operation and cause an accident.  
CAUTION  
Ø Do not put foreign material into the disc slot.  
It may cause a fire or malfunction.  
Ø Do not clean plastic finished parts with solvent such as benzene or thinner.  
The parts may deform causing a fire or malfunction.  
íSome models.  
6-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page278  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (278,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
qOperating Tips for Disc  
Playable discs  
DVD video*1, DVD audio*2, video CD, audio CD, CD-R, CD-RW, DVD-R, DVD-RW and  
dts CD*3 can be played.  
NOTE  
It may not be possible to play DVD video, DVD audio, video CD, audio CD, and MP3/WMA CD  
according to the procedures indicated in these instructions if the playback conditions have been  
restricted by the producer.  
Read the instruction manual accompanying the DVD video, video CD, DVD audio, audio CD.  
6-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page279  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (279,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
DVD video  
DVD videos bearing the following logo can be played.  
DVD audio  
DVD audio bearing the following logo can be played.  
Region code must include 1or ALL.  
NTSC  
(National Television System Committee)  
recorded type.  
8 cm (3in) or 12 cm (5in) size  
DVD-R and DVD-RW  
DVD-Rs and DVD-RWs bearing each of the following logos can  
be played.  
Video CD, audio CD, CD-R, and CD-RW  
Video CDs, audio CDs, CD-Rs, and CD-RWs bearing each of the  
following logos can be played.  
Playback control function supported.  
8 cm (3in) or 12 cm (5in) size  
MP3 recorded type.  
*1: Audio is not produced by the headphones when DTS audio is selected. Listen to DTS audio over the vehicle's  
speakers.  
*2: Stereo playback is produced.  
*3: Audio is not produced from the headphones. Listen to this audio from the speakers.  
Unplayable discs  
l
Discs not bearing the logo mark indicated in the above table.  
Discs not including 1or ALLin region code.  
Discs recorded in other than NTSC (e.g. PAL or SECAM).  
l
l
6-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page280  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (280,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
l
DVD-ROM, DVD-RAM, DVD+RW, CD-ROM, CDV, CD-G, CVD, VSD, SVCD,  
SACD, photo CDs, non-conventional discs (e.g. heart-shaped), and partially transparent  
discs.  
l
l
Discs recorded in CD-TEXT format.  
HD DVD and Blu-ray discs  
Handling of discs  
l
Do not use non-conventional discs such as heart-shaped, octagonal discs, or discs with a  
memory portion that is transparent or translucent. The unit could be damaged.  
Transparent  
l
When driving over uneven surfaces, the sound may jump.  
Be sure never to touch the signal surface when handling the discs. Pick up the discs by  
l
grasping the outer edge or the edge of the hole and the outer edge.  
Do not write on or attach labels, stickers or similar to discs.  
Defective (cracked or badly bent) discs should never be used.  
A new disc may have rough edges on its inner and outer perimeters. If a disc with rough  
l
l
l
edges is used, proper setting will not be possible and the unit will not play the disc.  
Remove the rough edges in advance by using a ball-point pen or pencil as shown below.  
To remove the rough edges, rub the side of the pen or pencil against the inner and outer  
perimeter of the discs.  
6-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page281  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (281,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Disc cleaning  
Do not use record sprays, antistatic agents, or household spray cleaners. Volatile chemicals  
such as benzine and thinner can also damage the surface of the disc and must not be used.  
Anything that can damage, warp or fog plastic should never be used to clean discs.  
Condensation  
Immediately after turning on the heater when the vehicle is cold, the disc or optical  
components (prism and lens) in the unit may become clouded with condensation. At this  
time, the disc will eject immediately when placed in the unit. A clouded disc can be  
corrected simply by wiping it with a soft cloth. Clouded optical components will clear  
naturally in about an hour. Wait for normal operation to return before attempting to use the  
unit.  
Operating tips for DVD video  
Region code  
The playback restriction area is set in a DVD video. The playback restriction area is  
indicated by a region code, and a DVD video can be played only in its indicated area.  
The region code for U.S.A. and Canada are 1. DVD videos bearing region code  
including 1or ALLon the package or the instruction manual can be played by this  
unit. The region code setting for this unit has been set to 1.  
DVD videos bearing any of the following logos on the package or instruction manual can  
be played.  
6-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page282  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (282,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Playable DISC specification  
CD-R and CD-RW including MP3/WMA files can be played with this unit. Discs which  
conform to the following formats can be played.  
Name  
Standard  
Explanation  
Level 1  
Level 2  
Joliet  
ISO9660  
CD-R, CD-RW format  
ISO9660 extension  
Supported  
Romeo  
Multi-session  
Maximum hierarchy  
number  
8 hierarchies (Including root)  
256 folders  
Maximum folder  
number  
512 files (Total capacity included in a disc.) Files other than MP3 or WMA are not  
included.)  
Maximum file number  
Operating tips for MP3  
NOTE  
Supply of this product only conveys a license for private, non-commercial use and does not convey a  
license nor imply any right to use this product in any commercial (i.e. revenue-generating) real time  
broadcasting (terrestrial, satellite, cable and/or any other media), broadcasting/streaming via the  
Internet, intranets and/or other networks or in other electronic content distribution systems, such as  
pay-audio or audio-on-demand applications. An independent license for such use is required. For  
details, please visit http://www.mp3licensing.com.  
Playable MP3 file specification  
Playable MP3 files are as follows:  
Item  
Content  
MPEG1 AUDIO LAYER3  
Specification  
MPEG2.5 AUDIO LAYER3  
MPEG2 AUDIO LAYER3  
32, 44.1, 48kHz  
MPEG1  
Sampling frequency  
Bit rate  
MPEG2  
16, 22.05, 24kHz  
32, 40, 48, 56, 64, 80, 96, 112, 128, 160, 192, 224, 256, 320  
kbps  
MPEG1  
MPEG2, 2.5  
32, 40, 48, 56, 64, 80, 96, 112, 128, 144, 160 kbps  
Supported  
VBR (Variable Bit Rate)  
Channel mode  
ID3 tag  
Stereo, Joint stereo, Dual channel, Monaural  
Ver. 1.0, Ver. 1.1 title, artist name, album name  
l
This unit corresponds to MP3 files in which both header and data comply with the MP3  
format.  
6-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page283  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (283,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
l
This unit corresponds to multi-session recorded disc playback at a maximum of 49  
sessions.  
l
l
l
l
Some data on multi-session recorded discs cannot be played.  
Playback of discs with added sessions is possible.  
Packet Write recorded discs cannot be played.  
This unit does not correspond to MP3i (MP3 interactive), MP3 PRO, and RIFF-style  
MP3 formats.  
l
The maximum number of characters available for a file name is as follows, however, the  
displayable number of characters on this unit is limited.  
Maximum number of characters in a file name  
(including a separator .and the three letters of the file exten-  
sion)  
ISO9660 level 1  
12*  
31*  
64  
ISO9660 level 2  
Joliet extended format  
Romeo extended format  
128  
* English one-byte characters (capitalized only) and underbar _are available.  
MP3  
CAUTION  
This unit plays files with the (.mp3) file extension as a MP3 file. Do not use the MP3  
file extension for files other than MP3 files. It may cause noise or a malfunction.  
l
In a MP3 file, the track name, artist name, album name and category name are recorded  
with data called ID3-Tag, and the information can be displayed on the monitor.  
MP3 files which do not comply with the specific standard may not be played correctly  
l
or its file and folder name may not be displayed correctly.  
The file extension may not be provided depending on the computer operating system,  
l
version, software, or settings. In this case, add the file extension .mp3to the end of the  
file name, and then write the disc.  
Playlist  
This unit can play playlist files. Playlist is a function that allows free setting of the  
playback order of MP3 files. The file extension of a playlist file in which the order of  
playback is recorded is . m3uor . pls.  
Operating tips for WMA  
WMA is short for Windows Media Audio and is the audio compression format used by  
Microsoft.  
Audio data can be created and stored at a higher compression ratio than MP3.  
*Microsoft and Window Media are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation U.S. in  
the United States and other countries.  
6-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page284  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (284,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Playable WMA file specification  
CD-R and CD-RW including WMA files can be played with this unit. Discs which  
conform to the following formats can be played.  
Playable WMA files are as follows:  
Item  
Content  
Windows Media Audio Version7.0  
22.05kHz . . . . 32 kbps  
Specification  
32kHz. . . . . . . 48, 64 kbps  
Sampling frequency  
Bit rate  
44.1kHz . . . . . 48, 64, 80, 96, 128, 160, 192, 256, 320 kbps  
48kHz. . . . . . . 64, 96, 128, 160, 192 kbps  
Supported  
VBR (Variable Bit Rate)  
Channel mode  
Stereo/Monaural  
WMA tag  
Title, artist name, album name  
WMA  
CAUTION  
This unit plays files with the (.wma) file extension as a WMA file. Do not use the  
WMA file extension for files other than WMA files. It may cause noise or a  
malfunction.  
l
In a WMA file, the track name, artist name, album name and category name are  
recorded with data called WMA-Tag, and the information can be displayed on the  
monitor.  
l
l
WMA files which do not comply with the specific standard may not be played correctly  
or its file and folder name may not be displayed correctly.  
The file extension may not be provided depending on the computer operating system,  
version, software, or settings. In this case, add the file extension .wmato the end of  
the file name, and then write the disc.  
Operating tips for Dolby  
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.  
Dolby,” “MLP Lossless,and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.  
6-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page285  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (285,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Operating tips for dts  
DTSand DTS Digital Surroundare registered trademarks of Digital Theater Systems,  
Inc.  
qOperation Tips for Headphones  
To listen to audio other than from the speakers of the Rear Entertainment System, it is  
necessary to use the wireless headphones that are included.  
Specification  
Item  
Transmission system  
Content  
Infrared light  
Modulation system  
Carrier frequency  
Frequency modulation  
Right channel 2.8 MHz, left channel 2.3 MHz  
6-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page286  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (286,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Part Names  
qRear Entertainment System Main Unit  
Monitor screen release knob  
Disc slot  
DISC IN indicator light  
Eject button  
Wireless headphone signal transmitter/Remote  
control signal receiver  
Monitor screen  
6-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page287  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (287,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
qRemote Controller  
No.  
Name  
No.  
Name  
RETURN button  
PLAY button  
MENU button  
Slow playback button  
POWER button  
ENTER/Select button  
STOP button  
SOURCE button  
PAUSE button  
Picture adjust mode button  
Picture adjust button  
SET UP button  
Fast-forward button  
Rewind button  
PREVIOUS (Track down) button  
NEXT (Track up) button  
DISPLAY button  
Number keys  
DISPLAY MODE button  
6-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page288  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (288,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
qHeadphone  
Power button  
Volume dial  
Power indicator  
L (left) side  
Arm  
R (right) side  
Infrared receiver  
6-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page289  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (289,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Before Operation  
NOTE  
l
qDisplay Opening/Closing  
If the display is closed while the power is  
on, it automatically turns off.  
The display locks in two positions when  
opened to 100 or 120-degrees.  
CAUTION  
l
Ø Close the display while the Rear  
Entertainment System is not in  
use. If the display is left open, a  
passenger could be injured by  
hitting the display, or the display  
could be damaged.  
Ø Do not press the monitor screen  
while opening the display. It may  
cause a malfunction.  
Opening the display  
Press the monitor screen release knob and  
open the display until it is in the lock  
position.  
qDisc Insertion/Ejection  
CAUTION  
If the signal surface of a disc is  
touched, it could cause the sound to  
skip. Pick up a disc by grasping the  
edge of the hole and the outer edge.  
Monitor screen  
release knob  
NOTE  
When no disc is inserted, No Discis  
displayed on the monitor.  
Closing the display  
Close and press the display until a  
clicking sound can be heard.  
6-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page290  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (290,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Inserting the disc  
NOTE  
l
When the eject button is pressed, the disc is  
ejected halfway.  
A disc can be ejected with the Rear  
Entertainment System turned off.  
Insert the disc into the disc slot with the  
label-side up.  
l
qPicture Adjustment  
The brightness (BRIGHT), color  
adjustment (TINT), color density  
(COLOR), and contrast (CONTRAST) of  
the screen can be adjusted.  
Press the picture adjust button  
Disc slot  
(PICTURE) on the remote controller to  
change to the picture adjustment mode.  
The picture mode changes in the order of  
BRIGHT TINT COLOR  
CONTRAST OFF each time the  
button is pressed in this mode.  
Press the picture adjust button ( ) or ( ),  
positioned to top/bottom of the picture  
adjustment mode button (PICTURE), to  
adjust each picture mode.  
CAUTION  
Insert the disc with its label-side  
(decorated side) facing upward. If the  
disc is inserted upside-down, it may  
cause a malfunction.  
NOTE  
NOTE  
If a disc is inserted while the Rear  
Entertainment System is turned off but the  
display is open, and when the ignition switch is  
in the ACC or ON position, the system  
automatically turns on and starts playback.  
l
If the picture adjustment mode is on and no  
operation has been done for about 5  
seconds, the mode is canceled  
automatically.  
l
If the picture is no longer adjustable by  
pressing the picture adjust button ( ) or  
Ejecting the disc  
(
), it indicates that the adjustment value  
Press the eject button to eject the disc.  
has reached the maximum/minimum value.  
Adjusting the brightness  
1. Press the picture adjustment mode  
button (PICTURE) and select the  
BRIGHT mode.  
2. Press the picture adjust button ( ) or  
(
) to adjust.  
Eject button  
l
Picture adjust button ( ): Brighten  
6-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page291  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (291,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
l
l
Picture adjust button ( ): Darken  
Picture adjust button ( ): Lighten  
Adjusting the color adjustment  
Adjusting the contrast (definition)  
1. Press the picture adjustment mode  
button (PICTURE) and select the TINT  
mode.  
1. Press the picture adjustment mode  
button (PICTURE) and select the  
CONTRAST mode.  
2. Press the picture adjust button ( ) or  
2. Press the picture adjust button ( ) or  
(
) to adjust.  
(
) to adjust.  
l
l
l
Picture adjust button ( ): Green  
Picture adjust button ( ): Red  
Picture adjust button ( ): Higher  
Picture adjust button ( ): Lower  
l
Adjusting the color density  
qScreen Size Setting  
1. Press the picture adjustment mode  
button (PICTURE) and select the  
COLOR mode.  
The size of the screen can be changed.  
Press the DISPLAY MODE button to set  
the desired screen size.  
The screen size changes in the order of  
Full Normal Wide Cinema each  
time the button is pressed.  
2. Press the picture adjust button ( ) or  
(
) to adjust.  
l
Picture adjust button ( ): Darken  
6-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page292  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (292,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Full screen  
Cinema screen  
Image is displayed on the full screen.  
The image is enlarged upward and  
downward. A 4:3 and 16:9 screen ratio  
image are displayed with the upper/lower  
part of the image cut off.  
NOTE  
Because images are enlarged lengthwise for  
display, a horizontal streak may be seen,  
however, it does not indicate a malfunction.  
* A 16:9 screen ratio image is shown in  
the above figure.  
Normal screen  
A 4:3 screen ratio image is the standard  
display, and black bands appear on each  
side of the screen.  
* A 16:9 screen ratio image is shown in  
the above figure.  
NOTE  
The display varies depending on the style of  
the image recorded on the disc.  
Refer to the following table and set the screen  
size.  
* A 16:9 screen ratio image is scaled to a  
4:3 screen ratio.  
Wide screen  
The center part of the image is  
compressed toward the center, and the  
surrounding area is enlarged toward the  
edge.  
Image style  
4:3  
Recommendation  
Normal or wide screen  
Full screen  
16:9  
Letter box  
Full or cinema screen  
qDisplay Off  
Only sound, without image, can be  
played.  
Press and hold the DISPLAY button  
(
) on the remote controller.  
DISPLAY OFFis displayed, and then  
image turns off.  
Press any button on the remote controller  
to display the image.  
* A 16:9 screen ratio image is shown in  
the above figure.  
6-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page293  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (293,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Using the remote controller  
qRemote Controller  
A battery has already been installed in the  
remote controller.  
Remove the electrical leak-protection  
insulation sheet before using the remote  
controller.  
Operate the Rear Entertainment System  
with the remote controller except for disc  
insertion/ejection.  
CAUTION  
Do not apply excessive force to the  
remote controller or get it wet. Also,  
do not leave the remote controller in  
a place exposed to direct sunlight or  
high temperature. It could cause a  
malfunction.  
NOTE  
Insulation  
sheet  
Operate the remote controller with it pointed  
to the disc slot of the unit. Signals may not be  
received depending of the angle.  
Maintenance  
Replacing the battery  
Stow the remote controller in its case and  
put it in the seatback pocket of a front  
seat.  
Place the remote controller into its case  
properly in the direction shown in the  
figure and stow it in the front seatback  
pocket.  
If the buttons on the remote controller are  
inoperable, or the operation range  
becomes narrow or unsteady, the battery  
may be dead.  
Replace the battery using the following  
procedure.  
NOTE  
If the remote controller is placed in the  
incorrect direction, abnormal noise or an  
operation error could result.  
6-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page294  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (294,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Battery: CR2025 LITHIUM or  
equivalent (1)  
CAUTION  
Ø Install the battery with the correct  
pole pointing in the correct  
direction. Battery leakage could  
occur if they are not installed  
correctly.  
1. Press the battery case tab in the  
direction indicated by the arrow using  
your thumbnail, and pull out the  
battery case.  
Ø When replacing the batteries, be  
careful not to bend the electrical  
terminals or get oil on them. Also,  
be careful not to get dirt in the  
remote controller as it could be  
damaged.  
Battery  
case  
Tab  
2. Remove the old battery and install a  
new one with the plus pole pointed up.  
Battery  
3. Press the battery case tab in the  
direction of the arrow until a click  
sound is heard.  
NOTE  
If the remote controller is inoperable even  
after the batteries are replaced, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
6-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page295  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (295,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Sound Output  
qSound Output from Vehicle Speakers  
Vehicles with audio system  
Change the audio system to the Rear Entertainment System mode. Sound/Music being  
played by the Rear Entertainment System can be heard from the vehicle speakers.  
For audio operation, refer to Audio System(page 6-17).  
Press the MEDIA button (  
) on the audio unit or the mode switch (  
) of the  
audio control switch. RSESis displayed on the information display and it changes to the  
Rear Entertainment System sound.  
Adjust the volume with the dial on the audio unit.  
Vehicles with navigation system  
Change the navigation system to the Rear Entertainment System mode. Sound/Music being  
played by the Rear Entertainment System can be heard from the vehicle speakers.  
For navigation system operation, refer to the separate manual NAVIGATION SYSTEM.  
Press the MEDIA button (  
) on the navigation unit or the mode switch (  
) of the  
audio control switch. RSESis displayed on the information display and it changes to the  
Rear Entertainment System sound.  
Adjust the volume with the dial on the navigation unit.  
qUsing the Headphone Speakers  
CAUTION  
Ø For safety reasons, the driver should never wear the headphones while driving.  
Not being able to hear sound outside of the vehicle could result in a serious  
accident.  
Ø Use the headphones with the volume set at moderate level. Listening at an  
excessive volume level for extended periods of time will have an adverse effect on  
your hearing ability.  
Ø If the headphone arms are spread excessively is could result in damage.  
Ø Do not apply excessive force to the headphones or get them wet. Also, do not  
leave the headphones in a place exposed to direct sunlight or high temperature. It  
could cause a malfunction.  
6-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page296  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (296,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
NOTE  
l
To listen to audio other than from the speakers of the rear entertainment system, it is necessary to  
use the wireless headphones that are included. For headphone specification, refer to  
Operation Tips for Headphones(page 6-59).  
l
l
l
When the headphones are not in use, turn them off.  
DTS formatted sound cannot be generated through the headphones. Use the vehicle's speakers.  
If there is no sound produced from a signal for 3 minutes or longer after the headphone power is  
turned on, or there is no signal reception, the headphone power turns off automatically.  
If the headphones are continuously used for 4 hours or more after the sound signal is received, the  
headphone power turns off automatically.  
l
The acceptable range for signals (infrared rays) from the Rear Entertainment System is as  
follows:  
Rear Entertainment System  
Wireless headphone signal  
(infrared rays) transmitter  
The signals (infrared rays) can be received in  
any location on the rear seats. However, the  
rear of the transmitter is out of the acceptable  
range.  
A wireless headphone can be used in any position on the rear seats, however, the sound  
may skip under the following conditions because the acceptable range varies or the signals  
are blocked.  
l
When affected by intense light such as direct sunshine.  
6-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page297  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (297,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
l
When the wireless headphone receiver does not point to the Rear Entertainment System  
transmitter.  
When the signal is blocked by an obstruction such as the seat.  
l
Replacing the battery  
1. Remove the screw using a coin or equivalent, and remove the cover. Remove the  
batteries.  
Cover  
Screw  
2. Insert two AAA-size batteries. Match the polarity of the batteries with  
the and marks in the battery case.  
3. Install the cover.  
4. Install the screw.  
NOTE  
Battery life (reference)  
Manganese batteries: About 20 hours  
Alkaline batteries: About 40 hours  
The battery life is indicated as a reference and does not provide any guarantees. The battery life  
varies depending on usage conditions (volume, surrounding environment).  
6-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page298  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (298,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
CAUTION  
Ø If the battery power is depleted the headphones will not operate properly. If any of  
the following occurs, replace the batteries.  
Ø
Ø
Ø
The power indicator does not illuminate even when the power is turned on.  
Noise is mixed with the sound.  
The reception range narrows.  
Ø Periodically inspect the batteries for leakage.  
Ø If the headphones are not to be used for an extended period, remove the batteries.  
Ø Be careful not to allow the battery case screw to become loose.  
Ø Install the batteries with the ( )/( ) poles correctly positioned. Battery leakage  
could occur if they are not installed correctly.  
Ø When replacing the batteries, be careful not to bend the electrical terminals or get  
oil on them.  
Ø Be careful not to allow dirt to get into the headphones as it could damage them.  
The following points regarding the battery must be observed.  
If the batteries are not handled properly, it could result in a headphone malfunction.  
Ø Do not use rechargeable batteries.  
Ø When replacing the batteries, replace both batteries at the same time. Do not use  
a new battery and an old battery, or the different types of battery.  
6-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page299  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (299,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Rear Entertainment System Functions  
qMode  
The Rear Entertainment System has Disc and AUX modes.  
Mode  
Function  
Page  
DVD video, video CD, DVD audio, and audio CD can be  
played.  
Disc mode  
AUX (Auxiliary) mode *  
AVequipment with output terminals for image and sound,  
such as a video game player and a video camera, can be  
used.  
* Auxiliary terminals in which AVequipment can be connected are equipped.  
Refer to Auxiliary terminals and accessory socket on page 6-88.  
Mode change  
Press the SOURCE button. The mode changes between Disc and AUX.  
AUX mode  
Disc mode  
("DISC" is displayed.)  
("AUX" is displayed.)  
6-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page300  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (300,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
qBasic Operation  
DVD video, DVD audio,  
Video CD, Audio CD and  
MP3/WMA CD Playback  
(Disc Mode)  
Power ON/OFF  
Turning on the power  
The Rear Entertainment System  
automatically turns on when any of the  
following operations are done with the  
ignition switch in the ACC or ON  
position.  
DVD video, DVD audio, Video CD,  
Audio CD, and MP3/WMA CD can be  
played in the Disc mode.  
l
The display is open and a disc is  
CAUTION  
For safe driving, adjust the volume  
while driving so that ambient sound  
can be heard.  
inserted.  
l
The POWER button on the remote  
controller is pressed.  
Turning off  
The Rear Entertainment System turns off  
when any of the following operations are  
done.  
NOTE  
l
Do not use the Rear Entertainment System  
for a long period with the engine off. The  
vehicle battery could run down.  
l
The POWER button on the remote  
controller is pressed.  
The ignition switch is turned to the  
LOCK position.  
The display is closed.  
l
To listen to the Rear Entertainment System  
l
sound from the vehicle speakers, change the  
audio or navigation system sound to the  
Rear Entertainment System sound.  
Refer to Sound on page 6-69.  
l
Playback  
l
To listen to audio other than from the  
The top menu or disc menu may be  
displayed on the monitor screen when a  
disc is played. From these menus, the disc  
functions can be performed.  
Refer to Top menu and disc menu on page  
speakers of the rear entertainment system, it  
is necessary to use the wireless headphones  
that are included. For headphone  
specification, refer to  
Operation Tips for Headphones(page  
l
The cooling fan of this unit may activate if  
the temperature of the unit is high, however,  
this does not indicate a malfunction.  
NOTE  
l
For some discs, the top menu or disc menu  
may be displayed automatically after  
playback.  
l
Refer to the instruction manual attached to  
the disc for the top menu or disc menu.  
When no disc is inserted  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or  
ON position.  
6-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page301  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (301,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
2. Insert the disc into the disc slot.  
After the disc is inserted, the playback  
starts.  
NOTE  
If the RETURN button is pressed after the  
playback has been stopped, the resume  
playback function is canceled. Once the  
resume playback function is canceled, the  
playback starts from the first chapter (DVD  
video)/track (video CD, audio CD, DVD  
audio, or MP3/WMA CD) when the PLAY  
button is pressed.  
CAUTION  
Insert the disc with its label-side  
(decorated side) facing upward. If the  
disc is inserted upside-down, it may  
cause a malfunction.  
Pausing the playback  
When a disc has been inserted  
Press the PAUSE button to pause the  
playback.  
Press the PAUSE or PLAY button to  
resume the playback.  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or  
ON position.  
2. Turn on the Rear Entertainment  
System.  
Fast-forward/Reverse  
3. Press the PLAY button to start  
playback.  
Fast-forward  
Image and sound is fast-forwarded while  
the FWD button (  
NOTE  
) is pressed.  
If the Rear Entertainment System has been  
turned off during a previous playback,  
playback automatically resumes when the  
system is turned on.  
Reverse  
Image and sound is reversed while the  
REW button ( ) is pressed.  
Slow playback (DVD video and video  
CD)  
Stopping the playback  
Press the STOP button to stop the  
playback.  
To resume the playback, press the PLAY  
button.  
Press the SLOW button to slow the  
playback.  
Press the SLOW or PLAY button to return  
to normal playback speed.  
Resume playback function  
NOTE  
The Rear Entertainment System stores the  
position where the playback has been  
stopped using the resume playback  
function.  
l
Slow playback is not available for audio  
CD, DVD audio and MP3/WMA CD.  
l
The unit is muted while in slow playback.  
Press the PLAY button to resume the  
playback from the position previously  
stopped.  
Skipping the chapter/track  
Chapter (DVD video) or track (video CD,  
DVD audio, audio CD, and MP3/WMA  
CD) can be skipped (changed).  
6-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page302  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (302,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Fast-forward skip  
Skipping to desired title/group  
Press the NEXT button (  
the next chapter/track.  
) to skip to  
The playback can be started from the  
desired title/group by entering the title/  
group number.  
Reverse skip  
1. Enter the title/group number using the  
number keys (0 to 9) while the  
playback is stopped.  
Press the PREV button (  
the beginning of the current chapter/track.  
) to return to  
NOTE  
2. Press the ENTER button to start the  
playback from the selected title.  
Example: When selecting title number  
2”  
To return to the beginning of the previous  
chapter/track, press the PREV button (  
again within 2 seconds after the button is  
pressed.  
)
1.Press the number key (2).  
2.Press the ENTER button.  
Skipping to desired chapter/track  
The playback can be started from the  
NOTE  
l
desired chapter (DVD video)/track (video  
CD, DVD audio and audio CD) by  
entering the chapter/track number.  
If a title/group number not in the disc is  
input, the last title/group is played.  
l
Refer to the instruction manual attached to  
the disc for the title/group numbers.  
1. Enter the chapter/track number using  
the number keys (0 to 9) while the disc  
is being played.  
Bonus group playback  
1. Press the number button (0) while a  
disc is not being played.  
2. Press the ENTER button to start the  
playback from the selected chapter/  
track.  
If the disc has a bonus group*, the  
display shows as follows.  
Example: when selecting chapter/track  
number 10”  
1.Press the number key (1).  
2.Press the number key (0).  
3.Press the ENTER button.  
NOTE  
l
If a chapter/track number not in the disc is  
input, the last chapter/track is played.  
l
Refer to the instruction manual attached to  
the disc for chapter/track numbers.  
6-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page303  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (303,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
2. Press the ENTER button to change the  
display to the password input screen,  
then enter the password.  
Displaying/selecting top menu/disc  
menu  
1. To display the top menu on the screen,  
press the MENU button while the disc  
is not being played. To display the disc  
menu on the screen, press the MENU  
button during playback.  
For the password, see the instruction  
manual attached to the disc.  
2. Move the cursor to the desired menu  
by operating the select button up/down  
or left/right.  
3. Press the ENTER button to operate the  
selected menu.  
4. To return to playback, press the MENU  
button or the STOP button, then the  
PLAY button.  
* Bonus group means the 'Bonus tracks'  
originally recorded in the disc.  
Function menu  
In the function menu, the following items  
can be selected/operated while in  
playback.  
Language (sound and subtitle)  
selection (DVD video and DVD audio)  
Subtitle ON/OFF (DVD video)  
Display angle change (DVD video and  
DVD audio)  
q
Assist Functions (DVD video, DVD  
audio, video CD and audio CD)  
Top menu and disc menu  
NOTE  
Operation may vary or cannot be performed  
depending on the disc. Refer to the instruction  
manual attached to the disc.  
Sound output balance adjustment  
(Video CD)  
Repeat/random playback (Video CD,  
DVD audio and audio CD)  
Top menu  
Multiple titles may have been recorded on  
some discs.  
DVD video function menu  
For these DVD discs, the desired title can  
be selected in the top menu.  
Disc menu  
The unique functions of each DVD disc  
are recorded as the menu. This is referred  
to as the disc menu.  
Various menu related images and sound  
are recorded in the disc menu.  
6-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page304  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:19 PM  
Black plate (304,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
NOTE  
For audio CD, the function menu is  
automatically displayed when playback is  
started.  
DVD audio function menu  
Language (sound and subtitles)  
selection (DVD video and DVD audio)  
Sound and subtitles can be changed to the  
desired language.  
NOTE  
Available languages varies depending on the  
DVD disc.  
Video CD/audio CD function menu  
1. Press the DISPLAY button to display  
the function menu.  
2. Move the cursor and select the sound  
select mode or subtitle select mode by  
operating the select button to the left or  
right.  
NOTE  
l
In the function menu, the title/group  
number, chapter/track number, and  
playback elapsed time cannot be selected/  
changed.  
l
Settings set in the function menu are  
available only for the current disc. Settings  
set in the initial setting function menu are  
available for the Rear Entertainment  
System unit itself so that the settings remain  
after the disc is changed. Refer to Initial  
setting function on page 6-83.  
3. Move the cursor and select the desired  
language by operating the select button  
up or down.  
4. Press the DISPLAY button to finish the  
function menu.  
Displaying the function menu  
Subtitle ON/OFF (DVD video)  
Press the DISPLAY button while in  
playback to display the function menu on  
the monitor screen.  
Press the DISPLAY button again to  
cancel.  
Subtitle on/off can be set.  
1. Press the DISPLAY button to display  
the function menu.  
6-78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page305  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (305,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
2. Move the cursor to the subtitle ON/  
OFF mode by operating the select  
button to the left or right.  
2. Move the cursor to the display angle  
change mode by operating the select  
button to the left or right.  
3. Select ON to display the subtitles, or  
OFF to hide them by operating the  
select button up or down.  
3. Move the cursor and select the desired  
angle by operating the select button up  
or down.  
4. Press the DISPLAY button to finish the  
function menu.  
4. Press the DISPLAY button to finish the  
function menu.  
Display angle change (DVD video and  
DVD audio)  
Sound output balance adjustment  
(Video CD)  
The image can be displayed at the desired  
angle.  
1. Press the DISPLAY button during the  
video CD playback to display the  
function menu.  
NOTE  
l
Display angle change is not available for  
2. Move the cursor to the sound output  
balance adjustment mode by operating  
the select button to the left or right.  
discs other than multi-angle recorded DVD  
discs. Refer to the instruction manual  
attached to the disc for details.  
l
The available angles vary depending on the  
disc.  
1. Press the DISPLAY button to display  
the function menu.  
6-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page306  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (306,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
3. Set the sound output to the desired  
balance by operating the select button  
up or down.  
3. Select the desired mode by operating  
the select button up or down.  
(1) During DVD audio:  
Press the button and the settings  
changes in the order of L+R L R.  
The sound balance changes according  
to the setting.  
Each time the button is pressed, the  
mode changes in the order of 1 ―  
NON RPF NOF RND ―  
RNF ALL 1.  
ALL: Repeats all tracks.  
L: Audio recorded in the audio output  
channel from the left is output.  
R: Audio recorded in the audio output  
channel from the right is output.  
1: Repeats the current track.  
RPF: Repeats all tracks in the current  
group  
NOF: Stops playback after all tracks in  
the current group are played.  
RND: Randomly selects and plays a  
track from all tracks.  
L
R: Audio recorded in the audio  
output channel from the left/right is  
output.  
RNF: Randomly selects and plays a  
track from the current group.  
(2) During video CD and audio CD  
Each time the button is pressed, the  
mode changes in the order of 1 ―  
NON RND ALL 1.  
ALL: Repeats all tracks. (Returns to  
the beginning of the disc after all tracks  
are played.)  
4. Press the DISPLAY button to finish the  
function menu.  
Repeat/random playback (Video CD,  
DVD audio and audio CD)  
Tracks can be played repeatedly or  
randomly.  
1. Press the DISPLAY button while in the  
playback to display the function menu  
on the monitor screen.  
1: Repeats the current track.  
NON: Stops playback after all tracks in  
the disc are played.  
2. Move the cursor to the repeat/random  
playback mode by operating the select  
button to the left or right.  
RND: Randomly plays a track.  
4. Press the DISPLAY button to finish the  
function menu.  
NOTE  
The function menu is displayed during audio  
CD playback and it cannot be canceled by  
pressing the DISPLAY button during playback.  
q
Assist Functions (MP3/WMA CD)  
Folders and files  
The order of MP3/WMA file playback is  
as follows:  
l
A folder number is assigned to each  
folder on a disc.  
6-80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page307  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (307,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
l
For example, the folder numbers for  
Folder/File information display  
window  
folders (1), (3), and (5) in the figure are  
not displayed because they do not  
contain MP3/WMA files.  
Display mode  
l
Folders and files in a hierarchy are  
played in the order that they are  
recorded on the disc by the writing  
software.  
l
Up to 255 files in 8 hierarchies can be  
played.  
l
The loading time may be longer  
depending on the disc.  
: Folder  
: Order of playback  
: MP3 file  
: WMA file  
Changing the display mode  
1. Move the cursor to the display mode  
by operating the select button to the left  
or right.  
2. Change the display mode by operating  
the select button up or down.  
Display  
Displayed information  
FOLDER  
All folders and files display  
File tag display  
(FOLDER name, FILE name,  
TITLE name, ARTIST name,  
and ALBUM name) display  
TAG INFO  
TREE IDX  
PLST IDX  
Folder tree display  
Playlist display  
(If there is a playlist on the  
disc.)  
Level 1 Level 2  
Level 3  
Level 4  
Files on playlist display  
(If the files on the playlist are  
being played.)  
PLAYLIST  
CD TRACK  
Function menu  
CD track display  
If MP3/WMA files are to be played,  
operate the select button and move the  
cursor to select the playback file,  
playback mode, and display mode.  
Folder number/Playback list number  
File number  
(If CD tracks on a disc which  
has both MP3/WMA and CD  
audio files are being played.)  
Changing the playback mode  
1. Move the cursor to the playback mode  
by operating the select button to the left  
or right.  
Playback elapsed time  
Playback mode  
Playback status  
6-81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page308  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (308,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
2. Change the display mode by operating  
the select button up or down.  
While in TREEIDX display mode  
1. Move the cursor to the folder/file  
information display window by  
operating the select button to the left or  
right.  
Display  
Playback mode  
ALL  
All files are played repeatedly.  
The current file is played  
repeatedly.  
1
2. Move the cursor to the folder where the  
desired file is located by operating the  
select button up or down.  
All files are played once and the  
playback stops.  
NON  
RPF  
All files in the current folder are  
played repeatedly.  
3. Press the ENTER button. Playback  
starts from the first track in the selected  
folder.  
Files in the current folder are  
played once and the playback  
stops.  
NOF  
RND  
RNF  
All files are played randomly.  
NOTE  
Files in the current folder are  
played randomly.  
l
mark is attached to a folder if the  
folder has a playable MP3/WMA file.  
If a disc including a playlist is being  
played, the playlist file can be selected.  
l
NOTE  
If RND or RNF is selected during a playlist  
playback, files on the playlist are played  
randomly. Refer to Playlist File Playback on  
Playlist file playback  
Playlist files can be played using the  
following procedure:  
Selection file  
1. Set the display mode to the TREEIDX  
mode. Refer to Changing the display  
mode on page 6-80.  
While in FOLDER display mode  
1. Move the cursor to the folder/file  
information display window by  
operating the select button to the left or  
right.  
2. Move the cursor to the PLAYLIST by  
operating the select button.  
3. Press the ENTER button to change the  
display from TREEIDX to PLSTIDX.  
2. Move the cursor to the desired folder/  
file by operating the select button up or  
down.  
4. Move the cursor to the desired playlist  
file by operating the select button up or  
down.  
3. Press the ENTER button to play the  
selected file or to move to the selected  
folder.  
5. Press the ENTER button. Playback  
starts in the order programmed in the  
playlist file.  
NOTE  
To return to an upper hierarchy, move the  
cursor to the PARENT FOLDERand press  
the ENTER button.  
NOTE  
The loading time after pressing the ENTER  
button may be longer depending on the disc.  
6-82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page309  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (309,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
3. Press the ENTER button. The selected  
menu is highlighted to indicate that the  
menu is selected.  
qInitial Setting Function  
The settings set in the initial setting  
function remain after the unit is turned off  
or the disc is changed.  
The following items can be set in the  
initial setting.  
Lang: Sound and subtitle setting  
Rating: Parental lock setting  
Mark: On-Screen Mark, Angle Mark and  
Mode Priority settings  
Audio: Audio DRC setting  
Aspect: Not available  
Displaying/selecting the initial setting  
function menu  
4. Select the item to be set by operating  
the select button up or down.  
1. Press the SET UP button while the disc  
is not being played to display the initial  
setting function menu on the monitor  
screen.  
NOTE  
l
The initial setting can be performed with no  
disc inserted.  
l
After setting the initial setting, the playback  
starts from the first chapter/track.  
2. Move the cursor to the desired menu  
by operating the select button up/down  
or left/right.  
6-83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page310  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (310,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
5. Press the ENTER button. The  
highlighted color returns to the  
previous color to indicate that the  
selected item is set.  
Changing to a language other than  
English and Japanese  
NOTE  
l
Languages other than English and  
Japanese can be set by entering the  
language code in the language code list.  
Refer to Language code list on page 6-92.  
l
If the selected language is not recorded in  
the disc, the language is not available.  
1. Move the cursor to Otherby  
operating the select button up or down.  
2. Press the ENTER button, and then  
operate the select button to the right.  
6. To finish the function menu on the  
monitor display, press the SET UP,  
MENU, or STOP button.  
Lang (Language)  
Sound and subtitles can be changed to the  
desired language.  
3. Enter the desired language code by  
pressing the number keys (0 to 9) or  
operating the select button up or down.  
4. Press the ENTER button to set the  
language of the entered language code.  
NOTE  
If Englishor Japaneseis selected  
afterward, the previously entered language  
code is cleared.  
Menu language: Language used for top  
menu/disc menu  
Sound language: Language used for  
movie sound (voice)  
Subtitle language: Language used for  
subtitles  
Rating  
If the disc has a parental lock code,  
viewing can be restricted. Also, the setting  
can be protected by a password to prevent  
someone changing the setting.  
6-84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page311  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (311,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Viewing can be restricted by setting the  
parent lock level.  
For example, if the level is set to 6, level 7  
or higher viewing is locked and cannot be  
played.  
Changing the Rating setting  
1. Enter the password by pressing the  
number keys (0 to 9) or operating the  
select button up or down.  
NOTE  
l
Parent lock is not available depending on  
the disc.  
l
The initial password setting (when  
purchased) is 0000.  
2. Press the ENTER button.  
If the password is confirmed, the  
Rating change mode is displayed.  
NOTE  
The setting cannot be changed without the  
correct password. Note down the password so  
you don't forget it.  
Rating change: Parent lock level setting  
Country change: Setting for the country  
where the disc is being played.  
Password change: Registered password  
changes  
3. Select the desired parent lock level and  
press the ENTER button to set.  
6-85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page312  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (312,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Country change  
3. Enter the country code by pressing the  
number keys (0 to 9) or operating the  
select button up or down.  
NOTE  
It is necessary to set the country code because  
the parent lock level is different depending on  
the country. When using the unit in U.S.A., set  
the country code to 3018. The parent lock  
function is disabled without the country code  
setting (page 6-94).  
1. Enter the password by pressing the  
number keys (0 to 9) or operating the  
select button up or down.  
4. Press the ENTER button to set the  
country of the entered country code.  
Changing the password  
1. Enter the password by pressing the  
number keys (0 to 9) or operating the  
select button up or down.  
2. Press the ENTER button.  
If the password is confirmed, the  
password change mode is displayed.  
NOTE  
The setting cannot be changed without the  
correct password. Note down the password so  
you don't forget it.  
2. Press the ENTER button.  
If the password is confirmed, the  
password change mode is displayed.  
NOTE  
The setting cannot be changed without the  
correct password. Note down the password so  
you don't forget it.  
6-86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page313  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (313,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Mark  
The DVD video playback status and angle  
display on/off, and priority of the inserted  
discs can be set.  
3. Enter the new password by pressing the  
number keys (0 to 9) or operating the  
select button up or down.  
4. Press the ENTER button to set the new  
password.  
On-Screen Mark  
Select ON to display, OFF not to display  
the DVD video playback status on the  
upper right corner of the screen.  
When the screen display is on, the  
following marks are displayed on the  
upper right corner of the screen (in Disc  
mode).  
Mark  
Condition  
Playback  
Stop (Resume standby)  
Pause  
Fast-forward  
Reverse  
Angle display  
The camera mark display when multi-  
angle can be performed.  
6-87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page314  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (314,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
NOTE  
Auxiliary Input (AUX mode)  
l
The display angle change is not available  
for discs other than multi-angle recorded  
DVD discs. Refer to the instruction manual  
accompanying the disc for details.  
The screen size and angle can be changed  
when On-Screen Mark and Angle Mark is  
off.  
In AUX mode, AVequipment such as a  
video game player or a video camera can  
be used by connecting the image and  
sound cables to the auxiliary terminals.  
l
NOTE  
l
Before operating, read the instruction  
manual accompanying the AVequipment to  
be used.  
To listen to the Rear Entertainment System  
sound from the vehicle speakers, change the  
audio or navigation system sound to the  
Rear Entertainment System sound.  
Refer to Sound on page 6-69.  
Mode Priority  
The priority of the inserted discs (CD-R/  
CD-RW) can be selected.  
l
Audio  
Digital Output  
Not used with this unit.  
To listen to audio other than from the  
speakers of the rear entertainment system, it  
is necessary to use the wireless headphones  
that are included. For headphone  
specification, refer to  
Operation Tips for Headphones(page  
The cooling fan for this unit may activate if  
Audio DRC  
The audio dynamic range can be adjusted  
to reduce the difference between the  
maximum and minimum audio output.  
Audio compression of the DVD video  
playback can be selected or deselected  
during playback using the following  
modes:  
l
the temperature of the unit is high, however,  
this does not indicate a malfunction.  
Mode  
Function  
qAuxiliary Terminals and Power  
NONE  
Playback with normal volume  
Lower volume is increased to  
reduce difference in volume range.  
Outlet  
LINE  
RF  
The auxiliary terminals and power outlet  
are positioned as shown in the figure.  
Use when it is still difficult to hear  
sound while using LINE.  
Sound quality is reduced while  
using RF.  
Power outlet  
(AC115V)  
NOTE  
Only sound output from the headphones is  
available.  
Auxiliary  
terminals  
6-88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page315  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (315,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Auxiliary terminals  
WARNING  
Ø Never use medical instruments  
with the power outlet.  
Ø Follow the cautions below to  
prevent electrical shock.  
The auxiliary terminals consist of one  
image input terminal and two sound input  
terminals (for left and right).  
Image input terminal: Yellow  
Sound input (Right) terminal: Red  
Sound input (Left) terminal: White  
To use, open the cover.  
Ø
Do not plug accessories into the  
power outlet or unplug them  
with wet hands.  
Ø
Ø
Do not put anything other than  
plugs into the outlet.  
CAUTION  
Close the cover when the terminals  
are not in use. If foreign material  
penetrates, or liquid is spilled on it, it  
may cause a malfunction.  
Do not disassemble the outlet.  
CAUTION  
Ø Always close the cover when not in  
use. If foreign objects or liquid  
penetrate the outlet, it may cause  
a malfunction.  
NOTE  
l
For monaural equipment (with one sound  
output terminal), connect the terminal to  
the sound input terminal (White). The  
sound is output from the speaker to which  
the terminal has been connected.  
Noise may occur depending on the  
connected equipment.  
Ø Do not use electrical appliances  
that exceed the prescribed power  
capacity. It may cause a  
l
malfunction.  
NOTE  
Power Outlet  
To prevent discharging of the battery, do not  
use the auxiliary input for long periods with  
the engine off or idling.  
The power outlet can be used as a power  
supply for electrical devices when the  
ignition switch is in the ACC or ON  
position.  
Plug-in  
1. Open the cover.  
Only use AC 115 V electrical appliances  
requiring no greater than 100 W  
Open the cover to use the power outlet.  
6-89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page316  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (316,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
2. Lightly insert the plug and turn the  
outlet 90 degrees, then insert it fully.  
NOTE  
The following electrical appliances may not  
operate even if their electrical capacity is 100  
W or less.  
POWER OUTLET  
l
Appliances requiring large amounts of  
power for activation (such as cathode-ray  
tube televisions, refrigerators with a  
compressor, electrical pumps, and electrical  
tools)  
l
Appliances with a power supply frequency  
switch function (such as clocks and audio)  
l
Appliances for precise data processing  
(such as measurement equipment)  
Some electrical appliances other than the  
above may not operate.  
The protection circuit may operate and the  
power supply may be stopped to prevent  
battery depletion.  
When using an electrical appliance for data  
processing such as a personal computer, back  
up the data frequently.  
Unplug  
1. Pull the plug out.  
2. Close the cover.  
The power outlet (AC115V) cannot be used in  
the following cases:  
l
Battery power is weak  
l
Appliances with a capacity of 100 W or  
more are used  
l
Cabin temperature is extremely hot  
Noise may occur during radio or television  
operation depending on the electrical  
appliance being used.  
qUsing AV Equipment  
CAUTION  
For safe driving, adjust the volume  
while driving so that ambient sound  
can be heard.  
NOTE  
Before operating, read the instruction manual  
accompanying the AVequipment to be used.  
6-90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page317  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (317,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK  
position.  
5. Press the SOURCE button and select  
the AUX mode.  
Refer to Mode on page 6-73.  
2. If a power supply is necessary, connect  
the outlet to the power outlet.  
Refer to Power outlet on page 6-88.  
3. Connect the image cable and sound  
cables to the input terminals.  
Accessory socket  
(DC12 V, 10 A)  
Plug  
AV  
Auxiliary  
equipment  
terminals  
Red  
White  
Yellow  
6. Operate the equipment following the  
instruction manual accompanying the  
equipment.  
Sound cable (Right)  
Sound cable (Left)  
Image cable  
NOTE  
l
For monaural equipment (with one sound  
output terminal), connect the terminal to  
either of the sound input terminals (Red)  
and (White). The sound is output from the  
speaker to which the terminal has been  
connected.  
l
Noise may occur depending on the  
connected equipment.  
4. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or  
ON position.  
6-91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page318  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (318,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Language Code List  
Language  
Code  
1001  
Language  
Code  
Abkhazian  
Afar  
ab  
aa  
af  
Greek  
el  
kl  
1411  
2011  
1613  
1620  
1700  
1822  
1708  
1720  
1818  
1813  
1800  
1804  
1810  
1600  
1819  
1900  
1922  
2013  
2018  
2010  
2722  
2024  
2713  
2014  
2020  
2114  
2100  
2121  
2113  
2119  
2210  
2206  
2218  
2211  
2219  
2208  
2217  
2214  
2213  
1000  
1005  
2816  
1012  
1017  
1724  
1018  
1024  
1025  
1100  
1420  
1113  
1325  
1107  
1108  
1117  
1106  
2224  
1104  
2012  
1200  
3507  
1214  
1717  
1218  
1300  
2311  
1413  
1414  
1419  
1514  
1509  
1508  
1517  
1524  
1611  
1304  
2000  
Greenlandic  
Guarani  
Gujarati  
Hausa  
Afrekaans  
Albanian  
Amharic  
Arabic  
gn  
gu  
ha  
iw  
hi  
sq  
am  
ar  
Hebrew  
Armenian  
Assamase  
Aymara  
Azerbaijani  
Bashkir  
Basque  
hy  
as  
ay  
az  
ba  
eu  
bn  
dz  
bh  
bi  
Hindi  
Hungarian  
Icelandic  
Indonesian  
Interlingua  
Interlingue  
Inupiak  
hu  
is  
in  
ia  
ie  
Bengali  
Bhutani  
Bihari  
ik  
Irish  
ga  
it  
Italian  
Bislama  
Breton  
Japanese  
Javanese  
Kannada  
Kashmiri  
Kazakh  
ja  
br  
bg  
my  
be  
km  
ca  
zh  
co  
hr  
cs  
da  
nl  
jw  
kn  
ks  
kk  
rw  
ky  
rn  
Bulgarian  
Burmese  
Byelorussian  
Cambodian  
Catalan  
Chinese  
Corsican  
Croatian  
Czech  
Kinyarwanda  
Kirghiz  
Kirundi  
Korean  
ko  
ku  
lo  
Kurdish  
Laothian  
Latin  
Danish  
la  
Dutch  
Latvian  
lv  
English  
Esperanto  
Estonian  
Faroese  
Fiji  
en  
eo  
et  
Lingala  
ln  
Lithuanian  
Macedonian  
Malagasy  
Malay  
lt  
mk  
mg  
ms  
ml  
mt  
mi  
mr  
mo  
mn  
fo  
fj  
Finnish  
French  
fi  
Malayalam  
Maltese  
fr  
Friesian  
Galician  
German  
Gorgian  
fy  
gl  
Maori  
Marathi  
de  
ka  
Moldavian  
Mongolian  
6-92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page319  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (319,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Language  
Code  
2300  
2304  
2314  
2402  
2417  
2412  
2500  
2518  
1500  
2511  
2519  
2620  
2712  
2714  
2720  
2812  
2806  
2800  
1603  
2817  
2807  
2819  
2913  
2813  
2803  
2808  
2818  
2810  
2811  
2814  
1418  
2820  
2822  
2821  
2911  
2906  
2900  
2919  
2904  
2907  
1114  
Language  
Code  
2908  
2914  
2918  
2910  
2917  
2922  
3010  
3017  
3025  
3108  
3114  
1224  
3214  
3307  
1908  
3414  
3520  
Nauru  
na  
ne  
no  
oc  
or  
om  
pa  
ps  
fa  
Tigrinya  
Tonga  
ti  
to  
Nepali  
Norwegian  
Occtian  
Oriya  
Tsonga  
Tukmen  
Turkish  
Twi  
ts  
tk  
tr  
Oromo  
tw  
uk  
ur  
uz  
vi  
Panjabi  
Ukrainian  
Urdu  
Pashto, Pushto  
Persian  
Uzbek  
Vietnamese  
Volapuk  
Welsh  
Polish  
pl  
Portuguese  
Quechua  
Rhaeto-Romance  
Romanian  
Russian  
Samoan  
Sangho  
pt  
vo  
cy  
wo  
xh  
ji  
qu  
rm  
ro  
ru  
sm  
sg  
sa  
gd  
sr  
Wolof  
Xhosa  
Yiddish  
Yoruba  
Zulu  
yo  
zu  
SanSkrit  
Scots-Gaelic  
Serbian  
Serbo-Croatian  
Sesotho  
Setswana  
Shona  
sh  
st  
tn  
sn  
sd  
si  
Sindhi  
Singhalese  
Siswaiti  
Slovak  
ss  
sk  
sl  
Slovenian  
Somali  
so  
es  
su  
sw  
sv  
tl  
Spanish  
Sundanese  
Swahili  
Swedish  
Tagalog  
Tajik  
tg  
Tamil  
ta  
Tatar  
tt  
Telugu  
te  
Thai  
th  
Tibetan  
bo  
6-93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page320  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (320,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Country Code List  
Country  
Code  
1005  
Country  
Code  
Afghanistan  
Albania  
AF  
AL  
DZ  
AS  
AD  
AO  
AI  
Cape Verde  
CV  
KY  
CF  
1221  
2024  
1205  
2903  
1211  
1213  
1223  
1202  
1214  
2012  
1206  
1011  
1325  
1018  
1003  
1014  
1008  
1016  
1006  
1017  
1012  
1022  
1020  
1019  
1025  
1118  
1107  
1103  
1101  
1124  
1104  
1125  
1109  
1112  
1119  
1114  
1100  
1122  
1121  
1117  
Cayman Islands  
Central African Republic  
Chad  
Algeria  
American Samoa  
Andorra  
TD  
CL  
CN  
CX  
CC  
CO  
KM  
CG  
Chile  
Angola  
China  
Anguilla  
Christmas Island  
Cocos (Keeling) Islands  
Colombia  
Antarctica  
Antigua and Barbuda  
Argentina  
Armenia  
AQ  
AG  
AR  
AM  
AW  
AU  
AT  
Comoros  
Congo  
Aruba  
Congo,The Democratic  
Republic of the  
CD  
1203  
Australia  
Cook Islands  
Costa Rica  
Cote D'Ivoire  
Croatia (Hrvatska)  
Cuba  
CK  
CR  
CI  
1210  
1217  
1208  
1717  
1220  
1224  
1225  
1310  
1309  
1312  
1314  
2915  
1402  
1406  
2821  
1616  
1417  
1404  
1419  
1510  
1514  
1509  
1508  
1517  
1605  
2505  
Austria  
Azerbaijan  
Bahamas  
Bahrain  
AZ  
BS  
HR  
CU  
CY  
CZ  
DK  
DJ  
BH  
BD  
BB  
BY  
BE  
BZ  
BJ  
Bangladesh  
Barbados  
Belarus  
Cyprus  
Czech Republic  
Denmark  
Belgium  
Djibouti  
Belize  
Dominica  
DM  
DO  
TP  
EC  
EG  
SV  
GQ  
ER  
EE  
ET  
FK  
FO  
FJ  
Benin  
Dominican Republic  
East Timor  
Ecuador  
Bermuda  
Bhutan  
BM  
BT  
BO  
BA  
BW  
BV  
BR  
Bolivia  
Egypt  
Bosnia and Herzegovina  
Botswana  
Bouvet Island  
Brazil  
El Salvador  
Equatorial Guinea  
Eritrea  
Estonia  
British Indian Ocean  
Territory  
IO  
1814  
Ethiopia  
Brunei  
BN  
BG  
BF  
1113  
1106  
1105  
1108  
2007  
1212  
1200  
Falkland Islands (Malvinas)  
Faroe Islands  
Fiji  
Bulgaria  
Burkina Faso  
Burundi  
BI  
Finland  
FI  
Cambodia  
Cameroon  
Canada  
KH  
CM  
CA  
France  
FR  
GF  
PF  
French Guiana  
French  
6-94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page321  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (321,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Country  
Code  
2905  
1600  
1612  
1604  
1304  
1607  
1608  
1617  
1611  
1603  
1615  
1620  
1619  
1613  
1622  
1624  
1719  
1712  
3100  
1713  
1710  
1720  
1818  
1813  
1803  
1817  
1816  
1804  
1811  
1819  
1912  
1915  
1914  
2025  
2004  
2008  
Country  
Lao People's Democratic  
Latvia  
Code  
2100  
2121  
2101  
2118  
2117  
2124  
2108  
2119  
2120  
2214  
French Southern Territories  
TF  
LA  
LV  
LB  
LS  
LR  
LY  
LI  
Gabon  
GA  
GM  
GE  
DE  
GH  
GI  
Gambia  
Lebanon  
Georgia  
Lesotho  
Germany  
Ghana  
Liberia  
Libyan Arab Jamahiriya  
Liechtenstein  
Lithuania  
Gibraltar  
Greece  
GR  
GL  
GD  
GP  
GU  
GT  
GN  
GW  
GY  
HT  
HM  
VA  
HN  
HK  
HU  
IS  
LT  
Greenland  
Grenada  
Luxembourg  
Macau  
LU  
MO  
Guadeloupe  
Guam  
Macedonia, the Former  
Yugoslav Republic of  
MK  
2210  
Madagascar  
Malawi  
MG  
MW  
MY  
MV  
ML  
MT  
MH  
MQ  
MR  
MU  
YT  
2206  
2222  
2224  
2221  
2211  
2219  
2207  
2216  
2217  
2220  
3419  
2223  
1512  
2203  
2202  
2213  
2218  
2200  
2225  
2212  
2300  
2317  
2315  
2311  
1013  
2302  
2325  
2308  
2304  
Guatemala  
Guinea  
Malaysia  
Guinea-Bissau  
Guyana  
Maldives  
Mali  
Haiti  
Malta  
Heard and McDonald Islands  
Holy See (Vatican City State)  
Honduras  
Hong Kong  
Hungary  
Marshall Islands  
Martinique  
Mauritania  
Mauritius  
Mayotte  
Iceland  
Mexico  
MX  
FM  
MD  
MC  
MN  
MS  
MA  
MZ  
MM  
NA  
NR  
NP  
India  
IN  
Micronesia, Federated States  
Moldova, Republic  
Monaco  
Indonesia  
Iran, Islamic Republic of  
Iraq  
ID  
IR  
IQ  
Mongolia  
Ireland  
IE  
Montserrat  
Morocco  
Israel  
IL  
Italy  
IT  
Mozambique  
Myanmar (Burma)  
Namibia  
Jamaica  
JM  
JP  
Japan  
Jordan  
JO  
Nauru  
Kazakstan  
Kenya  
KZ  
KE  
KI  
Nepal  
Netherlands  
Netherlands Antilles  
New Caledonia  
New Zealand  
Nicaragua  
NL  
Kiribati  
AN  
NC  
NZ  
Korea (North), Democratic  
People's Republic  
KP  
2015  
Korea (South), Republic of  
Kuwait  
KR  
KW  
KG  
2017  
2022  
2006  
NI  
Kyrgyzstan  
Niger  
NE  
6-95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page322  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (322,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Country  
Code  
2306  
2320  
2305  
2215  
2314  
2412  
2510  
2522  
Country  
Code  
Nigeria  
NG  
NU  
NF  
South Africa  
ZA  
GS  
3500  
Niue  
South Georgia and the South  
Sandwich Islands  
1618  
Norfolk Island  
Spain  
ES  
LK  
SD  
SR  
1418  
2110  
2803  
2817  
Northern Mariana Islands  
MP  
NO  
OM  
PK  
Sri Lanka  
Sudan  
Norway  
Oman  
Suriname  
Pakistan  
Palau  
Svalbard and Jan Mayen  
Islands  
PW  
SJ  
2809  
Palestinian Territory,  
Occupied  
PS  
2518  
Swaziland  
SZ  
SE  
2825  
2804  
1207  
2824  
2922  
2909  
2925  
2907  
2906  
2910  
2914  
2919  
2913  
2917  
2912  
2902  
2921  
3006  
3000  
1004  
1601  
3018  
Sweden  
Panama  
PA  
PG  
PY  
PE  
2500  
2506  
2524  
2504  
2507  
2513  
2511  
2519  
2517  
2600  
2704  
2714  
2720  
2722  
2807  
2013  
2102  
2512  
Switzerland  
CH  
SY  
TW  
TJ  
Papua New Guinea  
Paraguay  
Syrian Arab Republic  
Taiwan, Province of China  
Tajikistan  
Peru  
Philippines  
Pitcairn  
PH  
PN  
PL  
Tanzania,United Republic  
Thailand  
TZ  
TH  
TG  
TK  
TO  
TT  
TN  
TR  
TM  
TC  
TV  
UG  
UA  
AE  
GB  
US  
Poland  
Togo  
Portugal  
PT  
Tokelau  
Puerto Rico  
Qatar  
PR  
QA  
RE  
RO  
RU  
RW  
SH  
KN  
LC  
PM  
Tonga  
Trinidad and Tobago  
Tunisia  
Reunion  
Romania  
Turkey  
Russian Federation  
Rwanda  
Turkmenistan  
Turks and Caicos Islands  
Tuvalu  
Saint Helena  
Saint Kitts and  
Saint Lucia  
Saint Pierre and Miquelon  
Uganda  
Ukraine  
United Arab Emirates  
United Kingdom  
United States  
Saint Vincent and the  
Grenadines  
VC  
3102  
Samoa  
WS  
SM  
ST  
SA  
SN  
SC  
SL  
SG  
SK  
SI  
3218  
2812  
2819  
2800  
2813  
2802  
2811  
2806  
2810  
2808  
2801  
2814  
San Marino  
United States Minor Outlying  
Islands  
UM  
3012  
Sao Tome and Principe  
Saudi Arabia  
Senegal  
Uruguay  
Uzbekistan  
Vanuatu  
UY  
UZ  
VU  
3024  
3025  
3120  
Seychelles  
Vatican City State See Holy  
See  
Sierra Leone  
Singapore  
VA  
3100  
Venezuela  
VE  
VN  
VG  
VI  
3104  
3113  
3106  
3108  
Slovakia (Slovak Republic)  
Slovenia  
Viet Nam  
Virgin Islands, British  
Virgin Islands, U.S.  
Solomon Islands  
Somalia  
SB  
SO  
6-96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page323  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (323,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Country  
Code  
3205  
1407  
3404  
3420  
Wallis and Futuna Islands  
Western Sahara  
Yemen  
WF  
EH  
YE  
YU  
Yugoslavia  
Zaire See Congo, The  
Democratic Republic of the  
ZR  
3517  
Zambia  
ZM  
ZW  
3512  
3522  
Zimbabwe  
6-97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page324  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (324,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Error Message  
Incorrect region code  
qMessage  
An error message is displayed if a disc  
other than one with region code 1 or  
including region 1 is inserted.  
Disc mode error message  
Use of Non-supported Disc  
An error message is displayed if a non-  
supported DVD-ROM disc, a non-  
supported disc format or a disc (PAL,  
other) with a different image signal  
encoding is read.  
High temperature malfunction  
If the temperature surrounding the DVD  
player area exceeds 88°C (190°F), the  
DVD player operation is stopped to  
protect the unit. When the temperature  
decreases to 70°C (158°F) or less, the  
protective circuit function is cleared and  
the operation is restored.  
If the disc content cannot be read:  
An error message is displayed if the disc  
cannot be read due to scratches or the  
content cannot be read.  
6-98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page325  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (325,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
System errors (Common to each mode)  
Power malfunction  
An error message is displayed if the  
power supply to the rear entertainment  
system drops (About 9.5 Vor less), and  
the power is turned off.  
The power is restored when the power  
supply to the rear entertainment system is  
10 Vor more.  
High temperature malfunction  
If the temperature around the LCD area  
exceeds 95°C (203°F), the power supply  
is turned off to protect the LCD.  
When the temperature around the LCD  
area is 85°C (185°F) or less, the  
protective circuit function is cleared and  
the operation is restored.  
6-99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page326  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (326,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Symptoms and Actions  
If any malfunction is suspected, verify the following before requesting a repair.  
If the problem cannot be solved after performing the procedure, have the system inspected  
at an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Some functions are not available depending on the disc. Read the instruction manual  
attached to the disc before operating.  
Symptom  
Cause  
Action  
The ignition switch is in the LOCK  
position.  
Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position.  
The remote controller batteries are  
weak.  
Replace the batteries with new ones.  
Refer to Remote Controller on page 6-67.  
System  
cannot be  
turned on  
Remote controller batteries poles are  
pointed in the wrong direction.  
Install the batteries in the correct direction.  
Refer to Remote Controller on page 6-67.  
The vehicle battery is weak.  
Recharge or replace the vehicle battery.  
The cabin temperature  
(Rear Entertainment System unit tem- Retry after the temperature has lowered.  
perature) is high.  
The ignition switch is in the LOCK  
Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position.  
position.  
No disc is inserted.  
Insert a disc.  
Image  
cannot be  
displayed  
Insert a disc which can be played by this unit.  
Refer to Operating Tips for Discs on page 6-52.  
An invalid disc is inserted.  
Select the correct mode by pressing the SOURCE button.  
Refer to Mode on page 6-73.  
The wrong mode has been selected.  
No disc is inserted.  
Insert a disc.  
Disc cannot  
be played  
Disc is inserted upside down.  
Parent lock level is set.  
Insert the disc with the label-side up.  
Clear or change the parent lock level.  
The ignition switch is in the LOCK  
position.  
Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position.  
Adjust the volume.  
Volume is too low.  
The audio unit/navigation system is not Set the audio unit/navigation system in the Rear  
set in the Rear Entertainment System  
mode.  
Entertainment System mode.  
Refer to Sound Output on page 6-69.  
Sound  
Insert a disc which can be played by this unit.  
Refer to Operating Tips for Discs on page 6-52.  
cannot be  
output  
An invalid disc has been inserted.  
No disc is inserted.  
Insert a disc.  
Disc is inserted upside down.  
Playback has been paused.  
Insert the disc with the label-side up.  
Cancel the pause.  
The playback is in slow, fast-forward, or Select normal playback.  
reverse mode. Refer to Basic operation on page 6-74.  
6-100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page327  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (327,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Symptom  
Cause  
Action  
Audio  
output from DTS format language is selected and  
vehicle  
played back.  
Select audio other than DTS format.  
speakers but (The wireless headphones cannot play-  
not from  
back DTS format language)  
headphones  
The disc is dirty.  
Clean the signal surface of the disc.  
Replace the disc with another one.  
Clear the dew condensation.  
Image  
and/or sound The disc has a scratch.  
is distorted.  
Dew condensation on the disc  
There are  
The LCD is high tech equipment with a  
subtle spots  
99.99% effective sensor resolution.  
or  
However, please be aware that 0.01%  
luminescent  
pixel failure or pixel continuous  
spots on the  
illuminated pixels may exist.  
screen.  
Subtitles  
cannot be  
changed  
Other languages are not recorded on the Check the available language in the instruction manual  
disc. accompanying the disc.  
Display  
angle cannot  
be changed  
Multiple angles are not recorded on the Check the available angle in the instruction manual  
disc.  
accompanying the disc.  
The remote controller is not pointed  
toward the receiver on the unit.  
Point the remote controller toward the receiver on the unit.  
The receiver is near the disc slot.  
Operate the remote controller avoiding the obstruction so  
that the signal reaches the receiver on the unit. The  
receiver is near the disc slot.  
There is an obstruction between the  
remote controller and the unit.  
Remote  
controller is  
inoperable  
The remote controller batteries are  
weak.  
Replace the batteries with new ones.  
Refer to Remote Controller on page 6-67.  
Remote controller batteries poles are  
pointed in the wrong direction.  
Install the batteries in the correct direction.  
Refer to Remote Controller on page 6-67.  
No power to the headphones.  
Turn on the power to the headphones.  
The headphones' optical receiver is not Point the headphones' optical receiver towards the main  
pointed towards the main unit's  
transmitter.  
unit's transmitter. The main unit's transmitter is located  
near the disc insertion area.  
There is an obstruction between the  
headphones and the main unit.  
Avoid the obstruction.  
No audio The headphones' batteries are depleted. Replace the batteries with new ones.  
output from  
The headphones' batteries have not been  
the  
correctly inserted in the  
directions.  
/
Insert the batteries correctly.  
headphones.  
The headphones are exposed to direct  
sunlight.  
Use the headphones while avoiding direct sunlight.  
If there is no sound for 3 minutes or longer, or if the  
headphones are continuously used for 4 hours, there is a  
function which automatically turns the power off. Turn the  
power to headphones back on.  
Power turns off automatically.  
6-101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page328  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (328,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Rear Entertainment System  
Symptom  
The  
Cause  
Action  
headphones'  
optical  
reception  
range is too  
narrow.  
The headphones' batteries are weak.  
Replace the batteries with new ones.  
Replace the batteries with new ones.  
There is  
excessive  
noise in the The headphones' batteries are weak.  
headphone  
audio  
6-102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page329  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (329,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
NOTE  
l
Bluetooth Hands-Freeí  
If the ignition switch is turned off during a  
hands-free call, the line is transferred to the  
mobile telephone automatically.  
qWhat is a Bluetooth Hands-Free?  
l
If the mobile telephone is in a location  
where radio reception is difficult such as a  
metal container or in the trunk, the call may  
not be connected using Bluetooth. If  
communication is not possible, change the  
location of the mobile telephone.  
Bluetooth Hands-Free Outline  
By connecting a Bluetooth equipped  
mobile telephone to the hands-free unit  
equipped on the vehicle, making and  
receiving calls are possible using the  
phone button located on the steering  
wheel and voice commands.  
qComponent parts  
Bluetooth equipped mobile telephone  
The Bluetooth Hands-Free consists of the  
following parts:  
A Bluetooth equipped mobile telephone  
communicates with the hands-free unit  
equipped on the vehicle using radio  
transmission (Bluetooth).  
For example, if the mobile telephone is  
placed in a coat pocket, the phone calls  
can be made through your mobile service  
without direct use of the mobile  
telephone.  
l
Phone button  
Information display  
Microphone  
Audio unit/Navigation system  
l
l
l
Phone button  
Basic functions of the Bluetooth Hands-  
Free can be used such as making calls or  
hanging up by operating the phone button.  
Applicable Bluetooth specification  
Ver. 1.1 or higher  
Response profile  
l
HFP (Hands Free Profile) Ver.1.0  
DUN (Dial-up Networking Profile)  
l
Ver.1.1  
Phone button  
Bluetooth is the registered trademark of  
Bluetooth SIG. Inc.  
Phone button operations  
A short press or a long press of the phone  
button is used depending on the operation  
status as follows:  
l
Short press (Press the button less than  
0.7 sec.)  
l
Long press (Press the button 0.7 sec. or  
more.)  
íSome models. 6-103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page330  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (330,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
Information display  
If the Bluetooth Hands-Free is operated,  
information such as radio wave reception  
conditions of the Bluetooth Hands-Free  
are displayed on the screen. (With  
navigation system)  
Telephone numbers, Bluetooth Hands-  
Free messages, and operation status are  
displayed.  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
information  
Microphone  
qVoice  
The microphone is used for inputting  
voice commands or exchanging  
conversation.  
To prevent the deterioration in voice  
recognition rate and voice quality, the  
following points must be observed:  
l
It is not necessary to face the  
microphone or approach it. Call out the  
voice commands while maintaining a  
safe driving position.  
Microphone  
Audio unit/Navigation system  
The audio unit or navigation system is  
used for adjusting the volume.  
6-104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page331  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (331,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
l
Close the windows and/or the  
qFunction restrictions while using  
moonroof to shut out loud noises from  
outside the vehicle, or turn down the  
airflow of the climate control system  
while the Bluetooth Hands-Free is  
being used. Voice recognition may not  
function correctly or voice quality may  
deteriorate under the following  
conditions.  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
Functions are limited as follows while the  
Bluetooth Hands-Free is being used.  
l
Beep sound and voice guidance related  
to the audio unit and navigation system  
are not heard.  
Beep sound related to the A/C  
operation is not heard.  
The VOICE switch of the navigation  
system located on the steering wheel  
cannot be used.  
l
l
A passenger is speaking.  
Driving with the window and/or the  
l
l
moonroof open.  
Driving on bumpy roads.  
Noise outside of the vehicle is loud.  
l
l
qHow to use this section  
(Construction sites, inside tunnels,  
excess oncoming traffic, or heavy  
rain.)  
Descriptions in the text are as follows:  
Say: Voice commands to be called out by  
you.  
Prompt: Voice guidance output from the  
speaker.  
A beep sound [Beep] is output from the  
speaker. Call out after the beep sound is  
heard.  
Example)  
Say: [Beep] Dial”  
Prompt: Number, please”  
Say: [Beep] XXXXXXXXXXX (Ex.  
555-1234) (Telephone number)”  
l
Operation noise from turn signals,  
wipers, or the horn is heard.  
A/C airflow is strong or wind is  
l
blowing on the microphone.  
There is noise coming from cargo  
l
loaded inside of the vehicle.  
Voice commands may not be  
recognized depending on the voice. If  
the voice commands are not recognized  
correctly, repeat the commands in a  
louder voice.  
l
l
Dialects or different wording other than  
hands-free prompts cannot be  
recognized by voice recognition. Call  
out in the wording specified by the  
voice commands.  
Please be aware that the voice recognition  
may error despite following the above  
points.  
6-105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page332  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (332,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
NOTE  
Basic Bluetooth Hands-  
Free Operation  
l
A mobile telephone can be programmed  
only when the vehicle is parked.  
l
Since the communication range of a  
Bluetooth equipped mobile telephone is  
about 10 meters (32 ft), if a mobile  
telephone is placed within a 10-meter (32  
ft) radius of the vehicle, it may be detected/  
programmed unintentionally while another  
telephone is being programmed.  
q
Bluetooth Hands-Free preparation  
Language setting  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Setup”  
3. Prompt: Select one of the following:  
Pairing options, confirmation prompts,  
select phone, language, or passcode, or  
say cancelto return to the main  
menu.”  
1. Activate the Bluetooth application of  
the mobile telephone.  
NOTE  
For the operation of the mobile telephone,  
refer to its instruction manual.  
4. Say: [Beep] Language”  
2. Press the phone button (Short press).  
5. Prompt: Select a language: English,  
French, or Spanish.”  
3. Say: [Beep] Setup”  
6. Say: [Beep] French(Call out the  
desired language: English, French”  
or Spanish)  
4. Prompt: Select one of the following:  
Pairing options, confirmation prompts,  
select phone, language, or passcode, or  
say cancelto return to the main  
menu.”  
7. Prompt: French (Desired language)  
selected. Is this correct?”  
5. Say: [Beep] Pairing options”  
8. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
6. Prompt: Do you want to pair a phone,  
9. Prompt: French (Desired language)  
delete a phone, or list paired phones?”  
selected, returning to main menu.”  
7. Say: [Beep] Pair a phone”  
Mobile telephone programming  
(Pairing)  
8. Prompt: Please say a 4-digit pairing  
To use a Bluetooth Hands-Free, the phone  
has to be programmed to the hands-free  
unit using the following procedure.  
Up to seven Bluetooth equipped mobile  
telephones can be programmed to your  
vehicle.  
code.”  
9. Say: [Beep] XXXX(Call out an  
arbitrary 4-digit pairing code. This can  
be any combination of 4 numbers.)  
NOTE  
Record the code as it will be used to program  
your phone in Step 16.  
10. Prompt: Pairing code XXXX (4-  
digit number). Is this correct?”  
6-106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page333  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (333,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
11. Say: [Beep] Yesor No”  
22. Say: [Beep] 1(Call out a number of  
the desired priority from 1 to 7.)  
12. If Yes, go to Step 13.  
If No, the procedure returns to Step  
8.  
NOTE  
l
Normally, 1is to be input (Highest  
priority).  
13. Prompt: Start pairing procedure on  
phone. See phone's manual for  
instructions.”  
l
If more than two mobile telephones are  
registered, input the priority order from 1 to  
7.  
14. Using the mobile telephone, perform  
a search for the Bluetooth device  
(Peripheral device).  
23. Prompt: XXXXXX - - - (Ex.  
Mary's phone) (Phone tag) set to  
priority X (Priority number). Is this  
correct?”  
NOTE  
For the operation of the mobile telephone,  
refer to its instruction manual.  
24. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
25. Prompt: Pairing complete”  
15. Select Mazdafrom the device list  
searched by the mobile phone.  
After a mobile telephone is registered, the  
system automatically identifies the phone.  
By pressing the phone button again, or by  
pressing the phone button first after  
turning the ignition switch from the  
LOCK to the ACC position, the system  
reads out a voice guidance XXXXXX - -  
- (Ex. Mary's phone) (Phone tag) is  
connected. If two or more telephones are  
registered, the one with the highest  
priority is selected.  
16. Input the 4-digit pairing code set in  
Step 9 to the mobile telephone.  
17. Prompt: Please say the name of the  
phone after the beep.”  
18. Say: [Beep] XXXX - - -(Call out a  
phone tag, an arbitrary name for the  
phone.)  
Example: Stan's phone.”  
NOTE  
qMaking a call using a telephone  
Call out a programmed phone tagwithin 10  
seconds.  
If more than two mobile telephones are to be  
programmed, they cannot be programmed with  
the same or similar phone tag.  
number  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Dial”  
3. Prompt: Number, please”  
19. Prompt: Adding XXXXXX - - -  
(Ex. Mary's phone) (Phone tag). Is  
this correct?”  
4. Say: [Beep] XXXXXXXXXXX (Ex.  
555-1234) (Telephone number)”  
20. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
5. Prompt: Dialing XXXXXXXXXXX  
(Ex. 555-1234) (Telephone number)  
is this correct?”  
21. Prompt: Assign a priority for this  
phone between 1 and 7, where 1 is  
the phone used most often.”  
6. Say: [Beep] Yesor No.  
6-107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page334  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (334,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
7. When Yesis called out, the call is  
made.  
qHelp function use  
The help function informs the user of all  
the available voice commands under the  
current conditions.  
When Nois called out, the procedure  
returns to Step 3.  
qReceiving an incoming call  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
1. Prompt: Incoming call, press the  
2. Say: [Beep] Help”  
phone button to answer.  
3. Follow prompts to get the appropriate  
voice guidance.  
2. To accept the call, press the phone  
button (Short press).  
To reject the call, press the phone  
button (Long press).  
qHanging up a call  
Press the phone button during the call  
(Long press).  
Beep will confirm call is ended.  
qVolume adjustment  
Turn the power/volume dial of the audio  
unit or navigation system to adjust the  
volume.  
Turn the power/volume dial to the right to  
increase volume, to the left to decrease it.  
Audio unit  
Navigation system  
NOTE  
The volume can also be adjusted using the  
volume button on the steering wheel.  
6-108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page335  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (335,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
15. Prompt: XXXXXXXXXXX (Ex.  
555-1234) (Phone number  
Convenient Use of the  
Hands-Free System  
registration). Is this correct? ”  
16. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
qPhone book usage  
17. Prompt: Number saved. Would you  
like to add another number for this  
entry?”  
Phone book registration  
Phone numbers can be registered to the  
Bluetooth Hands-Free phone book.  
18. Say: [Beep] Yesor No.  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
19. If Yes, an additional phone number  
registration can be made for the same  
entry.  
2. Say: [Beep] Phone book”  
3. Prompt: Select one of the following:  
new entry, edit, list names, delete or  
erase all..., or say cancelto return to  
main menu.”  
If No, the procedure proceeds to  
Step 20.  
20. Prompt: Returning to main menu.”  
4. Say: [Beep] New entry”  
Making calls using the phone book  
5. Prompt: Name please.”  
Telephone calls can be made by saying  
the name of a person (voice tag) whose  
phone number has been registered in the  
Bluetooth Hands-Free system in advance.  
For the phone book setting method, refer  
to (page 6-111).  
6. Say: [Beep] XXXXX... (Ex. Mary's  
phone)(Say a voice tag for the name  
registered.)  
7. Prompt: Adding XXXXX... (Ex.  
Mary's phone) (Registered voice  
tag). Is this correct?”  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Call”  
8. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
3. Prompt: Name please.”  
9. Prompt: Home, Work, Mobile, or  
Pager?”  
4. Say: [Beep] XXXXX... (Ex. John's  
phone)(Say a voice tag registered in  
the phone book.)  
10. Say: [Beep] Mobile(Say Home,  
Work, Mobile, or Pager, for the  
desired location to be registered.)  
5. Prompt: Calling XXXXX... (Ex.  
John's phone) XXXX (Ex. at  
home). Is this correct?(Voice tag and  
phone number location registered in  
phone book).  
11. Prompt: Mobile(Location to be  
registered). Is this correct?  
12. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
6. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
13. Prompt: Number, please.”  
14. Say: [Beep] XXXXXXXXXXX  
(Ex. 555-1234)(Say the phone  
number to be registered.)  
7. Prompt: Dialing”  
6-109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page336  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (336,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
qRedialing function  
qTransferring a call  
Redialing the number of the person  
previously dialed is possible.  
Transferring a call from the Hands-  
Free system to a mobile phone  
Communication between the hands-free  
unit and a mobile phone is canceled, and  
the line can be switched to a standard call  
using a mobile phone.  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Redial”  
3. Prompt: Dialing”  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Transfer call”  
qEmergency calls  
A call can be made to the emergency  
phone number (911) using the voice input  
command.  
3. Prompt: Transferred call to phone”  
Transferring a call from a mobile  
phone to the Hands-Free system  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
Communication between mobile phones  
can be switched to the Bluetooth Hands-  
Free system.  
2. Say: [Beep] Emergency”  
3. Prompt: Calling 911, is this  
correct?”  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
4. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
2. Say: [Beep] Transfer call”  
5. Prompt: Dialing”  
3. Prompt: Transferred call to Hands  
Free system”  
qRefusing an incoming call  
Call waiting  
For incoming call refusal, refer to  
Receiving an incoming call(page  
6-108).  
A call can be interrupted to receive and  
incoming call from a third party.  
Call interrupt  
qMute  
A call can be switched to a new incoming  
call.  
The microphone can be muted during a  
call.  
l
Press the phone button (Short press).  
NOTE  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Mute”  
l
To refuse an incoming call, press the phone  
button (Long press).  
l
After receiving a new incoming call, the  
previous call is placed on hold.  
3. Prompt: Microphone muted”  
Canceling mute  
Switching calls  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Mute off”  
Switching back to the previous call can  
also be done.  
l
Press the phone button (Short press).  
3. Prompt: Microphone unmuted”  
6-110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page337  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (337,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
Ending the current call  
9. Prompt: XXXXX... (Ex. Mary's  
phone) (Registered voice tag) XXXX  
(Ex. home) (Registered location). Is  
this correct?”  
l
Press the phone button during the call  
(Long press).  
q
Voice guidance interrupt operation  
10. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
Voice guidance can be stopped by  
pressing the phone button (Short press)  
while it is being heard. A new voice input  
command can then be called out by the  
user.  
11. Prompt: The current number is  
XXXXXXXXXXX (Ex. 555-1234)  
(Currently registered number). New  
number, please.”  
NOTE  
· Press the phone button (Short press).  
If there was no previous phone number  
registered to a location (Ex. Work), the  
prompt will only read out Number, please.  
qPhone book settings  
Editing phone book  
12. Say: [Beep] XXXXXXXXXXX  
(Ex. 555-1234)(Say the new  
phone number to be registered.)  
The data registered to the Bluetooth  
Hands-Free phone book can be edited.  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
13. Prompt: XXXXXXXXXXX (Ex.  
555-1234) (The new phone number  
to be registered). Is this correct?”  
2. Say: [Beep] Phone book”  
3. Prompt: Select one of the following:  
new entry, edit, list names, delete or  
erase all..., or say cancelto return to  
main menu.”  
14. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
15. Prompt: Number changed. Would  
you like to call this number, edit  
another entry..., or say cancelto  
return to main menu.”  
4. Say: [Beep] Edit”  
5. Prompt: Please say the name of the  
entry you would like to edit, or say  
List names..., or say cancelto  
return to main menu.”  
Phone book data deletion  
Erasing individual phone book data  
Individual data registered to the Bluetooth  
Hands-Free phone book can be cleared.  
6. Say: [Beep] XXXXX... (Ex. Mary's  
phone)(Say the voice tag for the  
registered name to be edited in the  
phone book.)  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Phone book”  
7. Prompt: Home, Work, Mobile, or  
3. Prompt: Select one of the following:  
new entry, edit, list names, delete or  
erase all..., or say cancelto return to  
main menu.”  
Pager?”  
8. Say: [Beep] Home(Say the  
registered location to be edited:  
Home, Work, Mobile, or  
Pager).  
4. Say: [Beep] Delete”  
6-111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page338  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (338,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
5. Prompt: Please say the name of the  
entry you would like to delete, or say  
List names..., or say cancelto  
return to main menu.”  
9. Prompt: Please wait, erasing the  
Hands Free system phone book.”  
10. Prompt: Hands-Free system phone  
book erased, returning to main  
menu.”  
6. Say: [Beep] XXXXX... (Ex. John's  
phone)(Say the registered voice tag  
to be deleted from the phone book.)  
Read-out of names registered to the  
Bluetooth Hands-Free phone book  
7. Prompt: Deleting XXXXX... (Ex.  
John's phone) (Registered voice tag)  
Home (Registered location). Is this  
correct?”  
The Bluetooth Hands-Free system can  
read out the list of names registered to its  
phone book.  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
8. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
2. Say: [Beep] Phone book”  
9. Prompt: XXXXX... (Ex. John's  
phone) (Registered voice tag) Home  
(Registered location) deleted, returning  
to main menu.”  
3. Prompt: Select one of the following:  
new entry, edit, list names, delete or  
erase all..., or say cancelto return to  
main menu.”  
Complete deletion of the phone book  
data  
4. Say: [Beep] List names”  
All data registered to the Bluetooth  
Hands-Free phone book can be erased.  
5. Prompt: XXXXX..., XXXXX...,  
XXXXX... (Ex. John's phone, Mary's  
phone, Bill's phone)(Voice guidance  
reads out the voice tags registered to  
the phone book.)  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Phone book”  
3. Prompt: Select one of the following:  
new entry, edit, list names, delete or  
erase all..., or say cancelto return to  
main menu.”  
Press the phone button during the read-out  
at the desired name, and then say one of  
the following voice commands to execute  
it.  
l
Continue: Continues the voice  
4. Say: [Beep] Erase all”  
guidance.  
Call: Calls the registered phone  
l
5. Prompt: Are you sure you want to  
erase everything from your Hands Free  
system phone book?”  
number.  
l
Edit: Edits the registered phone  
number.  
6. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
l
Delete: Deletes the registered phone  
number.  
7. Prompt: You are about to delete  
everything from your Hands Free  
system phone book. Do you want to  
continue?”  
l
Previous: Returns to the previous  
phone number.  
Cancel: Returns to main menu.  
l
6. Prompt: End of list, would you like  
8. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
to start from the beginning?”  
6-112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page339  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (339,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
7. Say: [Beep] No”  
Hands-Free Telephone Setting  
8. Prompt: Returning to main menu.”  
qMobile phone  
Mobile phone registration  
For the registration of a Bluetooth  
equipped mobile telephone to the  
Bluetooth Hands-Free system, refer to  
Bluetooth Hands-Free preparation(page  
6-106).  
Registered mobile phone read-out  
The Bluetooth Hands-Free system can  
read-out the mobile phones registered to  
its system.  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Setup”  
3. Prompt: Select one of the following:  
pairing options, confirmation prompts,  
select phone, language, or passcode...,  
or say cancelto return to main  
menu.”  
4. Say: [Beep] Pairing options”  
5. Prompt: Do you want to pair a  
phone, delete a phone, or list paired  
phones?”  
6. Say: [Beep] List phones”  
7. Prompt: XXXXX..., XXXXX...,  
XXXXX... (Ex. Phone A, phone B,  
phone C)(The voice guidance reads  
out the phone tags registered to the  
phone book.)  
Press the phone button during the read-out  
at the desired phone, and then say one of  
the following voice commands to execute  
it.  
l
Select: Registers the mobile phone  
when the phone button was pressed.  
6-113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page340  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (340,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
l
Continue: Continues the voice  
guidance.  
Delete: Deletes the registered mobile  
phone.  
Previous: Returns to the previous  
mobile phone.  
9. Prompt: XXXXX... (Ex. phone B...)  
(Phone tag) will temporarily override  
phone priorities, returning to main  
menu.”  
l
l
Registered mobile phone deletion  
Registered mobile phones can be deleted  
individually or collectively.  
8. Prompt: End of list, would you like  
to start from the beginning?”  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
9. Say: [Beep] No”  
2. Say: [Beep] Setup”  
10. Prompt: Returning to main menu.”  
Mobile phone selection  
3. Prompt: Select one of the following:  
pairing options, confirmation prompts,  
select phone, language, or passcode...,  
or say cancelto return to main  
menu.”  
This function is for switching to a  
different mobile phone which has been  
registered beforehand. The selected  
mobile phone will remain in effect until  
the ignition switch is turned off.  
4. Say: [Beep] Pairing options”  
5. Prompt: Do you want to pair a  
phone, delete a phone, or list paired  
phones?”  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Setup”  
3. Prompt: Select one of the following:  
pairing options, confirmation prompts,  
select phone, language, or passcode...,  
or say cancelto return to main  
menu.”  
NOTE  
A registered mobile phone can be deleted  
using the registration list.  
6. Say: [Beep] Delete phone”  
7. Prompt: Please say 1 (priority 1) for  
XXXXX... (Ex. phone A), 2 (priority  
2) for XXXXX... (Ex. phone B...)”  
(The voice guidance reads out each  
phone in the order of priority and the  
phone tag).  
4. Say: [Beep] Select phone”  
5. Prompt: Please say 1 (priority 1) for  
XXXXX... (Ex. phone A), 2 (priority  
2) for XXXXX... (Ex. phone B...)”  
6. Say: [Beep] 2(Say the priority  
number for the mobile phone to be  
used as first priority.)  
8. Say: [Beep] 2(Say the order of  
priority of the mobile phone to be  
deleted.)  
7. Prompt: XXXXX... (Ex. phone B...)  
(Registered phone tag) selected, is this  
correct?”  
NOTE  
Say Allto delete all mobile phones.  
8. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
9. Prompt: Removing XXXXX... (Ex.  
phone B...) (Registered phone tag). Is  
this correct?”  
6-114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page341  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (341,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
10. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
4. Say: [Beep] Passcode”  
11. Prompt: Deleted”  
5. Prompt: Passcode is disabled. Would  
you like to enable it?”  
qLanguage setting  
6. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
English, Spanish, and Canadian French  
are available. If the language setting is  
changed, all of the voice guidance and  
voice input commands are done in the  
selected language.  
7. Prompt:Please say a 4-digit passcode.  
Remember this passcode. It will be  
required to use this system.”  
8. Say: [Beep] XXXX(Say a desired 4-  
digit passcode, PCode.)  
Method 1  
9. Prompt:Passcode XXXX (Passcode,  
Refer to Bluetooth Hands-Free  
preparation on page 6-106.  
PCode). Is this correct?”  
10. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
Method 2  
11. Prompt:Passcode is enabled,  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
returning to main menu.”  
2. Say: [Beep] French(Say the desired  
language: English, French, or  
Spanish.)  
Using the Bluetooth Hands-Free system  
with a passcode  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
3. Prompt: Would you like to change  
the language to French (Desired  
language) ?”  
2. Prompt:Hands-Free system is locked.  
State the passcode to continue.”  
4. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
3. Say: [Beep] XXXX(Say the set  
passcode PCode.)  
5. Prompt: Please wait. Switching to  
French phone book. French selected,  
returning to main menu.”  
4. If the correct passcode is input, voice  
guidance XXXXXX... (Ex. Mary's  
phone) (Phone tag) is connectedis  
announced.  
qSecurity setting  
If the passcode is incorrect, voice  
guidance XXXX (4-digit passcode,  
Pcode) incorrect passcode, please try  
againis announced.  
If a passcode is set, the system cannot be  
activated unless the passcode is input.  
Passcode setting  
Canceling the passcode  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Setup”  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Setup”  
3. Prompt:Select one of the following:  
pairing options, confirmation prompts,  
select phone, language, or passcode...,  
or say cancelto return to main  
menu.”  
6-115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page342  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (342,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
3. Prompt: Select one of the following:  
pairing options, confirmation prompts,  
select phone, language, or passcode...,  
or say cancelto return to main  
menu.”  
3. Prompt:Select one of the following:  
pairing options, confirmation prompts,  
select phone, language, or passcode...,  
or say cancelto return to main  
menu.”  
4. Say: [Beep] Passcode”  
4. Say: [Beep] Confirmation prompts”  
5. Prompt:Passcode is enabled. Would  
5. Prompt:Confirmation prompts are  
on/off. Would you like to turn  
you like to disable it?”  
confirmation prompts off/on?”  
6. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
6. Say: [Beep] Yes”  
7. Prompt:Passcode is disabled,  
returning to main menu.”  
7. Prompt:Confirmation prompts are  
off/on, returning to main menu.”  
Confirmation Prompts  
The confirmation prompt confirms the  
command content to the user before  
advancing to the operation requested by  
the user. When this function is turned on,  
the system reads out the voice input  
command previously received and  
confirms whether the command is correct  
before advancing to the command  
execution.  
When the confirmation prompt function is  
turned on:  
(Ex. Calling John's phone. Is this  
correct?)  
qVoice recognition learning  
function (Speaker enrollment)  
The voice recognition learning function  
enables voice recognition appropriate to  
the characteristics of the user's voice.  
If the recognition of the voice input  
commands to the system is not adequate,  
this function can largely improve the  
system's voice recognition of the user. If  
your voice can be recognized sufficiently  
without using this function, you may not  
realize the added benefit of the function,  
as high-level voice recognition can be  
achieved by using this function.  
When the confirmation prompt function is  
turned off:  
To register your voice, the voice input  
command list must be read out. Read out  
the list when the vehicle is parked.  
Perform the registration in as quite a place  
as possible (page 6-104).  
The registration must be performed  
completely. The required time is about 10  
to 15 minutes. The user needs to be seated  
in the driver's seat with the voice input  
command list for voice recognition  
learning open to the page indicated below.  
(Ex. Calling John's phone.)  
NOTE  
If the confirmation prompt function is turned  
off when making an emergency call, the system  
reads out and confirms the command before  
executing it.  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Setup”  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Voice training”  
6-116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page343  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (343,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
3. Prompt: This operation must be  
performed in a quiet environment while  
the vehicle is stopped. See the owner's  
manual for the list of required training  
phrases. Press and release the phone  
button when you are ready to begin.  
Press and hold the phone button to  
cancel at any time.”  
(888) 555-1212must be called out  
Eight, eight, eight, five, five, five, one,  
two, one, two.”  
Explanation  
English  
1
#790  
671  
2
3
212-4903  
235-3494  
315-5657  
456-7930  
793-5462  
794-1826  
826-3145  
962-7305  
4
4. Press the phone button (Short press).  
5
6
5. The voice guidance reads out the voice  
input command (refer to the voice  
input command list for voice  
recognition learning). (Ex. Please read  
phrase 1)  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
(531) 742-9860  
(632) 807-4591  
(800) 222-5015  
(888) 555-1212  
0123456789  
6. Say: [Beep] #790(Say the voice  
input command for voice recognition  
learning (1 to 45) according to the  
voice guidance.)  
55 66 77 88 99  
44 33 22 11 00  
Call 293-5804  
Call 350  
7. Prompt: Speaker enrollment is  
complete, returning to main menu.”  
Voice input command list for voice  
recognition learning  
Call 1 (234) 567-8901  
Dial 639-1542  
Dial #780  
When reading out, the following points  
must be observed:  
l
Read out the numbers one at a time  
Dial (987) 654-3210  
1058# 3794# Send  
27643# 4321# Send  
Cancel  
correctly and naturally.  
(For example, 1234must be read out  
one, two, three, four, not twelve, thirty  
four.)  
Continue  
l
#Must be read out Pound.  
Emergency  
l
Must be read out Star.  
Erase All  
l
Do not read out parentheses. (and  
hyphens -are used for separating  
numbers in a phone number.  
Help  
Home, Work, Mobile, Pager  
List Names  
Ex.  
No  
Phonebook: Delete  
Phonebook: New Entry  
Previous  
Phonebook: Erase All  
Redial  
6-117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page344  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (344,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
Explanation  
English  
When the Bluetooth  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
Retrain  
Hands-Free cannot be used  
Setup Confirmation Prompts  
Setup Language  
Setup Pairing Options  
Pair A Phone  
The Bluetooth Hands-Free cannot be used  
under the following conditions:  
l
Outside of the communication area.  
Mobile telephone has a malfunction.  
Mobile telephone is not connected to  
Transfer Call  
l
Yes  
l
the hands-free unit equipped on the  
vehicle.  
The mobile telephone battery is weak.  
The mobile telephone is turned off.  
The mobile telephone is placed where  
NOTE  
After user voice registration is completed,  
voice guidance Speaker enrollment is  
complete, returning to main menuis  
announced.  
l
l
l
radio reception is difficult.  
qDTMF (dial tone multi-frequency  
signal) transmission  
This function is used when transmitting  
DTMF via the user's voice. The receiver  
of a DTMF transmission is generally a  
home telephone answering machine or a  
company's automated guidance call center  
(When you send tone signals back  
according to the voice guidance  
recording).  
1. Press the phone button (Short press).  
2. Say: [Beep] Send XXXX...(Say  
DTMF code)  
3. Prompt: Sending XXXX... (DTMF  
code)”  
6-118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page345  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (345,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
Safety Certification  
FCC ID: CB2MBLUEC07 IC:279B-  
MBLUEC07  
This device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules and with RSS-210 of Industry  
Canada. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions:  
(1) This device may not cause harmful  
interference, and  
(2) This device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause undesired  
operation.  
WARNING  
Changes or modifications not  
expressively approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could void  
the user's authority to operate the  
equipment.  
The term IC: before the radio  
certification number only signifies that  
Industry Canada technical specifications  
were met.  
The antenna used for this transmitter must  
not be co-located or operating in  
conjunction with any other antenna or  
transmitter. End-users and installers must  
be provided with installation instructions  
and transmitter operating conditions for  
satisfying RF exposure compliance.  
6-119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page346  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (346,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
qVanity Mirrors  
Sunvisors  
To use the vanity mirror, lower the  
sunvisor.  
The vanity mirror light will illuminate  
when you open the cover.  
When you need a sunvisor, lower it for  
use in front or swing it to the side.  
Sunvisor  
qSide Extention Sunvisors  
The visor extender extends the sunvisor's  
range of sun shading.  
To use, pull it out.  
CAUTION  
When moving the sunvisor, reinsert  
the visor extender, otherwise the  
visor extender could hit the rearview  
mirror.  
6-120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page347  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (347,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
qOverhead Lights  
Interior Lights  
When the center/rear overhead light  
switch is in the DOOR position, the  
center/rear overhead light can be turned  
on or off using the front overhead light  
switch.  
qIlluminated Entry System  
When the illuminated entry system  
operates, the overhead light (switch is in  
the DOOR position) and the courtesy  
lights turn on for:  
Front  
l
About 30 seconds after the driver's  
door is unlocked and the ignition  
switch is in the LOCK position (with  
the ignition key removed).  
l
About 15 seconds after all doors are  
closed (If your vehicle is equipped with  
the advanced key, the overhead light  
turns on for about 5 seconds when the  
advanced key is outside of the vehicle).  
l
About 15 seconds after the ignition  
switch is in the LOCK position (with  
the ignition key removed) with all  
doors closed.  
Switch  
Overhead Lights  
Position  
The light also turns off when:  
l
Light off  
All overhead lights are off when  
l
The ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position and all doors are closed.  
The driver's door is locked.  
l
the center/rear overhead light  
switch is in the DOOR position  
l
l
Light is on when any door is open  
Light is on or off when the  
NOTE  
l
Battery saver  
illuminated entry system is on  
If any door is left opened, the light goes out  
after about 30 minutes to save the battery.  
The light turns on again when the ignition  
switch is turned to the ON position, or when  
any door is opened after all doors have been  
closed.  
l
Light on  
All overhead lights are on when  
the center/rear overhead light  
switch is in the DOOR position  
l
6-121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page348  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (348,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
Center/Rear  
qLuggage Compartment Light  
Switch  
Switch  
Overhead Lights  
Position  
Luggage Compartment Light  
Position  
Light off  
Light off  
Light on or off in accordance with the  
operation of front overhead light  
switch  
Light on when the liftgate is open  
qCourtesy Lights  
Light on  
Turns on when any door is open or the  
illuminated entry system is on.  
qMap Lights  
The map lights are switched on or off by  
pressing the switches.  
Courtesy Light  
6-122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page349  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (349,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
Information Display  
Climate control display (Front  
passenger)/ Ambient temperature  
display  
Climate control display  
(Driver)  
Clock  
Audio display  
Without  
navigation system  
qInformation Display Functions  
The information display has the following functions:  
l
Clock  
l
Ambient Temperature Display (Outside Temperature Display)  
Climate Control Display  
Audio Display  
l
l
6-123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page350  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (350,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
Time resetting  
qClock  
While the clock is displayed, press the  
SET switch 1.5 seconds or more. When  
the switch is released, a beep will sound  
and the clock will be reset as follows:  
(Example)  
When the ignition switch is in the ACC or  
ON position, the time is displayed.  
12:0112:2912:00  
12:3012:591:00  
NOTE  
When the SET switch is released, the seconds  
are reset to 00.  
With navigation system  
Refer to the separate manual  
NAVIGATION SYSTEM.  
Without navigation system  
Time setting  
NOTE  
Minutes and seconds are adjusted by the GPS,  
however, it is necessary to adjust hours under  
the following conditions:  
1. Press the CLK switch until a beep  
sounds, and 12Hrand 24Hrwill be  
displayed.  
l
Driving across different time zones  
l
Daylight saving time start and end  
2. Press the SET switch to switch between  
12Hrand 24Hrdisplays. The  
selected display will flash.  
qAmbient Temperature Display  
When the ignition switch is in the ON  
position, press the OUTSIDE switch  
(page 6-6) to display the ambient  
temperature.  
To select the desired clock setting,  
press the CLK switch again while the  
preferred setting is flashing.  
3. Hr. ADJUSTwill be displayed next,  
and the hour portion of the display will  
flash. Press the SET switch to set the  
hour, then press the CLK switch.  
4. Min. ADJUSTwill be displayed  
next, and the minutes portion of the  
display will flash. Press the SET switch  
to set the minutes, then press the CLK  
switch.  
6-124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page351  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (351,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
NOTE  
Cup Holder  
l
Under the following conditions, the ambient  
temperature display may differ from the  
actual ambient temperature depending on  
the surroundings and vehicle conditions:  
WARNING  
Never use a cup holder to hold hot  
liquids while the vehicle is moving:  
Using a cup holder to hold hot liquids  
while the vehicle is moving is  
l
Significantly cold or hot temperatures.  
Sudden changes in ambient temperature.  
The vehicle is parked.  
The vehicle is driven at low speeds.  
l
l
l
dangerous. If the contents spill, you  
could be scalded.  
l
Press the OUTSIDE switch a few seconds  
or more to switch the display from  
Fahrenheit to Centigrade or vice versa.  
Press the OUTSIDE switch again to switch  
the display from ambient temperature to the  
temperature set for the air conditioner.  
Do not put anything other than cups or  
drink cans in cup holders:  
l
Putting objects other than cups or  
drink cans in a cup holder is  
dangerous.  
During sudden braking or  
maneuvering, occupants could be hit  
and injured, or objects could be  
thrown around the vehicle, causing  
interference with the driver and the  
possibility of an accident. Only use a  
cup holder for cups or drink cans.  
qClimate Control Display  
The climate control system status is  
displayed. To operate the climate control  
system, refer to Climate Control System”  
(page 6-2).  
qAudio Display  
CAUTION  
To reduce the possibility of injury in  
an accident or a sudden stop, keep  
cup holders closed when not in use.  
The audio system status is displayed. To  
operate the audio system, refer to  
Audio System(page 6-17).  
6-125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page352  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (352,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
Right-side  
qFront  
To use the cup holder, push the release  
button.  
Left-sideí  
qRear  
Second-row seat  
Cup holders are located in the armrest.  
Third-row seat  
Cup holders are located in the third-row  
seat side trims.  
6-126 íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page353  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (353,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
Bottle Holder  
Storage Compartments  
Bottle holders are on the inside of the  
doors.  
WARNING  
Keep storage boxes closed when  
driving:  
Driving with the storage boxes open  
is dangerous. To reduce the  
possibility of injury in an accident or  
a sudden stop, keep the storage  
boxes closed when driving.  
CAUTION  
Do not leave lighters or eyeglasses in  
the storage boxes while parked under  
the sun. A lighter could explode or  
the plastic material in eyeglasses  
could deform and crack from high  
temperature.  
Bottle holder  
CAUTION  
Do not use the bottle holders for  
containers without caps. The  
contents may spill when the door is  
opened or closed.  
qOverhead Console  
This console box is designed to store  
accessories.  
Push and release to open.  
6-127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page354  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (354,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
qCoin Box  
qCenter Console  
To open, press the release catch down and  
pull the lid downward.  
To open, push the button.  
qArmrest Boxí  
qGlove Box  
To open, pull the release catch.  
To open the glove box, pull the latch  
toward you.  
Insert the key (auxiliary key*) and turn it  
clockwise to lock, counterclockwise to  
unlock.  
* Advanced key equipped vehicle  
Unlock  
Lock  
qCargo Securing Loops  
WARNING  
Make sure luggage and cargo is  
secured before driving:  
Not securing cargo while driving is  
dangerous as it could move or be  
crushed during sudden braking or a  
collision and cause injury.  
6-128 íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page355  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (355,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
Use the loops in the luggage compartment  
to secure cargo with a rope or net. The  
tensile strength of the loops is 196 N (20  
kgf, 44 lbf). Do not apply excessive force  
to the loops as it will damage them.  
2. Secure the trunk board using the straps  
on the third-row seatbacks.  
Side cargo sub-compartment  
Pull the compartment's strap to open the  
cover.  
qCargo Sub-Compartment  
Center cargo sub-compartment  
1. Lift the trunk board.  
Some models.  
qShopping Bag Hook  
The shopping bag hook can be used for  
hanging shopping bags.  
CAUTION  
Do not hang excessive weight on the  
shopping bag hook as it could be  
damaged.  
6-129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page356  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (356,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
2. Put the other golf bag on top of the first  
bag with its top pointing to the right.  
Shopping bag hook  
(tensile strength:3 kg  
(6.6 lb))  
qLuggage Compartment  
NOTE  
Golf bags can be carried in the luggage  
compartment.  
To carry two golf bags, use the following  
procedure:  
l
Some golf bags cannot fit depending on  
their size.  
l
Golf bags up to nine inches in diameter can  
be carried.  
1. Put one golf bag in the luggage  
compartment with its top pointing to  
the left.  
6-130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page357  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (357,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
Rear  
Accessory Sockets  
Only use genuine Mazda accessories or  
the equivalent requiring no greater than  
120 W (DC 12 V, 10 A).  
Front  
The ignition switch must be in the ACC  
or ON position.  
CAUTION  
To prevent accessory socket damage  
or electrical failure, pay attention to  
the following:  
Ø Do not use accessories that require  
more than 120 W (DC 12 V, 10 A).  
Ø Do not use accessories that are not  
genuine Mazda accessories or the  
equivalent.  
Ø Close the cover when the accessory  
socket is not in use to prevent  
foreign objects and liquids from  
getting into the accessory socket.  
Ø Correctly insert the plug into the  
accessory socket.  
Center/Rear  
The accessory sockets can be used  
regardless of the position of the ignition  
switch.  
Center  
NOTE  
To prevent discharging of the battery, do not  
use the socket for long periods with the engine  
off or idling.  
6-131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page358  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (358,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
Power Outletí  
The power outlet is positioned as shown  
in the figure.  
For more details, refer to  
Auxiliary terminals and power outlet”  
(page 6-88).  
6-132 íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page359  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (359,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
7
Helpful information on what to do in an emergency.  
7-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page360  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (360,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Parking in an Emergency  
Parking in an Emergency  
The hazard warning lights should always  
be used when you stop on or near a  
roadway in an emergency.  
The hazard warning lights warn other  
drivers that your vehicle is a traffic hazard  
and that they must take extreme caution  
when near it.  
Depress the hazard warning flasher and all  
the turn signals will flash.  
NOTE  
l
The turn signals do not work when the  
hazard warning lights are on.  
l
Check local regulations about the use of  
hazard warning lights while the vehicle is  
being towed to verify that it is not in  
violation of the law.  
7-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page361  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (361,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
Spare Tire and Tool Storage  
Spare tire and tools are stored in the locations illustrated in the diagram.  
Spare tire carrier bolt socket  
Flat tire belt  
Tiedown eyelet  
Jack lever  
Lug wrench  
Jack  
7-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page362  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (362,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
qJack  
qSpare Tire  
To remove the jack  
1. Open the cargo sub-compartment.  
2. Remove the cover.  
Your Mazda has a temporary spare tire.  
The temporary spare tire is lighter and  
smaller than a conventional tire, and is  
designed only for emergency use and  
should be used only for VERY short  
periods. Temporary spare tires should  
NEVER be used for long drives or  
extended periods.  
WARNING  
Do not install the temporary spare tire  
in place of a driving wheel:  
Driving with the temporary spare tire  
on one of the driving wheels is  
dangerous. Especially on ice or snow.  
Handling will be affected. You could  
lose control of the vehicle and have  
an accident. Move a regular tire to a  
driving wheel and install the  
3. Turn the wing bolt counterclockwise.  
temporary spare tire to the non-  
driving wheel.  
Wing bolt  
Jack  
To secure the jack  
Perform the removal procedure in reverse.  
7-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page363  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (363,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
3. Remove the cover.  
CAUTION  
Ø When using the temporary spare  
tire, driving stability may decrease  
compared to when using only the  
conventional tire. Drive carefully.  
Ø To avoid damage to the temporary  
spare tire or to the vehicle, observe  
the following precautions:  
Ø
Do not exceed 80 km/h (50  
mph).  
Ø
Avoid driving over obstacles.  
Also, do not drive through an  
automatic car wash. This tire's  
diameter is smaller than a  
conventional tire, so the ground  
clearance is reduced about  
25 mm (1 in).  
Cover  
4. Attach the socket to the spare tire  
carrier bolt, the jack lever to the socket,  
and the lug wrench to the opposite end  
of the jack lever.  
Ø
Ø
Do not use a tire chain on this  
tire because it will not fit  
properly.  
Do not use your temporary  
spare tire on any other vehicle;  
it has been designed only for  
your Mazda.  
Use only one temporary spare  
tire on your vehicle at the same  
time.  
Lug wrench  
Jack lever  
Socket  
Bolt  
Ø
NOTE  
(With Tire Pressure Monitoring System)  
A tire pressure sensor is not installed to the  
temporary spare tire. The warning light will  
flash continuously while the temporary spare  
tire is being used (page 5-29).  
To remove the spare tire  
1. Have everyone get out of the vehicle  
and away from the vehicle and traffic.  
2. Open the cargo sub-compartment.  
7-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page364  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (364,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
5. Slowly turn the lug wrench  
counterclockwise until the spare tire  
reaches the ground and the cable  
becomes loose.  
NOTE  
A flat tire which has been removed from the  
vehicle for repair cannot be carried in the  
spare tire carrier. Secure the flat tire with the  
flat tire belt in the cargo sub-compartment  
(page 7-11).  
7. If the temporary spare tire is not  
reinstalled in the spare tire carrier,  
tighten the spare tire carrier bolt  
completely to wind up the spare tire  
carrier cable.  
Spare tire  
CAUTION  
Do not loosen the cable too much as  
this may cause damage to the spare  
tire carrier.  
6. Rotate the small lever on top of the  
retaining plate and pull the retaining  
plate out from the center hole of the  
tire.  
WARNING  
Always tighten the spare tire carrier  
bolt completely tight and make sure  
the spare tire is locked in the highest  
position:  
A loose spare tire carrier bolt is  
dangerous. The cable could be cut  
causing the spare tire to fall off. This  
could result in someone being  
seriously injured or even killed. Use a  
lug wrench to tighten the carrier bolt  
and make sure to tighten it until a  
click sound is heard.  
7-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page365  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (365,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
To secure the spare tire  
WARNING  
1. Place the tire with the outer side facing  
upward, rotate the small lever on top of  
the retaining plate and slide the  
retaining plate through the center hole  
of the tire.  
Place the specialized temporary spare  
tire in the spare tire carrier correctly:  
Placing the specialized temporary  
spare tire in the spare tire carrier  
wrong side up or using any tire other  
than the small temporary spare tire  
designed for use with this vehicle is  
dangerous. It will result in poor  
Rotate the small lever into place.  
Lever  
attachment and insufficient ground  
clearance in the spare tire carrier and  
the danger of the tire falling off. This  
could result in someone being badly  
injured or even killed.  
Always tighten the spare tire carrier  
bolt completely tight and make sure  
the spare tire is locked in the highest  
position:  
A loose spare tire carrier bolt is  
dangerous. The cable could be cut  
causing the spare tire to fall off. This  
could result in someone being  
seriously injured or even killed. Use a  
lug wrench to tighten the carrier bolt  
and make sure to tighten it until a  
click sound is heard.  
NOTE  
Secure the spare tire as shown below.  
Spare tire  
CAUTION  
If you hear rattling from the spare  
tire carrier while the vehicle is  
moving, the spare tire carrier cable  
may be cut.  
Have it repaired at an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
2. Raise the spare tire slowly in reverse  
order of removal.  
7-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page366  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (366,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
NOTE  
Changing a Flat Tire  
l
Make sure the jack is well lubricated before  
using it.  
NOTE  
(With Tire Pressure Monitoring System)  
If the following occurs while driving, it could  
indicate a flat tire.  
l
Be sure to register the tire pressure sensor  
ID signal code whenever tires or wheels are  
changed (page 5-31).  
l
Steering becomes difficult.  
The vehicle begins to vibrate excessively.  
l
l
The vehicle pulls in one direction.  
1. Park on a level surface off the right-of-  
way and firmly set the parking brake.  
If you have a flat tire, drive slowly to a  
level spot that is well off the road and out  
of the way of traffic to change the tire.  
Stopping in traffic or on the shoulder of a  
busy road is dangerous.  
2. Shift into Park (P) and turn off the  
engine.  
3. Turn on the hazard warning flasher.  
4. Have everyone get out of the vehicle  
and away from the vehicle and traffic.  
WARNING  
Be sure to follow the directions for  
changing a tire, and never get under a  
vehicle that is supported only by a jack:  
Changing a tire is dangerous if not  
done properly. The vehicle can slip off  
the jack and seriously injure  
5. Remove the jack, tool, and spare tire  
(page 7-3).  
6. Block the wheel diagonally opposite  
the flat tire. When blocking a wheel,  
place a tire block both in front and  
behind the tire.  
someone.  
Never allow anyone inside a vehicle  
supported by a jack:  
Allowing someone to remain in a  
vehicle supported by a jack is  
dangerous. The occupant could cause  
the vehicle to fall resulting in serious  
injury.  
CAUTION  
(With Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System)  
The wheels equipped on your Mazda  
are specially designed for installation  
of the tire pressure sensors. Do not  
use non-genuine wheels, otherwise it  
may not be possible to install the tire  
pressure sensors.  
NOTE  
When blocking a tire, use rocks or wood blocks  
of sufficient size if possible to hold the tire in  
place.  
7-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page367  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (367,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
qRemoving a Flat Tire  
WARNING  
1. Loosen the lug nuts by turning them  
counterclockwise one turn each, but  
don't remove any lug nuts until the tire  
has been raised off the ground.  
Use only the front and rear jacking  
positions recommended in this manual:  
Attempting to jack the vehicle in  
positions other than those  
recommended in this manual is  
dangerous. The vehicle could slip off  
the jack and seriously injure or even  
kill someone. Use only the front and  
rear jacking positions recommended  
in this manual.  
Use only the jack provided with your  
Mazda:  
Using a jack that is not designed for  
your Mazda is dangerous. The vehicle  
could slip off the jack and seriously  
injure someone.  
2. Place the jack under the jacking  
position closest to the tire being  
changed.  
Never place objects under the jack:  
Jacking the vehicle with an object  
under the jack is dangerous. The jack  
could slip and someone could be  
seriously injured by the jack or the  
falling vehicle.  
3. Insert the jack lever and attach the lug  
wrench to tire jack.  
Jacking position  
Jacking position  
7-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page368  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (368,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
qLocking Lug Nutsí  
4. Turn the lug wrench clockwise and  
raise the vehicle high enough so that  
the spare tire can be installed. Before  
removing the lug nuts, make sure your  
Mazda is firmly in position and that it  
cannot slip or move.  
If your vehicle has optional antitheft  
wheel lug nuts, one on each wheel will  
lock the tires and you must use a special  
key to unlock them. This key is attached  
to the lug wrench and is stored with the  
spare tire. Register them with the lock  
manufacturer by filling out the card  
provided in the glove box and mailing it  
in the accompanying envelope. If you lose  
this key, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer or use the lock manufacturer's  
order form, which is with the registration  
card.  
Antitheft lug nut  
Special key  
5. Remove the lug nuts by turning them  
counterclockwise; then remove the  
wheel and center cap.  
To remove an antitheft lug nut  
1. Obtain the key for the antitheft lug nut.  
2. Place the key on top of the nut, and be  
sure to hold the key square to it. If you  
hold the key at an angle, you may  
damage both key and nut. Don't use a  
power impact wrench.  
3. Place the lug wrench on top of the key  
and apply pressure. Turn the wrench  
counterclockwise.  
7-10  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page369  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (369,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
To install the nut  
3. Install the lug nuts with the beveled  
edge inward; tighten them by hand.  
1. Place the key on top of the nut, and be  
sure to hold the key square to it. If you  
hold the key at an angle, you may  
damage both key and nut. Don't use a  
power impact wrench.  
2. Place the lug wrench on top of the key,  
apply pressure, and turn it clockwise.  
qMounting the Spare Tire  
1. Remove dirt and grime from the  
mounting surfaces of the wheel and  
hub, including the hub bolts, with a  
cloth.  
WARNING  
Do not apply oil or grease to lug nuts  
and bolts and do not tighten the lug  
nuts beyond the recommended  
tightening torque:  
Applying oil or grease to lug nuts and  
bolts is dangerous. The lug nuts  
could loosen while driving and cause  
the tire to come off, resulting in an  
accident. In addition, lug nuts and  
bolts could be damaged if tightened  
more than necessary.  
4. Turn the lug wrench counterclockwise  
and lower the vehicle. Use the lug  
wrench to tighten the nuts in the order  
shown.  
WARNING  
Make sure the mounting surfaces of  
the wheel, hub and lug nuts are clean  
before changing or replacing tires:  
When changing or replacing a tire,  
not removing dirt and grime from the  
mounting surfaces of the wheel, hub  
and hub bolts is dangerous. The lug  
nuts could loosen while driving and  
cause the tire to come off, resulting in  
an accident.  
2. Mount the spare tire.  
7-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page370  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (370,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
If you are unsure of how tight the nuts  
should be, have them inspected at an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
8. Return the third-row seatback to its  
original position.  
Refer to Fold the Third-Row Seat on  
Nut tightening torque  
108147  
N·m (kgf·m, ft·lbf)  
9. Remove the tire blocks and store the  
tools and jack.  
(1114, 80108)  
10. Place the flat tire in the cargo sub-  
compartment.  
WARNING  
Always securely and correctly tighten  
the lug nuts:  
Improperly or loosely tightened lug  
nuts are dangerous. The wheel could  
wobble or come off. This could result  
in loss of vehicle control and cause a  
serious accident.  
Be sure to reinstall the same nuts you  
removed or replace them with metric  
nuts of the same configuration:  
Because the wheel studs and lug nuts  
on your Mazda have metric threads,  
using a non-metric nut is dangerous.  
On a metric stud, it would not secure  
the wheel and would damage the  
stud, which could cause the wheel to  
slip off and cause an accident.  
11. Thread the belt through the wheel as  
shown in the figure, then attach the  
belt clips to the hook.  
5. Open the cargo sub-compartment.  
6. Remove the cover.  
7. Remove the belt for securing the flat  
tire.  
7-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page371  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (371,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
NOTE  
(With Tire Pressure Monitoring System)  
A tire pressure sensor is not installed to the  
temporary spare tire. The warning light will  
flash continuously while the temporary spare  
tire is being used (page 5-29).  
NOTE  
To prevent the jack and tool from rattling, store  
them properly.  
12. Pull the belt end to secure the flat tire.  
13. Check the tire inflation pressure.  
Refer to the specification charts on  
14. Have the flat tire repaired or replaced  
as soon as possible.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with any tires that have  
incorrect air pressure:  
Driving on tires with incorrect air  
pressure is dangerous. Tires with  
incorrect pressure could affect  
handling and result in an accident.  
When you check the regular tires' air  
pressure, check the spare tire, too.  
7-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page372  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (372,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Overheating  
3. Apply the parking brake.  
Overheating  
4. Turn off the air conditioner.  
If the temperature gauge indicates  
overheating, the vehicle loses power, or  
you hear a loud knocking or pinging  
noise, the engine is probably too hot.  
5. Check whether coolant or steam is  
escaping from under the hood or from  
the engine compartment.  
If steam is coming from the engine  
compartment:  
WARNING  
Don't go near the front of the vehicle.  
Stop the engine.  
Wait until the steam dissipates, then  
open the hood and start the engine.  
Turn off the ignition switch and  
make sure the fan is not running before  
attempting to work near the cooling  
fan:  
If neither coolant nor steam is  
escaping:  
Open the hood and idle the engine until  
it cools.  
Working near the cooling fan when it  
is running is dangerous. The fan  
could continue running indefinitely  
even if the engine has stopped and  
the engine compartment temperature  
is high. You could be hit by the fan  
and seriously injured.  
CAUTION  
If the cooling fan does not operate  
while the engine is running, the  
engine temperature will increase.  
Stop the engine and call an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Do not remove either cooling  
system caps when the engine and  
radiator are hot:  
6. Make sure the cooling fan is operating,  
then turn off the engine after the  
temperature has decreased.  
When the engine and radiator are  
hot, scalding coolant and steam may  
shoot out under pressure and cause  
serious injury.  
7. When cool, check the coolant level.  
If it's low, look for coolant leaks from  
the radiator and hoses.  
Open the hood ONLY after steam is no  
longer escaping from the engine:  
Steam from an overheated engine is  
dangerous. The escaping steam could  
seriously burn you.  
If the temperature gauge indicates  
overheating:  
1. Drive safely to the side of the road and  
park off the right-of-way.  
2. Shift into park (P).  
7-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page373  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (373,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Overheating  
If you find a leak or other damage, or if  
coolant is still leaking:  
Stop the engine and call an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
If you find no problems, the engine is  
cool, and no leaks are obvious:  
Carefully add coolant as required (page  
CAUTION  
If the engine continues to overheat or  
frequently overheats, have the  
cooling system inspected. The engine  
could be seriously damaged unless  
repairs are made. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
7-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page374  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (374,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Starting  
Starting a Flooded Engine  
If the engine fails to start, it may be  
flooded (excessive fuel in the engine).  
Follow this procedure:  
1. If the engine does not start within 5  
seconds on the first try, turn the key to  
the LOCK position, wait 10 seconds  
and try again.  
2. Depress the accelerator all the way and  
hold it there.  
3. Turn the ignition switch to the START  
position and hold it therefor up to 10  
seconds. If the engine starts, release the  
key and accelerator immediately  
because the engine will suddenly rev  
up.  
4. If the engine fails to start, crank it  
without depressing the acceleratorfor  
up to 10 seconds.  
If the engine still does not start using the  
above procedure, have your vehicle  
inspected by an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
7-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page375  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (375,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Starting  
Jump-Starting  
Jump-starting is dangerous if done incorrectly. So follow the procedure carefully. If you  
feel unsure about jump-starting, we strongly recommend that you have a competent service  
technician do the work.  
WARNING  
Follow These Precautions Carefully:  
To ensure safe and correct handling of the battery, read the following precautions  
carefully before using the battery or inspecting it.  
Always wear eye protection when working near the battery:  
Working without eye protection is dangerous. Battery fluid contains SULFURIC ACID  
which could cause blindness if splashed into your eyes. Also, hydrogen gas produced  
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode.  
Wear eye protection and protective gloves to prevent contact with battery  
fluid:  
Spilled battery fluid is dangerous.  
Battery fluid contains SULFURIC ACID which could cause serious injuries if it gets in  
eyes, skin or clothing. If this happens, immediately flush your eyes with water for 15  
minutes or wash your skin thoroughly and get medical attention.  
Always keep batteries out of the reach of children:  
Allowing children to play near batteries is dangerous. Battery fluid could cause  
serious injuries if it gets in the eyes or on the skin.  
Do not allow the positive ( ) terminal to contact any other metal object that  
could cause sparks:  
Flames and sparks near open battery cells are dangerous. Hydrogen gas, produced  
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode. An  
exploding battery can cause serious burns and injuries. When working near a  
battery, do not allow metal tools to contact the positive ( ) or negative (  
terminal of the battery.  
)
7-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page376  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (376,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Starting  
Keep all flames, including cigarettes, and sparks away from open battery cells:  
Flames and sparks near open battery cells are dangerous. Hydrogen gas, produced  
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode. An  
exploding battery can cause serious burns and injuries.  
Do not jump-start a frozen battery or one with a low fluid level:  
Jump-starting a frozen battery or one with a low fluid level is dangerous. It may  
rupture or explode, causing serious injury.  
Connect the negative cable to a good ground point away from the battery:  
Connecting the end of the second jumper cable to the negative ( ) terminal of the  
discharged battery is dangerous.  
A spark could cause the gas around the battery to explode and injure someone.  
Route the jumper cables away from parts that will be moving:  
Connecting a jumper cable near or to moving parts (cooling fans, belts) is dangerous.  
The cable could get caught when the engine starts and cause serious injury.  
CAUTION  
Use only a 12 V booster system. You can damage a 12 V starter, ignition system, and  
other electrical parts beyond repair with a 24 V power supply (two 12 V batteries in  
series or a 24 V motor generator set).  
Connect cables in  
Discharged  
numerical order and  
battery  
disconnect in reverse  
Jumper cables  
order  
Booster battery  
7-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page377  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (377,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Starting  
1. Make sure the booster battery is 12 V  
and that its negative terminal is  
grounded.  
Push-Starting  
Do not push-start your Mazda.  
2. If the booster battery is in another  
vehicle, don't allow both vehicles to  
touch. Turn off the engine of the  
vehicle with the booster battery and all  
unnecessary electrical loads in both  
vehicles.  
NOTE  
You can't start a vehicle with an automatic  
transaxle by pushing it.  
3. Connect the jumper cables in the exact  
sequence as in the illustration.  
l
Connect one end of a cable to the  
positive terminal on the discharged  
battery (1).  
Attach the other end to the positive  
l
terminal on the booster battery (2).  
Connect one end of the other cable  
l
to the negative terminal of the  
booster battery (3).  
Connect the other end to the ground  
l
point indicated in the illustration  
away from the discharged battery  
(4).  
4. Start the engine of the booster vehicle  
and run it a few minutes. Then start the  
engine of the other vehicle.  
5. When finished, carefully disconnect the  
cables in the reverse order described in  
the illustration.  
7-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page378  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (378,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Towing  
Towing Description  
CAUTION  
Don't tow the vehicle pointed  
backward with driving wheels on the  
ground. This may cause internal  
damage to the transaxle.  
We recommend that towing be done only  
by an Authorized Mazda Dealer or a  
commercial tow-truck service.  
Proper lifting and towing are necessary to  
prevent damage to the vehicle.  
Particularly when towing a AWD vehicle,  
where all the wheels are connected to the  
drive train, proper transporting of the  
vehicle is absolutely essential to avoid  
damaging the drive system. Government  
and local laws must be followed.  
Wheel dollies  
CAUTION  
Don't tow with sling-type equipment.  
This could damage your vehicle. Use  
wheel-lift or flatbed equipment.  
A towed 2WD vehicle should have its  
drive wheels (front wheels) off the  
ground. If excessive damage or other  
conditions prevent this, use wheel dollies.  
When towing a 2WD vehicle with the rear  
wheels on the ground, release the parking  
brake.  
A towed AWD vehicle must have all its  
wheels off the ground.  
7-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page379  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (379,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Towing  
Tiedown Hooks  
WARNING  
Always tow a AWD vehicle with all four  
wheels off the ground:  
CAUTION  
Towing a AWD vehicle with either the  
front or rear wheels on the ground is  
dangerous as the drive train could be  
damaged, or the vehicle could trail  
away from the tow truck and cause  
an accident. If the drive train has  
been damaged, transport the vehicle  
on a flat bed truck.  
Don't use the tiedown hooks under  
the front and rear for towing.  
They are designed ONLY for tying  
down the vehicle when it's being  
transported. Using them for towing  
will damage the bumper.  
qTiedown Hooks  
1. Remove the tiedown eyelet and the lug  
wrench from the trunk (page 7-3).  
2. Wrap a flathead screwdriver or similar  
tool with a soft cloth to prevent  
damage to the bumper and open the  
cap located on the front and rear  
bumper.  
7-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page380  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (380,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Towing  
4. Hook the tying rope to the tiedown  
eyelet.  
CAUTION  
The cap cannot be completely  
removed. Do not use excessive force  
as it may damage the cap or scratch  
the painted bumper surface.  
3. Securely install the tiedown eyelet  
using the lug wrench.  
Lug wrench  
Lug wrench  
CAUTION  
If the tiedown eyelet is not securely  
tightened, it may loosen or disengage  
from the bumper when tying down  
the vehicle. Make sure that the  
tiedown eyelet is securely tightened  
to the bumper.  
7-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page381  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (381,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Towing  
Recreational Towing  
An example of recreational towingis  
towing your vehicle behind a motorhome.  
The transaxle is not designed for towing  
this vehicle on all 4 wheels.  
When doing recreational towing refer to  
Towing Description(page 7-20) and  
Tiedown Hooks(page 7-21) and  
carefully follow the instructions.  
7-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page382  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (382,1)  
7-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page383  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (383,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
8
How to keep your Mazda in top condition.  
8-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page384  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (384,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Introduction  
Introduction  
Be extremely careful and prevent injury to yourself and others or damage to your vehicle  
when using this manual for inspection and maintenance.  
If you're unsure about any procedure it describes, we strongly urge you to have a reliable  
and qualified service shop perform the work, preferably an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Factory-trained Mazda technicians and genuine Mazda parts are best for your vehicle.  
Without this expertise and the parts that have been designed and made especially for your  
Mazda, inadequate, incomplete, and insufficient servicing may result in problems. This  
could lead to vehicle damage or an accident and injuries.  
For expert advice and quality service, consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
The owner should retain evidence that proper maintenance has been performed as  
prescribed.  
Claims against the warranty resulting from lack of maintenance, as opposed to defective  
materials or authorized Mazda workmanship, will not be honored.  
Any auto repair shop using parts equivalent to your Mazda's original equipment may  
perform maintenance. But we recommend that it always be done by an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer using genuine Mazda parts.  
8-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page385  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (385,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Scheduled Maintenance (USA, Canada, and Puerto Rico)  
Follow Schedule 1 if the vehicle is operated mainly where none of the following conditions  
apply.  
l
Repeated short-distance driving  
Driving in dusty conditions  
Driving with extended use of brakes  
Driving in areas where salt or other corrosive materials are being used  
Driving on rough or muddy roads  
Extended periods of idling or low-speed operation  
Driving for long periods in cold temperatures or extremely humid climates  
l
l
l
l
l
l
If any do apply, follow Schedule 2 (Canada and Puerto Rico residents follow Schedule 2).  
NOTE  
After the prescribed period, continue to follow the described maintenance at the recommended  
intervals.  
8-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page386  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:20 PM  
Black plate (386,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
qSchedule 1  
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first  
Months  
×1000 km  
×1000 miles  
6
12  
24  
15  
18  
36  
24  
48  
30  
30  
60  
36  
72  
45  
42  
84  
48  
96  
60  
Maintenance Interval  
12  
7.5  
22.5  
37.5  
52.5  
ENGINE  
Inspect every 168,000 km (105,000 miles)  
Replace every 240,000 km (150,000 miles)  
Drive belts  
Engine oil  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Engine oil filter  
COOLING SYSTEM  
Replace at first 192,000 km (120,000 miles) or 10 years; after  
that, every 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 5 years  
FL22 type*1  
Others  
Engine coolant  
Replace at first 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 4 years; after that,  
every 2 years  
FUEL SYSTEM  
Air filter  
C
R
C
I
Fuel lines and hoses*2  
Hoses and tubes for emission*2  
IGNITION SYSTEM  
Spark plugs  
I
I
Replace every 160,000 km (100,000 miles)  
I
CHASSIS and BODY  
Brake lines, hoses and connections  
Disc brakes  
I
I
I
I
I
Tire (Rotation)  
Rotate every 12,000 km (7,500 miles)  
I
Steering operation and linkages  
I
I
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel  
bearing axial play  
I
*3*4  
Rear differential oil (AWD)  
Driveshaft dust boots  
I
I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body  
Exhaust system and heat shields  
All locks and hinges  
T
T
Inspect every 72,000 km (45,000 miles) or 5 years  
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
8-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page387  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (387,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first  
Months  
×1000 km  
×1000 miles  
6
12  
24  
15  
18  
36  
24  
48  
30  
30  
60  
36  
72  
45  
42  
84  
48  
96  
60  
Maintenance Interval  
12  
7.5  
22.5  
37.5  
52.5  
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM  
Cabin air filter  
Replace every 40,000 km (25,000 miles) or 2 years  
Chart symbols:  
I: Inspect and repair, clean, adjust, or replace if necessary.  
R: Replace  
C: Clean  
T: Tighten  
L: Lubricate  
Remarks:  
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding  
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.  
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not  
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at  
the recommended time or mileage/kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.  
*3 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the rear differential oil at  
every 45,000 km (28,100 miles).  
a) Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier  
b) Driving in dusty, sandy or wet condition  
c) Extended periods of idling or low speed operation  
d) Repeated short trips of less than 16 km (10 miles)  
*4 If this component has been submerged in water, the oil should be replaced.  
8-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page388  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (388,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
qSchedule 2  
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first  
Months  
×1000 km  
×1000 miles  
4
8
5
8
12 16 20 24 28 32 36 40 44 48  
Maintenance Interval  
16 24 32 40 48 56 64 72 80 88 96  
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60  
ENGINE  
Inspect every 160,000 km (100,000 miles)  
Replace every 240,000 km (150,000 miles)  
Replace every 5,000 km (3,000 miles) or 3 months  
Drive belts  
Engine oil  
Puerto Rico  
Others  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Engine oil filter  
COOLING SYSTEM  
Replace at first 192,000 km (120,000 miles) or 10 years; after  
that, every 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 5 years  
FL22 type*1  
Others  
Engine coolant  
Replace at first 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 4 years; after that,  
every 2 years  
Engine coolant level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
FUEL SYSTEM  
Puerto Rico  
Others  
C
R
C
R
Air filter  
C
R
C
Fuel lines and hoses*2  
Hoses and tubes for emission*2  
I
I
I
IGNITION SYSTEM  
USA  
Others*3  
Replace every 96,000 km (60,000 miles)  
Replace every 160,000 km (100,000 miles)  
Spark plugs  
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM  
Function of all lights  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
8-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page389  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (389,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first  
Months  
×1000 km  
×1000 miles  
4
8
5
8
12 16 20 24 28 32 36 40 44 48  
Maintenance Interval  
16 24 32 40 48 56 64 72 80 88 96  
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60  
CHASSIS and BODY  
Brake lines, hoses and connections  
Brake fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Disc brakes  
Tire (Rotation)  
Rotate every 8,000 km (5,000 miles)  
Tire inflation pressure and tire wear  
Steering operation and linkages  
Power steering fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel  
bearing axial play  
I
I
*4*5  
Rear differential oil (AWD)  
Driveshaft dust boots  
I
I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body  
Exhaust system and heat shields  
All locks and hinges  
T
T
Inspect every 72,000 km (45,000 miles) or 5 years  
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
Washer fluid level  
8-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page390  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (390,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first  
Months  
×1000 km  
×1000 miles  
4
8
5
8
12 16 20 24 28 32 36 40 44 48  
Maintenance Interval  
16 24 32 40 48 56 64 72 80 88 96  
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60  
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM  
Cabin air filter  
Replace every 40,000 km (25,000 miles) or 2 years  
Chart symbols:  
I: Inspect and repair, clean, adjust, or replace if necessary.  
R: Replace  
C: Clean  
T: Tighten  
L: Lubricate  
Remarks:  
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding  
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.  
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not  
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at  
the recommended time or mileage/kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.  
*3 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the spark plugs at every  
96,000 km (60,000 miles) or shorter.  
a) Repeated short-distance driving  
b) Extended periods of idling or low-speed operation  
c) Driving for long periods in cold temperatures or extremely humid climates  
*4 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the rear differential oil at  
every 45,000 km (28,100 miles).  
a) Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier  
b) Driving in dusty, sandy or wet condition  
c) Extended periods of idling or low speed operation  
d) Repeated short trips of less than 16 km (10 miles)  
*5 If this component has been submerged in water, the oil should be replaced.  
8-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page391  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (391,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Scheduled Maintenance (Mexico)  
Follow Schedule 1 if the vehicle is operated mainly where none of the following conditions  
apply.  
l
Repeated short-distance driving  
Driving in dusty conditions  
Driving with extended use of brakes  
Driving in areas where salt or other corrosive materials are being used  
Driving on rough or muddy roads  
Extended periods of idling or low-speed operation  
Driving for long periods in cold temperatures or extremely humid climates  
Driving in extremely hot conditions  
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Driving in mountainous conditions continually  
If any do apply, follow Schedule 2.  
NOTE  
After the prescribed period, continue to follow the described maintenance at the recommended  
intervals.  
8-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page392  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (392,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
qSchedule 1  
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first  
Maintenance Interval  
ENGINE  
Months  
6
12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 72  
×1000 km  
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120  
Inspect every 40,000 km or 2 years  
Replace every 240,000 km  
Drive belts  
Engine oil  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Engine oil filter  
COOLING SYSTEM  
Cooling system  
I
I
I
Replace at first 190,000 km or 10 years; after that, every  
60,000 km or 3 years  
FL22 type*1  
Others  
Engine coolant  
Replace every 40,000 km or 2 years  
FUEL SYSTEM  
Air filter  
R
R
I*2  
I*2  
R
R
R
I*2  
I*2  
R
R
R
I
Fuel lines and hoses  
Hoses and tubes for emission  
Fuel filter  
I
R
IGNITION SYSTEM  
Spark plugs  
Replace every 60,000 km  
CHASSIS and BODY  
Brake lines, hoses and connections  
Brake fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Brake fluid  
R
I
R
I
R
I
Disc brakes  
I
I
I
Tire (Rotation)  
Rotate every 10,000 km  
Tire inflation pressure and tire wear  
Steering operation and linkages  
Power steering fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel  
bearing axial play  
I
I
I
I
I
I
Driveshaft dust boots  
I
T
I
I
T
I
I
T
I
I
T
I
I
T
I
I
T
I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body  
Exhaust system and heat shields  
All locks and hinges  
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
Washer fluid level  
8-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page393  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (393,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first  
Maintenance Interval  
Months  
6
12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 72  
×1000 km  
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120  
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM  
Cabin air filter  
R
R
R
Chart symbols:  
I: Inspect and repair, clean, adjust, or replace if necessary.  
R: Replace  
T: Tighten  
L: Lubricate  
Remarks:  
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding  
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.  
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not  
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at  
the recommended time or kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.  
8-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page394  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (394,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
qSchedule 2  
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first  
Maintenance Interval  
ENGINE  
Months  
3
5
6
9
12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 36  
×1000 km  
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60  
Inspect every 40,000 km or 2 years  
Replace every 240,000 km  
Drive belts  
Engine oil  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Engine oil filter  
COOLING SYSTEM  
Cooling system  
I
Replace at first 190,000 km or 10 years; after that, every  
60,000 km or 3 years  
FL22 type*1  
Others  
Engine coolant  
Replace every 40,000 km or 2 years  
Engine coolant level  
FUEL SYSTEM  
Air filter  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
C
R
C
R
I*2  
I*2  
R
C
R
Fuel lines and hoses  
Hoses and tubes for emission  
Fuel filter  
IGNITION SYSTEM  
Spark plugs  
Replace every 60,000 km  
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM  
Function of all lights  
CHASSIS and BODY  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Brake lines, hoses and connections  
Brake fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Brake fluid  
R
I
Disc brakes  
I
I
Tire (Rotation)  
Rotate every 10,000 km  
Tire inflation pressure and tire wear  
Steering operation and linkages  
Power steering fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel  
bearing axial play  
I
I
I
Driveshaft dust boots  
I
T
I
I
T
I
I
T
I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body  
Exhaust system and heat shields  
All locks and hinges  
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
Washer fluid level  
8-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page395  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (395,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first  
Maintenance Interval  
Months  
3
5
6
9
12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 36  
×1000 km  
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60  
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM  
Cabin air filter  
R
R
R
Chart symbols:  
I: Inspect and repair, clean, adjust, or replace if necessary.  
R: Replace  
C: Clean  
T: Tighten  
L: Lubricate  
Remarks:  
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding  
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.  
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not  
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at  
the recommended time or kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.  
8-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page396  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (396,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
(Cont.)  
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first  
Maintenance Interval  
ENGINE  
Months  
39 42 45 48 51 54 57 60 63 66 69 72  
65 70 75 80 85 90 95 100 105 110 115 120  
×1000 km  
Inspect every 40,000 km or 2 years  
Replace every 240,000 km  
Drive belts  
Engine oil  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Engine oil filter  
COOLING SYSTEM  
Cooling system  
I
I
Replace at first 190,000 km or 10 years; after that, every  
60,000 km or 3 years  
FL22 type*1  
Others  
Engine coolant  
Replace every 40,000 km or 2 years  
Engine coolant level  
FUEL SYSTEM  
Air filter  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
C
R
I*2  
I*2  
R
C
R
C
R
I
Fuel lines and hoses  
Hoses and tubes for emission  
Fuel filter  
I
R
IGNITION SYSTEM  
Spark plugs  
Replace every 60,000 km  
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM  
Function of all lights  
CHASSIS and BODY  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Brake lines, hoses and connections  
Brake fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Brake fluid  
R
I
R
I
Disc brakes  
I
Tire (Rotation)  
Rotate every 10,000 km  
Tire inflation pressure and tire wear  
Steering operation and linkages  
Power steering fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel  
bearing axial play  
I
I
I
Driveshaft dust boots  
I
T
I
I
T
I
I
T
I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body  
Exhaust system and heat shields  
All locks and hinges  
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
Washer fluid level  
8-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page397  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (397,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first  
Maintenance Interval  
Months  
×1000 km  
39 42 45 48 51 54 57 60 63 66 69 72  
65 70 75 80 85 90 95 100 105 110 115 120  
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM  
Cabin air filter  
R
R
R
Chart symbols:  
I: Inspect and repair, clean, adjust, or replace if necessary.  
R: Replace  
C: Clean  
T: Tighten  
L: Lubricate  
Remarks:  
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding  
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.  
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not  
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at  
the recommended time or kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.  
8-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page398  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (398,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Owner Maintenance Schedule  
The owner or a qualified service technician should make these vehicle inspections at the  
indicated intervals to ensure safe and dependable operation.  
Bring any problem to the attention of an Authorized Mazda Dealer or qualified service  
technician as soon as possible.  
qWhen Refueling  
l
Brake fluid level (page 8-23)  
Engine coolant level (page 8-21)  
Engine oil level (page 8-20)  
Washer fluid level (page 8-26)  
l
l
l
qAt Least Monthly  
Tire inflation pressures (page 8-33)  
qAt Least Twice a Year (For Example, Every Spring and Fall)  
l
Automatic transaxle fluid level (page 8-24)  
Power steering fluid level (page 8-24)  
l
You can do the following scheduled maintenance items if you have some mechanical  
ability and a few basic tools and if you closely follow the directions in this manual.  
l
Engine coolant (page 8-21)  
Engine oil (page 8-19)  
l
8-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page399  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (399,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Owner Maintenance Precautions  
Improper or incomplete service may result in problems. This section gives instructions only  
for items that are easy to perform.  
As explained in the Introduction (page 8-2), several procedures can be done only by a  
qualified service technician with special tools.  
Improper owner maintenance during the warranty period may affect warranty coverage.  
For details, read the separate Mazda Warranty statement provided with the vehicle. If  
you're unsure about any servicing or maintenance procedure, have it done by an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
There are strict environmental laws regarding the disposal of waste oil and fluids. Please  
dispose of your waste properly and with due regard to the environment.  
We recommend that you entrust the oil and fluid changes of your vehicle to an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
WARNING  
Do not perform maintenance work if you lack sufficient knowledge and experience or  
the proper tools and equipment to do the work. Have maintenance work done by a  
qualified technician:  
Performing maintenance work on a vehicle is dangerous if not done properly. You  
can be seriously injured while performing some maintenance procedures.  
If you must run the engine while working under the hood, make certain that you  
remove all jewelry (especially rings, bracelets, watches, and necklaces) and all  
neckties, scarves, and similar loose clothing before getting near the engine or cooling  
fan which may turn on unexpectedly:  
Working under the hood with the engine running is dangerous. It becomes even  
more dangerous when you wear jewelry or loose clothing.  
Either can become entangled in moving parts and result in injury.  
Turn off the ignition switch and make sure the fan is not running before attempting  
to work near the cooling fan:  
Working near the cooling fan when it is running is dangerous. The fan could  
continue running indefinitely even if the engine has stopped and the engine  
compartment temperature is high. You could be hit by the fan and seriously injured.  
8-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page400  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (400,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Engine Compartment Overview  
Brake fluid reservoir  
Automatic transaxle fluid-level dipstick  
Engine coolant reservoir  
Power steering  
fluid reservoir  
Battery  
Fuse block  
Relay box  
Engine oil dipstick  
Windscreen washer  
fluid reservoir  
Engine oil-filler cap  
8-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page401  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (401,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Only use oils Certified For Gasoline  
Enginesby the American Petroleum  
Institute (API). An oil with this trademark  
symbol conforms to the current engine  
and emission system protection standards  
and fuel economy requirements of the  
International Lubricant Standardization  
and Approval Committee (ILSAC),  
comprised of U.S. and Japanese  
Engine Oil  
NOTE  
Changing the engine oil should be done by an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
qRecommended Oil  
Use SAE 5W-20 engine oil.  
Oil container labels provide important  
information.  
automobile manufacturers.  
A chief contribution this type of oil makes  
to fuel economy is reducing the amount of  
fuel necessary to overcome engine  
friction.  
–30  
–10  
10  
30  
20  
40 50  
–20  
0
–20  
80  
100  
0
20 40  
60  
120  
U.S.A. and CANADA  
5W-20  
Except U.S.A. and CANADA  
(ILSAC)  
(ILSAC)  
8-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page402  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (402,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
The quality designation SM, or ILSAC  
must be on the label.  
CAUTION  
Don't add engine oil over MAX. This  
may cause engine damage.  
–10  
10  
30  
–30  
20  
40 50  
–20  
0
6. Make sure the O-ring on the dipstick is  
positioned properly before reinserting  
the dipstick.  
–20  
80  
100  
120  
0
20 40  
60  
5W-20  
qInspecting Engine Oil Level  
1. Be sure the vehicle is on a level  
surface.  
2. Warm up the engine to normal  
operating temperature.  
3. Turn it off and wait at least 5 minutes  
for the oil to return to the oil pan.  
4. Pull out the dipstick, wipe it clean, and  
reinsert it fully.  
Max  
OK  
Min  
5. Pull it out again and examine the level.  
It's OK between MIN and MAX.  
But if it's near or below MIN, add  
enough oil to bring the level to MAX.  
8-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page403  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (403,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Inspect the antifreeze protection and  
coolant level in the coolant reservoir at  
least once a yearat the beginning of the  
winter seasonand before traveling  
where temperatures may drop below  
freezing.  
Engine Coolant  
qInspecting Coolant Level  
WARNING  
Do not use a match or live flame in the  
engine compartment. DO NOT ADD  
COOLANT WHEN THE ENGINE IS HOT:  
A hot engine is dangerous. If the  
engine has been running, parts of the  
engine compartment can become  
very hot. You could be burned.  
Carefully inspect the engine coolant  
in the coolant reservoir, but do not  
open it.  
Inspect the condition and connections of  
all cooling system and heater hoses.  
Replace any that are swollen or  
deteriorated.  
The coolant should be at full in the  
radiator and between the F and L marks  
on the coolant reservoir when the engine  
is cool.  
Turn off the ignition switch and  
make sure the fan is not running before  
attempting to work near the cooling  
fan:  
Working near the cooling fan when it  
is running is dangerous. The fan  
could continue running indefinitely  
even if the engine has stopped and  
the engine compartment temperature  
is high. You could be hit by the fan  
and seriously injured.  
If it's at or near L, add enough coolant to  
the coolant reservoir to provide freezing  
and corrosion protection and to bring the  
level to F.  
Do not remove either cooling  
system cap when the engine and  
radiator are hot:  
When the engine and radiator are  
hot, scalding coolant and steam may  
shoot out under pressure and cause  
serious injury.  
NOTE  
Changing the coolant should be done by an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
8-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page404  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (404,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
NOTE  
CAUTION  
If the FL22mark is shown on or near the  
cooling system cap, use FL22 type engine  
coolant. If engine coolant other than FL22  
type is used, the engine coolant must be  
replaced earlier than the specified replacement  
interval indicated in the scheduled  
Ø Radiator coolant will damage  
paint.  
Rinse it off quickly if spilled.  
Ø Use only soft (demineralized)  
water in the coolant mixture.  
Water that contains minerals will  
cut down on the coolant's  
effectiveness.  
maintenance (page 8-3).  
Ø Don't add only water. Always add  
a proper coolant mixture.  
Ø The engine has aluminum parts  
and must be protected by an  
ethylene-glycol-based coolant to  
prevent corrosion and freezing.  
Ø DO NOT USE coolants Containing  
Alcohol, methanol, Borate or  
Silicate.  
These coolants could damage the  
cooling system.  
If the coolant reservoir is empty or new  
coolant is required frequently, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Ø DO NOT MIX alcohol or methanol  
with the coolant. This could  
damage the cooling system.  
Ø Don't use a solution that contains  
more than 60% antifreeze.  
This would reduce effectiveness.  
8-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page405  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (405,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
qAdding Brake Fluid  
Brake Fluid  
WARNING  
Be careful not to spill brake fluid on  
yourself or on the engine:  
qInspecting Brake Fluid Level  
Inspect the fluid level in the reservoir  
regularly. It should be kept at MAX.  
The level normally drops with  
accumulated distance, a condition  
associated with wear of brake linings. If it  
is excessively low, have the brake system  
inspected by an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
Spilled brake fluid is dangerous. If it  
gets in your eyes, they could be  
seriously injured. If this happens,  
immediately flush your eyes with  
water and get medical attention.  
Brake fluid spilled on a hot engine  
could cause a fire.  
If the brake/clutch fluid level is low,  
have the brakes and clutch inspected:  
Low brake fluid levels are dangerous.  
Low levels could signal brake lining  
wear or a brake system leak. Your  
brakes could fail and cause an  
accident.  
If the fluid level is low, add fluid until it  
reaches MAX.  
Before adding fluid, thoroughly clean the  
area around the cap.  
CAUTION  
Ø Brake fluid will damage painted  
surfaces. If brake fluid does get on  
a painted surface, wash it off with  
water immediately.  
Ø Using nonspecified brake fluids  
(page 10-4) will damage the  
system. Mixing different fluids will  
also damage it.  
If the brake system frequently  
requires new fluid, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
8-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page406  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (406,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Power Steering Fluid  
Automatic Transaxle Fluid  
(ATF)  
qInspecting Power Steering Fluid  
Level  
qInspecting Automatic Transaxle  
Fluid Level  
CAUTION  
The automatic transaxle fluid level should  
be inspected regularly. Measure it as  
described below.  
To avoid damage to the power  
steering pump, don't operate the  
vehicle for long periods when the  
power steering fluid level is low.  
The volume of fluid changes with  
temperature. Fluid must be checked while  
idling the engine without driving at  
normal operating temperature.  
NOTE  
Use specified power steering fluid (page 10-4).  
Inspect the fluid level in the reservoir at  
each engine oil change with the engine off  
and cold. Add fluid if necessary; it does  
not require periodic changing.  
CAUTION  
Ø Low fluid level causes transaxle  
slippage. Overfilling can cause  
foaming, loss of fluid, and  
transaxle malfunction.  
Ø Use specified fluid (page 10-4). A  
nonspecified fluid could result in  
transaxle malfunction and failure.  
1. Park on a level surface and set the  
parking brake firmly.  
2. Start the engine and depress the brake  
pedal.  
3. Move the shift lever through all ranges,  
then set it at P.  
The level must be kept between MAX and  
MIN.  
WARNING  
Visually examine the lines and hoses for  
leaks and damage.  
Make sure the brake pedal is applied  
before shifting the shift lever:  
Shifting the shift lever without first  
depressing the brake pedal is  
If new fluid is required frequently, consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
dangerous. The vehicle could move  
suddenly and cause an accident.  
4. With the engine still idling, pull out the  
dipstick, wipe it clean, and put it back.  
8-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page407  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (407,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
5. Pull it out again.  
Fully insert the dipstick. When adding  
fluid, inspect with the dipstick to make  
sure it doesn't pass full.  
The proper fluid level is marked on the  
dipstick as follows.  
NOTE  
Inspect the fluid on both sides of the dipstick in  
a well lit area for an accurate reading.  
Full  
A
Low  
Full  
B
Low  
Fluid hot scale A  
When the vehicle has been driven and the  
fluid is at normal operating temperature,  
about 65°C (150°F), the level must be  
between Full and Low.  
Fluid cold scale B  
When the engine has not been running  
and the outside temperature is about 20°C  
(70°F), the fluid level should be close to,  
but not above, the bottom notch on the  
dipstick.  
CAUTION  
Ø Use the cold scale only as a  
reference.  
Ø If outside temperature is lower  
than about 20°C (70°F), start the  
engine and inspect the fluid level  
after the engine reaches operating  
temperature.  
Ø If the vehicle has been driven for  
an extended period at high speeds  
or in city traffic in hot weather,  
inspect the level only after  
stopping the engine and allowing  
the fluid to cool for 30 minutes.  
8-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page408  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (408,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Inspect fluid level in the washer fluid  
reservoir; add fluid if necessary.  
Washer Fluid  
qInspecting Washer Fluid Level  
WARNING  
Use only windshield washer fluid or  
plain water in the reservoir:  
Using radiator antifreeze as washer  
fluid is dangerous. If sprayed on the  
windshield, it will dirty the  
windshield, affect your visibility, and  
could result in an accident.  
Using Washer Fluid Without Anti-freeze  
Protection in Cold Weather:  
Use plain water if washer fluid is  
unavailable.  
Operating your vehicle in  
temperatures below 4 degrees C (40  
degrees F) using washer fluid without  
anti-freeze protection is dangerous  
as it could cause impaired windshield  
vision and result in an accident. In  
cold weather, always use washer  
fluid with anti-freeze protection.  
But use only washer fluid in cold weather  
to prevent it from freezing.  
NOTE  
Front and rear washer fluid is supplied from  
the same reservoir.  
NOTE  
State or local regulations may restrict the use  
of volatile organic compounds (VOCs), which  
are commonly used as anti-freeze agents in  
washer fluid. A washer fluid with limited VOC  
content should be used only if it provides  
adequate freeze resistance for all regions and  
climates in which the vehicle will be operated.  
8-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page409  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (409,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Body Lubrication  
Wiper Blades  
All moving points of the body, such as  
door and hood hinges and locks, should  
be lubricated each time the engine oil is  
changed. Use a nonfreezing lubricant on  
locks during cold weather.  
CAUTION  
Ø Hot waxes applied by automatic  
car washers have been known to  
affect the wiper's ability to clean  
windows.  
Ø To prevent damage to the wiper  
blades, don't use gasoline,  
kerosene, paint thinner, or other  
solvents on or near them.  
Make sure the hood's secondary latch  
keeps the hood from opening when the  
primary latch is released.  
Contamination of either the windshield or  
the blades with foreign matter can reduce  
wiper effectiveness. Common sources are  
insects, tree sap, and hot wax treatments  
used by some commercial car washes.  
If the blades are not wiping properly,  
clean the window and blades with a good  
cleaner or mild detergent; then rinse  
thoroughly with clean water. Repeat if  
necessary.  
q
Replacing Windshield Wiper Blades  
When the wipers no longer clean well, the  
blades are probably worn or cracked.  
Replace them.  
CAUTION  
To prevent damage to the wiper arms  
and other components, don't try to  
sweep the wiper arm by hand.  
NOTE  
To prevent damage to the wiper arm blades  
when raising both the driver and passenger  
side wiper arms, raise the driver side wiper  
arm first. Conversely, when setting down the  
wiper arms, set the passenger side wiper arm  
down first.  
1. Raise the wiper arm.  
8-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page410  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (410,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
2. Open the clip and slide the blade  
assembly in the direction of the arrow.  
5. Pull down the blade rubber and slide it  
out of blade holder.  
3. Wrap a flathead screwdriver or similar  
tool with a soft cloth to prevent  
damage to the clip.  
6. Remove the metal stiffeners from each  
blade rubber and install them in the  
new blade.  
NOTE  
Using a soft cloth-wrapped flathead  
screwdriver.  
4. Tilt the blade assembly and remove it  
from the arm.  
CAUTION  
To prevent damage to the windshield  
let the wiper arm down easily, don't  
let it slap down on the windshield.  
8-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page411  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (411,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
1. Remove the cover and raise the wiper  
arm.  
CAUTION  
Ø Don't bend or discard the  
stiffeners. You need to use them  
again.  
Ø If the metal stiffeners are  
switched, the blade's wiping  
efficiency could be reduced.  
So don't use the driver's side metal  
stiffeners on the passenger's side,  
or vice versa.  
Ø Be sure to reinstall the metal  
stiffeners in the new blade rubber  
so that the curve is the same as it  
was in the old blade rubber.  
2. Firmly rotate the wiper blade to the  
right until it unlocks, then remove the  
blade.  
7. Carefully insert the new blade rubber.  
Then install the blade assembly in the  
reverse order of removal.  
CAUTION  
To prevent damage to the rear  
window let the wiper arm down  
easily, don't let it slap down on the  
rear window.  
qReplacing Rear Window Wiper  
Blade  
When the wiper no longer cleans well, the  
blade is probably worn or cracked.  
Replace it.  
CAUTION  
To prevent damage to the wiper arm  
and other components, don't try to  
sweep the wiper arm by hand.  
8-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page412  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (412,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
3. Pull down the blade rubber and slide it  
out of the blade holder.  
5. Carefully insert the new blade rubber.  
Then install the blade assembly in the  
reverse order of removal.  
4. Remove the metal stiffeners from each  
blade rubber and install them in the  
new blade.  
CAUTION  
Don't bend or discard the stiffeners.  
You need to use them again.  
8-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page413  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (413,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Battery  
WARNING  
Wash hands after handling the battery and related accessories:  
Battery posts, terminals and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds,  
chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and reproductive harm.  
Read the following precautions carefully before using the battery or inspecting  
to ensure safe and correct handling:  
Always wear eye protection when working near the battery:  
Working without eye protection is dangerous. Battery fluid contains SULFURIC ACID  
which could cause blindness if splashed into your eyes. Also, hydrogen gas produced  
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode.  
Wear eye protection and protective gloves to prevent contact with battery  
fluid:  
Spilled battery fluid is dangerous.  
Battery fluid contains SULFURIC ACID which could cause serious injuries if it gets in  
eyes, or on the skin or clothing. If this happens, immediately flush your eyes with  
water for 15 minutes or wash your skin thoroughly and get medical attention.  
Always keep batteries out of the reach of children:  
Allowing children to play near batteries is dangerous. Battery fluid could cause  
serious injuries if it gets in the eyes or on the skin.  
Keep flames and sparks away from open battery cells and do not allow metal  
tools to contact the positive ( ) or negative ( ) terminal of the battery when  
working near a battery. Do not allow the positive ( ) terminal to contact the vehicle  
body:  
Flames and sparks near open battery cells are dangerous. Hydrogen gas, produced  
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode. An  
exploding battery can cause serious burns and injuries. Keep all flames including  
cigarettes and sparks away from open battery cells.  
8-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page414  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (414,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Keep all flames, including cigarettes, and sparks away from open battery cells:  
Flames and sparks near open battery cells are dangerous. Hydrogen gas, produced  
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode. An  
exploding battery can cause serious burns and injuries.  
qBattery Maintenance  
To get the best service from a battery:  
l
Keep it securely mounted.  
Keep the top clean and dry.  
Keep terminals and connections clean,  
l
l
tight, and coated with petroleum jelly  
or terminal grease.  
Rinse off spilled electrolyte  
l
immediately with a solution of water  
and baking soda.  
If the vehicle will not be used for an  
l
extended time, disconnect the battery  
cables.  
8-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page415  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (415,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring Systemí  
does not alleviate the need to check the  
tire condition every day, including  
whether the tires all look inflated properly.  
Inspect all tire pressure monthly  
(including the spare) when the tires are  
cold. Maintain recommended pressures  
for the best ride, handling, and minimum  
tire wear.  
Tires  
For reasons of proper performance, safety,  
and better fuel economy, always maintain  
recommended tire inflation pressures and  
stay within the recommended load limits  
and weight distribution.  
WARNING  
Using Different Tire Types:  
When checking the tire pressures, use of a  
digital tire pressure gauge is  
recommended.  
Driving your vehicle with different  
types of tires is dangerous. It could  
cause poor handling and poor  
braking; leading to loss of control.  
Except for the limited use of the  
temporary spare tire, use only the  
same type tires (radial, bias-belted,  
bias-type) on all four wheels.  
Using Wrong-Sized Tires:  
Using any other tire size than what is  
specified for your Mazda (page 10-6)  
is dangerous. It could seriously affect  
ride, handling, ground clearance, tire  
clearance, and speedometer  
calibration. This could cause you to  
have an accident. Use only tires that  
are the correct size specified for your  
Mazda.  
Refer to the specification charts (page  
qTire Inflation Pressure  
WARNING  
Always inflate the tires to the correct  
pressure:  
Overinflation or underinflation of  
tires is dangerous. Adverse handling  
or unexpected tire failure could result  
in a serious accident.  
Refer to specification charts on page  
íSome models.  
8-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page416  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (416,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
l
l
l
NOTE  
Improper wheel alignment  
Out-of-balance wheel  
Severe braking  
l
Always check tire pressure when tires are  
cold.  
l
Warm tires normally exceed recommended  
pressures. Don't release air from warm tires  
to adjust the pressure.  
Underinflation can cause reduced fuel  
After rotation, inflate all tire pressures to  
specification (page 10-6) and inspect the  
lug nuts for tightness.  
l
economy, uneven and accelerated tire wear,  
and poor sealing of the tire bead, which  
will deform the wheel and cause separation  
of tire from rim.  
CAUTION  
Rotate unidirectional tires and radial  
tires that have an asymmetrical tread  
pattern or studs only from front to  
rear, not from side to side. Tire  
performance will be weakened if  
rotated from side to side.  
l
Overinflation can produce a harsh ride,  
uneven and accelerated tire wear, and a  
greater possibility of damage from road  
hazards.  
Keep your tire pressure at the correct  
levels. If one frequently needs inflating,  
have it inspected.  
CAUTION  
Limited-Slip Differential system;  
don't use the following:  
Ø Tires not of the designated size  
Ø Tires of different sizes or types at  
the same time  
qTire Rotation  
To equalize tread wear, rotate the tires if  
irregular wear develops. According to the  
scheduled maintenance charts.Refer to  
Scheduled Maintenance on page 8-3.  
During rotation, inspect them for correct  
balance.  
Ø Tires not sufficiently inflated  
If these instructions aren't followed,  
the rotation of the left and right  
wheels will be different and will thus  
apply a constant load on the limited-  
slip differential.  
This will cause a malfunction.  
qReplacing a Tire  
WARNING  
Always use tires that are in good  
condition:  
Forward  
Do not include (TEMPORARY USE ONLY)  
spare tire in rotation.  
Driving with worn tires is dangerous.  
Reduced braking, steering, and  
traction could result in an accident.  
Also, inspect them for uneven wear and  
damage. Abnormal wear is usually caused  
by one or a combination of the following:  
l
Incorrect tire pressure  
8-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page417  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (417,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
NOTE  
CAUTION  
Tires degrade over time, even when they are  
not being used on the road. It is recommended  
that tires generally be replaced when they are  
6 years or older. Heat caused by hot climates  
or frequent high loading conditions can  
accelerate the aging process. You should  
replace the spare tire when you replace the  
other road tires due to the aging of the spare  
tire. Regarding the manufacturing week and  
year is indicated with 4 digit.  
(With Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System)  
When replacing/repairing the tires or  
wheels or both, have the work done  
by an Authorized Mazda Dealer, or  
the tire pressure sensors may be  
damaged.  
NOTE  
(With Tire Pressure Monitoring System)  
Refer to The tire labeling on page 9-23.  
l
When tires with steel wire reinforcement in  
the sidewalls are used, the system may not  
function correctly even with a genuine  
wheel.  
Refer to System Error Activation on page  
qTemporary Spare Tire  
Inspect the temporary spare tire at least  
monthly to make sure it's properly inflated  
and stored.  
l
Be sure to install the tire pressure sensors  
NOTE  
whenever tires or wheels are replaced.  
Refer to Tires and Wheels on page 5-31.  
The temporary spare tire condition gradually  
deteriorates even if it has not been used.  
If a tire wears evenly, a wear indicator  
will appear as a solid band across the  
tread.  
The temporary spare tire is easier to  
handle because of its construction. It is  
lighter and smaller than a conventional  
tire and should be used only for an  
emergency and only for a short distance.  
Replace the tire when this happens.  
Tread wear indicator  
Use the temporary spare tire only until the  
conventional tire is repaired, which should  
be as soon as possible.  
Maintain its pressure at 420 kPa (4.2  
kgf/cm2 or bar, 60 psi).  
New tread  
Worn tread  
You should replace it before the band is  
across the entire tread.  
8-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page418  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (418,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
CAUTION  
CAUTION  
Ø Don't use your temporary spare  
tire rim with a snow tire or a  
conventional tire. Neither will  
properly fit and could damage  
both tire and rim.  
Ø The temporary spare tire has a  
tread life of less than 5,000 km  
(3,000 miles). The tread life may  
be shorter depending on driving  
conditions.  
Ø The temporary spare tire is for  
limited use, however, if the tread  
wear solid-band indicator  
appears, replace the tire with the  
same type of temporary spare  
(page 8-34).  
Ø A wrong-sized wheel may  
adversely affect:  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Tire fit  
Wheel and bearing life  
Ground clearance  
Snow-chain clearance  
Speedometer calibration  
Headlight aim  
Bumper height  
Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System  
Ø
Limited-Slip Differential System  
Ø (With Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System)  
Ø
When replacing/repairing the  
tires or wheels or both, have the  
work done by an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer, or the tire  
pressure sensors may be  
NOTE  
Tires degrade over time, even when they are  
not being used on the road. It is recommended  
that tires generally be replaced when they are  
6 years or older. Heat caused by hot climates  
or frequent high loading conditions can  
accelerate the aging process. You should  
replace the spare tire when you replace the  
other road tires due to the aging of the spare  
tire. Regarding the manufacturing week and  
year is indicated with 4 digit.  
damaged.  
Ø
The wheels equipped on your  
Mazda are specially designed  
for installation of the tire  
pressure sensors. Do not use  
non-genuine wheels, otherwise  
it may not be possible to install  
the tire pressure sensors.  
Refer to The tire labeling on page 9-23.  
NOTE  
Be sure to install the tire pressure sensors  
whenever tires or wheels are replaced. Refer to  
Tires and Wheels on page 5-31.  
qReplacing a Wheel  
WARNING  
Always use wheels of the correct size  
on your vehicle:  
When replacing a wheel, make sure the  
new one is the same as the original factory  
wheel in diameter, rim width, and offset.  
Using a wrong-sized wheel is  
dangerous. Braking and handling  
could be affected, leading to loss of  
control and an accident.  
Proper tire balancing provides the best  
riding comfort and helps reduce tread  
wear. Out-of-balance tires can cause  
vibration and uneven wear, such as  
cupping and flat spots.  
8-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page419  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (419,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Light Bulbs  
Overhead light (Center)  
Overhead light (Rear)  
Side turn signal lights  
Overhead light/Map lights (Front)  
Vanity mirror lights  
Courtesy lights  
Headlights (High beam)  
Fog lights  
Front side marker lights  
Front turn signal lights  
Headlights (Low beam)  
High-mount brake light  
Taillights  
Luggage  
compartment light  
License plate lights  
Reverse lights  
Rear side marker lights  
Brake lights/Taillights  
Rear turn signal lights  
Some models.  
8-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page420  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (420,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
3. Turn the cover counterclockwise and  
remove it.  
WARNING  
Do not replace the xenon fusion bulbs  
yourself:  
Replacing the xenon fusion bulbs  
yourself is dangerous. Because the  
xenon fusion bulbs require high  
voltage, you could receive an electric  
shock if the bulbs are handled  
incorrectly. Consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer when the replacement  
is necessary.  
Never touch the glass portion of a  
halogen bulb with your bare hands and  
always wear eye protection when  
handling or working around the bulbs:  
When a halogen bulb breaks, it is  
dangerous. These bulbs contain  
pressurized gas. If one is broken, it  
will explode and serious injuries  
could be caused by the flying glass.  
If the glass portion is touched with  
bare hands, body oil could cause the  
bulb to overheat and explode when  
lit.  
4. Disconnect the electrical connector  
from the bulb by pressing the tab on  
the connector with your finger and  
pulling the connector downward.  
5. Turn the socket and bulb assembly to  
remove it. Carefully remove the bulb  
from its socket in the reflector by  
gently pulling it straight backward out  
of the socket.  
Always keep halogen bulbs out of the  
reach of children:  
Playing with a halogen bulb is  
dangerous. Serious injuries could be  
caused by dropping a halogen bulb  
or breaking it some other way.  
qReplacing Exterior Light Bulbs  
Replacing a headlight bulb  
High-beam bulb  
6. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
1. Make sure the ignition switch is turned  
off and the headlight switch is off.  
2. Lift the hood.  
8-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page421  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (421,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
NOTE  
4. Turn the cover counterclockwise and  
remove it.  
l
To replace the bulb, contact an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
l
If the halogen bulb is accidentally touched,  
it should be cleaned with rubbing alcohol  
before being used.  
l
Use the protective cover and carton of the  
replacement bulb to dispose of the old bulb  
promptly out of the reach of children.  
Low-beam bulb  
(Xenon fusion bulb)  
You cannot replace the low beam bulbs by  
yourself.  
The bulbs must be replaced at an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
(Halogen bulbs)  
5. Disconnect the electrical connector  
from the bulb by pressing the tab on  
the connector with your finger and  
pulling the connector downward.  
1. Make sure the headlight switch is off.  
2. Lift the hood.  
6. Turn the socket and bulb assembly to  
remove it. Carefully remove the bulb  
from its socket in the reflector by  
gently pulling it straight backward out  
of the socket.  
3. Remove the attachment bolts and the  
coolant reservoir before replacing the  
light bulb.  
7. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
8-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page422  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (422,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
8. Install the coolant reservoir. If you are  
unsure of how tight the bolts should be,  
have them inspected at an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
Front side marker lights  
Bolt tightening torque  
6.911.8  
N·m (kgf·m, ft·lbf)  
(0.71.2, 5.18.7)  
NOTE  
l
To replace the bulb, contact an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
l
If the halogen bulb is accidentally touched,  
it should be cleaned with rubbing alcohol  
before being used.  
Use the protective cover and carton for the  
Front turn signal lights  
l
replacement bulb to dispose of the old bulb  
promptly and out of the reach of children.  
Front side marker lights, Front turn  
signal lights  
1. Make sure the headlight switch is off.  
2. Lift the hood.  
3. Remove the attachment bolts and the  
coolant reservoir before replacing the  
light bulb.  
6. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
7. Install the coolant reservoir. If you are  
unsure of how tight the bolts should be,  
have them inspected at an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
Bolt tightening torque  
6.911.8  
N·m (kgf·m, ft·lbf)  
(0.71.2, 5.18.7)  
Fog lightsí  
4. Turn the socket and bulb assembly  
counterclockwise and remove it.  
1. Make sure the headlight switch is off.  
2. Turn the screws counterclockwise and  
remove them.  
5. Remove the bulb by pushing it in  
slightly and turning it  
counterclockwise.  
8-40  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page423  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (423,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
3. Turn the screws and the center section  
of the plastic retainers  
NOTE  
l
To replace the bulb, contact an Authorized  
counterclockwise and remove them,  
then remove the mudguard.  
Mazda Dealer.  
l
l
If the halogen bulb is accidentally touched,  
it should be cleaned with rubbing alcohol  
before being used.  
Use the protective cover and carton for the  
replacement bulb to dispose of the old bulb  
promptly and out of the reach of children.  
Removal  
Side turn signal lightsí, Brake lights,  
Taillights (Rear combination light side),  
High-mount brake light  
Installation  
Due to the complexity and difficulty of  
the procedure, the LED bulbs should be  
replaced by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
4. Disconnect the electrical connector  
from the bulb by pressing the tab on  
the connector with your finger and  
pulling the connector downward.  
NOTE  
LED bulb replacement is not possible. The  
rear combination component must be replaced.  
Rear turn signal lights/Rear side-  
marker light  
5. Turn the socket and bulb assembly  
counterclockwise and remove it.  
1. Turn the bolts counterclockwise and  
remove them.  
Carefully remove the bulb from its  
socket in the reflector by gently pulling  
it straight backward out of the socket.  
6. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
íSome models.  
8-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page424  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (424,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
2. Pull the unit rearward to remove it.  
Taillights (Liftgate side), Reverse lights  
1. Remove the cover.  
3. Turn the socket and bulb assembly  
counterclockwise and remove it.  
2. Turn the socket and bulb assembly  
counterclockwise and remove it.  
Rear direction indication light  
Rear side-maker  
light  
3. Disconnect the bulb from the socket.  
4. Disconnect the bulb from the socket.  
Reverse light  
Taillight  
5. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
4. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
NOTE  
To replace the bulb, contact an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
License plate lights  
1. Wrap a flathead screwdriver with a soft  
cloth to prevent damage to the lens and  
remove the lens by carefully prying on  
the edge of the lens with a flathead  
screwdriver.  
8-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page425  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (425,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
2. Disconnect the bulb by pulling it out.  
Overhead light (Center, Rear)  
3. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
Luggage compartment light  
qReplacing Interior Light Bulbs  
Overhead light/Map lights (Front),  
Overhead light (Center, Rear), Luggage  
compartment light, Courtesy lights,  
Vanity mirror lights  
Edge  
1. Wrap a small flathead screwdriver with  
a soft cloth to prevent damage to the  
lens and remove the lens by carefully  
prying on the edge of the lens with the  
flathead screwdriver.  
Courtesy lights  
2. Disconnect the bulb by pulling it out.  
Overhead light/Map lights (Front)  
8-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page426  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (426,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Vanity mirror lights  
Fuses  
Your vehicle's electrical system is  
protected by fuses.  
If any lights, accessories, or controls don't  
work, inspect the appropriate circuit  
protector. If a fuse has blown, the inside  
element will be melted.  
If the same fuse blows again, avoid using  
that system and consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
3. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
qFuse Replacement  
Replacing fuses located behind the  
glove box  
If an electrical system is inoperative,  
inspect the fuses located behind the glove  
box.  
1. Turn off the ignition switch and other  
switches.  
2. Open the glove box.  
3. Remove the cover.  
8-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page427  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (427,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
6. Push in a new fuse of the same  
amperage rating, and make sure it fits  
tightly. If it doesn't, have an expert  
repairer install it. We recommend an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Fuse  
If you have no spare fuses, borrow one  
of the same rating from a circuit not  
essential to vehicle operation, such as  
the ROOM circuit.  
CAUTION  
Always replace a fuse with one of the  
same rating. Otherwise you may  
damage the electric system.  
4. Pull the fuse straight out with the fuse  
puller provided on the fuse block  
located in the engine compartment.  
Replacing the fuses under the hood  
If the headlights or other electrical  
components do not work and the fuses in  
the cabin are normal, inspect the fuse  
block under the hood. If a fuse is blown, it  
must be replaced. Follow these steps:  
1. Turn off the ignition switch and all  
other switches.  
2. Remove the fuse block cover or the  
relay box cover.  
Fuse block  
5. Inspect the fuse and replace it if it's  
blown.  
Blown  
Normal  
8-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page428  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (428,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Relay box  
3. If any fuse but the MAIN fuse is  
blown, replace it with a new one of the  
same amperage rating.  
Normal  
Blown  
WARNING  
Do not replace the main fuse by  
yourself. Have an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer perform the replacement:  
Replacing the fuse by yourself is  
dangerous because the MAIN fuse is  
a high current fuse. Incorrect  
replacement could cause an electrical  
shock or a short circuit resulting in a  
fire.  
8-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page429  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (429,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
qFuse Panel Description  
Fuse block (Engine compartment)  
FUSE  
DESCRIPTION  
PROTECTED COMPONENT  
For protection of all circuits  
RATING  
1
2
3
4
5
6
MAIN  
ENGINE  
R HEATER  
P.SEAT R  
HEATER  
IGKEY2  
150A  
20A  
40A  
30A  
50A  
40A  
30Aí  
40Aí  
40A  
30A  
40A  
30A  
30A  
15A  
30A  
25A  
15A  
Transaxle control system  
Heater  
Power seat (RH)í  
Heater  
For protection of various circuits  
Cooling fan  
7
FAN1  
8
P.SEAT L  
DEFOG  
BTN  
Power seat (LH)í  
Rear window defroster  
For protection of various circuits  
Fuel pump  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
FUEL PUMP  
IGKEY1  
FOG  
For protection of various circuits  
Fog lightsí  
ABS (SOL)  
D/L  
ABS solenoid  
Power door locks  
ROOM  
Overhead light  
íSome models.  
8-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page430  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (430,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
FUSE  
RATING  
DESCRIPTION  
PROTECTED COMPONENT  
Accessory socket (Center)  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
OUTLET CTR  
OUTLET RR  
AC PWR  
15A  
15A  
Accessory socket (Rear)  
Moon roofí, DC/AC inverter  
Seat warmerí  
15A  
S.WARM  
15A  
A/C MAG  
BOSE  
10A  
Air conditioner  
25A  
Audio system (Bose® Sound System-equipped model)í  
30Aí  
40Aí  
50A  
23  
FAN2  
Cooling fan  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
ABS  
ABS  
IG COIL  
H/L LOW L  
H/L LOW R  
H/L HIGH  
HAZARD  
ENG +B  
25A  
Ignition system  
15A  
Headlight-left (Low beam)  
Headlight-right (Low beam)  
Headlight-high (High beam)  
Hazard warning flashers  
PCM  
15A  
20A  
15A  
10A  
HORN  
15A  
Horn  
STOP  
7.5A  
10A  
Brake lights  
EGI INJ  
Engine control system  
Air flow sensor, EGR control valve  
PCM  
ENG BAR  
ENG BAR 2  
20A  
7.5A  
8-48  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page431  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (431,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Relay box (Engine compartment)í  
FUSE  
DESCRIPTION  
PROTECTED COMPONENT  
RATING  
1
2
3
INJ  
7.5A  
Injectors  
íSome models.  
8-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page432  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (432,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Fuse block (Glove box)  
FUSE  
DESCRIPTION  
PROTECTED COMPONENT  
Accessory Socket (Front)  
RATING  
15A  
7.5A  
1
2
OUTLET FR  
MIRROR  
Power control mirror  
3
4
METER  
SAS  
10A  
7.5A  
7.5A  
7.5A  
Instrument cluster  
ABS, Air bag  
5
6
ENG.IGA  
STA  
Engine control system  
Ignition system  
7
8
9
A/C  
7.5A  
15A  
Air conditioner  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
R.WIPER  
Rear window wiper and washer  
P.LIFT GATE  
SUNROOF  
AUDIO  
M.DEF  
20A  
15A  
10A  
10A  
Power lift gateí  
Moonroofí  
Audio system  
Mirror defrosterí  
TAIL  
10A  
10A  
7.5A  
Taillight  
ILLUMI  
INJ  
Dashboard illumination  
Injectors  
8-50  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page433  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (433,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
FUSE  
RATING  
DESCRIPTION  
PROTECTED COMPONENT  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
WIPER  
P.WIND  
30A  
30A  
Windshield wiper and washer  
Power windows  
8-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page434  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (434,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
qDamage Caused by Bird  
How to Minimize  
Environmental Paint Damage  
Dropping, Insects, or Tree Sap  
Occurrence  
The paintwork on your Mazda represents  
the latest technical developments in  
composition and methods of application.  
Bird droppings contain acids. If these  
aren't removed they can eat away the clear  
and color base coat of the vehicle's  
paintwork.  
Environmental hazards, however, can  
harm the paint's protective properties, if  
proper care is not taken.  
When insects stick to the paint surface  
and decompose, corrosive compounds  
form. These can erode the clear and color  
base coat of the vehicle's paintwork if  
they are not removed.  
Here are some examples of possible  
damage, with tips on how to prevent  
them.  
Tree sap will harden and adhere  
qEtching Caused by Acid Rain or  
permanently to the paint finish. If you  
scratch the sap off while it is hard, some  
vehicle paint could come off with it.  
Industrial Fallout  
Occurrence  
Prevention  
Industrial pollutants and vehicle emissions  
drift into the air and mix with rain or dew  
to form acids. These acids can settle on a  
vehicle's finish. As the water evaporates,  
the acid becomes concentrated and can  
damage the finish.  
It is necessary to have your Mazda  
washed and waxed to preserve its finish  
according to the instructions in this  
section. This should be done as soon as  
possible.  
And the longer the acid remains on the  
surface, the greater the chance is for  
damage.  
Bird droppings can be removed with a  
soft sponge and water. If you are traveling  
and these are not available, a moistened  
tissue may also take care of the problem.  
The cleaned area should be waxed  
according to the instructions in this  
section.  
Insects and tree sap are best removed with  
a soft sponge and water or a commercially  
available chemical cleaner.  
Prevention  
It is necessary to wash and wax your  
vehicle to preserve its finish according to  
the instructions in this section. These  
steps should be taken immediately after  
you suspect that acid rain has settled on  
your vehicle's finish.  
Another method is to cover the affected  
area with dampened newspaper for one to  
two hours. After removing the newspaper,  
rinse off the loosened debris with water.  
8-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page435  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (435,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
NOTE  
l
qWater Marks  
The paint chipping zone varies with the  
speed of the vehicle. For example, when  
traveling at 90 km/h (56 mph), the paint  
chipping zone is 50 m (164 ft).  
In low temperatures a vehicle's finish  
hardens. This increases the chance of paint  
chipping.  
Chipped paint can lead to rust forming on  
your Mazda. Before this happens, repair the  
damage by using Mazda touch-up paint  
according to the instructions in this section.  
Failure to repair the affected area could  
lead to serious rusting and expensive  
repairs.  
Occurrence  
Rain, fog, dew, and even tap water can  
contain harmful minerals such as salt and  
lime. If moisture containing these  
minerals settles on the vehicle and  
evaporates, the minerals will concentrate  
and harden to form white rings. The rings  
can damage your vehicle's finish.  
l
l
Prevention  
It is necessary to wash and wax your  
vehicle to preserve its finish according to  
the instructions in this section. These  
steps should be taken immediately after  
you find water marks on your vehicle's  
finish.  
qPaint Chipping  
Occurrence  
Paint chipping occurs when gravel thrown  
in the air by another vehicle's tires hits  
your vehicle.  
How to avoid paint chipping  
Keeping a safe distance between you and  
the vehicle ahead reduces the chances of  
having your paint chipped by flying  
gravel.  
8-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page436  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (436,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
l
Use plenty of lukewarm or cold water  
and a soft cloth when washing the  
vehicle. Do not use a nylon cloth.  
Rub gently when washing or drying the  
vehicle.  
Take your vehicle only to a car wash  
that keeps its brushes well maintained.  
Don't use abrasive cleansers or wax  
that contain abrasives.  
Exterior Care  
Follow all label and container directions  
when using a chemical cleaner or polish.  
Read all warnings and cautions.  
l
l
l
qMaintaining the Finish  
Washing  
To help protect the finish from rust and  
deterioration, wash your Mazda  
thoroughly and frequently, at least once a  
month, with lukewarm or cold water.  
CAUTION  
Ø Don't use steel wool, abrasive  
cleaners, or strong detergents  
containing highly alkaline or  
caustic agents on chrome-plated  
or anodized aluminum parts. This  
may damage the protective  
coating; also, cleaners and  
detergents may discolor or  
deteriorate the paint.  
Ø To prevent damaging the antenna,  
remove it before entering a car  
wash facility or passing beneath a  
low overhead clearance.  
If the vehicle is washed improperly, the  
paint surface could be scratched. Here are  
some examples of how scratching could  
occur.  
Scratches occur on the paint surface  
when:  
l
The vehicle is washed without first  
rinsing off dirt and other foreign  
matter.  
The vehicle is washed with a rough,  
l
Pay special attention to removing salt,  
dirt, mud, and other foreign material from  
the underside of the fenders, and make  
sure the drain holes in the lower edges of  
the doors and rocker panels are clean.  
dry, or dirty cloth.  
l
l
The vehicle is washed at a car wash  
that uses brushes that are dirty or too  
stiff.  
Cleansers or wax containing abrasives  
are used.  
Insects, tar, tree sap, bird droppings,  
industrial fallout, and similar deposits can  
damage the finish if not removed  
immediately. When prompt washing with  
plain water is ineffective, use a mild soap  
made for use on vehicles.  
NOTE  
l
Mazda is not responsible for scratches  
caused by automatic car washes or  
improper washing.  
l
Scratches are more noticeable on vehicles  
with darker paint finishes.  
Thoroughly rinse off all soap with  
lukewarm or cold water. Don't allow soap  
to dry on the finish.  
To minimize scratches on the vehicle's  
paint finish:  
l
Rinse off any dirt or other foreign  
matter using lukewarm or cold water  
before washing.  
8-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page437  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (437,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
After washing the vehicle, dry it with a  
clean chamois to prevent water spots from  
forming.  
qRepairing Damage to the Finish  
Deep scratches or chips on the finish  
should be repaired promptly. Exposed  
metal quickly rusts and can lead to major  
repairs.  
WARNING  
Dry wet brakes by driving very slowly  
and applying the brakes lightly until  
brake performance is normal:  
Driving with wet brakes is  
CAUTION  
If your Mazda is damaged and needs  
metal parts repaired or replaced,  
make sure the body shop applies  
anti-corrosion materials to all parts,  
both repaired and new. This will  
prevent them from rusting.  
dangerous. Increased stopping  
distance or the vehicle pulling to one  
side when braking could result in a  
serious accident. Light braking will  
indicate whether the brakes have  
been affected.  
qPaint Damage Touch-up  
Waxing  
Repair damage to the finish caused by  
stone chipping, damage during parking  
etc., by using Mazda touch-up paint  
before rust begins to form. First, remove  
the dirt and grease with a clean soft cloth.  
Your vehicle needs to be waxed when  
water no longer beads on the finish.  
Always wash and dry the vehicle before  
waxing it. In addition to the vehicle body,  
wax the metal trim to maintain its luster.  
If rust has already begun to form:  
1. Use wax which contains no abrasives.  
Waxes containing abrasive will remove  
paint and could damage bright metal  
parts.  
1. Remove rust completely with  
sandpaper.  
2. Wipe with a clean soft cloth.  
2. Use a good grade of natural wax for  
metallic, mica, and solid colors.  
3. Apply rust preventive primer to the  
area.  
3. When waxing, coat evenly with the  
sponge supplied or a soft cloth.  
4. After drying it completely, apply a  
suitable top coat material to the area.  
4. Wipe off the wax with a soft cloth.  
Of course there will be no problem if you  
assign the work to an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
NOTE  
A spot remover to remove oil, tar, and similar  
materials will usually also take off the wax.  
Rewax these areas even if the rest of the  
vehicle doesn't need it.  
8-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page438  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (438,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
qCavity Protection  
qUnderbody Maintenance  
Cavities are treated for protection at the  
factory, but additional protective treatment  
after the vehicle has been put into use will  
extend the life of the body.  
We recommend that you consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer concerning this  
additional precaution.  
Road chemicals and salt used for ice and  
snow removal and solvents used for dust  
control may collect on the underbody. If  
not removed, they will speed up rusting  
and deterioration of such underbody parts  
as fuel lines, frame, floor pan, and exhaust  
system, even though these parts may be  
coated with anti-corrosive material.  
qBright-Metal Maintenance  
Thoroughly flush the underbody and  
wheel housings with lukewarm or cold  
water at the end of each winter. Try also  
to do this every month.  
l
Use tar remover to remove road tar and  
insects. Never do this with a knife or  
similar tool.  
To prevent corrosion on bright-metal  
l
surfaces, apply wax or chrome  
preservative and rub it to a high luster.  
During cold weather or in coastal areas,  
cover bright-metal parts with a coating  
of wax or preservative heavier than  
usual. It would also help to coat them  
with noncorrosive petroleum jelly or  
some other protective compound.  
Pay special attention to these areas  
because they easily hide mud and dirt. It  
will do more harm than good to wet  
down the road grime without removing  
it.  
l
The lower edges of doors, rocker panels,  
and frame members have drain holes that  
should not be clogged. Water trapped  
there will cause rusting.  
CAUTION  
Don't use steel wool, abrasive  
cleaners, or strong detergents  
containing highly alkaline or caustic  
agents on chrome-plated or anodized  
aluminum parts. This may result in  
damage to the protective coating and  
cause discoloration or paint  
WARNING  
Dry wet brakes by driving very slowly  
and applying the brakes lightly until  
brake performance is normal:  
Driving with wet brakes is  
dangerous. Increased stopping  
distance or the vehicle pulling to one  
side when braking could result in a  
serious accident. Light braking will  
indicate whether the brakes have  
been affected.  
deterioration.  
8-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page439  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (439,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
qUndercoating  
Interior Care  
This special coating is applied to the  
critical parts of the underside to protect  
vehicles from damage caused by  
chemicals or stones. This coating is liable  
to be damaged with time. Check this  
coating periodically.  
qDashboard Precautions  
Prevent caustic solutions such as perfume  
and cosmetic oils from contacting the  
dashboard. They'll damage and discolor it.  
If these solutions get on the dashboard,  
wipe them off immediately.  
An Authorized Mazda Dealer are well  
informed on how repairs should be made.  
Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
CAUTION  
Do not use glazing agents.  
Glazing agents contain ingredients  
which may cause discoloration,  
wrinkling, cracks and peeling.  
qAluminum Wheel Maintenance  
A protective coating is provided over the  
aluminum wheels. Special care is needed  
to protect this coating.  
qCleaning the Upholstery and  
Interior Trim  
NOTE  
l
Don't use a wire brush or any abrasive  
Vinyl  
cleaner, polishing compound, or solvent on  
aluminum wheels. They may damage the  
coating.  
Remove dust and loose dirt from vinyl  
with a whisk broom or vacuum cleaner.  
Clean vinyl with a leather-and-vinyl  
cleaner.  
l
Only use a mild soap or neutral detergent  
and always use a sponge or soft cloth to  
clean the wheels.  
Rinse thoroughly with lukewarm or cold  
water. Also, be sure to clean the wheels  
after driving on dusty or salted roads. This  
helps prevent corrosion.  
Leatherí  
Real leather isn't uniform and may have  
scars, scratches, and wrinkles. Clean it  
with a leather cleaner or mild soap.  
l
Avoid washing your vehicle in an automatic  
Wipe it with a damp soft cloth; then dry  
and buff it with a dry soft cloth.  
car wash that uses high-speed or hard  
brushes.  
l
If your aluminum wheels lose luster, wax  
the wheels.  
Fabric  
Remove dust and loose dirt from fabric  
with a whisk broom or vacuum cleaner.  
Clean it with a mild soap solution good  
for upholstery and carpets. Remove fresh  
spots immediately with a fabric spot  
cleaner.  
íSome models.  
8-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page440  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (440,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
To keep the fabric looking clean and  
fresh, take care of it. Otherwise its color  
will be affected, it can be stained easily,  
and its fire-resistance may be reduced.  
WARNING  
Have an Authorized Mazda Dealer  
replace damaged seat belts  
immediately:  
Using damaged seat belts is  
dangerous. In a collision, damaged  
belts cannot provide adequate  
protection.  
CAUTION  
Use only recommended cleaners and  
procedures. Others may affect  
appearance and fire-resistance.  
Piano black panelí  
qCleaning the Window Interiors  
The following parts are fitted with panels  
that have been treated with a special  
coating that resists scratching.  
If the windows become covered with an  
oily, greasy, or waxy film, clean them  
with glass cleaner. Follow the directions  
on the container.  
l
Center panel  
Steering wheel (partial)  
Shift lever panel  
Door trim panel  
l
l
CAUTION  
Don't scrape or scratch the inside of  
the rear window. You may damage  
the rear window defroster grid.  
l
When the panel needs to be cleaned, use a  
soft cloth to wipe off dirt from the surface.  
NOTE  
Scratches or nicks on the panels resulting from  
the use of a hard brush or cloth may not be  
repairable.  
qCleaning the Lap/Shoulder Belt  
Webbing  
Clean the webbing with a mild soap  
solution recommended for upholstery or  
carpets. Follow instructions. Don't bleach  
or dye the webbing; this may weaken it.  
After cleaning the belts, thoroughly dry  
the belt webbing and make sure there is  
no remaining moisture before retracting  
them.  
8-58  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page441  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (441,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting  
Safety Defects  
9
Important consumer information including warranties and add-on equipment.  
9-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page442  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (442,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
Customer Assistance (U.S.A.)  
Your complete and permanent satisfaction is our business. We are here to serve you. All  
Authorized Mazda Dealers have the knowledge and the tools to keep your Mazda vehicle  
in top condition.  
If you have any questions or recommendations for improvement regarding the service of  
your Mazda vehicle or servicing by Mazda Dealer personnel, we recommend that you take  
the following steps:  
NOTE  
If it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the supplementary restraint  
system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical conditions in accordance with a  
certified physician, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
qSTEP 1: Contact Your Mazda Dealer  
Discuss the matter with an Authorized Mazda Dealer. This is the quickest and best way to  
address the issue.  
l
If your concern has not been resolved by the CUSTOMER RELATIONS, SALES,  
SERVICE, or PARTS MANAGER, then please contact the GENERAL MANAGER of  
the dealership or the OWNER.  
If it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the supplementary  
l
restraint system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical conditions in  
accordance with a certified physician, go to STEP2.  
qSTEP 2: Contact Mazda North American Operations  
If for any reason you feel the need for further assistance after contacting your dealership  
management and it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the  
supplementary restraint system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical  
conditions in accordance with a certified physician, you can reach Mazda North American  
Operations by one of the following ways.  
Log on: at www.mazdaUSA.com  
Answers to many questions, including how to locate or contact a local Mazda dealership in  
the U.S., can be found here.  
E-mail: click on Contact Usat the bottom of the page at www.mazdaUSA.com  
By phone at: 1 (800) 222-5500  
9-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page443  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (443,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
By letter at:  
Attn: Customer Assistance  
Mazda North American Operations  
7755 Irvine Center Drive  
Irvine, CA 92618-2922  
P.O. Box 19734  
Irvine, CA 92623-9734  
In order to serve you efficiently and effectively, please help us by providing the following  
information:  
1. Your name, address, and telephone number  
2. Year and model of vehicle  
3. Vehicle Identification Number (17 digits, noted on your registration or title or located on  
the upper driver's side corner of the dash)  
4. Purchase date and current mileage  
5. Your dealer's name and location  
6. Your question(s)  
If you live outside the U.S.A., please contact your nearest Mazda Distributor.  
9-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page444  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (444,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
Customer Assistance (Canada)  
qSatisfaction Review Process  
Your complete and permanent satisfaction is of primary concern to Mazda. All Authorized  
Mazda Dealers have both the knowledge and tools to keep your Mazda in top condition. In  
our experience, any questions, problems, or complaints regarding the operation of your  
Mazda or any other general service transactions are most effectively resolved by your  
dealer. If the cause of your dissatisfaction cannot adequately be addressed by normal  
dealership procedures, we recommend that you take the following steps:  
qSTEP 1: Contact the Mazda Dealer  
Discuss the matter with a member of dealership management. If the Service Manager has  
already reviewed your concerns, contact the owner of the dealership or its General  
Manager.  
qSTEP 2: Contact the Mazda Regional Office  
If you feel that you still require assistance, ask the dealer Service Manager to arrange for  
you to meet the local Mazda Service Representative. If more expedient, contact Mazda  
Canada Inc.Regional Office nearest you for such arrangements. Regional Office address  
and phone numbers are shown (page 9-6).  
qSTEP 3: Contact the Mazda Customer Relations Department  
If still not substantially satisfied, contact the Customer Relations Department, Mazda  
Canada Inc., 55 Vogell Road, Richmond Hill, Ontario, L4B 3K5 Canada TEL: 1 (800)  
263-4680.  
Provide the Department with the following information:  
1. Your name, address and telephone number  
2. Year and model of vehicle  
3. Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). Refer to the Vehicle Identification Labelspage  
of section 10 of this manual for the location of the VIN.  
4. Purchase date  
5. Present odometer reading  
6. Your dealer's name and location  
7. The nature of your problem and/or cause of dissatisfaction  
The Department, in cooperation with the local Mazda Service Representative, will review  
the case to determine if everything possible has been done to ensure your satisfaction.  
9-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page445  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (445,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
Please recognize that the resolution of service problems in most cases requires the use of  
your Mazda dealer's service facilities, personnel and equipment. We urge you to follow the  
above three steps in sequence for most effective results.  
qMediation/Arbitration Program  
Occasionally a customer concern cannot be resolved through Mazda's Customer  
Satisfaction Program. If after exhausting the procedures in this manual your concern is still  
not resolved, you have another option.  
Mazda Canada Inc. participates in an arbitration program administered by the  
Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP). CAMVAP will advise you about  
how your concern may be reviewed and resolved by an independent third party through  
binding arbitration.  
Your complete satisfaction is the goal of Mazda Canada Inc. and our dealers.  
Mazda's participation in CAMVAP makes a valuable contribution to our achieving that  
goal. There is no charge for using CAMVAP. CAMVAP results are fast, fair and final as the  
award is binding on both you and Mazda Canada Inc.  
qCanadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP)  
If a specific item of concern arises, where a solution cannot be reached between an owner,  
Mazda, and/or one of it's dealers (that all parties cannot agree upon), the owner may wish  
to use the services offered by the Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP).  
CAMVAP uses the services of Provincial Administrators to assist consumers in scheduling  
and preparing for their arbitration hearings. However, before you can proceed with  
CAMVAP you must follow your Mazda dispute resolution process as outlined previously.  
9-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page446  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (446,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
CAMVAP is fully implemented in all provinces and territories.  
Consumers wishing to obtain further information about the Program should contact the  
Provincial Administrator at 1 (800) 207-0685, or by contacting the  
Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan Office at:  
Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan  
235 Yorkland Boulevard, suite 300  
North York, Ontario  
M2J 4Y8  
http://camvap.ca  
Provincial Administrators may be reached locally as listed below:  
Province/Territory  
British Columbia & Yukon Territories  
Alberta & Northwest Territories  
Saskatchewan  
CAMVAP Number  
1 (800) 207-0685  
1 (800) 207-0685  
1 (800) 207-0685  
1 (800) 207-0685  
1 (800) 207-0685  
1 (800) 207-0685  
1 (800) 207-0685  
Manitoba  
Ontario  
Atlantic Canada  
Quebec  
qRegional Offices  
REGIONAL OFFICES  
AREAS COVERED  
MAZDA CANADA INC.  
WESTERN REGION  
8171 ACKROYD ROAD  
SUITE 2000  
ALBERTA,  
BRITISH COLUMBIA,  
MANITOBA,  
RICHMOND B.C.  
V6X 3K1  
SASKATCHEWAN,  
YUKON  
(604) 303-5670  
MAZDA CANADA INC.  
CENTRAL/ATLANTIC REGION  
55 VOGELL ROAD,  
ONTARIO  
RICHMOND HILL,  
ONTARIO, L4B 3K5  
(905) 787-7000  
MAZDA CANADA INC.  
QUEBEC REGION  
6111 ROUTE TRANS  
CANADIENNE  
QUEBEC,  
NEW BRUNSWICK,  
NOVA SCOTIA,  
POINTE CLAIRE, QUEBEC  
H9R 5A5  
PRINCE EDWARD ISLAND,  
NEWFOUNDLAND  
(514) 694-6390  
9-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page447  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (447,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
Customer Assistance (Puerto Rico)  
Your complete and permanent satisfaction is our business. That is why all Authorized  
Mazda Dealers have the knowledge and the tools to keep your Mazda vehicle in top  
condition.  
If you have any questions or recommendations for improvement regarding the service of  
your Mazda vehicle or servicing by Mazda Dealer personnel, we recommend that you take  
the following steps:  
qSTEP 1  
Discuss the matter with an Authorized Mazda Dealer. This is the quickest and best way to  
address the issue. If your concern has not been resolved by the CUSTOMER RELATIONS,  
SALES, SERVICE, or PARTS MANAGER, then please contact the GENERAL  
MANAGER of the dealership or the OWNER.  
qSTEP 2  
If, after following STEP 1, you feel the need for further assistance, please contact your  
area's Mazda representative (Indicated on the next page).  
Please help us by providing the following information:  
1. Your name, address, and telephone number  
2. Year and model of vehicle  
3. Vehicle Identification Number (17 digits, noted on your registration or title or located on  
the upper driver's side corner of the dash)  
4. Purchase date and current mileage  
5. Your dealer's name and location  
6. Your question(s)  
9-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page448  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (448,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
Customer Assistance (Mexico)  
Your complete and permanent satisfaction is our business. We are here to serve you. All  
Authorized Mazda Dealers have the knowledge and the tools to keep your Mazda vehicle  
in top condition.  
If you have any questions or recommendations for improvement regarding the service of  
your Mazda vehicle or servicing by Mazda Dealer personnel, we recommend that you take  
the following steps:  
qSTEP 1: Contact Your Mazda Dealer  
Discuss the matter with an Authorized Mazda Dealer. This is the quickest and best way to  
address the issue.  
l
If your concern has not been resolved by the CUSTOMER RELATIONS, SALES,  
SERVICE, or PARTS MANAGER, then please contact the GENERAL MANAGER of  
the dealership or the OWNER.  
If it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the supplementary  
l
restraint system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical conditions in  
accordance with a certified physician, go to STEP2.  
qSTEP 2: Contact Mazda Motor de Mexico  
If for any reason you feel the need for further assistance after contacting your dealership  
management and it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the  
supplementary restraint system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical  
conditions in accordance with a certified physician, you can reach Mazda Motor de Mexico  
by one of the following ways.  
Log on: at www.MazdaMexico.com.mx  
Answers to many questions, including how to locate or contact a local Mazda dealership in  
Mexico, can be found here.  
E-mail: click on Contactanosat the top of the page at www.MazdaMexico.com.mx  
By phone at: 1 (866) 315 0220  
By letter at:  
Attn: Customer Assistance  
Mazda North American Operations  
7755 Irvine Center Drive  
Irvine, CA 92618-2922  
P.O. Box 19734  
Irvine, CA 92623-9734  
9-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page449  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (449,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
In order to serve you efficiently and effectively, please help us by providing the following  
information:  
1. Your name, address, and telephone number  
2. Year and model of vehicle  
3. Vehicle Identification Number (17 digits, noted on your registration or title or located on  
the upper driver's side corner of the dash)  
4. Purchase date and current mileage  
5. Your dealer's name and location  
6. Your question(s)  
9-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page450  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (450,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Mazda Importer/Distributors  
Importer/Distributor  
Distributor in Each Area  
qU.S.A.  
qCANADA  
Mazda North American Operations  
7755 Irvine Center Drive  
Mazda Canada Inc.  
55 Vogell Road, Richmond Hill,  
Irvine, CA 92618-2922 U.S.A.  
P.O. Box 19734  
Irvine, CA 92623-9734 U.S.A.  
TEL: 1 (800) 222-5500 (in U.S.A.)  
(949) 727-1990 (outside U.S.A.)  
Ontario, L4B 3K5 Canada  
TEL: 1 (800) 263-4680 (in Canada)  
(905) 787-7000 (outside Canada)  
q
PUERTO RICO/U.S. Virgin Island  
Plaza Motors Corp. (Mazda de Puerto  
Rico)  
P.O. Box 362722, San Juan, Puerto Rico  
00936-2722  
TEL: (787) 641-9300  
qMEXICO  
Mazda Motor de Mexico  
Circuito Guillermo Gonzalez Camarena N  
1500 Col. Centro de Ciudad Santa Fe.  
01210, Mexico, D.F.  
TEL: Center of Attention to Clients:  
01 (800) 016 2932. in Mexico  
qGUAM  
Triple J Motors  
157 South Marine Drive, Tamuning,  
GUAM 96911 USA  
P.O. Box 6066 Tamuning, Guam 96931  
TEL: (671) 649-6555  
qSAIPAN  
Pacific International Marianas, Inc.  
(d.b.a. Midway Motors)  
P.O. Box 887 Saipan, MP 96950  
TEL: (670) 234-7524  
9-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page451  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (451,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Mazda Importer/Distributors  
Triple J Saipan, Inc.  
(d.b.a. Triple J Motors)  
P.O. Box 500487 Saipan, MP 96950-0487  
TEL: (670) 234-7133/3051  
9-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page452  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (452,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Warranty  
Warranties for Your Mazda  
l
l
l
l
l
New Vehicle Limited Warranty  
Distributor Major Component Limited Warranty (Canada only)  
Safety Restraint System Limited Warranty  
Anti-perforation Limited Warranty  
Federal Emission Control Warranty (U.S.A. only)  
l
Emission Defect Warranty  
Emission Performance Warranty  
l
l
l
l
l
California Emission Control Warranty (U.S.A. only)  
Emission Control Warranty (Canada only)  
Replacement Parts and Accessories Limited Warranty  
Tire Warranty  
NOTE  
Detailed warranty information is provided with your Mazda.  
9-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page453  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (453,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Warranty  
Outside the United States and Canada  
Government regulations in the United States and Canada require that automobiles meet  
specific emission regulations and safety standards. Therefore, vehicles built for use in the  
United States, its territories, and Canada may differ from those sold in other countries.  
The differences may make it difficult or even impossible for your vehicle to receive  
satisfactory servicing in other countries. We strongly recommend that you NOT take your  
Mazda outside these areas.  
You may have these problems if you do:  
l
Recommended fuel may be unavailable. Any kind of leaded fuel or low-octane fuel will  
affect vehicle performance and damage the emission controls and engine.  
Proper repair facilities, tools, testing equipment, and replacement parts may not be  
l
available.  
The Mazda warranty applies only to Mazda vehicles registered and normally operated in  
the United States, its territories, and Canada.  
9-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page454  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (454,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Warranty  
Outside the United States  
Government regulations in the United States require that automobiles meet specific  
emission regulations and safety standards. Therefore, vehicles built for use in the United  
States may differ from those sold in other countries.  
The differences may make it difficult or even impossible for your vehicle to receive  
satisfactory servicing in other countries. We strongly recommend that you NOT take your  
Mazda outside the United States. However, in the event that you are moving to Canada  
permanently, Mazda vehicles built for use in the United States could be eligible for  
exportation to Canada with specific vehicle modifications to comply with the Canadian  
Motor Vehicle Safety requirements (CMVSS).  
NOTE  
The above is applicable for a permanent import/export situation and not related to travelers on  
vacation.  
You may have the following problems if you do take your vehicle outside of the United  
States:  
l
Recommended fuel may be unavailable. Any kind of leaded fuel or low-octane fuel will  
affect vehicle performance and damage the emission controls and engine.  
Proper repair facilities, tools, testing equipment, and replacement parts may not be  
l
available.  
Please refer to your Manufacturer's Warranty Booklet for more information.  
9-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page455  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (455,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Warranty  
Outside Canada  
Government regulations in Canada require that automobiles meet specific emission  
regulations and safety regulations. Therefore, vehicles built for use in Canada may differ  
from those sold in other countries.  
The differences may make it difficult or even impossible for your vehicle to receive  
satisfactory servicing in other countries. We strongly recommend that you NOT take your  
Mazda outside Canada. However, in the event that you are moving to the United States  
permanently, Mazda vehicles built for use in Canada could be eligible for exportation to the  
United States with specific vehicle modifications to comply with the United States Federal  
Motor Vehicle Safety Standards (FMVSS).  
NOTE  
The above is applicable for a permanent import/export situation and not related to travelers on  
vacation.  
You may have the following problems if you do take your vehicle outside of Canada:  
l
Recommended fuel may be unavailable. Any kind of leaded fuel or low-octane fuel will  
affect vehicle performance and damage the emission controls and engine.  
Proper repair facilities, tools, testing equipment, and replacement parts may not be  
l
available.  
Please refer to your Manufacturer's Warranty Booklet for more information.  
9-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page456  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (456,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Warranty  
Registering Your Vehicle in A Foreign Country (Except  
United States and Canada)  
Government regulations in your country could require that automobiles meet specific  
emission and safety standards.  
Vehicles built for your country may differ from those built for other countries. In addition  
to registration problems, satisfactory service may be difficult or even impossible in another  
country.  
The fuel specified for your vehicle may be unavailable.  
Parts, servicing techniques, and tools necessary to maintain and repair your vehicle may be  
unavailable.  
There might not be an Authorized Mazda Dealer in the country you plan to take your  
vehicle.  
The Mazda warranty is valid only in certain countries.  
9-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page457  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (457,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Warranty  
Add-On Non-Genuine Parts and Accessories  
Non-genuine parts and accessories for Mazda vehicles can be found in stores.  
These may fit your vehicle, but they are not approved by Mazda for use with Mazda  
vehicles. When you install non-genuine parts or accessories, they could affect your  
vehicle's performance or safety systems; the Mazda warranty doesn't cover this. Before you  
install any non-genuine parts or accessories, consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
WARNING  
Always consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer before you install non-genuine parts or  
accessories:  
Installation of non-genuine parts or accessories is dangerous. Improperly designed  
parts or accessories could seriously affect your vehicle's performance or safety  
systems. This could cause you to have an accident or increase your chances of  
injuries in an accident.  
Be very careful in choosing and installing add-on electrical equipment, such as  
mobile telephones, two-way radios, stereo systems, and car alarm systems:  
Incorrectly choosing or installing improper add-on equipment or choosing an  
improper installer is dangerous. Essential systems could be damaged, causing engine  
stalling, air-bag (SRS) activation, ABS inactivation, or a fire in the vehicle.  
Mazda assumes no responsibility for death, injury, or expenses that may result from the  
installation of add-on non-genuine parts or accessories.  
9-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page458  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (458,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Cell Phones  
Cell Phones Warning  
WARNING  
Please comply with the legal regulations concerning the use of communication  
equipment in vehicles in your country:  
Use of any electrical devices such as cell phones, computers, portable radios, vehicle  
navigation or other devices by the driver while the vehicle is moving is dangerous.  
Dialing a number on a cell phone while driving also ties-up the driver's hands. Use of  
these devices will cause the driver to be distracted and could lead to a serious  
accident. If a passenger is unable to use the device, pull off the right-of-way to a safe  
area before use. If use of a cell phone is necessary despite this warning, use a hands-  
free system to at least leave the hands free to drive the vehicle. Never use a cell  
phone or other electrical devices while the vehicle is moving and, instead,  
concentrate on the full-time job of driving.  
9-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page459  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (459,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Type Approval of Equipment  
Type Approval of Equipment (Mexico)  
Immobilizer system  
9-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page460  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (460,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Type Approval of Equipment  
Keyless entry system  
9-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page461  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (461,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading System (UTQGS)  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading System (UTQGS)  
This information relates to the tire grading system developed by the U.S. National  
Highway Traffic Safety Administration for grading tires by tread wear, traction, and  
temperature performance.  
qTread Wear  
The tread wear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested  
under controlled conditions on a specified government test course.  
For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one-and-a-half times as well on the government  
course as a tire graded 100.  
The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however,  
and may depart significantly from the norm because of variations in driving habits, service  
practices and differences in road characteristics and climate.  
qTraction-AA, A, B, C  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. These grades represent  
the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on  
specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor  
traction performance.  
WARNING  
The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on braking (straight ahead) traction  
tests and does not include acceleration cornering (turning), hydroplaning, or peak  
traction characteristics.  
qTemperature-A, B, C  
The temperature grades A (the highest), B, and C, represent the tire's resistance to the  
generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions  
on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel.  
Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire  
life, and excessive temperatures can lead to sudden tire failure.  
Grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger vehicle tires must meet  
under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent  
higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by  
law.  
9-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page462  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (462,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading System (UTQGS)  
WARNING  
Keep your vehicle's tires properly inflated and not overloaded:  
Driving with improperly inflated or overloaded tires is dangerous. Excessive speed,  
underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause  
heat buildup and possible tire failure. The temperature grade for this tire is  
established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded.  
These grades will be added to the sidewalls of passenger vehicle tires over the next several  
years according to a schedule established by the NHTSA and the tire manufacturers.  
The grade of tires available as standard or optional equipment on Mazda vehicles may vary  
with respect to grade.  
ALL PASSENGER VEHICLE TIRES MUST CONFORM TO THESE GRADES AND  
TO ALL OTHER FEDERAL TIRE-SAFETY REQUIREMENTS.  
qUniform Tire Quality Grading  
Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder  
and maximum section width.  
For example:  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A  
UTQGS MARK (example)  
TREADWEAR 200 TRACTION AA  
TEMPERATURE A  
9-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page463  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (463,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Tire Labeling  
Federal law requires tire manufacturers to place standardized information on the sidewall of  
all tires. This information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of the tire  
and also provides a tire identification number for safety standard certification and in case of  
a recall.  
qInformation on Passenger Vehicle Tires  
Please refer to the diagram below.  
1. TIN: U.S. DOT tire identification number  
2. Passenger car tire  
3. Nominal width of tire in millimeters  
4. Ratio of height to width (aspect ratio)  
5. Radial  
6. Rim diameter code  
7. Load index & speed symbol  
8. Severe snow conditions  
9. Tire ply composition and materials used  
10. Max. load rating  
9-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page464  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (464,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
11. Tread wear, traction and temperature grades  
12. Max. permissible inflation pressure  
13. SAFETY WARNING  
P215/65R15 95H is an example of a tire size and load index rating. Here is an explanation  
of the various components of that tire size and load index rating. Note that the tire size and  
load index rating may be different from the example.  
P
Indicates a tire that may be installed on cars, SUVs, minivans and light trucks as designated  
by the Tire and Rim Association (T&RA).  
NOTE  
If your tire size does not begin with a letter this may mean it is designated by either ETRTO  
(European Tire and Rim Technical Organization) or JATMA (Japan Tire Manufacturing Association).  
215  
215is the nominal width of the tire in millimeters. This three-digit number gives the  
width in millimeters of the tire from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger  
the number, the wider the tire.  
65  
65is the aspect ratio. This two-digit number indicates the tire's ratio of height to width.  
R
Ris the tire construction symbol. R indicates Radial ply construction.  
15  
15is the wheel rim diameter in inches.  
95  
95is the Load Index. This two-or three-digit number indicates how much weight each  
tire can support.  
9-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page465  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (465,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
H
His the speed rating. The speed rating denotes the maximum speed for which the use of  
the tire is rated.  
Letter Rating  
Speed Rating  
99 mph  
Q
R
S
106 mph  
112 mph  
118 mph  
124 mph  
130 mph  
149 mph  
168* mph  
186* mph  
T
U
H
V
W
Y
* For tires with a maximum speed capability over 149 mph, tire manufacturers sometimes use the letters ZR. For  
tires with a maximum speed capability over 186 mph, tire manufacturers always use the letters ZR.  
M+S or M/S: Mud and Snow  
AT: All Terrain.  
AS: All Season. The M+Sor M/Sindicates that the tire has some functional use in  
mud and snow.  
U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN)  
This begins with the letters DOTwhich indicates the tire meets all federal standards. The  
next two numbers or letters are the plant code where it was manufactured, and the last four  
numbers represent the week and year the tire was manufactured. For example, the numbers  
457 means the 45st week of 1997. After 2000 the numbers go to four digits. For example,  
the number 2102 means the 21th week of 2002. The other numbers are marketing codes  
used at the manufacturer's discretion. This information is used to contact consumers if a tire  
defect requires a recall.  
Tire Ply Composition and Materials Used  
The number of plies indicates the number of layers of rubber-coated fabric in the tire. In  
general, the greater the number of plies, the more weight a tire can support. Tire  
manufacturers also must indicate the tire materials, which include steel, nylon, polyester,  
and other.  
Maximum Load Rating  
This number indicates the maximum load in kilograms and pounds that can be carried by  
the tire.  
Maximum Permissible Inflation Pressure  
This number is the greatest amount of air pressure that should ever be put in the tire under  
normal driving conditions.  
9-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page466  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (466,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Tread Wear, Traction and Temperature Grades  
Tread wear: The tread wear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire  
when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For  
example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the  
government course as a tire graded 100.  
Traction: The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B, and C. The grades  
represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions  
on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have  
poor traction performance.  
Temperature: The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C, representing the tire's  
resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under  
controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel.  
Snow Tires  
In some heavy snow areas, local governments may require true snow tires, those with very  
deeply cut tread. These tires should only be used in pairs or placed on all four wheels.  
Make sure you purchase snow tires that are the same size and construction type as the other  
tires on your vehicle.  
SAFETY WARNING  
The following safety warning appears on the tire's sidewall.  
SERIOUS INJURY MAY RESULT FROM:  
l
EXPLOSION OF TIRE/RIM ASSEMBLY DUE TO IMPROPER MOUNTING-  
MATCH TIRE DIAMETER TO RIM DIAMETER; NEVER EXCEED 40 psi (275 kPa)  
TO SEAT BEADS-ONLY SPECIALLY TRAINED PERSONS SHOULD MOUNT  
TIRES.  
l
TIRE FAILURE DUE TO UNDER-INFLATION/OVERLOADING/DAMAGE-  
FOLLOW OWNER'S MANUAL AND PLACARD IN VEHICLE-FREQUENTLY  
CHECK INFLATION PRESSURE AND INSPECT FOR DAMAGE.  
9-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page467  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (467,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
qInformation on Temporary Tires  
Please refer to the diagram below.  
1. Temporary tires  
2. Nominal width of tire in millimeters  
3. Ratio of height to width (aspect ratio)  
4. Diagonal  
5. Rim diameter code  
6. Load index&speed symbol  
T115/70D 16 90M is an example of a tire size and load index rating. Here is an explanation  
of the various components of that tire size and load index rating. Note that the tire size and  
load index rating may be different from the example.  
T
Indicates a tire that may be installed on cars, SUVs, minivans and light trucks as designated  
by the Tire and Rim Association (T&RA).  
115  
115is the nominal width of the tire in millimeters. This three-digit number gives the  
width in millimeters of the tire from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger  
the number, the wider the tire.  
9-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page468  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (468,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
70  
70is the aspect ratio. This two-digit number indicates the tire's ratio of height to width.  
D
Dis the tire construction symbol. D indicates diagonal ply construction.  
16  
16is the wheel rim diameter in inches.  
90  
90is the Load Index. This two-or three-digit number indicates how much weight each  
tire can support.  
M
Mis the speed rating. The speed rating denotes the maximum speed for which the use of  
the tire is rated.  
Letter Rating  
Speed Rating  
M
81 mph  
9-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page469  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (469,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Location of the Tire Label (Placard)  
You will find the tire label containing tire inflation pressure by tire size and other important  
information on the driver's side B-pillar or on the edge of the driver's door frame.  
SAMPLE  
qRecommended Tire Inflation Pressure  
On the tire label you will find the recommended tire inflation pressure in both kPa and psi  
for the tires installed as original equipment on the vehicle. It is very important that the  
inflation pressure of the tires on your vehicle is maintained at the recommended pressure.  
You should check the tire pressure regularly to insure that the proper inflation pressure is  
maintained.  
Refer to Tires on page 10-6.  
NOTE  
Tire pressures listed on the vehicle placard or tire information label indicate the recommended cold  
tire inflation pressure, measured when the tires are cold, after the vehicle has been parked for at least  
3 hours. As you drive, the temperature in the tire warms up, increasing the tire pressure.  
9-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page470  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (470,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
WARNING  
Always check the tire inflation pressures on a regular basis according to the  
recommended tire inflation pressure on the tire label and in conjunction with the  
information in this owner's manual:  
Driving your vehicle with under-inflated tires is dangerous.  
Under-inflation is the most common cause of failures in any kind of tire and may  
result in severe cracking, tread separation or blowout, with unexpected loss of  
vehicle control and increased risk of injury. Under-inflation increases sidewall flexing  
and rolling resistance, resulting in heat buildup and internal damage to the tire. It  
results in unnecessary tire stress, irregular wear, loss of control and accidents. A tire  
can lose up to half of its air pressure and not appear to be flat!  
It is impossible to determine whether or not tires are properly inflated just by looking  
at them.  
qChecking Tire Pressure  
1. When you check the air pressure, make sure the tires are cold meaning they are not  
hot from driving even a mile.  
2. Remove the cap from the valve on one tire.  
3. Firmly press a tire gauge onto the valve.  
4. Add air to achieve recommended air pressure.  
5. If you overfill the tire, release air by pushing on the metal stem in the center of the  
valve. Then recheck the pressure with your tire gauge.  
6. Replace the valve cap.  
7. Repeat with each tire, including the spare.  
NOTE  
Some spare tires require higher inflation pressure.  
8. Visually inspect the tires to make sure there are no nails or other objects embedded that  
could poke a hole in the tire and cause an air leak.  
9. Check the sidewalls to make sure there are no gouges, cuts, bulges, cracks or other  
irregularities.  
NOTE  
Warm tires normally exceed recommended pressures. Don't release air from warm tires to adjust the  
pressure.  
Under-inflation can cause serious failures and accidents.  
Over-inflation can produce a harsh ride and the greater possibility of damage from road hazards.  
9-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page471  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (471,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
qGlossary of Terms  
Tire Placard: A label indicating the OE tire sizes, recommended inflation pressure, and  
the maximum weight the vehicle can carry.  
Tire Identification Number (TIN): A number on the sidewall of each tire providing  
information about the tire brand and manufacturing plant, tire size, and date of  
manufacture.  
Inflation Pressure: A measure of the amount of air in a tire.  
kPa: Kilopascal, the metric unit for air pressure.  
psi: Pounds per square inch, the English unit for air pressure.  
B-pillar: The structural member at the side of the vehicle behind the front door.  
Original Equipment (OE): Describes components originally equipped on the vehicle.  
Vehicle Load Limit: The maximum value of the combination weight of occupants and  
cargo.  
Bead Area of the Tire: Area of the tire next to the rim.  
Sidewall Area of the Tire: Area between the bead area and the tread.  
Tread Area of the Tire: Area on the perimeter of the tire that contacts the road when it's  
mounted on the vehicle.  
Seating capacity means the total allowable number of vehicle occupants. Seating capacity  
is described on the tire label.  
Production options weight is the combination weight of installed regular production  
options weighing over 2.3 kilograms in excess of the standard items which they replace,  
and not previously considered in the curb weight or accessory weight, including heavy  
duty brakes, ride levelers, roof rack, heavy duty battery, and special trim.  
Rim is the metal support (wheel) for a tire or a tire and tube assembly upon which the tire  
beads are seated.  
9-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page472  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (472,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Tire Maintenance  
Improper or inadequate vehicle maintenance can cause tires to wear abnormally. Here are  
some important maintenance points:  
qTire Inflation Pressure  
Inspect all tire pressure monthly (including the spare) when the tires are cold. Maintain  
recommended pressures for the best ride, top handling, and minimum tire wear. Use the  
pressures specified on the vehicle tire information placard or tire label for optimum service.  
qTire Rotation  
To equalize tread wear, rotate the tires every 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or sooner if irregular  
wear develops. During rotation, inspect them for correct balance.  
Forward  
Do not include (TEMPORARY USE ONLY)  
spare tire in rotation.  
Inspect the tires for uneven wear and damage. Abnormal wear is usually caused by one or a  
combination of the following:  
l
Incorrect tire pressure  
Improper wheel alignment  
Out-of-balance wheel  
Severe braking  
l
l
l
After rotation, inflate all tire pressures to specification (page 10-6) and inspect the lug nuts  
for tightness.  
CAUTION  
Rotate unidirectional tires and radial tires that have an asymmetrical tread pattern  
or studs only from front to rear, not from side to side. Tire performance will be  
weakened if rotated from side to side.  
9-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page473  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (473,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
qReplacing a Tire  
WARNING  
Always use tires that are in good condition:  
Driving with worn tires is dangerous. Reduced braking, steering, and traction could  
result in an accident.  
If a tire wears evenly, a wear indicator will appear as a solid band across the tread. Replace  
the tire when this happens.  
Tread wear indicator  
New tread  
Worn tread  
You should replace it before the band is across the entire tread.  
NOTE  
Tires degrade over time, even when they are not being used on the road. It is recommended that tires  
generally be replaced when they are 6 years or older. Heat caused by hot climates or frequent high  
loading conditions can accelerate the aging process. You should replace the spare tire when you  
replace the other road tires due to the aging of the spare tire. Regarding the manufacturing week and  
year is indicated with 4 digit. Refer to The tire labeling on page 9-23.  
qSafety Practices  
The way you drive has a great deal to do with your tire mileage and safety. So cultivate  
good driving habits for your own benefit.  
l
Observe posted speed limits  
Avoid fast starts, stops and turns  
Avoid potholes and objects on the road  
Do no run over curbs or hit the tire against the curb when parking  
l
l
l
9-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page474  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (474,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
CAUTION  
If you feel a sudden vibration or ride disturbance while driving or you suspect your  
tire or vehicle has been damaged, immediately reduce your speed. Drive with caution  
until you can safely pull off the road. Stop and inspect the tire for damage. If the tire  
is under-inflated or damaged, deflate it, remove the tire and rim and replace it with  
your spare tire. If you cannot detect a cause, have the vehicle towed to the nearest  
vehicle or tire dealer to have the vehicle inspected.  
9-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page475  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (475,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Vehicle Loading  
This section will guide you in the proper loading of your vehicle and/or trailer, to keep  
your loaded vehicle weight within its design rating capability, with or without a trailer.  
Properly loading your vehicle will provide maximum return of vehicle design performance.  
Before loading your vehicle, familiarize yourself with the following terms for determining  
your vehicle's weight ratings, with or without a trailer, from the vehicle's Safety  
Certification Label and Tire and Load Information Label:  
WARNING  
Overloaded Vehicle:  
Overloading a vehicle is dangerous. The results of overloading can have serious  
consequences in terms of passenger safety. Too much weight on a vehicle's  
suspension system can cause spring or shock absorber failure, brake failure,  
handling or steering problems, irregular tire wear, tire failure or other damage.  
Overloading makes a vehicle harder to drive and control. It also increases the  
distance required for stopping. In cases of serious overloading, brakes can fail  
completely, particularly on steep grades. The load a tire will carry safely is a  
combination of the size of the tire, its load range, and corresponding inflation  
pressure.  
Never overload the vehicle and always observe the vehicle's weight ratings from the  
vehicle's Safety Certification and Tire and Load Information labels.  
Base Curb Weight is the weight of the vehicle including a full tank of fuel and all  
standard equipment. It does not include passengers, cargo, or optional equipment.  
Vehicle Curb Weight is the weight of your new vehicle when you picked it up from your  
dealer plus any aftermarket equipment.  
PAYLOAD  
9-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page476  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:21 PM  
Black plate (476,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Payload is the combination weight of cargo and passengers that the vehicle is designed to  
carry. The maximum payload for your vehicle can be found on the Tire and Load  
Information label on the driver's door frame or door pillar. Look for THE  
COMBINATION WEIGHT OF OCCUPANTS AND CARGO SHOULD NEVER  
EXCEED XXX kg or XXX lbsfor your maximum payload. The payload listed on the tire  
label is the maximum payload for the vehicle as built by the assembly plant. If any  
aftermarket or dealer installed equipment has been installed on the vehicle, the weight of  
the equipment must be subtracted from the payload listed on the tire label in order to be  
accurate.  
SAMPLE  
9-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page477  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (477,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
CARGO  
Cargo Weight includes all weight added to the Base Curb Weight, including cargo and  
optional equipment. When towing, trailer tongue load or king pin weight is also part of  
cargo weight.  
The cargo weight limit decreases depending on the number of vehicle occupants. The cargo  
weight limit can be calculated by subtracting the total weight of the vehicle occupants from  
the combination weight of occupants and cargo should never exceedvalue on the tire  
label.  
Examples: Based on a single occupant weight of 68 kg, and a value of 385 kg for the  
combination weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed:  
_
_
The cargo weight limit with one occupant is 385 kg 68 kg = 317 kg  
The cargo weight limit with two occupants is 385 kg (68 × 2) kg = 249 kg  
If the weight of the occupant increases, the cargo weight limit decreases by that much.  
GAW (Gross Axle Weight) is the total weight placed on each axle (front and rear) -  
including vehicle curb weight and all payload.  
9-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page478  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (478,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) is the maximum allowable weight that can be carried  
by a single axle (front or rear). These numbers are shown on the Safety Compliance  
Certification Label located on the driver's door frame or door pillar. The total load on  
each axle must never exceed its GAWR.  
GVW  
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) is the Vehicle Curb Weight + cargo + passengers.  
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) is the maximum allowable weight of the fully  
loaded vehicle (including all options, equipment, passengers and cargo). The GVWR is  
shown on the Safety Compliance Certification Label located on the driver's door  
frame or door pillar. The GVW must never exceed the GVWR.  
9-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page479  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (479,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
SAMPLE  
WARNING  
Exceeding Axle Weight Rating Limits:  
Exceeding the Safety Certification Label axle weight rating limits is dangerous and  
could result in death or serious injury as a result of substandard vehicle handling,  
performance, engine, transmission and/or structural damage, serious damage to the  
vehicle, or loss of control.  
Always keep the vehicle within the axle weight rating limits.  
Do not taw a trailer with this vehicle:  
Towing a trailer with this vehicle is dangerous because it has not been designed to  
tow a trailer and doing so will affect the drive system which could result in vehicle  
damage.  
9-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page480  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (480,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
GCW  
GCW (Gross Combination Weight) is the weight of the loaded vehicle (GVW) plus the  
weight of the fully loaded trailer.  
GCWR (Gross Combination Weight Rating) is the maximum allowable weight of the  
vehicle and the loaded trailer - including all cargo and passengers - that the vehicle can  
handle without risking damage. (Important: The towing vehicle's braking system is rated  
for operation at GVWR, not at GCWR. Separate functional brakes should be used for safe  
control of towed vehicles and for trailers weighing more than 1,500 lbs). The GCW must  
never exceed the GCWR.  
Maximum Loaded Trailer Weight is the highest possible weight of a fully loaded trailer  
the vehicle can tow. It assumes a vehicle with only mandatory options, no cargo (internal or  
_
_
external), a tongue load of 10 15% (conventional trailer) or king pin weight of 15 25%  
(fifth-wheel trailer), and driver only (150 lbs). Consult your dealership (or the RV and  
Trailer Towing Guide provided by your dealership) for more detailed information.  
Tongue Load or Fifth-Wheel King Pin Weight refers to the amount of the weight that a  
trailer pushes down on a trailer hitch.  
Examples: For a 5000 lb conventional trailer, multiply 5000 by 0.10 and 0.15 to obtain a  
proper tongue load range of 500 to 750 lbs. For an 11,500 lb fifth-wheel trailer, multiply by  
0.15 and 0.25 to obtain a proper king pin load range of 1,725 to 2,875 lbs.  
9-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page481  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (481,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
WARNING  
Exceeding GVWR or GAWR Specifications:  
Exceeding the GVWR or the GAWR specified on the certification label is dangerous.  
Exceeding any vehicle rating limitation could result in a serious accident, injury, or  
damage to the vehicle.  
Do not use replacement tires with lower load carrying capacities than the originals  
because they may lower the vehicle's GVWR and GAWR limitations. Replacement  
tires with a higher limit than the originals do not increase the GVWR and GAWR  
limitations.  
Never exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on the certification label.  
9-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page482  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (482,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Steps for Determining the Correct Load Limit:  
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit:  
(1) Locate the statement The combined weight of occupants and cargo should  
never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbson your vehicle's placard.  
(2) Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be  
riding in your vehicle.  
(3) Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg  
or XXX lbs.  
(4) The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load  
capacity. For example, if the XXXamount equals 1400 lbs. and there  
will be five 150 lb passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available  
_
cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs. (1400 750 (5 × 150) = 650  
lbs.)  
(5) Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the  
vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage  
load capacity calculated in Step 4.  
(6) If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, the load from your trailer will be  
transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this  
reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.  
9-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page483  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (483,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects (U.S.A.)  
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could  
cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway  
Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Mazda Motor  
Corporation (Your Mazda Importer/Distributor).  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it  
finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and  
remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual  
problems between you, your dealer, or Mazda Motor Corporation (Your Mazda  
Importer/Distributor).  
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-  
327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153) ; go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:  
Administrator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington, DC 20590. You  
can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://  
www.safercar.gov.  
NOTE  
If you live in the U.S.A., all correspondence to Mazda Motor Corporation should be forwarded to:  
Mazda North American Operations  
7755 Irvine Center Drive  
Irvine, California 92618-2922  
P.O. Box 19734  
Irvine, CA 92623-9734  
Customer Assistance Center or toll free at 1 (800) 222-5500  
If you live outside of the U.S.A., please contact the nearest Mazda Distributor shown (page 9-10) in  
this booklet.  
9-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page484  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (484,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects (Canada)  
Canadian customers who wish to report a safety-related defect to Transport Canada, Defect  
Investigations and Recalls, may telephone the toll free hotline 1-800-333-0510, or contact  
Transport Canada by mail at: Transport Canada, ASFAD, Place de Ville Tower C, 330  
Sparks Street, Ottawa ON K1A 0N5.  
For additional road safety information, please visit the Road Safety website at:  
http://www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety/menu.htm  
9-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page485  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (485,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Service Publications  
Service Publications  
Factory-authorized Mazda service publications are available for owners who wish to do  
some of their own maintenance and repair.  
When requesting any of our publications through an Authorized Mazda Dealer, refer to the  
chart below.  
If they don't have what you need in stock, they can order it for you.  
PUBLICATION ORDER NUMBER  
9999-95-003B-07  
PUBLICATION DESCRIPTION  
2007 WORKSHOP MANUAL (English)  
2007 WORKSHOP MANUAL (Spanish)  
2007 WIRING DIAGRAM (English)  
2007 WIRING DIAGRAM (Spanish)  
2007 OWNER'S MANUAL  
9999-MX-003B-07  
9999-95-009G-07  
9999-MX-009G-07  
9999-95-011C-07 (U.S.A. only)  
9999-EC-011C-07 (Canada only)  
9999-PR-011C-07 (Puerto Rico, Mexico only)  
9999-95-011C-07QT  
2007 OWNER'S MANUAL  
2007 OWNER'S MANUAL  
2007 QUICK TIPS  
9999-95-001F-07  
2007 SERVICE HIGHLIGHTS  
9999-95-011C-07NAV (U.S.A. only)  
9999-EC-011C-07NAV (Canada only)  
2007 NAVIGATION SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL  
2007 NAVIGATION SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL  
qWORKSHOP MANUAL:  
Covers recommended maintenance and repair procedures of the drive train, body and  
chassis.  
qWIRING DIAGRAM:  
Provides electrical schematics as well as component location for the entire electrical  
system.  
qOWNER'S MANUAL:  
This booklet contains information regarding the proper care and operation of your vehicle.  
This is not a technician's manual.  
qQUICK TIPS:  
This guide contains quick and concise information regarding proper operation of your  
vehicle and it's many features. This is not a technician's manual.  
9-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page486  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (486,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Service Publications  
qSERVICE HIGHLIGHTS:  
Provides description and operation of the many systems of your Mazda.  
qNAVIGATION SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL:  
This booklet contains information regarding the proper operation and use of the navigation  
system. This is not a technician's manual.  
9-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page487  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (487,1)  
Specifications  
10  
Technical information about your Mazda.  
10-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page488  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (488,1)  
Identification Numbers  
qChassis Number  
Vehicle Information Labels  
qVehicle Identification Number  
The vehicle identification number legally  
identifies your vehicle. The number is on  
a plate attached to the cowl panel located  
on the left corner of the dashboard. This  
plate can easily be seen through the  
windshield.  
qVehicle Emission Control  
Information Label  
q
Motor Vehicle Safety Standard Label  
10-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page489  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (489,1)  
Identification Numbers  
q
Tire Pressure Label (Except Canada)  
qEngine Number  
Forward  
10-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page490  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (490,1)  
Specifications  
Specifications  
qEngine  
Item  
Specification  
Type  
DOHC-24V 60°V Duratec 35, 6-cylinder  
92.5 × 86.7 mm (3.64 × 3.41 in)  
3,496 ml (3,496 cc, 213.3 cu in)  
10.3  
Bore×Stroke  
Displacement  
Compression ratio  
qElectrical System  
Item  
Battery  
Classification  
12V-55AH/5HR MF  
Spark-plug number  
Spark-plug gap  
ZZJ1-18110*1  
1.291.45 mm (0.0510.057 in)  
*1 ex factory  
CAUTION  
When cleaning the iridium plugs, do not use a wire brush. The fine particulate  
coating on the iridium alloy and platinum tips could be damaged.  
qLubricant Quality  
Lubricant  
Classification  
Refer to the recommended SAE viscosity numbers on page 8-19.  
JWS3309  
Engine oil  
Automatic transaxle fluid  
Transfer case oil  
API Service GL-5 (SAE 75W-140)  
API Service GL-5 (SAE 80W-90)  
Rear differential oil  
Power steering fluid  
Brake fluid  
ATF M-III, M-V, or equivalent (e.g. Dexron® II)  
SAE J1703, or FMVSS116 DOT-3  
10-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page491  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (491,1)  
Specifications  
qCapacities  
(Approximate Quantities)  
Item  
Capacity  
With oil filter replacement  
5.2 L (5.5 US qt, 4.6 Imp qt)  
4.7 L (5.0 US qt, 4.2 Imp qt)  
11.7 L (12.4 US qt, 10.3 Imp qt)  
11.1 L (11.7 US qt, 9.77 Imp qt)  
7.0 L (7.4 US qt, 6.2 Imp qt)  
0.532 L (0.562 US qt, 0.468 Imp qt)  
1.0 L (1.1 US qt, 0.9 Imp qt)  
4.5 L (4.8 US qt, 4.0 Imp qt)  
76.0 L (20.1 US gal, 16.7 Imp gal)  
Engine oil  
Coolant  
Without oil filter replacement  
With Towing Package  
Without Towing Package  
Automatic transaxle fluid  
Transfer case oil  
Rear differential oil  
Washer fluid  
Fuel tank  
Check oil and fluid levels with dipsticks or reservoir gauges.  
qDimensions  
Item  
Overall length  
Overall width  
Overall height  
Front tread  
Vehicle specification  
5,074 mm (199.8 in)  
1,936 mm (76.2 in)  
1,728 mm (68.0 in)  
1,654 mm (65.1 in)  
1,644 mm (64.7 in)  
2,875 mm (113.2 in)  
Rear tread  
Wheelbase  
qWeights  
Weight  
Item  
2WD  
AWD  
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating)  
2,633 kg (5,805 lbs)  
1,271 kg (2,802 lbs)  
1,390 kg (3,064 lbs)  
2,733 kg (6,025 lbs)  
1,307 kg (2,881 lbs)  
1,456 kg (3,210 lbs)  
Front  
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)  
Rear  
qAir Conditioner  
Item  
Classification  
HFC134a (R-134a)  
Refrigerant Type  
10-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page492  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (492,1)  
Specifications  
qLight Bulbs  
Exterior light  
Category  
Light bulb  
Wattage  
60  
ECE R (SAE)  
HB3 (HB3)  
H11 ()  
High beam  
Headlights  
Low beam  
Halogen  
55  
Xenon fusion  
35  
D2S (D2S)  
(#1156NA)  
WY5W ()  
HB4 (#9006)  
()  
Front turn signal lights  
Front side-marker lights  
Fog lightsí  
Side turn signal lightsí  
High-mount brake light*1  
Rear turn signal lights  
Brake lights*2  
27  
5
51  
LED bulb*1  
2.26  
2.4  
21  
()  
WY21W (32CP)  
()  
5.4  
Rear  
combination  
0.7  
()  
light side*2  
Taillights  
Liftgate side  
3.8  
21  
5
(#194)  
W21W (#7440)  
T10 ()  
Reverse lights  
License plate lights  
Rear side-marker lights  
5
W5W (4CP)  
*1 Bulb replacement is not possible because it is built into the unit. Replace the unit.  
*2 Bulb replacement is not possible. The rear combination component must be replaced.  
Interior light  
Category  
Light bulb  
Wattage  
ECE R  
Overhead lights/Map lights (Front)  
Overhead light (Center)  
Overhead light (Rear)  
8
10  
10  
5
Courtesy lights  
Vanity mirror lightsí  
T10  
2
Luggage compartment light  
10  
qTires  
NOTE  
The tires have been optimally matched with the chassis of your vehicle.  
When replacing tires, Mazda recommends that you replace tires of the same type originally fitted to  
your vehicle. For details, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
10-6  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page493  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (493,1)  
Specifications  
Check the tire pressure label for tire size and inflation pressure.  
Refer to Tire Inflation Pressure on page 8-33.  
Standard tire  
Inflation pressure  
Tire size  
Front  
Rear  
P245/60R18  
P245/50R20  
250 kPa (36 psi)  
230 kPa (34 psi)  
250 kPa (36 psi)  
230 kPa (34 psi)  
Temporary spare tire  
Tire size  
Inflation pressure  
420 kPa (60 psi)  
T155/90D18  
qFuses  
Refer to the fuse rating on page 8-44.  
10-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page494  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (494,1)  
10-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page495  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (495,1)  
Index  
11  
11-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
 
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page496  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (496,1)  
Index  
A
A
Automatic Transaxle  
B
Battery  
Beeps  
Audio  
Brake  
11-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page497  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (497,1)  
Index  
B
D
Brakes  
Defroster  
C
Child Restraint  
E
Engine  
Engine Coolant  
D
11-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page498  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (498,1)  
Index  
E
H
Headlights  
F
Flasher  
Fluids  
I
Ignition  
Fuel  
G
11-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page499  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (499,1)  
Index  
J
O
K
P
L
Light Bulbs  
R
M
Maintenance  
Mirrors  
O
11-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page500  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (500,1)  
Index  
S
S
Seat Belt System  
Seats  
T
Tiedown  
Security System  
Tires  
11-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page501  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (501,1)  
Index  
T
W
Towing  
V
Windows  
11-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  
CX-9_8V83-EA-06I_Edition3 Page502  
Monday, February 26 2007 7:22 PM  
Black plate (502,1)  
11-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8V83-EA-06I  

Lennox Hearth Indoor Fireplace SV45CTS Series User Manual
Lenovo Computer Accessories 0A33942 User Manual
LG Electronics DVD Player DVX692H User Manual
LG Electronics Headphones X 1 User Manual
Lincoln Electric Welder 1GX User Manual
Lindy Switch 32254 User Manual
Magic Chef Oven EWTO7S10 User Manual
Makita Blower XBU01 User Manual
Makita Cordless Saw 5093DWA User Manual
Memorex DVD Player MVD2037 User Manual